P11 - 160824 (1) - Compressed
P11 - 160824 (1) - Compressed
P11 - 160824 (1) - Compressed
Paper 11
Study Notes
SYLLABUS 2022
www.icmai.in
First Edition : August 2022
Reprint : November 2022
Reprint : January 2023
Reprint : March 2023
Reprint : June 2023
Reprint : August 2023
Reprint : January 2024
Reprint : March 2024
Reprint : May 2024
Revised Edition: July 2024
Price: ` 600.00
Published by :
Directorate of Studies
The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
CMA Bhawan, 12, Sudder Street, Kolkata - 700 016
studies@icmai.in
Printed at:
Copyright of these Study Notes is reserved by the Institute of Cost Accountants of India and prior permission
from the Institute is necessary for reproduction of the whole or any part thereof.
Copyright © 2024 by The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
PAPER 11 : FINANCIAL MANAGEMENT AND
BUSINESS DATA ANALYTICS
Syllabus Structure:
The syllabus comprises the following topics and study weightage:
B
20%
A
80%
Learning Environment – Paper 11
Subject Title FINANCIAL MANAGEMENT AND BUSINESS DATA ANALYTICS
Subject Code FMDA
Paper No. 11
Course The subject Financial Management provides the fundamental concepts of finance and also
Descriptionintroduces the larger domain of financial markets and institutions – the main providers of
business finance. It also focuses on important tools for financial analyses. The subject offers a
detail discussion of theories and methods associated with capital structure decisions, working
capital management and capital budgeting decisions with adequate examples of real-life decision
situations.
The subject Business Data Analytics provides an overview of application of data science in
business decisions and offers a detail discussion on the techniques of data preparation, data
presentation, data analysis and building financial models.
CMA Course 1. Interpret and appreciate emerging national and global concerns affecting organizations and
Learning be in a state of readiness for business management.
Objectives a. Identify emerging national and global forces responsible for enhanced/varied business
(CMLOs) challenges.
b. Assess how far these forces pose threats to the status-quo and creating new opportunities.
c. Find out ways and means to convert challenges into opportunities
2. Acquire skill sets for critical thinking, analyses and evaluations, comprehension, syntheses,
and applications for optimization of sustainable goals.
a. Be equipped with the appropriate tools for analyses of business risks and hurdles.
b. Learn to apply tools and systems for evaluation of decision alternatives with a 360-degree
approach.
c. Develop solutions through critical thinking to optimize sustainable goals.
3. Develop an understanding of strategic, financial, cost and risk-enabled performance
management in a dynamic business environment.
a. Study the impacts of dynamic business environment on existing business strategies.
b. Learn to adopt, adapt and innovate financial, cost and operating strategies to cope up with
the dynamic business environment.
c. Come up with strategies and tactics that create sustainable competitive advantages.
4. Learn to design the optimal approach for management of legal, institutional, regulatory
and ESG frameworks, stakeholders’ dynamics; monitoring, control, and reporting with
application-oriented knowledge.
a. Develop an understanding of the legal, institutional and regulatory and ESG frameworks
within which a firm operates.
b. Learn to articulate optimal responses to the changes in the above frameworks.
c. Appreciate stakeholders’ dynamics and expectations, and develop appropriate reporting
mechanisms to address their concerns.
5. Prepare to adopt an integrated cross functional approach for decision management and
execution with cost leadership, optimized value creations and deliveries.
a. Acquire knowledge of cross functional tools for decision management.
b. Take an industry specific approach towards cost optimization, and control to achieve
sustainable cost leadership.
c. Attain exclusive knowledge of data science and engineering to analyze and create value.
Subject A. Financial Management
Learning 1. To obtain in-depth knowledge on different fundamental concepts of finance and understand
Objectives the role of financial management in dynamic business environment. (CMLO 3a, b)
[SLOB(s)]
2. To obtain an overview of financial institutions and their role in business, financial markets
and the instruments traded therein through which a business procure capital for short term,
medium term and long term. (CMLO 1a, b)
3. To acquire application-oriented knowledge of various tools for financial analysis in order to
assist the management in planning and decision making. (CMLO 2a, b, 3b)
4. To develop critical thinking and problem-solving competencies so that students can assist
the management in selecting a suitable capital structure that caters to a balanced approach
towards risk, return and value. (CMLO 2b, 3c)
5. To develop critical thinking and problem-solving competencies so that students can assist the
management in ensuring optimum management of working capital and capital expenditure in
existing as well as new projects. (CMLO 5a, b)
B. Business Data Analytics
1. To develop a detail understanding of the fundamental concepts of data science and its
expected role in business decisions. (CMLO 5a, c)
2. To equip oneself with application-oriented knowledge in data preparation, data presentation
and finally data analysis and modelling to facilitate quality business decisions. (CMLO 5a, c)
Subject A. Financial Management
Learning SLOC(s)
Outcome
1. Students will be able to compare various financial instruments and guide management in
[SLOC(s)]
selecting the most suitable one to be availed by the management for procuring funds.
and
Application 2. They will be able to apply appropriate analytical tools to identify the cause(s) behind any
Skill [APS] business problem.
3. Students will attain abilities to guide the management in identifying the most suitable capital
structure with due considerations for risks, costs, and return.
4. They will be able to assist leadership team in following the appropriate polices and processes
for managing various components of working capital with a risk-based approach to ensure
optimum utilization of short-term funds.
5. They will be able to guide the management in selecting the best alternatives for sourcing and
deploying long term funds.
APS
1. Students will be able to frame and articulate policies and procedures for short- and long-term
fund management and prepare analytical statements with root cause analyses of risks and
challenges for optimising capital allocation.
2. Students will attain necessary skills to prepare comparative reports and analyses for
evaluating alternative capital structures and funding from various sources for optimisation of
financial costs.
3. They will acquire necessary skill to appraise long term projects and provide the best
comparative view while considering a capital budgeting decision.
B. Business Data Analytics
SLOC(s)
1. They will be able to apply contemporary data analysis tools encompassing big data analytics,
sophisticated programming and econometric modelling in solving real business problems.
APS
1. Students will attain application-oriented skills for data analyses, interpret results and draw
inferences from the outcome.
2. Students will attain capabilities to build automated financial models that will provide results
for sensitivity analyses for changes in decision parameters.
Module wise Mapping of SLOB(s)
Module Additional Resources (Research articles,
Topics SLOB Mapped
No. books, case studies, blogs)
A. Financial Management
1 Fundamentals Van Horne James C. and Wachowicz John M., To obtain in-depth knowledge on
of Financial Jr. Fundamentals of Financial Management, different fundamental concepts
Management Prentice Hall, Latest Edition. of finance and understand the
role of financial management in
dynamic business environment.
Khan, M Y and P K Jain, Financial
Management- Text, Problems and Cases,
McGraw-Hill Publishing Co., New Delhi,
2019.
The popularity of ‘data analytics’ is on the rise. Whereas, ‘financial management’ and ‘corporate finance’ is
maintaining the positions of popularity. If we look at the average interest over time, ‘financial management’ is
the most sought-after search word in India as well as worldwide.
In recent years, the role of financial analysis is being taken over by a new wave of digital transformation, which
includes advanced analytics, in corporate finance. These technologies are spawning disruptive new business
models and transforming the procedures that serve as the basis for corporate performance management.
A successful bonding of data analytics and financial management may culminate into the production of in-
depth analyses to answer business-specific issues and anticipate potential future financial scenarios. It may
help to develop a corporate plan based on trustworthy, verifiable findings rather than intuition. Data analytics
is the science and art of integrating data in a logical and relevant manner in order to anticipate an enterprise’s
financial position - profitability, cash flow, and company value.
Data analytics enables firms to obtain visibility and a deeper understanding of revenue, cost, profitability, and
cash flow, as well as to identify areas requiring attention to influence good business results more quickly than
would be feasible otherwise.
In such a scenario, it has become almost imperative for the finance managers to have an understanding of data
analytics. And, this is the primary reason behind introducing the modules on ‘Business Data Analytics’ in this
Paper.
Contents as per Syllabus
SECTION A: FINANCIAL MANAGEMENT 01 - 552
Module 1. Fundamentals of Financial Management 3-50
1.1 Introduction to Financial Management
1.2 Time Value of Money
1.3 Risk and Return
PV TABLES 645-648
SECTION-A
Financial Management
Fundamentals of Financial Management
Fundamentals of Financial
1
Management
This Module Includes
1.1 Introduction to Financial Management
1.2 Time Value of Money
1.3 Risk and Return
F
inance is called “The science of money”. It studies the principles and the methods of obtaining control
of money from those who have saved it, and of administering it by those into whose control it passes.
Finance is a branch of economics till 1890. Economics is defined as study of the efficient use of scarce
resources.
The decisions made by business firm in production, marketing, finance and personnel matters form the subject
matters of economics. Finance is the process of conversion of accumulated funds to productive use. It is so
intermingled with other economic forces that there is difficulty in appreciating the role of it plays.
Howard and Upton in their book Introduction to Business Finance define Finance “as that administrative area or
set of administrative functions in an organisation which relate with the arrangement of cash and credit so that the
organisation may have the means to carry out its objectives as satisfactorily as possible”.
In the words of Parhter and Wert, “Business finance deals primarily with raising, administering and disbursing
funds by privately owned business units operating in nonfinancial fields of industry”.
Corporate finance is concerned with budgeting, financial forecasting, cash management, credit administration,
investment analysis and fund procurement of the business concern and the business concern needs to adopt modern
technology and application suitable to the global environment.
Financial Management is managerial activity which is concerned with the planning and controlling of the firm’s
financial resources.
Howard and Upton define Financial Management “as an application of general managerial principles to the area of
financial decision-making”.
Weston and Brigham define Financial Management “as an area of financial decision making, harmonizing
individual motives and enterprise goal”.
According to Van Horne, “Financial management is concerned with the acquisition, financing and management of
assets with some overall goal in mind.”
From the above definitions, two aspects of financial management are quite apparent - (i) procurement of funds and
(ii) effective utilisation of funds. Procurement of funds indicates determining the sources of funds, deciding on
the methods of raising funds etc. Effective utilisation of funds implies the investment decisions, capital budgeting
decisions, working capital management decisions etc.
Objectives of Financial
Management
(i) Profit Maximization: In the economic theory, the behaviour of a firm is analysed in terms of profit
maximization. It implies that a firm either produces maximum output for a given amount of input or uses
minimum input for producing a given output. So, profit is considered to be the main driving force in business.
A firm should manage all aspects of the business in such a way that revenues are maximised and costs are
minimised to obtain maximum profit. Arguments in favour and against of profit maximisation are discussed
in subsequent section of this chapter.
(ii) Value/ Wealth Maximization: The earlier objective of profit maximization is now replaced by value/ wealth
maximization. Since profit maximization is a limited one it cannot be the sole objective of a firm. Value
creation is the driving force behind financial management. Creating wealth for shareholders by increasing the
value for their investment is the key goal of financial management today. Maximising the market value of the
firm can be calculated by using the formula
MV= MVE+MVD
Where,
When the book values and market values of debts are the same, value or wealth maximization essentially reflects
maximisation of market value per equity share.
Arguments in favour and against of profit maximisation are discussed in subsequent section of this chapter.
Another objective of financial management is to trade-off between risk and return. For this, the firm has to make
efficient use of economic resources mainly capital.
Functions of
Financial Management
Working
Capital Dividend Retained
Capital
Budgeting Policy Earnings
Management
Capital
Cost of
Structure Leverages
Capital
Decisions
Shareholder’s value/wealth = No. of shares owned × Current market price per equity share
Higher the share price per share, the greater will be the shareholder’s wealth.
Arguments in favour of Value/Wealth Maximization:
(i) Due to wealth maximization, the short-term money lenders get their payments in time.
(ii) The long-time lenders too get a fixed rate of interest on their investments.
(iii) The employees share in the wealth gets increased.
(iv) The various resources are put to economical and efficient use.
Argument against Value/Wealth Maximization:
(i) It is socially undesirable.
(ii) It is not a descriptive idea.
(iii) Only stock holders’ wealth maximization does not lead to firm’s wealth maximization.
(iv) The objective of wealth maximization is endangered when ownership and management are separated. In spite
of the arguments against wealth maximization, it is the most appropriative objective of a firm.
From the above discussion, wealth maximization is a long-term sustainable objective of a firm. Wealth maximization
objective of the firm is a better and broader objective compared to the profit maximization objective. Wealth
maximization objective considers the following which, profit maximization doesn’t.
There is a conflict goal between the two.
Why value/wealth maximization objective considers superior than profit maximization, we may put forward some
arguments.
These are:
(i) Wealth maximization considers the cash inflows and not the profit figure.
(ii) This objective is the long-term objective of a firm.
(iii) Wealth maximization considers the risk factor, which profit maximization doesn’t.
(iv) Wealth maximization objective considers the time value of money, so the cash inflows at different points of
time are discounted to arrive at present value of cash inflows.
(v) This objective takes into account both the qualitative and quantitative aspects i.e cash inflows represent the
quantitative aspect and the net present value represents the qualitative aspect, whereas profit maximization
objective considers only the quantitative aspect.
(vi) A firm with wealth maximization pays regular dividend to shareholders whereas those having profit
maximization may not pay regular dividend.
(vii) Wealth maximization objective is preferred by shareholders.
(viii)This objective takes into account all the factors influencing the market value of shares, which profit
maximization doesn’t.
As a result, finance is required to play an ever more vital strategic role within the company. The finance manager
has emerged as a team player in the overall effort of a company to create value.
The finance manager or CFO is, therefore, concerned with all financial activities of planning, raising, allocating
and controlling the funds in an efficient manner. In addition, profit planning is another important function of the
finance manager.
This can be done by decision making in respect of the following areas:
(i) Investment decisions for obtaining maximum profitability after taking the time value of the money into
account.
(ii) Financing decisions through a balanced capital structure of Debt-Equity Ratio, sources of finance, EBIT/ EPS
computations and Interest Coverage Ratio etc.
(iii) Dividend decisions, issue of bonus shares and retention of profits with objective of maximization of market
value of the equity share.
(iv) Best utilization of fixed assets.
(v) Efficient working capital management (inventory, debtors, cash marketable securities and current liabilities).
(vi) Taking the cost of capital, risk, return and control aspects into account.
(vii) Tax administration and tax planning.
(viii) Pricing, volume of output, product-mix and cost-volume-profit analysis (CVP Analysis).
(ix) Cost control.
(x) Analyse the trends in the stock market and their impact on the price of company’s share and share buyback.
Besides, the CFO should comply the regulatory requirements in formulation of financial strategies.
The principal elements of this regulatory framework are: -
(i) Different provisions of the Companies Act, 2013.
(ii) Provisions, guidelines, rules of the Securities and Exchange Board of India Act 1992.
(iii) Provisions of Foreign Exchange Management Act, 1999.
If you become a finance manager, your ability to adapt to change, raise funds, invest in assets, and manage wisely
will affect the success of your firm and, ultimately, the overall economy as well. In an economy, efficient allocation
of resources is vital to optimal growth in that economy; it is also vital to ensuring that individuals obtain satisfaction
of their highest levels of personal wants. Thus, through efficiently acquiring, financing, and managing assets,
the financial manager contributes to the firm and to the vitality and growth of the economy as a whole.
Today’s finance manager must have the flexibility to adapt to the changing external environment if his or her
firm is to survive. The successful finance manager of tomorrow will need to supplement the traditional metrics of
performance with new methods that encourage a greater role for uncertainty and multiple assumptions. These new
methods will seek to value the flexibility inherent in initiatives – that is, the way in which taking one step offers you
the option to stop or continue down one or more paths. In short, a correct decision may involve doing something
today that in itself has small value, but gives you the option to do something of greater value in the future.
M
ost financial decisions, personal as well as business, involve time value of money considerations. Money
of the financial problems involves cash flows occurring at different points of the time. For evaluating
such cash flows an explicit consideration of the time value of money is required.
Money has time value. A rupee today is more valuable than a rupee a year hence.
So, the time value of money is an individual’s preference for possession of a given amount of money now, rather
than the same amount at some future date.
Mainly there are three reasons may be attributed to the individual’s time preference for money.
(i) Risk: We are not certain about future cash receipts. In an inflationary period, a rupee today represents a
greater real Purchasing Power than a rupee a year hence. So, an individual prefers receiving cash now.
(ii) Preference for consumption: Individuals, in general, prefer current consumption to future consumption.
(iii) Investment opportunities: Capital can be employed productively to generate positive returns. An investment
of one rupee today would grow to (1+r) a year hence (r is the rate of return earned on the investments).
1.2.2 Techniques
There are two methods of estimating time value of money which are shown below figure.
Discounting
Compounding
To find out the future value (FV) of a single cash flow, we can use the MS Excel’s built-in function.
The FV is given below:
FV (RATE, NPER, PMT, PV, TYPE)
RATE is the discount or the interest rate for a period.
NPER is the number of periods.
PMT is the equal payment (annuity) each period
PV is the present value
TYPE indicates the timing of cash flow, occurring either at the beginning or at the end of the period.
Illustration 1
If a person invests ` 1,50,000 in an investment which pays 12% rate of interest, what will be the future value of the
invested amount at the end of 10 years?
Solution:
The future value (FV) of the invested amount at the end of 10 years will be
FV = PV (1+r)n
FV = ` 1,50,000 (1 + 0.12)10
FV = ` 1,50,000 × 3.106
FV = ` 4,65,900
Doubling Period
Investor wants to know how long would take to double the investment amount at a given rate of interest. If we look
at the future value interest factor table, we find that when the interest rate is 12% it takes about 6 years to double
the amount. When the interest rate is 6%, it takes about 12 years to double the amount, so on and so forth.
There is a thumb rule of 72 that helps to find out the doubling period. According to this rule of thumb, the doubling
period is obtained by dividing 72 by the interest rate.
However, an accurate way of calculating the doubling period is the Rule of “69”.
69
Under this Rule, doubling period = 0.35 +
Interest Rate
Illustration 2
How long it will take for ` 20,000 to double at a compound rate of 8% per annum (approximately)?
Solution:
The rule of 72 is
The rule of 72 is
r = 72 Where,
n r = rate of interest or return
n = number of investment years
72
No. of years =
Annual rate of Interest
72
No. of years (n) =
8
No. of years (n) = 9 years
Future value of single and multiple cash flows can be calculated by using the following formulae:
Table 1.1 Future Value of Single and Multiple Cash Flows
1
n in above equation called the discounting factor or the present value interest (PVIFi,n), the value of
1 + r)
(PVIFi,n) for several combinations of i and n.
To find out the present value (FV) of a single cash flow, we can use the MS Excel’s built-in function.
The PV is given below:
PV (RATE, NPER, PMT, FV, TYPE)
RATE is the discount or the interest rate for a period.
NPER is the number of periods.
PMT is the equal payment (annuity) each period
FV is the Future value
TYPE indicates the timing of cash flow, occurring either at the beginning or at the end of the period.
Illustration 3
Suppose someone promise to give you ` 1,000 three years hence. What is the present value of this amount if the
interest rate is 10%?
Solution:
The present value can be calculated by discounting ` 1,000, to the present point of time, as follows:
Value of three years hence = ` 1,000
1
Value two years hence = ` 1,000 × Value one year hence = ` 1,000 ×
(1 + 0.10)
1
Value one year hence = ` 1,000 ×
(1 + 0.10) 2
1
Value now (present value) = ` 1,000 × = ` 1,000 × 0.751 = ` 751
(1 + 0.10)3
1.2.4 Annuity and Perpetuity
(A) Annuity
An annuity is a series of equal payments or receipts occurring over a specified number of periods. The time period
between two successive payments is called payment period or rent period. The word annuity in broader sense
includes payments which can be annual, semi-annual, quarterly or any other length of time. For example, when a
company set aside a fixed sum each year to meet a future obligation, it is using annuity.
Future Value of Ordinary Annuity
In an ordinary annuity, payments or receipts occur at the end of each period. In a ten-year ordinary annuity, the last
payment is made at the end of the tenth year.
Future Value of Ordinary Annuity can be calculated by using the following formula:
(1 + r) n − 1
FVAn= A
r
Or
FVAn= A[{(1+r)n-1}/r]
Where,
FVAn = Future value of an annuity which is the sum of the compound amounts of all payments and a
duration of n periods
A = Amount of each instalment or constant periodic flow
r = Interest rate per period
n = Number of periods
Illustration 4
Apex Ltd. has an obligation to redeem ` 50 crore bonds 6 years hence. How much should the company deposit
annually in a sinking fund account wherein it earns 12% interest, to accumulate ` 50 crore in 6 years’ time?
Solution:
The future value interest factor for a 6-year annuity, given an interest rate 12% is:
(1+0.126)-1
FVIFAn=6, r=12% = = 8.115
0.12
The annul sinking fund deposit should be:
` 5, 00, 00, 000
=
8.115
= ` 61,61,429.00
Present Value of Ordinary Annuity can be calculated by using the following formula:
PVAn= A [{1 – (1/1+ r) n}/r]
where,
PVAn = Present value of an annuity which is the sum of the compound amounts of all payments and a duration
of n periods
A = Amount of each instalment or constant periodic flow
r = Discount rate
n = Number of periods
[{1- (1/1+r)n}/r] is called present value interest factor.
(B) Perpetuity:
Perpetuity is an annuity that occurs indefinitely. The stream of cash flows continues for an infinite amount of
time. Fixed coupon payments on permanently invested (irredeemable) sums of money are prime examples of
perpetuities. Scholarships paid perpetually from an endowment fund. The value of the perpetuity is finite because
receipts that are anticipated far in the future have extremely low present value.
By definition, in a perpetuity, time period, n, is so large (i.e., mathematically n approaches infinity) that tends to
become zero and the formula for a perpetuity simply becomes
Present value of a perpetuity may be written as follows:
P∞ = A × PVIF Ar,∞
Where,
So, P∞ = 1
r
Or,
Perpetuity
Present value of perpetuity =
Interest rate
EV 1/n
CAGR= − 1 × 100
BV
Where, EV= Ending balance is the value of the investment at the end of the investment period.
BV= Beginning balance is the value of the investment at the beginning of the investment period.
N = Number of years amount invested.
CAGR may be used in the following cases:
(i) Calculating and communicating the average returns of investment funds.
CAGR
Illustration 5
Find the present value of ` 1,000 receivable 6 years hence if the rate of discount is 10%.
Solution:
` 1,000 × PVIF10%, 6 = ` 1,000 × 0.5645 = ` 564.5
Illustration 6
Find the present value of ` 1,000 receivable 20 years hence if the discount rate is 8%.
Solution:
We obtain the answer as follows:
Illustration 7
An individual deposited ` 1,00,000 in a bank @ 12% compound interest per annum. How much he would receive
after 20 years ?
Given, FVIF12, 20 = 9.646
Solution:
FV= PV (1+r) n
Or, FV= PV (FVIFr, n),
Where,
PV = Present value or sum invested ` 100,000
FV = Future value
r = Interest rate i.e 12% or 0.12
n = Number of years i.e., 20
FV = PV (FVIFr, n)
FV = `100,000 × 9.646
FV = ` 9,64,600
Illustration 8
Mr. X is depositing ` 20,000 in a recurring bank deposit which pays 9% p.a. compounded interest. How much
amount Mr. A will get at the end of 5th Year.
Solution:
Formula for calculating future value of annuity
FVAn= A[{(1+r)n-1}/r]
where,
FVAn = Future value of an annuity which is the sum of the compound amounts of all payments and a duration
of n periods
Illustration 10
Ascertain the future value and compound interest of an amount of ` 75,000 at 8% compounded semi-annually for
5 years.
Solution:
Amount Invested = ` 75,000
Rate of Interest = 8%
Illustration 11
An investor expects a perpetual sum of ` 5,000 annually from his investment. What is the present value of the
perpetuity if interest rate is 10%?
Solution:
Perpetuity
Present value of a perpetuity =
Interest Rate
A
PV = = ` 50,000
i
R
eturn and risk are the two critical factors in investment decisions. They are closely linked. If high risk is
involved, the required return on the project should also be high. So, the level of risk is measured first and
then the level of return.
(ii) It helps in predicting returns from a security based on actual returns from it over years.
(iii) Companies can use historical data to predict future earnings
(iv) Government and other agencies can use actual results from the past data.
Risk
B. Unsystematic Risk
These are risks that emanate from known and controllable factors, which are unique and / or related to a particular
security or industry. These risks can be eliminated by diversification of portfolio.
(i) Business Risk: It is the volatility in revenues and profits of particular Company due to its market conditions,
product mix, competition, etc. It may arise due to external reasons or (Government policies specific to that
kind of industry) internal reasons (labour efficiency, management, etc.)
(ii) Financial Risk: These are risks that are associated with the Capital Structure of a Company. A Company with
no Debt Financing, has no financial risk. Higher the Financial Leverage, higher the Financial Risk. These may
also arise due to short term liquidity problems, shortage in working capital due to funds tied in working capital
and receivables, etc.
(iii) Default Risk: These arise due to default in meeting the financial obligations on time. Non-payment of financial
dues on time increases the insolvency and bankruptcy costs.
Illustration 12
The current market price of a share is ` 600. An investor buys 100 shares. After one year he sells these shares at a
price of ` 720 and also receives the dividend of ` 30 per share. Find the total return (%) of the investor.
Solution:
There are two commonly methods used in calculating average annual returns: (a) Arithmetic Mean and
(b) Geometric Mean.
When an investor wants to know the central tendency of a series of returns, the arithmetic mean is the appropriate
measure. It represents the typical performance for a single period.
If you want to calculate the average compound rate of growth that has actually occurred over multiple periods, the
arithmetic mean is not appropriate. Then geometric mean is used.
The expected return is simply a weighted average of the possible returns, with the weights being the probabilities
of occurrence. The expected rate of return can be calculated by using the formula given below:
P is the probability
Economic Conditions (1) Rate of Return (%) (2) Probability (3) Expected Rate of Return (4) = (2)×(3)
Growth 18.0 0.25 4.5
Expansion 11.0 0.25 2.75
Stagnation 1.0 0.25 0.25
Decline -5.0 0.25 -1.25
Expected Rate of Return 6.25
Illustration 13
X Ltd. has forecasted returns on its share with the following probability distribution:
Find out the following: (a) Expected Rate of Return (b) Variance (c) Standard Deviation
Solution:
(a) Expected Rate of Return
Expected Return can be calculated by using the following formula:
E(R) = R1 × P1+ R2 × P2+ R3 × P3+ R4 × P4+ .....................+ Rn × Pn
= (-20 × 0.05) + (-10 × 0.05) + (-5 × 0.10) + (5 × 0.10) + (10 × 0.15) + (18 × 0.25) + (20 × 0.25) + (30 ×
0.05) = 11%
σ = √150 = 12.25
(i) Coefficient of Variation: Variance or standard deviation are the absolute measure of risk. Standard deviation
can sometimes be misleading in comparing the risk.
The standard deviation when compared with the expected returns is known as the coefficient of variation
Standard Deviation
Coefficient of Variation (CV) =
Expected Value
Thus, the coefficient of variation is a measure of relative dispersion (risk) – a measure of risk “per unit of expected
return.” The larger the CV, the larger the relative risk of the investment.
Illustration 14
Consider, two securities, A and B, whose normal probability distributions of one-year returns have the following
characteristics:
Security A Security B
Expected return, [E(R)] 0.08 0.24
Standard deviation, (σ) 0.06 0.08
Coefficient of variation, (CV) 0.75 0.33
Comment on the above information.
Solution:
From the above information it is found that the standard deviation of Security B is larger than that of Security A.
So, Security B is the riskier investment opportunity with standard deviation as risk measurement tool.
However, relative to the size of expected return, Security A has greater variation. So, Security A is higher risky
investment than Security B.
(ii) Beta: The sensitivity of a security to market movements is called beta (β). When an investor wants to invest his
money in a portfolio of securities, beta is the proper measure of risk. Beta measures systematic risk i.e., that which
affects the market as a whole and hence cannot be eliminated through diversification.
Beta depends on the following factor:
(i) Standard Deviation (Risk) of the Security or Portfolio.
(ii) Standard Deviation (Risk) of the Market.
(iii) Correlation between the Security and Market.
According to the Capital Asset Pricing Model, the required rate of return is equivalent to the risk-free return plus
risk premium.
E(RP) = RF + { βP × (RM -RF)}
Where,
E(RP) = Expected Return on Portfolio
RF = Risk Free Rate of Interest/ Return
βP = Portfolio Beta or Risk Factor
RM = Expected Return on Market Portfolio
Beta is measured as follows:
Cov ( A.M .)
β =
σ M2
Cov(A,M) = Covariance of returns on an individual company’s security (A) with returns for market as a
whole (M).
We know,
Cov(A,M) = r(A,M) x σA x σM
If the value of changes in different ranges, accordingly, risk of the security would be changes. Inferences are shown
below:
Inferences
Illustration 15
Solution:
r( AM ) × σ A × σ M
Beta ( β ) =
σ M2
0.72 × 12 × 9 77.76
= = 0.96
92 81
Illustration 16
The stock price and dividend history of X Ltd. are given below:
Solution:
(i) Computation of annual rates of return
Closing Share Price (`) Dividend per Share (`) Annual rate of return
Year
(St) (Dt) [(St/St-1)-1) + Dt
Year Annual Return (Rt) Average Return (%) (Rm) (Rt- Rm) (Rt – Rm)2
2018 7.00 5.27 1.73 2.89
2019 4.20 5.27 -1.07 1.14
2020 6.37 5.27 1.10 1.22
2021 3.84 5.27 -1.43 2.03
2022 4.15 5.27 -1.11 1.23
2023 6.03 5.27 0.77 0.59
Total 9.20
Variance
Illustration 17
The following information is given:
Security Beta: 1.2
Risk-free rate: 4%
Expected market return: 12%
Calculate expected rate of return on the security.
Solution:
E(RS) = RF + { βS × (RM – RF)}
Substituting these data into the CAPM equation, we get
E(RS) = 4% + [1.20 × (12% – 4%)
= 4% + 9.6% = 13.6%.
Solved Case 1
Compute the future values of (1) an initial ` 100 compounded annually for 10 years at 10% and (2) an annuity of
` 100 for 10 years at 10%.
Solution:
The future value of an investment compounded annually = Fn = P(1+i)n = P × FIVFi,n = F10 = ` 100
(1+0.10)10 = ` 100 (2.5937) = ` 259.4
The future value of an annuity = A × FVIFAin = ` 100 × 15.937 = ` 1593.7
Solved Case 2
A note (secured premium note) is available for ` 1,400. It offer, including one immediate payment, 10 annual
payments of ` 210. Compute the rate of return (yield) on the note.
Solution:
⇒ ` 1,400 = ` 210 (1 + PVIFAr,9)
⇒ (1 + PVIFAr,9) = ` 1,400/ ` 210 = 6.67
(1 + PVIFAr,9) = 6.67 – 1 = 5.67
From the future value table, the closet values are 5.7590 (0.10) and 5.3282 (0.11). By interpolation, r = 10.2%.
Solved Case 3
The shares of ABC Ltd. are currently selling for ` 100 on which the expected dividend is ` 4. Compute the total
return on the shares if the earnings or dividends are likely to grow at (a) 5 % (b) 10 % and (c) 0 (zero) % (no
growth).
Solution:
r = (D1/P0) + g
(a) Rate of growth, 5%:
= (` 4/` 100) + 0.05 = 0.04 + 0.05 = 9%
(b) Rate of growth, 10%:
r = (` 4/` 100) + 0.10 = 14%
(c) Rate of growth, 0 (zero) % (no growth):
r = ` (4/ 100) = 4 %.
Solved Case 4
ABC Ltd. is considering a proposal to buy a machine for ` 30,000. The expected cash flows after taxes from the
machine for a period of 3 consecutive years are ` 20,000 each. After the expiry of the useful life of the machine,
the seller has guaranteed its repurchase at ` 2,000. The firm’s cost of capital is 10% and the risk adjusted discount
rate is 18%. Should the company accept the proposal of purchasing the machine?
Solution:
Solved Case 5
The Hypothetical Ltd is examining two mutually exclusive proposals. The management of the company uses
certainty equivalents (CE) approach to evaluate new investment proposals. From the following information
pertaining to these projects, advise the company as to which project should be taken up by it.
Proposal A Proposal B
Year
CFAT (` ) CE CFAT (` ) CE
0 (25,000) 1.0 (25,000) 1.0
1 15,000 0.8 9,000 0.9
2 15,000 0.7 18,000 0.8
3 15,000 0.6 12,000 0.7
4 15,000 0.5 16,000 0.4
The firm’s cost of capital is 12%, and risk-free borrowing rate is 6%.
Solution:
NPV under CE method: Project A
Exercise
A. Theoretical Questions:
� Multiple Choice Questions
(a) ` 11,000
(b) ` 19,310
(c) ` 15,000
(d) None of the above
7. How much amount should an investor invest now in order to receive five annuities starting from the end
of this year of ` 10,000 if the rate of interest offered by bank is 10 % per annum?
(a) ` 40,000
(b) ` 45,000
(c) ` 37,910
(d) none of the above
8. A bank offers 12% compound interests payable quarterly. If you deposit ` 2,000 now, how much it will
grow at the end of 5 years?
(a) ` 3,050
(b) ` 3,430
(c) ` 3,612
(d) ` 3,722
9. A company wants to repay a loan of ` 5,00,000, 10 years from today. What amount should it invest each
year for 10 years if the funds can earn 8% per annum. The first investment will be made at the beginning
of this year.
(a) ` 50,000
(b) ` 31,950
(c) ` 40,000
(d) ` 32,950
10. Risk of two securities having different expected return can be compared with
(a) standard deviation of securities
(b) variance of securities
(c) coefficient of variation
(d) mean
11. A portfolio consists of two securities and the expected return on two securities is 12% and 16% respectively.
Calculate return of portfolio if first security accounts for 40% of portfolio.
(a) 14%
(b) 14.4%
(c) 16%
(d) 12%
12. If the rate of interest is 12%, what are the doubling periods as per the rule 72 and the rule of 69 respectively?
(a) 5 Years and 5.2 Years
(b) 5.8 Years and 5.3 Years
(c) 6 Years and 6.1 Years
(d) 6.5 Years and 6.6 Years
13. To create a minimum variance portfolio, in what proportion should the two securities be mixed if the
following information is given S1 = 10%, S2 = 12%, P12 = 0.6?
(a) 0.72 and 0.28
(b) 0.70 and 0.30
(c) 0.60 and 0.40
(d) 0.50 and 0.40
14. A portfolio consisting of two risky securities can be made risk less i.e., Sp = 0, if
(a) the securities are perfectly positively correlated
(b) the securities are perfectly negatively correlated
(c) if the correlation ranges between 0 to 1
(d) if the correlation ranges between -1 to +1
15. Efficient portfolios are those portfolios, which offer (for a given level of risk)
(a) maximum return
(b) minimum return
(c) average return
(d) positive return
16. CAPM accounts for -
(a) systematic risk
(b) unsystematic risk
(c) both of the above
(d) moderate risk
17. Calculate the future value of `1,000 invested in State Bank Cash Certificate scheme for 2 years @5.5%
p.a., compounded semi- annually.
(a) ` 1,114.62
(b) ` 1,104.62
(c) ` 1,401.51
(d) ` 1,141.51
18. MAYANK Ltd. employs 12% as nominal required rate of return to evaluate its new investment projects.
In the recent meeting of the Board of Directors, it has been decided to protect the interest of shareholders
against purchasing power loss due to inflation. The expected inflation rate in the economy is 5%. What is
the real discount rate?
(a) 6.67%
(b) 6%
(c) 5%
(d) 6.5
19. Which of the following is the main objective of financial management?
(a) Revenue Maximisation
(b) Profit Maximisation
(c) Wealth Maximisation
(d) Cost Minimisation
20. Which one of the following activities is outside the purview of financing decision in financial management?
(a) Identification of the source of funds
(b) Measurement of the cost of funds
(c) Deciding on the time of raising the funds
(d) Deciding on the utilization of the funds
21. “Shareholders’ wealth” in a firm is reflected by:
(a) the number of people employed in the firm.
(b) the book value of the firm’s assets less the book value of its liabilities.
(c) the amount of salary paid to its employees.
(d) the market price per share of the firm
22. Objective of Financial Management is
(a) Management of Liquidity
(b) Maximization of Profit
(c) Maximization of Shareholders’ Wealth
(d) Management of Fixed Assets
23. The traditional view of financial management looks at :
(a) Arrangement of short-term and long-term funds from financial institutions.
(b) Mobilisation of funds through financial instruments
(c) Orientation of Finance function with Accounting function
(d) All of the above
24. Calculate the future value of ` 1,000 invested in State Bank Cash Certificate scheme for 2 years @ 5.5%
p.a., compounded semi-annually.
(a) ` 1,114.62
(b) ` 1,104.62
(c) ` 1,401.51
(d) ` 1,141.51.
25. From the following select one factor which is application of fund.
(a) Issue of share capital
(b) Decrease in working capital
(c) Increase in working capital
(d) None of the above
26. Which of the following are sources of funds?
(a) Issue of bonus shares
(b) Issue of shares against the purchase of fixed assets
(c) Conversion of debentures into shares
(d) None of the above
27. A risk associated with project and way considered by well diversified stockholder is classified as
(a) expected risk
(b) beta risk
(c) industry risk
(d) returning risk
28. Which of the following are treated as long term investments?
(a) Non-current investments
(b) Trade Investments
(c) Sinking fund investments
(d) All of the above
29. Investment decision is concerned with :
(a) Selection of asset in which funds will be invested by a firm
(b) Capital- mix or capital structure of a firm
(c) Distribution of profits of a firm to the shareholders
(d) None of the above
37. The term means manipulation of accounts in a way so as to conceal vital facts and present the
financial statements in a way to show a better position than what it actually is.
(a) window dressing
(b) creative accounting
(c) window accounting
(d) modified accounting
38. Collateralized borrowing and lending obligation (CBLO) is a discounted instrument available in electronic
book entry for the maturity period ranging from -------------.
(a) 1 day to 19 days
(b) 1 day to 15 days
(c) 1 day to 30 days
(d) None of the above
39. IPO refers to ; the first time a company comes to public to raise money.
(a) Immediate Public Offer
(b) Immediate Public Offering
(c) Initial Public Offer
(d) Initial Public Offering
40. SPO refers to , the second and subsequent time a company raises money from the public directly.
(a) Second Public Offering
(b) Subsequent Public Offering
(c) Subsequent Public Offer
(d) Secondary Public Offering
41. Liquid Liability = Current Liability – Bank Overdraft –
(a) Cash Credit
(b) Trade Credit
(c) Both of the above
(d) None of the above
Answers:
1 a 2 c 3 b 4 b 5 c 6 b
7 c 8 c 9 b 10 c 11 b 12 c
13 a 14 b 15 a 16 a 17 a 18 a
19 c 20 d 21 d 22 c 23 d 24 a
25 c 26 d 27 b 28 d 29 a 30 c
31 a 32 c 33 d 34 a 35 d 36 a
37 a 38 a 39 d 40 d 41 a
1. Time value of money signifies that the value of a unit of money remains unchanged during different time
periods.
2. Time value of a unit of money is different over different periods on account of the reinvestment
opportunities with the firms.
3. Cash flows accruing to the firms at different time periods are directly comparable.
4. Either compounding or discounting technique can be used, to make heterogeneous cash flows comparable.
5. Effective and nominal rate of interest remain the same irrespective of the frequency of compounding.
6. Effective rate of interest is positively correlated with frequency of compounding.
7. To arrive at the present value of cash flows, discounting is done at the rate which represents opportunity
cost of funds.
8. Present value tables for annuity can be directly applied to mixed stream of cash flows.
9. To facilitate comparison of cashflows that are occurring at different time periods, the technique of either
compounding all cash flows to the terminal year or discounting all cash flows to the time zero period can
be adopted.
10. Return on any financial asset consists of current yield and capital yield.
11. Risk of an individual financial asset refers to variability of its returns around its mean returns.
12. Return of a portfolio is simply weighted average of returns on individual securities in the portfolio
multiplied by their corresponding proportions (weights) in the portfolio.
13. For a given correlation coefficient, a minimum variance portfolio can be created, for which risk of
portfolio will be less than the risk of any security in the portfolio.
14. Correlation among the securities in the portfolio has nothing to do with the risk of portfolio.
15. If a portfolio consists of two securities, which are perfectly positively correlated, the risk of portfolio will
simply be the weighted average of the standard deviations of individual securities.
16. A portfolio consisting of two risky securities can be made riskless, if the securities are perfectly negatively
correlated.
17. Efficient frontier consists of those portfolios which offer maximum risk for a given level of expected
returns.
18. In CAPM, Beta represents total risk, i.e., systematic and unsystematic risk.
19. The point of tangency between the efficient frontier and risk-return indifference curve provides optimal
portfolio for the investor concerned.
20. Security market line (SML) and Capital market line (CML) are the same.
Answers:
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
F T F T F T T F T T
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
T T T F T T F F T F
Answers:
B. Numerical Questions:
� Comprehensive Numerical Problems
1. Mrs. P deposited ` 1,00,000 on January 2024 in a fixed deposit scheme with a nationalised bank for five
years. The maturity value of the fixed deposit is ` 2,00,000. Compute the rate of interest compounded
annually.
2. A company has issued debentures of ` 50 lakh to be repaid after 7 years. How much should the company
invest in a sinking fund earning 12 % in order to be able to repay debentures?
3. XYZ Ltd. has borrowed ` 5,00,000 to be repaid in five equal annual payments (interest and principal both).
The rate of interest is 16%. Compute the amount of each payment.
4. The ABC Ltd. company expects to receive ` 1,00,000 for a period of 10 years from a new project it has
just undertaken. Assuming a 10 % rate of interest, how much would be the present value of this annuity?
5. A life insurance company offers a 10-year single premium plan. According to the policy conditions, the
investor has to pay ` 1,00,000 at the beginning of first year and he will receive a pension of ` 16,000 at the
beginning of the second year onwards. What will be the yield generated by the investor?
6. Share of a company is traded at ` 60. An investor expects the company to pay dividend of ` 3 per share,
from one year now. The expected price one year now is ` 78.50.
(a) What is the expected dividend yield, rate of price change and holding period yield?
(b) If the beta of the share is 1.5, risk free rate is 6 % and the market risk premium is 10%, then calculate
the required rate of return.
Answer:
1 14.86% 2 ` 4.96 lakh
3 ` 1,52,704.39 4 ` 6,14,500
5 9.60% 6 (a) 5%, 30.83% and 35.83%; (b) 21%
Unsolved Case(s)
1. You want to borrow ` 30 lakh to buy a flat. You approach a bank which charges 13% interest. You can pay `4
lakh per year towards loan amortisation. What should be loan amortization period? .
2. Mr. X is the Chief Financial Officer (CFO) of ABC Ltd. in Kolkata. His company has performed in line with
expectations over the past year. He is currently preparing a financial blue print for the next five years. First,
he tried to forecast sales for the next five years. This is so because fixed and working capital needs depend on
sales. Therefore, these two items are estimated. He also collected data on possible profits in the coming years.
In this way, one can know how much money the company will provide. The remaining funds are arranged
externally by the company. He is also considering seeking funding from outside the company. Identify the
concept referred to in the above case and write any two points of importance of the financial concept, so
identified.
3. After completing her MBA, Mrs. R. Sharma took over the family food processing business manufacturing
pickles, jams and squashes. Started by her grandmother, the company was doing well, but had very high fixed
operating costs and poor cash flow. Now, she wants to modernize and diversify it. She approached a financial
consultant, who told her that approximately ` 50 lakh would be required for modernization and expansion
programme. He also informed her that the stock market was going through a bullish phase.
(a) After considering the above discussion, name the source of finance Mrs. Sharma should not choose for
financing the modernization and expansion of her food processing business. Give one reason in support of
your answer.
(b) Explain two other factors she should keep in mind while taking this decision.
4. Given the uneven streams of cash flows shown in the following table:
Cash Flow Stream
End of Year A (`) B (`)
1 50,000 10,000
2 40,000 20,000
3 30,000 30,000
4 20,000 40,000
5 10,000 50,000
Total 1,50,000 1,50,000
Answer the following:
(a) Find the present value of each stream, using a 10% discount rate.
(b) Compare the calculated present values, and discuss them in light of the fact that the undiscounted total cash
flows amount to ` 150,000 in each case.
References:
● Banerjee Bhabatosh, Financial Policy and Management Accounting, PHI, Eighth Edition.
● Bodie, Zvi et al, Investments, Tata McGraw-Hill Publishing Company Limited New Delhi: 2002.
● Chambers, Donald R., and Nelson J. Lacey. “Corporate Ethics and Shareholder Wealth Maximization.”
Financial Practice and Education 6 (Spring–Summer 1996), 93– 96.
● Chandra Prasanna, Financial Management, Theory and Practice, McGraw Hill., 2019.
F
unctional approach, financial markets facilitate the flow of funds in order to finance investments by
corporations, governments and individuals. Financial institutions arhe financial system plays the key
role in the economy by stimulating economic growth, influencing economic performance of the actors,
affecting economic welfare.
According to the structural approach, the financial system of an economy consists of three main components:
(a) Financial markets;
(b) Financial intermediaries Institutions;
(c) Financial regulators.
Each of the components plays a specific role in the economy.
According to the functional approach, financial markets facilitate the flow of funds in order to finance investments
by corporations, governments and individuals. Financial institutions are the key players in the financial markets
as they perform the function of intermediation and thus determine the flow of funds. The financial regulators
perform the role of monitoring and regulating the participants in the financial system.
Financial Institutions
Financial Institutions are the business organisations that act as mobilisers of savings, and as purveyors of credit or
finance. They also provide various financial services to the community. The financial institutions are classified into
banking institutions and non-banking institutions.
(i) Banking Financial Institutions
Banking institutions are those institutions, which participate in the economy’s payment system, i.e., they
provide transaction services. Their deposit liabilities constitute a major part of the national money supply and
they can, as a whole, create deposits or credit, which is money.
(ii) Non-Banking Financial Institutions
Non-banking financial institutions are those institutions which act as mere purveyors of credit and they will not
create credit, e.g., LIC, UTI, IDBI.
According to Sayers, banking institutions are ‘creators’ of credit and NBFIs are mere “purveyors” of credit.
The financial institutions are also classified into financial intermediaries and non-financial intermediaries.
(a) Financial Intermediaries Financial intermediaries are those institutions which are intermediate between
savers and investors; they lend money as well as mobilize savings, their liabilities are towards the ultimate
savers, while their assets are from the investors or borrowers.
(b) Non-financial Intermediaries Non-financial intermediaries are those institutions which do the loan business
but their resources are not directly obtained from the savers. Many non-banking institutions also act as
intermediaries and when they do so they are known as non-banking financial intermediaries, e.g. LIC, GIC,
IDBI, IFCI, NABARD.
RBI at a Glance
● Managed by Central Board of Directors
● India’s monetary authority to supervise financial system and issuer of currency
● Manager of foreign exchange reserves
● Banker and debt manager to government
● Supervisor of payment system
● Banker to banks
● Maintaining financial stability
● Developmental functions
● Research, data and knowledge sharing
Instruments
Cash Reserve
Ratio (CRR) Bank Rate
Open Market
Statutory Operations
Liquidity Repo/Reserve
Ratio (SLR) Repo/Corridor Marginal
Adjustment
Refinanc Market Facility
Facility Stabilisation
Scheme Liquidity
Adjustment
Facility
(b) Managing the governments’ domestic debt with the objective of raising the required amount of public debt
in a cost-effective and timely manner.
(c) Developing the market for government securities to enable the government to raise debt at a reasonable
cost, provide benchmarks for raising resources by other entities and facilitate transmission of monetary
policy actions.
At the end of each day, RBI’s electronic system automatically consolidates all of the government’s transactions
to determine the net final position. If the balance in the government’s account shows a negative posi- tion, RBI
extends a short-term, interest-bearing advance, called a Ways and Means Advance-WMA-the limit or amount
for which is set at the beginning of each financial year in April.
integration of the Indian economy with the global economy arising from greater trade and capital flows, the
foreign exchange market has evolved as a key segment of the Indian financial market.
The Reserve Bank plays a key role in the regulation and development of the foreign exchange market and
assumes three broad roles relating to foreign exchange:
(a) Regulating transactions related to the external sector and facilitating the development of the foreign
exchange market.
(b) Ensuring smooth conduct and orderly conditions in the domestic foreign exchange market.
(c) Managing the foreign currency assets and gold reserves of the country.
RBI’s work to promote financial literacy focuses on educating people about responsible financial management.
Efforts here include:
� Information and Knowledge-sharing: User-friendly website includes easy-to-understand tips and
guidance in multiple languages, brochures, advertisements and other marketing materials educate the
public about banking services.
� Credit Counseling: The Reserve Bank encourages commercial banks to set up financial literacy and
credit counseling centres, to help people develop better financial planning skills.
Commercial banks may be classified as (a) Indian and (b) foreign banks.
(a) Indian banks are those banks which are incorporated in India and whose head offices are in India.
(b) Foreign banks are those banks which are incorporated outside of India and whose head offices are in outside of
India.
Both types of banks will have to maintain cash reserves with the RBI at rates stipulated by it. Besides, RBI can
supervise over working of foreign banks operating in India.
Commercial banks may also be classified as (a) Private and (b) Public sector bank.
(a) Private sector banks are those banks whose at least 51% shares are holding by private sectors.
(b) Public sector banks are those banks which are not private sectors.
Functions of Commercial Banks
Functions of commercial banks can be divided in two groups–banking functions (primary functions) and non-
banking functions (secondary functions).
A. Banking Functions (primary functions): Most of banking functions are: –
(a) Acceptance of Deposits from Public: - Bank accepts following deposits from publics: -
(i) Demand deposits can be in the form of current account or savings account. These deposits are
withdrawable any time by depositors by cheques. Current deposits have no interest or nominal
interest. Such accounts are maintained by commercial firms and business man. Interest rate of
saving deposits varies with time period. Savings accounts are maintained for encouraging savings of
households.
(ii) Fixed deposits are those deposits which are withdrawable only after a specific period. It earns a
higher rate of interest.
(iii) In recurring deposits, people deposit a fixed sum every month for a fixed period of time.
(b) Advancing Loans: It extends loans and advances out of money deposited by public to various business
units and to consumers against some approved. Usually, banks grant short-term or medium-term loans
to meet requirements of working capital of industrial units and trading units. Banks discourage loans for
consumption purposes. Loans may be secured or unsecured. Banks do not give loan in form of cash.
They make the customer open account and transfer loan amount in the customer’s account.
Banks grant loan in following ways: –
(i) Overdraft: - Banks grant overdraft facilities to current account holder to draw amount in excess of
balance held.
(ii) Cash Credit: - Banks grant credit in cash to current account holder against hypothecation of goods.
(iii) Discounting Trade Bills: - The banks facilitate trade and commerce by discounting bills of exchange.
(iv) Term Loan: - Banks grant term loan to traders and to agriculturists against some collateral securities.
(v) Consumer Credit: - Banks grant credit to households in a limited amount to buy durable goods.
(vi) Money at Call or Short-term Advances: - Banks grant loan for a very short period not exceeding
7 days to dealers / brokers in stock exchange against collateral securities.
(c) Credit Creation:- Credit creation is another banking function of commercial bank. i.e., it manufactures
money.
(d) Use of Cheque System: - Banks have introduced the cheque system for withdrawal of deposits.
There are two types of cheques – bearer & cross cheque. A bearer cheque is encashable immediately at the
bank by its possessor. A crossed cheque is not encashable immediately.
It has to be deposited only in the payee’s account. It is not negotiable.
(e) Remittance of Funds: - Banks provides facilities to remit funds from one place to another for their
customers by issuing bank drafts, mail transfer etc.
B. Non-Banking functions (secondary functions): Non-banking functions are (a) Agency services (b) General
utility services
(a) Agency Services: - Banks perform following functions on behalf of their customers: -
(i) It makes periodic payments of subscription, rent, insurance premium etc as per standing orders from
customers.
(ii) It collects bill, cheques, demand drafts, etc on behalf of their customers.
(iii) It acts as a trustee for property of its customers.
(iv) It acts as attorney. It can help in clearing and forwarding goods of its customers.
(v) It acts as correspondents, agents of their clients.
(b) General Utility Services: - General utility services of commercial banks are as follows: -
(i) Lockers are provided by bank to its customers at nominal rate.
(ii) Shares, wills, other valuables documents are kept in safe custody. Banks return them when demanded
by its customers.
(iii) It provides travellers cheque and ATM facilities.
(iv) Banks maintain foreign exchange department and deal in foreign exchange.
(v) Banks underwrites issue of shares and debentures of concerns.
(vi) It compiles statistics and business information relating to trade and commerce.
(vii) It accepts public provident fund deposits.
banking institution which is a loan company or an investment company or a hire purchase finance company or an
equipment leasing company or a mutual benefit finance company.
(a) Loan disbursed by an NBFC-MFI to a borrower with a rural household annual income not exceeding `
1,00,000 or urban and semi-urban household income not exceeding ` 1,60,000;
(b) Loan amount does not exceed ` 50,000 in the first cycle and ` 1,00,000 in subsequent cycles;
(c) Total indebtedness of the borrower does not exceed ` 1,00,000;
(d) Tenure of the loan not to be less than 24 months for loan amount in excess of ` 15,000 with prepayment
without penalty;
(e) Loan to be extended without collateral;
(f) Aggregate amount of loans, given for income generation, is not less than 50 per cent of the total loans
given by the MFIs;
(g) Loan is repayable on weekly, fortnightly or monthly instalments at the choice of the borrower
(viii) Non-Banking Financial Company – Factors (NBFC-Factors): NBFC-Factor is a non-deposit taking
NBFC engaged in the principal business of factoring. The financial assets in the factoring business should
constitute at least 50 percent of its total assets and its income derived from factoring business should notbe
less than 50 percent of its gross income.
(ix) Mortgage Guarantee Companies (MGC): MGC are financial institutions for which at least 90% of
thebusiness turnover is mortgage guarantee business or at least 90% of the gross income is from mortgage
guarantee business and net owned fund is ` 100 crore.
(x) NBFC- Non-Operative Financial Holding Company (NOFHC): It is the financial institution through
which promoter / promoter groups will be permitted to set up a new bank. It’s a wholly-owned Non-
Operative Financial Holding Company (NOFHC) which will hold the bank as well as all other financial
services companies regulated by RBI or other financial sector regulators, to the extent permissible under the
applicable regulatory prescriptions.
Post office
Insurance
The insurance companies are financial intermediaries as they collect and invest large amounts of premiums. They
offer protection to the investors, provide means for accumulating savings, and channelise funds to the government,
and other sectors.
The insurance companies are active in the following fields among other—life, health, and general, and they have
begun to operate the pension schemes and mutual funds also. Insurance business consists of spreading risks over
time and sharing them between persons and organisations. The major part of insurance business is life insurance,
the operations of which depend on the laws of mortality.
The distinction between life and general insurance business is that with regard to the former, the claim is fixed and
certain, but in the case of the latter, the claim is uncertain i.e., the amount of claim is variable and it is ascertainable
only sometime after the event. Pension business is a specialised form of life assurance.
Insurance Sector Reforms
The insurance sector in India has gone through the process of reforms following these recommendations. The
Insurance Regulatory & Development Authority (IRDA) Bill was passed by the Indian Parliament in December
1999. The IRDA became a statutory body in April, 2000 and has been framing regulations and registering the
private sector insurance companies. The insurance sector was opened upto the private sector in August 2000.
Consequently, some Indian and foreign private companies have entered the insurance business now. There are
about 31 general insurance and 24 life insurance companies operating in the private sector in India, early in 2022.
Statutory Functions of IRDA:
8 Issue to the applicant a certificate of registration, renew, modify, withdraw, suspend or cancel such registration.
8 Protection of the interests of the policyholders in matters concerning assigning of policy, nomination by
policy holders, insurable interest, settlement of insurance claim, surrender value of policy and other terms and
conditions of contracts of insurance.
8 Specifying requisite qualifications, code of conduct and practical training for intermediaries or insurance
intermediaries and agents.
8 Specifying the code of conduct for surveyors and loss assessors.
8 Promoting efficiency in the conduct of insurance business.
8 Promoting and regulating professional organisations connected with insurance and reinsurance business.
8 Levying fees and other charges for carrying out the purposes of the Act.
8 Calling for information from, undertaking inspection of, conducting enquiries and investigations including
audit of the insurers, intermediaries, insurance intermediaries and other organisations connected with the
insurance business.
8 Control and regulation of rates, advantages, terms and conditions that may be offered by the insurers in respect
of general insurance business not so controlled and regulated by the Tariff Advisory Committee under Section
64 U of the Insurance Act 1938 (4 of 1938).
8 Specifying the form and manner in which books of accounts shall be maintained and statements of accounts
shall be rendered by insurers and other insurance intermediaries.
8 Regulating investment of funds by insurance companies.
8 Regulating maintenance of margin of solvency.
8 Adjudication of disputes between insurers and intermediaries or insurance intermediaries .
8 Supervising the functioning of the Tariff Advisory Committee.
8 Specifying the percentage of the premium income of the insurer to finance schemes for promoting and
regulating professional organisations referred to in clause (f).
8 Specifying the percentage of life insurance business and general insurance business to be undertaken by the
insurers in the rural and social sector.
8 Exercising such other powers as may be prescribed.
superannuation pension, (b) retirement pension, (c) permanent total disability pension, (d) widow or widower’s
pension, and (e) orphan pension. It is essentially a defined-contribution and defined benefit payas-you-go
scheme, which is financed by diverting 8.33 per cent of the employers’ existing share of PF contributions.
(ii) BEPS and IEPS: Bank Employees Pension Scheme (BEPS), 1993, and Insurance Employees Pension
Scheme (IEPS), 1993 are for the benefit of the employees of public sector banks, and government owned
insurance companies respectively. They are financed by the entire employer’s portion of the PF contribution
which is 10% of the basic salary. The main benefit under these schemes (after superannuation at 60 years of
age or after 33 years of service) is in the form of a pension of 50% of the average basic salary during the last
10 months of employment. An additional benefit of 50% of the average of the allowances which rank for the
PF but not for DA during the last 10 months of service is also provided to the employees, and this amounts to
2-4% of the employee’s salary.
(iii) Privately Administered Superannuation Fund: So far, the private sector has been kept out in respect
of setting up and running of pension funds; they have been run by the government or semi-government
organisations. If any employer sets up a privately administrated superannuation fund, it is stipulated that he
can accumulate funds in the form of an irrevocable trust fund during the employment period of the employee
concerned, but when the pension becomes payable, suitable annuities have to be purchased from the LIC.
Alternatively, the employer can have a superannuation scheme with the LIC and pay suitable contributions for
the employees in service.
LIC has introduced 4 pension plans in the recent past:
(i) Varistha Pension Bima Yojana (VPBY)
(ii) New Jeevan Akshay (NJA)
(iii) New Jeevan Dhara (NJD)
(iv) New Jeevan Suraksha (NJS)
2.1.6 Alternative Investment Funds (AIF): Angel Fund, Venture Capital Fund, Private
Equity Fund and Hedge Funds
Alternative Investment Fund (AIF) means any fund established or incorporated in India which is a privately
pooled investment vehicle which collects funds from sophisticated investors, whether Indian or foreign, for
investing it in accordance with a defined investment policy for the benefit of its investors.
AIF does not include funds covered under the SEBI (Mutual Funds) Regulations, 1996, SEBI (Collective
Investment Schemes) Regulations, 1999 or any other regulations of the SEBI to regulate fund management
activities. Further, certain exemptions from registration are provided under the AIF Regulations to family trusts
set up for the benefit of ‘relatives’ as defined under the Companies Act, 1956, employee welfare trusts or gratuity
trusts set up for the benefit of employees, ‘holding companies’ within the meaning of Section 4 of the Companies
Act, 1956 etc. [Ref. Regulation 2(1)(b) of the SEBI]
Categories of AIF
Category -I AIFs
AIFs which invest in start-up or early-stage ventures or social ventures or SMEs or infrastructure or other sectors
or areas which the government or regulators consider as socially or economically desirable and shall include
venture capital funds, SME Funds, social venture funds, infrastructure funds and such other Alternative Investment
Funds as may be specified. [Ref. Regulation 3(4)(a)]
~ Diversification:
(i) Inclusion of hedge funds in a balanced portfolio reduces overall portfolio risk and volatility and increases
returns.
(ii) Adding hedge funds to an investment portfolio provides diversification not otherwise available in
traditional investing.
(8) SEBI issued regulations pertaining to “Insider Trading” in November 1992 prohibiting dealings,
communication in matters relating to insider trading. Such regulations will help in protecting the market’s
integrity, and in the long run inspire investor confidence in the market.
(9) SEBI issued a separate set of guidelines for development financial institutions in September 1992 for
disclosure and investment protection regarding their raising of funds from the market. As per the guidelines,
there is no need for promoter’s contribution. Besides, underwriting is not mandatory.
(10) SEBI has notified the regulations for mutual funds. For the first time mutual fund’s are governed by a
uniform set of regulations which require them to be formed as trusts and managed by a separate Asset
Management Company (AMC) and supervised by a board of trustees. SEBI (Mutual fund) regulations
provide for laissez-faire relationship between the various constituents of the mutual funds and thus bring
about a structural change which will ensure qualitative improvement in the functioning of the mutual
funds and require that the AMCs have a minimum net worth of ` 6 crores of which the sponsors must
contribute at least 40 percent. The SEBS (Mutual Fund) Regulations also provide for an approval of the
offer documents of schemes by SEBI. The regulations are intended to ensure that the mutual funds grow
on healthy lines and investors’ interest is protected.
(11) To bring about greater transparency in transactions, SEBI has made it mandatory for brokers to maintain
separate accounts for their clients and for themselves. They must disclose the transaction price and
brokerage separately in the contract notes issued to their clients. They must also have their books audited
and audit reports filed with SEBI.
(12) SEBI has issued directives to the stock exchanges to ensure that contract notes are issued by brokers to
clients within 24 hours of the execution of the contract. Exchanges are to see that time limits for payment
of sale proceeds and deliveries by brokers and payment of margins by clients to brokers are complied with.
(13) In August 1994, guidelines were issued in respect of preferential issues for orderly development of the
securities market and to protect the interest of investors.
(14) The ‘Banker to the issue’ has been brought under purview of SEBI for investor protection. Unit Trust of
India (UTI) has also been brought under the regulatory jurisdiction of SEBI.
(15) In July 1995, the Committee set up by SEBI under the chairmanship of Y. H. Malegam to look into the
disclosure of norms for public issues, recommended stricter regulations to control irregularities affecting
the primary market. Following the recommendations of the Malegam Committee, SEBI issued a number
of guidelines in September and October 1995 to protect the interest of investors.
(16) A series of measures to control the prices and to check other malpractices on the stock exchanges were
announced by SEBI on December 21, 1995.
(17) Guidelines for reduction the entry norms for companies accessing capital market were issued by SEBI on
April 16, 1996.
(18) The above discussion shows that SEBI has undertaken a number of steps to establish a fair, transparent
and a strong regulatory structure for the efficient functioning of the capital market and for protecting the
interest of the investors. These steps have helped in developing the capital market on healthy lines.
Since inception, SEBI issued time to time Acts, Rules, Regulations, Guidelines, Master Circulars, General
Orders and Circulars
SEBI Regulations
(1) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Delisting of Equity Shares) Regulations, 2021 [Last amended on
August 3, 2021]
(2) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Issue and Listing of Non-Convertible Securities) Regulations,
2021
(3) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Share Based Employee Benefits and Sweat Equity) Regulations,
2021
(4) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Underwriters) (Repeal) Regulations, 2021
(5) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Vault Managers) Regulations, 2021
(6) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Portfolio Managers) Regulations, 2020
(7) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Foreign Portfolio Investors) Regulations, 2019
(8) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Appointment of Administrator and Procedure for Refunding to
the Investors) Regulations, 2018
(9) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Buy-back of Securities) Regulations 2018
(10) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Depositories and Participants) Regulations, 2018
(11) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Issue of Capital and Disclosure Requirements) Regulations 2018
(12) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Settlement Proceedings) Regulations, 2018
(13) Securities Contracts (Regulation) (Stock Exchanges and Clearing Corporations) Regulations, 2018
(14) SEBI (Procedure for Search and Seizure) Repeal Regulations, 2015
(15) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Issue and Listing of Municipal Debt Securities) Regulations,
2015
(16) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Listing Obligations and Disclosure Requirements) Regulations,
2015
(17) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Prohibition of Insider Trading) Regulations, 2015
(18) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Infrastructure Investment Trusts) Regulations, 2014
(19) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Real Estate Investment Trusts) Regulations, 2014
(20) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Research Analysts) Regulations, 2014
(21) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Investment Advisers) Regulations, 2013
(22) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Issue and Listing of Non-Convertible Redeemable Preference
Shares) Regulations, 2013
(23) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Alternative Investment Funds) Regulations, 2012
(24) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Substantial Acquisition of Shares and Takeovers) Regulations,
2011
(25) Securities and Exchange Board of India {KYC (Know Your Client) Registration Agency} Regulations,
2011
(26) SEBI (Investor Protection and Education Fund) Regulations, 2009
(27) SEBI (Issue of Capital and Disclosure Requirements) Regulations, 2009
(28) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Intermediaries) Regulations, 2008
(29) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Issue and Listing of Debt Securities) Regulations, 2008
(30) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Issue and Listing of Securitised Debt Instruments and Security
Receipts) Regulations, 2008
(31) SEBI (Certification of Associated Persons in the Securities Markets) Regulations, 2007
(32) SEBI (Regulatory Fee on Stock Exchanges) Regulations, 2006
(33) SEBI (Self-Regulatory Organisations) Regulations, 2004 [last amended on March 6, 2017]
(34) SEBI (Ombudsman) Regulations, 2003
(35) SEBI (Prohibition of Fraudulent and Unfair Trade Practices relating to Securities Market) Regulations,
2003
(36) SEBI (Procedure for Board Meetings) Regulations, 2001
(37) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Employees’ Service) Regulations, 2001
(38) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Foreign Venture Capital Investor) Regulations, 2000
(39) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Collective Investment Scheme) Regulations, 1999
(40) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Credit Rating Agencies) Regulations, 1999
(41) SEBI (Buy Back Of Securities) Regulations, 1998 [Last amended on on March 6, 2017]
(42) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Custodian) Regulations, 1996
(43) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Mutual Funds) Regulations, 1996
(44) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Bankers to an Issue) Regulations, 1994 [
(45) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Debenture Trustees) Regulations, 1993
(46) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Registrars to an Issue and Share Transfer Agents) Regulations,
1993
(47) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Merchant Bankers) Regulations, 1992
(48) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Stock Brokers) Regulations, 1992
C
apital market is a market for equity shares and long-term debt. In this market, the capital funds comprising
of both equity and debt are issued and traded. This also includes private placement sources of debt and
equity as well as organized markets like stock exchanges. Capital market includes financial instruments
with more than one year maturity. It is defined as a market in which money is provided for periods longer
than a year, as the raising of short-term funds takes place on other markets (e.g., the money market).
Functions of Capital Market
The capital market is an important constituent of the financial system. The functions of an efficient capital
market are as follows:
� Mobilises long-term savings to finance long-term investments.
� Provide risk capital in the form of equity or quasi-equity to entrepreneurs.
� Encourage broader ownership of productive assets.
� Provide liquidity with a mechanism enabling the investor to sell financial assets.
� Lower the costs of transactions and information.
� Improve the efficiency of capital allocation through a competitive pricing mechanism.
� Enable quick valuation of financial instruments-both equity and debt.
� Provide insurance against market risk or price risk through derivative trading and default risk through
investment protection fund.
� Provide operational efficiency through:
● Simplified transaction procedures;
● Lowering settlement timings; and
● Lowering transaction costs.
� Develop integration among:
● Real and financial sectors;
● Equity and debt instruments;
● Long-term and short-term funds;
● Long-term and short-term interest costs;
● Private and government sectors; and
● Domestic and external funds.
The77
Institute of Cost Accountants of India The Institute of Cost Accountants of77
India
Financial Management and Business Data Analytics
� Direct the flow of funds into efficient channels through investment, disinvestment, and reinvestment.
� Enable wider participation by enhancing the width of the market by encouraging participation through
networking institutions and associating individuals. constituents of capital market-
� Investment trust: Financial institutions which collects savings from public and invest that amount in industrial
securities. Example: Tata Investment Trust Pvt Ltd.
� Specialised Financial Institutions: These types of financial institution provide long term finance to industries.
Example: Industrial Financial Corporation of India (IFCI) Ltd.
� Insurance company: Insurance companies collect premium from policy holders and invest the amount in
different industrial securities. Example: Life Insurance Corporation Of India (LICI).
� Securities market: Securities is a broader term which encompasses shares, debentures, bonds etc. the market
where securities transactions are held is known as securities market. Securities market can be further classified
into primary or new issue market and secondary or share market.
Primary Market
The primary market is a market for new issues. Hence it is also known as new issue market. This refers to the long-
term flow of funds from the surplus sector to the government and corporate sector through primary issues and to
banks and non-bank financial intermediaries through secondary issues. Funds are mobilized in the primary market
through prospectus, rights issues, and private placement.
Table 2.5 Types of Issues or Methods of rising Funds in Primary Market
Private Bought out Depository
Public Issue Rights Issue Bonus Issue
Placement deals Receipts
Initial Public If a company Bonus issues 1) Private When the Issue of
offering (IPO)- this issue share in are made by Placement new issued negotiable
is the offer of sale the market to the company (Unlisted shares of equity
of securities of an raise additional when it has companies)- It an unlisted instruments
unlisted company capital, the huge amount is direct sale company by Indian
for the first time. existing of of securities to is bought companies
members are accumulated some specified large by for rising
given the first reserves and individuals investor or capital
preference wants to or financial by small from the
institutions. investors in international
group it is capital
1. BSE Ltd.
2. Calcutta Stock Exchange Ltd.
3. Indian Commodity Exchange Ltd.
4. Metropolitan Stock Exchange of India Ltd.
5. Multi Commodity Exchange of India Ltd.
6. National Commodity & Derivatives Exchange Ltd.
7. National Stock Exchange of India Ltd.
(Source: SEBI Website)
B. Debt Securities:
(i) Debentures: A Debenture is a document issued by a company under its common seal acknowledging a
debt to the holders. It is a debt security issued by a company which offers to pay interest for the money
it borrows for a certain period. Debenture holders are treated as creditors of the company. As per SEBI
guidelines, no public or rights issue of convertible or non-convertible debentures shall be made unless a
credit rating from a credit rating agency has been obtained and disclosed in the offer document.
(ii) Bonds: A bond is a negotiable certificate which entitles the holder for repayment of the principal sum plus
interest. They are debt securities issued by a company, or government agency whereby a bond investor
lends money to the issuer, and in exchange, the issuer promises to repay the loan amount on a specified
maturity date. Features and the various types of Bonds have been discussed in study note 2.4 (financial
market instruments) already.
Other Financial Instruments that are traded in Market
1. Secured Premium Notes (SPNs)
(a) Meaning: Secured Premium Notes are debt instruments issued along with a detachable warrant and is
redeemable after a specified period (4 to 7 Years).
(b) Option to Convert: SPNs carry an option to convert into equity shares, i.e. the detachable warrant can be
converted into equity shares.
(c) Period for Conversion: Conversion of detachable warrant into equity shares should be done within a time
period specified by the company.
2. American Depository Receipts (ADRs): American Depository Receipts popularly known as ADRs were
introduced in the American market in 1927. ADRs are negotiable instruments, denominated in dollars, and
issued by the US Depository Bank. A non-US company that seeks to list in the US, deposits its shares with a
bank and receives a receipt which enables the company to issue AD` These ADRs serve as stock certificates
and are used interchangeably with ADRs which represent ownership of deposited shares. Among the Indian
ADRs listed on the US markets, are Infy (the Infosys Technologies ADR), WIT (the Wipro ADR), tRdy(the
Dr Reddy’s Lab ADR), and Say (the Satyam Computer ADR). ADRs are listed in New York Stock Exchange
(NYSE) and NASDAQ (National association of Securities Dealers automated quotations). Issue of ADR offers
access to both institutional and retail market in Us.
3. Global Depository Receipts (GDRs): GDRs are equity instruments issued abroad by authorized overseas
corporate bodies against the shares/bonds of Indian companies held with nominated domestic custodian banks.
An Indian company intending to issue GDRs will issue the corresponding number of shares to an overseas
depository bank. GDRs are freely transferable outside India and dividend in respect of the share represented
by the GDR is paid in Indian rupees only. They are listed and traded on a foreign stock exchange. GDRs are
fungible, which means the holder of GDRs can instruct the depository to convert them into underlying shares
and sell them in the domestic market. GDRs re traded on Over the Counter (OTC) basis. Most of the Indian
companies have their GDR issues listed on the Luxembourg Stock Exchange and the London Stock Exchange.
Indian GDRs are primarily sold to institutional investors and the major demand is in the UK, US, Hongkong,
Singapore, France and Switzerland. There is no such difference between ADR and GDR from legal point of
view.
4. Derivatives: A derivative is a financial instrument, whose value depends on the values of basic underlying
variable. In the sense, derivatives is a financial instrument that offers return based on the return of some other
underlying asset, i.e., the return is derived from another instrument. Derivatives are a mechanism to hedge
market, interest rate, and exchange rate risks. Derivatives is divided into two types- Financial derivatives and
Commodity derivatives. Types of Financial derivatives include: Forwards, Futures, Options, Warrants, Swaps,
Swaptions. There are three types of traders in the derivatives market: Hedger, Speculator and arbitrageur.
5. External Commercial Borrowings (ECBs): ECBs are used by Indian companies to rise funds from foreign
sources like bank, export credit agencies, foreign collaborators, foreign share holders etc. Indian companies
rise funds through ECBs mainly for financing infrastructure projects.
6. Foreign Currency Convertible Bonds (FCCBs): Foreign currency convertible Bonds (FCCBs) are issued by
Indian companies but are subscribed by non-residents. These bonds have a specified fixed interest rate and can
be converted into ordinary shares at price preferred, either in part or in full.
8 By making suitable tax amendments, benefits are extended to promote these instruments, to :-
(i) safeguard the funds of financial institutions,
(ii) encouraging more equity participation, which will also require a higher compliance under corporate
laws, whereby organisations can be monitored more effectively.
Disadvantages of OCD:
Issuer
(a) Ability to match the projected cash inflows and outflows by altering the terms and timing of conversion is
diluted, and becomes a function of performance of the company and hence its market price.
(b) The company is not assured of hefty share premiums based on its past performance and an assured conversion
of debentures.
(c) Planning of capital structure becomes difficult in view of the uncertainties associated with conversion.
Investor: There are many regulatory requirements to be complied with for conversion.
Rematerialisation
Rematerialiation is the process by which a client/ shareholder can get his electronic holdings converted into
physical certificates.
Features of Rematerialisation
(a) A client can rematerialise his dematerialised holdings at any point of time.
(b) The rematerialisation process is completed within 30 days.
Depository Process
There are four parties in a demat transaction: the customer, the depository participant (DP), the depository, and
the share registrar and transfer agent (R&T). A Depository Participant (DP) is an agent of the depository through
which it interfaces with the investor and provides depository services. Public financial institutions, scheduled
commercial banks, foreign banks operating in India with the approval of the Reserve Bank of India, state financial
corporations, custodians, stock-brokers, clearing corporations /clearing houses, NBFCs and registrar to an issue
or Share Transfer Agent complying with the requirements prescribed by SEBI can be registered as DP. Banking
services can be availed through a branch whereas depository services can be availed through a DP. The investor
has to enter into an agreement with the DP after which he is issued a client account number or client ID number.
PAN Card is now mandatory to operate a demat account.
2.2.6 Initial Public Offering (IPO), Follow on Public Offer (FPO), Book Building, Green
shoe Option
Initial Public Offering (IPO)
An initial public offering (IPO) or stock market launch is a type of public offering where shares of stock in a
company are sold to the general public, on a securities exchange, for the first time. Through this process, a private
company transforms into a public company. It is an offering of either a fresh issue of securities or an offer for sale
of existing securities, or both by an unlisted company for the first time to the public. Initial public offerings are
used by companies to raise expansion capital, to possibly monetize the investments of early private investors, and
to become publicly traded enterprises. a company selling shares is never required to repay the capital to its public
investors.
The IPO process in India consists of the following steps:
8 Appointment of merchant banker and other intermediaries
8 Registration of offer document
8 Marketing of the issue
8 Post-issue activities
8 First issue of shares by the company is made through IPO when company first becoming a publicly traded
company on a national exchange while Follow on Public Offering is the public issue of shares for an already
listed company.
Book Building
Book building means a process by which a demand for the securities proposed to be issued by a body corporate
is elicited and built up and the price for such securities is assessed for the determination of the quantum of such
securities to be issued by means of notice/ circular / advertisement/ document or information memoranda or offer
document. It is a mechanism where, during the period for which the book for the offer is open, the bids are collected
from investors at various prices, which are within the price band specified by the issuer. The process is directed
towards both the institutional as well as the retail investors. The issue price is determined after the bid closure based
on the demand generated in the process.
The book-building system is part of Initial Public Offer (IPO) of Indian Capital Market. It was introduced by SEBI
on recommendations of Mr. Y.H. Malegam in October 1995. It is most practical, fast and efficient management
of mega issues. Book building involves sale of securities to the public and the institutional bidders on the basis of
predetermined price range.
8 Book building is a price discovery mechanism and is becoming increasingly popular as a method of issuing
capital. The idea behind this process is to find a better price for the issue.
8 The issue price is not determined in advance. Book Building is a process wherein the issue price of a security
is determined by the demand and supply forces in the capital market.
8 Book building is a process used for marketing a public offer of equity shares of a company and is a common
practice in most developed countries.
8 Book building refers to the collection of bids from investors, which is based on an indicative price range.
8 The issue price is fixed after the bid closing date. The various bids received from the investors are recorded in
a book that is why the process is called Book Building.
8 Unlike international markets, India has a large number of retail investors who actively participate in initial
Public Offer (IPOs) by companies. Internationally, the most active investors are the mutual funds and other
institutional investors, hence the entire issue is book built. But in India, 25 per cent of the issue has to be
offered to the general public. Here there are two options with the company.
8 An issuer company may make an issue of securities to the public through a prospectus in the following manner:
● 100% of the net offer to the public through the book building process, or
● 75% of the net offer to the public through the book building process and 25% at the price determined
through the book building. The fixed portion is conducted like a normal public issue after the book built
which the issue is determined.
Advantages of Book Building
1. The book building process helps in discovery of price and demand.
2. The costs of the public issue are much reduced.
3. The time taken for the completion of the entire process is much less than that in the normal public issue.
4. In book building, the demand for the share is known before the issue closes. Infact, if there is not much
demand, the issue may be deferred.
Eligible Buyer(s)
1. All investors registered with trading member of the exchanges other than the promoter(s)/ promoter group
entities.
2. In case a non-promoter shareholder offers shares through the OFS mechanism, promoters/ promoter group
entities of such companies may participate in the OFS to purchase shares subject to compliance with applicable
provisions of SEBI (Issue of Capital and Disclosure Requirements) Regulations, 2009 and SEBI (Substantial
Acquisition of Shares and Takeovers) Regulations, 2011.
Illegal: Dealing in securities by an insider is illegal when it is predicated upon utilization of inside information to
profit at the expense of other investors who do not have access to such investment information. It is prohibited and
is considered as an offence as per SEBI (Insider Trading) regulations,1992.
Punishable: Insider trading is an unethical practice resorted by those in power, causing huge losses to common
investors thus driving them away from capital market, and hence punishable.
Three decades have passed since the SEBI (Prohibition of Insider Trading) Regulations, 1992 were notified which
was framed to deter the practice of insider trading in the securities of listed companies. Since then there have been
several amendments to the regulations and judicial paradigm through case laws have also evolved in India. In fact,
world over, the regulatory focus is shifting towards containing the rising menace of insider trading effectively.
To ensure that the regulatory framework dealing with insider trading in India is further strengthened, SEBI seeks
review of the extant insider trading regulatory regime in India.
The Securities and Exchange Board of India (Prohibition of Insider Trading) Regulations 1992 requires that a
person who is connected with a listed company and is in possession of any unpublished price sensitive information
likely to materially affect the price of securities of company, shall not:
(i) On his behalf or on behalf of any other person deal in securities or
(ii) Communicate such information to any other person, who while in possession of such information shall not deal
in securities.
Accordingly, SEBI has constituted a High-Level Committee under the Chairmanship of Hon’ble Justice Mr. N.
K. Sodhi, retired Chief Justice of Karnataka High Court and Former Presiding officer of the Securities Appellate
Tribunal, for reviewing the SEBI (Prohibition of Insider Trading) Regulations, 1992.
2.2.9 Credit Rating - Credit Rating Methods and Rating Agencies in India
Credit rating is the assessment of a borrower’s credit quality. it is the assessment carried out from the viewpoint of
credit-risk evaluation on a specific date, on the quality of a-
Limitations:
(i) Rating Changes: Rating given to instruments can change over a period of time. they have to be kept under
rating watch. Downgrading of an instrument may not be timely enough to help investors.
(ii) Industry Specific rather than Company Specific: Downgrades are linked to industry rather than company
performance. Agencies give importance to macro aspects and not to micro-ones; over react to existing
conditions which come from optimistic / pessimistic views arising out of up / down turns.
(iii) Cost -Benefit of Rating: Ratings being mandatory, it becomes a must for entities rather than carrying out
cost Benefit Analysis of obtaining such, ratings. Rating should be optional and the entity should be free to
decide on the issue of obtaining a credit rating.
(iv) Conflict of Interest: The rating agency collects fees from the entity it rates leading to a conflict of interest.
Rating market being competitive there is a possibility of such conflict entering into the rating system especially
in a case where the rating agencies get their revenues from a single service or group.
(v) Transparency: Greater transparency in the rating process should exist an example being the disclosure of
assumptions leading to a specific public rating.
Methods /Process of Credit Rating:
The steps involved in the Credit Rating are:
(1) Rating Request: The Customer (Prospective issuer of Debt Instrument) makes a formal request to the Rating
Agency. The request spells out the terms of the rating assignment and contains analysis of the issues viz.
historical performance, competitive position, business risk profile, business strategies, financial policies
and evaluation of outlook for performance. information requirements are met through various sources like
references, reviews, experience, etc.
(2) Formation of Rating Team: The rating process is initiated once a rating agreement is signed between Rating
Agency and the client/ on receipt of a formal request (or mandate) from the client. Then the credit rating
agency forms a team, whose composition is based on the expertise and skills required for evaluating the
business of the issuer. The client is then provided with a list of information required and the broad framework
for discussions.
(3) Initial Analysis: On the basis of the information gathered, the analysts submit the report to the Rating team.
The authenticity and validity of the information submitted influences the credit rating activity.
(4) Evaluation by Rating Committee: Rating Committee is the final authority for assigning ratings. The rating
team makes a brief presentation about the issuers’ business and the management. All the issues identified
during discussions stage are analysed.
(5) Actual Rating: Rating is assigned and all the issues, which influence the rating, are clearly spelt out.
(6) Communication to Issuer: Assigned rating together with the key issues is communicated to the issuer’s top
management for acceptance. the ratings, which are not accepted, are either rejected or reviewed. The rejected
ratings are not disclosed and complete confidentiality is maintained.
(7) Review of Rating: If the rating is not acceptable to the issuer, he has a right to appeal for a review of the rating.
These reviews are usually taken up, only if the issuer provides fresh inputs on the issues that were considered
for assigning the rating. issuer’s response is presented to the rating committee. If the inputs are convincing, the
committee can revise the initial rating decision.
(8) Surveillance / Monitoring: credit rating agency monitors the accepted ratings over the tenure of the rated
instrument. Ratings are reviewed every year, unless warranted earlier. During this course, the initial rating
could be retained, upgraded or downgraded.
M
oney market is the market for dealing in monetary assets of short-term in nature. Short-term funds
up to one year and for financial assets that are close substitutes for money are dealt in the money
market. It is not a physical location (like the stock market), but an activity that is conducted over the
telephone. Money market instruments have the characteristics of liquidity (quick conversion into
money), minimum transaction cost and no loss in value. Excess funds are deployed in the money market, which in
turn is availed to meet temporary shortages of cash and other obligations.
Features of Money Market:
(a) Instruments Traded: Money market is a collection of instruments like Call Money, Notice Money, Repos,
Term Money, Treasury Bills, Commercial Bills, Certificate of Deposits, Commercial Papers, Inter-Bank
Participation Certificates, Inter Corporate Deposits, Swaps, etc.
(b) Large Participants : The participants of money market are — (i) lenders, (ii) mutual funds, (iii) financial
institutions including the RBI, Scheduled Commercial Banks, Discount and Finance House of India and (iv)
borrowers. Network of a large number of Participants exists which add greater depth to the market. This
network can be broadly classified as follows:
Organized Sector
(i) Commercial and Other Banks
(ii) Non-Banking Financial Companies
(iii) Co–operative Banks
Unorganised Sector
(i) Indigenous Bankers
(ii) Nidhis and Chit Funds
(iii) Unorganized Money Lenders
(c) Zone Centric Activities: Activities in the money market tend to concentrate in some centre, which serves a
region or an area. The width of such area may vary depending upon the size and needs of the market itself.
(d) Pure Competition: Relationship between participants in a money market is impersonal in character, and the
competition is relatively pure.
(e) Lower Price Differentials: Price differentials for assets of similar type tend to be eliminated by the interplay
of demand and supply.
(f) Flexible Regulations: Certain degree of flexibility in the regulatory framework exists and there are constant
endeavours for introducing a new instruments / innovative dealing technique.
(g) Market Size: It is a wholesale market and the volume of funds or financial assets traded are very large, i.e., in
crores of rupees.
Benefits:
(a) Banks and Institutions: Call market enables banks and financial institutions to even out their day- to-day
deficits and surpluses of money.
(b) Cash Reserve Requirements: Commercial Banks, Co-operative Banks and Primary Dealers are allowed to
borrow and lend in this market for adjusting their cash reserve requirements.
(c) Outlet for Deploying Funds: It serves as an outlet for deploying funds on short-term basis to the lenders
having steady inflow of funds.
Nature of Call Money Market
Call money represents the amount borrowed by the commercial banks from each other to meet their temporary
funds requirements. The market for such extremely short period loans is referred to as the “call money market”.
Call loans in India are given:
(i) to the bill market,
(ii) to dealers in stock exchange for the purpose of dealings in stock exchange,
(iii) between banks, and
(iv) to individuals of high financial status in Mumbai for ordinary trade purpose in order to save interest on cash
credit and overdrafts.
Among these uses, inter-bank use has been the most significant. These loans are given for a very short duration,
between 1 day to 15 days. There are no collateral securities demanded against these loans i.e., unsecured. The
borrower has to repay the loans immediately they are called for i.e., highly liquid. As such, these loans are described
as “call loans” or “call money”.
2.3.2 Treasury Bills
Treasury bills are short-term instruments issued by the Reserve Bank on behalf of the government to tide over short-
term liquidity shortfalls. This instrument is used by the government to raise short-term funds to bridge seasonal or
temporary gaps between its receipts (revenue and capital) and expenditure. They form the most important segment
of the money market not only in India but all over the world as well.
T-bills are repaid at par on maturity. The difference between the amount paid by the tenderer at the time of purchase
(which is less than the face value) and the amount received on maturity represents the interest amount on T-bills
and is known as the discount. Tax deducted at source (TDS) is not applicable on T-bills.
Features of T-bills
8 They are negotiable securities.
8 They are highly liquid as they are of shorter tenure and there is a possibility of inter-bank repos in them.
8 There is an absence of default risk.
8 They have an assured yield, low transaction cost, and are eligible for inclusion in the securities for SLR
purposes.
8 They are not issued in scrip form. the purchases and sales are effected through the subsidiary general ledger
(sgl) account.
8 At present, there are 91-day, 182-day, and 364-day T-bills in vogue. The 91-day T-bills are auctioned by
the RBI every Friday and the 364-day T-bills every alternate Wednesday, i.e., the Wednesday preceding the
reporting friday.
8 Treasury bills are available for a minimum amount of ` 25,000 and in multiples thereof.
Issue Price: Treasury Bills are issued at a discount and redeemed at face value.
Investors: Banks, Primary Dealers, State governments, Provident funds, financial institutions, Insurance
companies, NBFCs, FIIs (as per prescribed norms), NRIs can invest in T-Bills.
Participants in the T-Bills Market: The Reserve Bank of India, commercial banks, mutual funds, financial
institutions, primary dealers, provident funds, corporates, foreign banks, and foreign institutional investors are all
participants in the T-bills market. The state governments can invest their surplus funds as non-competitive bidders
in T-bills of all maturities.
Yield in Treasury Bills: It is calculated as per the following formula:
100 − P 365
Yield = × × 100
P D
Where,
P = Purchase price
D = Days to maturity
Day Count for Treasury Bill: Actual number of days to maturity/ 365
Types of Treasury Bills
At present, the Reserve Bank issues T-bills of three maturities: 91-day, 182-day, and 364-day.
(pre-export credit), and also within the country. In India, the use of bill of exchange appears to be in vogue for
financing agricultural operations, cottage and small-scale industries, and other commercial and trade transactions.
2.3.4 Commercial Paper
Commercial paper (CP) is an unsecured short-term promissory note, negotiable and transferable by endorsement
and delivery with a fixed maturity period. It is issued only by large, well known, creditworthy companies and is
typically unsecured, issued at a discount on face value, and redeemable at its face value. the aim of its issuance is
to provide liquidity or finance company’s investments, e.g., in inventory and accounts receivable.
The major issuers of commercial papers are financial institutions, such as finance companies, bank holding
companies, insurance companies. Financial companies tend to use CPs as a regular source of finance. Non-financial
companies tend to issue CPs on an irregular basis to meet special financing needs.
Advantages
(1) Simplicity: Documentation involved in issue of Commercial Paper is simple and minimum.
(2) Cash Flow Management: The issuer company can issue Commercial Paper with suitable maturity periods
(not exceeding one year), tailored to match the cash flows of the Company.
(3) Alternative for Bank Finance: A well-rated company can diversify its sources of finance from Banks, to
short-term money markets, at relatively cheaper cost.
(4) Returns to Investors: CP’s provide investors with higher returns than the banking system.
(5) Incentive for Financial Strength: Companies which raise funds through CP become well-known in the
financial world for their strengths. They are placed in a more favourable position for raising long-term capital
also. So, there is an inbuilt incentive for Companies to remain financially strong.
RBI Guidelines in respect of issue of Commercial Paper
(1) Eligible issuers of CP: (a) Corporates, (b) Primary Dealers (PDs), and (c) All-India Financial Institutions
(FIs) that have been permitted to raise short-term resources under the umbrella limit fixed by RBI are eligible
to issue CP.
8 All-India Financial Institutions (FIs) mean those financial institutions which have been permitted
specifically by the RBI to raise resources by way of Term Money, Term Deposits, Certificates of Deposit,
Commercial Paper and Inter-Corporate Deposits, where applicable, within umbrella limit.
8 Primary Dealer means a non-banking financial company which holds a valid letter of authorization as a
Primary Dealer issued by the RBI.
(2) Investors for CP: CP may be issued to and held by —
(a) Individuals
(b) Banking companies
(c) Other corporate Bodies registered/ incorporated in India
(d) Unincorporated Bodies
(e) Non-Resident Indians (NRIs) and
(f) Foreign Institutional Investors (FIIs)
(3) Maturity: CP can be issued for maturities between a minimum of 7 days and a maximum up to one year from
the date of issue. Maturity date of CP should not go beyond the date up to which the credit rating of the issuer
is valid.
(4) Denominations: CP can be issued in denominations of ` 5 lakh or multiples thereof. Amount invested by a
single investor should not be less than ` 5 lakh (face value).
(5) Basic issue conditions for a corporate: A Corporate would be eligible to issue CP provided –
(a) Its tangible net worth, as per the latest audited balance sheet, is not less than ` 4 Crores.
(b) It has been sanctioned working capital limit by bank/s or all-India financial institution/s.
(c) Its borrowal account is classified as a standard asset by the financing bank(s)/ institution(s).
(6) Credit Rating: All eligible participants shall obtain the credit rating for issuance of CP from –
(a) Credit Rating Information Services of India Ltd. (CRISIL) or
(b) Investment Information and Credit Rating Agency Of India Ltd. (ICRA) or
(c) Credit Analysis and Research Ltd. (CARE) or
(d) Fitch Ratings India Pvt. Ltd. or
(e) Such other credit rating agencies as may be specified by the RBI.
Minimum credit rating shall be P-2 of CRISIL or such equivalent rating by other agencies. At the time of
issuance of CP, the rating so obtained should be current and not fallen due for review.
(7) Amount of CP:
(a) The aggregate amount of CP from an issuer shall be the least of—
8 limit as approved by its Board of Directors, or
8 quantum indicated by the Credit Rating Agency for the specified rating.
(b) An FI can issue CP within the overall umbrella limit fixed by the RBI, i.e. issue of CP together with
Term Money Borrowings (TMB), Term Deposits (TD), Certificates of Deposit (CD) and Inter-Corporate
Deposits (ICD) should not exceed 100% of its Net Owned Funds, as per the latest audited Balance sheet.
(8) Time Period: The total amount of CP proposed to be issued should be raised within two weeks from the date
on which the issue is open for subscription. Every CP issue shall be reported to the RBI, through the Issuing
and Paying Agent (IPA) within three days from the date of completion of the issue.
(9) Mode of Issuance: The following points are relevant –
(a) CP can be issued either in the form of a promissory note (physical form) or in a dematerialized form
(Demat form) through any of the depositories approved by and registered with SEBI.
(b) CP will be issued at a discount to face value as may be determined by the issuer.
(c) No issuer shall have the issue of CP underwritten or co-accepted.
(10) Issuing and Paying Agent (IPA): Only a scheduled bank can act as an IPA for issuance of CP. Every issuer
must appoint an IPA for issuance of CP.
(11) Procedure for Issuance: Issuer should disclose its financial position to the potential investors. After the
exchange of deal confirmation, issuing Company shall issue physical certificates to the investor or arrange for
crediting the CP to the investor’s account with a depository. Investors shall be given a copy of IPA certificate
to the effect that the issuer has a valid agreement with the IPA and documents are in order.
(12) Mode of Investment in CP: The investor in CP shall pay the discounted value (issue price) of the CP by
means of a crossed account payee cheque to the account of the issuer through IPA.
(13) Repayment of CP on Maturity: On maturity of CP, when the CP is held in physical form, the holder of
the CP shall present the instrument for payment to the issuer through the IPA. When the CP is held in demat
form, the holder of the CP will get it redeemed through the depository and receive payment from the IPA.
(14) Defaults in CP Market: In order to monitor defaults in redemption of CP, Scheduled Banks which act as
IPAs, shall immediately report, on occurrence, full particulars of defaults in repayment of CPs to the RBI.
(15) Stand-by Facility: Non-bank entities including corporates may provide unconditional and irrevocable
guarantee for credit enhancement for CP issue provided –
(a) the issuer fulfils the eligibility criteria prescribed for issuance of CP,
(b) the guarantor has a credit rating at least one notch higher than the issuer given by an approved credit
rating agency, and
(c) the offer document for CP properly discloses the net worth of the guarantor company, the names of the
Companies to which the guarantor has issued similar guarantees, the extent of the guarantees offered by
the guarantor Company, and the conditions under which the guarantee will be invoked.
2.3.5 Certificate of Deposits (CD)
CD is a negotiable money market instrument and issued in dematerialized form or as a usance promissory note, for
funds deposited at a Bank or other eligible Financial Institution for a specified time period.
Salient Features:
8 CDs can be issued to individuals, corporations, companies, trusts, funds, associates, etc.
8 NRIs can subscribe to CDs on non-repatriable basis.
8 CDs attract stamp duty as applicable to negotiable instruments.
8 Banks have to maintain SLR and CRR on the issue price of CDs. no ceiling on the amount to be issued.
8 The minimum issue size of CDs is rs1 lakh and in multiples thereof.
8 CDs are transferable by endorsement and delivery.
8 The minimum lock-in-period for CDs is 15 days.
8 CDs are issued by Banks, when the deposit growth is sluggish and credit demand is high and a tightening trend
in call rate is evident. CDs are generally considered high-cost liabilities and banks have recourse to them only
under tight liquidity conditions.
Features of Repo:
(1) Banks and primary dealers are allowed to undertake both repo and reverse repo transactions.
(2) It is a collateralized short-term lending and borrowing agreement.
(3) It serves as an outlet for deploying funds on short-term basis.
(4) The interest rates depend on the demand and supply of the short-term surplus/deficit amongst the interbank
players.
(5) In addition to T-Bills all Central and State Government securities are eligible for repo.
(6) No sale of securities should be affected unless the securities are actually held by the seller in his own
investment portfolio.
(7) Immediately on sale, the corresponding amount should be reduced from the investment account of the seller.
(8) The securities under repo should be marked to market on the balance sheet.
Participants: Buyer in a Repo is usually a Bank which requires approved securities in its investment portfolio to
meet the statutory liquidity ratio (SLR).
Types of Repos:
8 Overnight Repo: When the term of the loan is for one day, it is known as an overnight repo. Most repos are
overnight transactions, with the purchase and sale taking place one day and being reversed the next day.
8 Term Repo: When the term of the loan is for more than one day it is called a term repo. Long-term repos
which are as such can be extended for a month or more.
8 Open Repo: Open repo simply has no end date. Usually, repos are for a fixed period of time, but openended
deals are also possible.
Interest:
(a) Computation: Interest for the period of Repo is the difference between Sale Price and Purchase Price.
(b) Recognition: Interest should be recognized on a time-proportion basis, both in the books of the buyer and
seller.
Government Securities
A government security is a tradable instrument issued by the central government or the state governments. It
acknowledges the Government’s debt obligation. Such securities are short-term (usually called treasury bills, with
original maturities of less than one year) or long-term (usually called Government bonds or dated securities with
original maturity of one year or more). In India, the Central Government issues both, treasury bills and bonds or
dated securities while the State Governments issue only bonds or dated securities, which are called the State De-
velopment Loans (SDLs). Government securities carry practically no risk of default and, hence, are called riskfree
gilt-edged instruments. Government of India also issues savings instruments (Savings Bonds, National Saving
Certificates (NSCs), etc.) or special securities (oil bonds, Food Corporation of India bonds, fertilizer bonds, power
bonds, etc.). They are, usually not fully tradable and are, therefore, not eligible to be SLR securities.
Government securities are mostly interest bearing dated securities issued by RBI on behalf of the government of
India GOI uses these funds to meet its expenditure commitments. These securities are generally fixed maturity and
fixed coupon securities carrying semi-annual coupon. Since the date of maturity is specified in the securities, these
are known as dated Government Securities.
Features of Government Securities
1. Issued at face value.
2. No default risk as the securities carry sovereign guarantee.
3. Ample liquidity as the investor can sell the security in the secondary market.
4. Interest payment on a half yearly basis on face value.
5. No tax deducted at source.
6. Can be held in demat form.
7. Rate of interest and tenor of the security is fixed at the time of issuance and is not subject to change (unless
intrinsic to the security like FRBs - Floating Rate Bonds).
8. Redeemed at face value on maturity.
9. Maturity ranges from 91 days-30 years.
10. Government securities qualify as SLR (Statutory Liquidity Ratio) investments, unless otherwise stated.
Government Securities- Types
1. Treasury Bills
2. Government Bonds or Dated Securities
3. State Development Loans
4. Any other security created and issued by the Government in such form and for such of the purposes of the
act as may be prescribed
Solved Case 1
Delhi Manufacturers intend to raise ` 40,00,000 of equity capital through a rights offering. It currently has 10,00,000
shares outstanding which have been most recently selling / trading for ` 50 and ` 56 per share. In consultation with
the SEBI Caps, the company has set the subscription price for the rights at ` 50 per share.
You are required to:
(a) Determine the number of new shares of the company should sell to raise the desired amount of capital.
(b) Ascertain the number of shares each right would entitle a holder of one share to purchase. How many additional
shares can an investor who holds 10,000 shares of the company purchase?
Solution:
` 40,00,000 (to be raised)
(a) Number of new shares = = 80,000 Shares
` 50 (Subcription price)
Solved Case 2
The RBI offers 91-Days Treasury Bills to raise ` 1,500 crore. The following bids have been received.
(a) Yield = Y =
Exercise
A. Theoretical Questions:
~ Multiple Choice Questions
20. In India, Commercial Papers are issued as per the lines issued by -
(a) Securities and Exchange Board of India
(b) Reserve Bank of India
(c) Forward Market Commission
(d) RBI
21. Commercial paper are generally issued at a pries
(a) Equal to face value
(b) More than face value
(c) Less than face value
(d) Equal to redemption value
22. Which of the following is not applicable to commercial paper?
(a) Face Value
(b) Issue Price
(c) Coupon Rate
(d) None of the above.
23. Which of the following forms of equity financing is especially designed for funding High Risk & High
Reward projects?
(a) ADR
(b) GDR
(c) FCCB
(d) Venture Capital
24. β (Beta) of a security measures its
(a) Divisible Risk
(b) Financial Risk
(c) Market Risk
(d) None of the above
25. Corporate financing instruments which have an unlimited life, voting right and right to receive dividends
are known as
(a) Non-Redeemable Preference Shares
(b) Redeemable Preference Shares
(b) Equity Shares
(d) Debentures
32. A company issue commercial paper for `3 crores with a maturity period of 90 days. The interest rate is
11% p.a. The net amount received by the company will be :
(a) ` 2.94 crores
(b) ` 2.92 crores
(c) ` 2.85 crores
(d) ` 3.08 crores
33. Global Depository Receipts (GDR) are issued to :
(a) Investors of India who want to subscribe to shares of foreign companies
(b) Only to persons of Indian origin residing in a foreign country
(c) Non resident investors against publicly traded shares of the issuing companies and denominated in US
dollars.
(d) Foreign banks as security to raise foreign currency loans.
34. RBI sold a 91 days T-Bill of face value of ` 100 at an yield of 7%. What was the issue price?
(a) ` 98.00
(b) ` 98.08
(c) ` 98.18
(d) ` 98.28
35. The face value of a 364-day T-bill is `100. If the purchase price is `86 then the yield on such a bill is
(a) 12.45%
(b) 13.36%
(c) 16.32%
(d) 16.56%
36. Preference shares must be redeemed within a period of _______ from the date of issue.
(a) 10 yrs
(b) 20 yrs
(c) 30 yrs
(d) 50 yrs
37. From the enumerated list please select instrument which is not dealt in capital market.
(a) Commercial Paper
(b) Debenture
(c) Sweat Equity
(d) None of the above
38. From the enumerated list please select instrument which is not dealt in money market.
(a) Equity shares
(b) Treasury Bill
(c) Certificate of Deposit
(d) None of the above
39. If the RBI intends to reduce the supply of money as part of an anti-inflation policy, it might
(a) Lower Bank rate
(b) Increase Cash Reserve Ratio
(c) Buy Govt. securities in open market
(d) Decrease Statutory Liquidy Ratio
40. The maturity period of commercial paper usually ranges from :
(a) 90 days to 360 days
(b) 6 months
(c) 91 days to 360 days
(d) 90 days
41. Which of the following is not a characteristics of GDR :
(a) Freely traded in the international market
(b) Investors earn fixed income by way of dividend
(c) Shares underlying the GDR carry voting rights.
(d) GDR is a negotiable instrument.
42. SPO refers to _________________, the second and subsequent time a company raises money from the
public directly.
(a) Second Public Offering
(b) Subsequent Public Offering
(c) Subsequent Public Offer
(d) Seasonal Public Offering
Answer:
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
b c b b b d c d b b d a
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
b a c c c b c b c d d c
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
c d b b b c b b c d c b
37 38 39 40 41 42
a a b a c d
1 F 2 T 3 F
4 F 5 T 6 F
7 T 8 T 9 F
10 F 11 F 12 T
13 T 14 F 15 T
16 T 17 F 18 F
19 T 20 F 21 F
22 F 23 T 24 F
25 F 26 F 27 F
28 T 29 F 30 F
31 F 32 F 33 F
34 F 35 T 36 F
37 T 38 T 39 F
40 F 41 F
8. The prices of new issues are influenced, to a marked extent, by the price movements in the _________
market.
9. Origination, underwriting and _________ are three services provided by the new issue market.
10. _________ is a method to sell securities to the existing shareholders of a company.
11. Pricing of issues is left to the investors in _________.
Answers:
18. Write down the similarities between Primary and Secondary Market.
19. Write short notes on (a) American Depository Receipts (ADRs) (b) Global Depository Receipts (GDRs)
20. What is compulsory convertible debenture (CCD)? Discuss its advantages and disadvantages.
21. What are Euro and Masala Bonds?
22. What is Rolling Settlement? State its benefits.
23. Discuss the Clearing House Operations (CHO)
24. State the merits and demerits of Depository system of recording shares and trading in shares and securities.
25. What is Follow on Public Offer (FPO)?
26. What is Reverse Book Building? Discuss the process for Reverse Book Building.
27. Explain briefly the concept of Green-shoe Option.
28. Discuss the Private Placement issue mechanism.
29. What do you mean by Insider Trading?
30. Discuss on Credit Rating Symbols in India.
31. What is Money Market? Discuss the features of Money Market.
32. Mention the features of Treasury Bills.
33. Discuss different types of Commercial Bills.
34. What is Commercial Paper? Discuss its salient features and advantages.
35. Discuss on RBI Guidelines in respect of issue of commercial Paper.
36. What is Certificate of Deposits? State its features.
37. What is Promissory Note? Discuss the essentials of a Promissory Note.
38. What is Government Securities? Discuss the features of Government Securities.
11. Discuss important Securities and Exchange Board of India (SEBI) Regulations.
12. Highlight the functions of a capital market.
13. Write short notes on: Initial Public Offering (IPO), Follow on Public Offer (FPO), Book Building, Green-
shoe Option Initial Public Offering (IPO).
14. What is Book Building Process? Discuss advantages and disadvantages of Book Building.
15. What is Credit Rating? Discuss on Credit Rating Methods and Rating Agencies in India.
16. Discuss different types of Money Market Instruments.
17. Discuss different types of Government Securities.
18. What are the risks involved in holding Government securities?
19. What is preference share? What are the key merits and demerits of preference shares as a source of
longterm finance?
20. Write short notes on: straight bond value, conversion value, market value and market premium.
21. Discuss the method for valuation of compulsorily convertible debentures into shares.
22. How is the value of an optionally convertible debenture affected by the straight debenture value, conversion
value and option value?
23. What is a warrant? How does it differ from convertible securities?
B. Numerical Questions:
1. The RBI offers 91-Days Treasury Bills to raise ` 5,000 crore. The following have been received.
Answer:
Fully accepted bidders: AB Ltd., BC Ltd., CD Ltd.
Proportionately allotted bidders: DE Ltd. and EF Ltd.
2. PQR Ltd. issued Commercial Paper and the details are given below:
Date of Issue : 17th January 2023
Date of Maturity : 17th April 2024
No. of Days : 90 Days
Interest Rate : 11.25%
Face Value : ` 100
Issue Size : ` 1,000 crore
Calculate the net amount received by the company on issue of commercial paper.
Answer: ` 973 crore
Unsolved Case(s)
1. Gupta Dairy Ltd. is one of the leading manufacturers and marketers of dairy-based branded foods in Hyderabad.
In the initial years, its operation was restricted only to collection and distribution of milk. But, over the years
it has achieved a reasonable market share by offering a diverse range of dairy-based products including
fresh milk, flavoured yogurt, ice creams, butter milk, cheese, ghee etc. In order to raise the capital finance its
expansion plans, Gupta Dairy Ltd. has decided to approach capital market through a mix of offer for sale of 4
crore shares and a public issue of 2 crores shares.
In context of the above case:
(a) Name and explain the segment of capital being approached by Gupta Dairy Ltd. and
(b) Identify the methods of floatation used by Gupta Dairy Ltd. to raise the required capital.
2. The SEBI has imposed a penalty of ` 6200 crore on Asianol Corporation Limited (ACL) and its four directors,
namely Mr. T. Ghosh, Mr. S. Singh, Mr. Tanay Bose, and Mr. K. Bhattacharyya who had mobilized funds from
the general public through illegal collective investments schemes in the name of purchase and development of
agriculture land.
While imposing the penalty, the biggest in its history, SEBI said ACL that to deserve the maximum penalty
for duping the common man. Its prevention of Fraudulent and Unfair Trade Practices Regulations provides for
severe-to-severe penalties for dealing with such violation. As per SEBI norms, it can impose penalty of ` 25
crore or three times of the profit made by indulging in Fraudulent and Unfair Trade Practices of the illicit gains.
In the context of the above case:
(a) State the objectives of setting up SEBI
(b) Identify the type of function performed by SEBI.
3. S. Ltd. is a large creditworthy company operating in Eastern India. It is an export-oriented unit, dealing in high
quality Basmati Rice. The floods in the region have created many problems for S. Ltd. Packaged rice has been
destroyed due to this. The S. Ltd. is therefore, unable to get an uninterrupted supply of rice from the wholesale
suppliers. To add to the problems of the organisation, the wholesale suppliers of rice who were earlier selling
on credit are asking the S. Ltd. for advance payment or cash payment on delivery. The company (S. Ltd.) is
facing a liquidity crisis.
The CEO of the S. Ltd. feels that taking a bank loan is the only option with the company to meet its short-term
shortage of cash.
As a finance manager of the S. Ltd., name and explain the alternative to bank borrowings that the company (S.
Ltd) can use to resolve the crisis.
References:
● Bhole, L. M. and Jitendra Mahakud, Financial Institutions and Markets: Structure, Growth and Innovations,
6e, 2017, McGraw Hill Education (India) Private Limited
● Chambers, Donald R., and Nelson J. Lacey. “Corporate Ethics and Shareholder Wealth Maximization.”
Financial Practice and Education 6 (Spring–Summer 1996), 93– 96.
● Chandra Prasanna, Financial Management, Theory and Practice, McGraw Hill., 2019.
● Fama, Eugene F; French, Kenneth R (Summer 2004). The Capital Asset Pricing Model: Theory and Evidence.
Journal of Economic Perspectives. 18 (3): 25 – 46.
● Fischer Donald E, and Jordon Ronald J., Security Analysis and Portfolio Management, PHI.
● Francis, Jack Clark, Investments: Analysis and Management, McGraw-Hill, Inc. New York: 1991.
● Gupta, L C, and Jain, N, “Indian Securities Depository System”, EPW, May 17, 2003.
● H. Markowitz, Portfolio Selection: Efficient Diversification of Investments, John Wiley & Sons, 1959.
A
financial statement is a numerical report covering financial information to express the financial results
and financial condition of the concern. According to AICPA (American Institute of Certified Public
Accountants), financial statements reflect a combination of recorded facts, accounting principles and
personal judgements.
Financial statements are prepared for presenting a periodical review or report on the progress by the management
and deal with
(i) the status of investments in the business and
(ii) the results achieved during the period under review.
The financial analysis of an enterprise is usually undertaken so that investors, creditors, and other stakeholders can
make decisions about those companies. It may be used internally to evaluate issues like employee performance,
operating efficiency, credit policies and exterrnally important to evaluate potential investments and credit-
worthiness of borrowers, among other things.
An analyst draws the financial data needed in financial analysis from many sources. The primary source is the data
provided by the company itself in its annual report and required disclosures. The annual report comprises of balance
sheet, income statement, the statement of cash flows as well as footnotes to these statements, chairman’s speech,
the director’s report, the auditor’s report and accounting policy changes. Schedules, supplementary statements,
explanatory notes, footnotes etc. supports these statements.
A. Financial Analysis – Meaning and Concept
Financial analysis means proper arrangement of the financial data and methodical classification of the data
given in the financial statement and regrouped into their distinct and different components parts. It involves
the division of facts based on some definite plans, classifying them into classes based on certain condition
and presenting them in most convenient simple and understandable form. It is really an art, it involves many
processes; like arrangement, analysis, establishing relations between available facts and drawing conclusion
on that basis.
The figures given in the financial statement will not help unless they are put in a simplified form. Interpretation
means explaining the meaning and significance of the data so simplified. It is comparison and examination of
components for making conclusion about the profitability, efficiency and liquidity position of the business.
B. Objectives of Financial Analysis
The basic objectives of financial analysis are as follows:
i. To examine the financial health of a firm;
ii. To evaluate the profitability of the enterprise;
iii. To understand the long-term and short-term solvency position of the firm;
iv. To study the debt servicing capacity of the firm;
Ratio Analysis
T
he analysis which is based on single year’s statement, will not be very much useful. For this purpose,
comparative analysis, common size analysis, trend analysis are necessary. In this section, comparative,
common-size financial statements and trend analysis are discussed.
(iv) Keeping in mind that the principles and procedures followed in the collection, and presentation of data should
not materially differ over the periods.
Advantages
The advantages of Comparative Financial Analysis are as follows
(i) Figures for two or more periods are placed side by side to facilitate inter-firm comparison and in horizontal
analysis.
(ii) It brings out more clearly the nature and trend of current changes that affect the enterprise.
(iii) It helps in estimating weakness in the operating cycle, financial health and future position of the business.
Disadvantages
(i) Comparative Financial Analysis may be misleading, if frequent changes have been allowed in principles and
procedures over the periods.
(ii) Without the knowledge of internal analysis, it may be extremely misleading.
(iii) It does not show the relation of any items to total assets or to total liabilities or to total net sales in a year.
(iv) Proper comparison between two or more firms cannot be possible by this statement because there is no
common base of comparison.
While calculating trend percentages care should be taken regarding the following matters: -
(i) The uniform accounting system should be followed from year to year for horizontal analysis.
(ii) The accounting principles and practices should follow consistency convention throughout the period of
analysis. Without such consistency, the comparison will be adversely affected.
(iii) The base year should be that normal year which is monitored and representative of the items shown in the
statement.
(iv) Trend percentages should be calculated only for items having logical relationship with one another.
(v) Trend percentages should be studied after considering the absolute figures on which they are based, otherwise,
they may give misleading results. For example, one expense may increase from ` 100 to ` 200 while other
expenses may increase from ` 10,000 to ` 15,000. In the first case, trend percentage will show 100% increase
while in second case it will show 50% increase. This is misleading because in the first case, the change
though 100% is not at all significant in Absolute/Monetary real terms as compared to second case.
(vi) The figures for the current year should also be adjusted in the light of price level changes as compared to the
base year before calculating the trend percentage, otherwise comparison will be meaningless.
Advatages
(i) It shows the trend of items with passage of time.
(ii) It shows the nature and rate of movement of various financial factors.
(iii) It shows horizontal and vertical analysis to reflect the behaviour of various financial items with passage of
time.
(iv) It helps in estimating the financial factor in future.
Disadvatages
If there is no uniform accounting system year after year, then trend ratios give misleading result.
(i) It does not take into consideration the inflation accounting system. So, figures of base period are incomparable
with the figures of current period in case of inflation.
(ii) Trend ratios must be always read with absolute data on which they are based, otherwise the conclusion drawn
may be misleading. It may be said that a 10% change in trend ratio may represent an absolute change of
`1000 only in one item, while a 10% change in another item may represent an absolute change of ` 10,000.
Illustration 1
From the following income statement, prepare a common size statement and also interpret the results.
Income Statement for the year ended 31st March
Particulars 2023 (`) 2024 (`)
Net Sales 10,50,000 13,50,000
Less: Cost of Goods Sold 5,70,000 6,45,000
Gross Profit 4,80,000 7,05,000
Less: Other Operating Expenses 1,50,000 2,16,000
Operating Profit 3,30,000 4,89,000
Less: Interest on Long-term Debt 60,000 51,000
Profit Before Tax (PBT) 2,70,000 4,38,000
Solution :
Common Size Statement for the year ended 31st March, 2023 and 2024
45.7% 52.2%
Gross Profit
Comments:
(i) The PBT to net sales has increased from 25.7% in the year 2022-23 to 32.4% in the year 2023-24. It indicates
that the profit earning capacity of the company has improved during the study period. This improvement in
the profitability of the company has been mainly due to significant reduction in the cost of goods sold of the
company. It may occur due to fall down of input market or may occur due to improvement in the efficiency
of the company. As other operating expenses are higher in 2023-24 so, it is clear that company has been
operated with tight supervision, tight inventory control for reduction of Cost of Goods Sold.
(ii) The interest on long-term debt to net sales has declined from 5.7% in the 2022-23 to 3.8% in 2023-24. It
implies that the financial burden of the company has reduced significantly during the study period. Higher
operating profit or fund from operation has been utilised for repayment of long-term debt, so that the financial
risk associated with the company has declined significantly during the study period.
Illustration 2
From the following figures prepare a common size comparative statement and comment on the results.
Cost of Materials
× 100
Sales
Labour Cost 16.67% 12.73% 15% 15% 18.42%
Labour Cost
× 100
Sales
Conversion Cost 12.50% 13.64% 14% 20% 18.42%
Conversion Cost
× 100
Sales
Total Manufacturing Cost 41.67% 46.36% 54% 55% 57.89%
Gross Profit
× 100
Net Sales
Operating Profit
× 100
Sales
Comments:
From the above analysis, it can be concluded that there was a clear upward rising trend in the manufacturing cost
of goods sold during the study period. As a result, gross profit to sales has been decreased very significantly during
the same period. It was 58.33% in the year 2019-20 which ultimately reduced to 42.11% in the ultimate year of the
study period i.e., 2023-24. It implies that operational efficiency of the company has been reduced very significantly
during the period.
Illustration 3
From the following balance sheet prepare a common size statement and comment.
Solution:
Common Size Balance Sheet as on 31.03.2023 & 31.03.2024
On 31.03.2023 On 31.03.2024
Particulars
% of total % of total
Shareholders’ Fund
Equity Share Capital 40% 36.92%
) Share Capital
Total Liabilities
× 100
)
Reserve & Surplus 16% 28%
) Reserve & Surplus
Total Liabilities
× 100
)
Total Shareholders Fund/Owners’ Equity 56% 64.22%
Non-current Liabilities
Long-Term Debt 30.33% 26.05%
) Long-Term Debt
Total Liabilities
× 100
)
Current Liabilities
Fixed Assets
Total Assets × 100
Current Assets
Inventory 14% 18%
Inventory
Total Assets × 100
Debtors
Total Assets × 100
On 31.03.2023 On 31.03.2024
Particulars
% of total % of total
Bank 9% 12%
Bank
Total Assets × 100
Comments:
(i) The proportion of owner’s equity to total liabilities of the company has been increased from 56% to 64.92%
whereas the proportion of long-term debt to total liabilities has been decreased from 30.33% to 26.05% in
the year 2023-24. So, we can conclude that the dependency on outsiders has been decreased and degree of
financial risk associated with the company has been reduced during the study period.
(ii) The percentage of current assets to total assets has been increased from 33% to 40% whereas the percentage of
current liabilities to total liabilities decreased from 13.33% to 9% in the year 2023-24. Therefore, it indicates
that the liquidity position of the company has been significantly improved during the period under study.
But reduction of fixed assets may hamper the long-term stability and operating efficiency of the company.
Illustration 4
The following are the income statements of A Limited for the years ended 31.03.2023 and 31.03.2024
Solution:
Comparative Income Statement of A Ltd. for the years ended 31st March, 2023 and 2024
Amount of Percentage
31.03.23 31.03.24
Particulars increase (+) or increase (+) or
(`) (`)
decrease (-) (`) decrease (-) (`)
Net Sales 1,70,000 1,90,400 (+) 20,400 Note (i) (+) 12.0
Less: Cost of goods sold 1,05,000 1,20,000 (+) 15,000 Note (ii) (+) 14.3
Gross Profit (P) 65,000 70,400 (+) 5,400 (+) 8.3
Administrative expenses (A) 13,200 14,960 (+) 1,760 (+) 13.3
Selling expenses:
Advertisement expenses 3,000 4,000 (+) 1,000 (+) 33.3
Other selling expenses 40,800 41,800 (+) 1,000 (+) 2.5
Total selling expenses (B) 43,800 45,800 (+) 2,000 (+) 4.6
Operating expenses (A + B) 57,000 60,760 (+) 3,760 (+) 6.6
Operating Profit (D) [D = P – (A + B)] 8,000 9,640 (+) 1,640 (+) 20.5
Other Incomes (E) 6,400 9,200 (+) 2,800 (+) 43.8
Other expenses (F) 6,800 4,800 (–) 2,000 (–) 29.4
Profit before tax (PBT) [PBT = D + E – F] 7,600 14,040 (+) 6,440 84.7
Income tax (T) 3,800 6,200 (+) 2,400 (+) 63.2
Profit after tax (PAT) [PAT = PBT – T] 3,800 7,840 (+) 4,040 (+) 106.3
Notes: Calculation for percentage increase (+) or decrease (–):
` 20, 400
(i) ` 1, 70, 000 × 100 = 12%
` 15, 000
(ii) ` 1, 05, 000 × 100 = 14.3%; and so on.
Comments:
Comparative income statement shows the income and expenses of two periods of same company, absolute changes
of each item for the year ended 31.03.2024 over 31.03.2023 and also shows percentage change.
The following comments can be made on the performance of A Ltd.:
(i) Sales of A Ltd. has been increased by ` 20,400 during the year 2023-24 over 2022-23. But, the cost of goods
sold has also increased by ` 15,000 in the same period. i.e., sales have improved by 12% and cost of goods
sold has increased by 14.3%. So, Gross Profit has not improved markedly. Cost of goods sold may increase
due to higher quantity of sales or due to higher input cost. As sale value has increased so it is clear cost of
goods sold has increased due to higher quantity of sales. If such quantity has been sold at previous price, then
sales value has been increased with higher amount. But here sales value has not increased significantly. It
indicates that the addition in sales has been due to lowering of sale price. It is also clear from advertisement
expenses. The increase in advertisement expenses (33.3%) has been much higher than the percentage increase
reduction of sale price was necessary in order to higher quantity of sales. Such situation may also arise due
to new product launching where huge advertisement is necessary and reduction of sale price is necessary.
(ii) There has been a substantial improvement in other incomes, both in relative term (43.8%) and in absolute
term (` 2,800). Similarly, there has been a considerable reduction in other expenses in relative term (29.4%)
as well as in absolute term (` 2,000). These items have been responsible for the increase in profit before tax
(PBT) for the period under study by 84.7%. It implies that more emphasis has been given by the management
of the company on earning non-operating profits as compared to the operating profits.
Illustration 5
Compute the Trend Ratios from the following data and comment.
Solution:
Computation of Trend Ratio (%)
2021-2022 2022-2023 2023-2024
2020-2021 2021 – 22 2022 – 23 2023 – 24
× 100 × 100 × 100
2020 – 21 2020 – 21 2020 – 21
R
atio analysis is the process of determining and interpreting numerical relationships based on financial
statements. A ratio is a statistical yard stick that provides a measure of the relationship between variables
figures. This relationship can be expressed as percent (i.e., cost of goods sold as a percent of sales) or as
a quotient (i.e., current assets as a certain number of times the current liabilities).
As ratios are simple to calculate and easy to understand there is a tendency to employ them profusely. While such
statistical calculations stimulate thinking and develop understanding there is a danger of accumulation of a mass
of data that obscures rather than clarifies relationships. The financial analyst has to steer a careful course. His
experience and objective of analysis help him in determining which of the ratios are more meaningful in a given
situation.
Ratios are used by the (i) Owners or investors; (ii) Creditors; and (iii) Financial executives. Although all these
three groups are interested in the financial conditions and operating results of an enterprise the primary information
that each seeks to obtain from these statements is to serve. Investors desire a primary basis for estimating earning
capacity. Creditors (trade and financial) are concerned primarily with liquidity and ability to pay interest and
redeem loan within a specific period. Management is interested in evolving analytical tools that will measure costs,
efficiency, liquidity and profitability with a view to making intelligent decisions.
Classification of Ratios
In view of the requirements of the various users of ratios, we may classify them into the following important
categories:
A. Profitability Ratios
B. Activity Ratios
C. Solvency Ratios
D. Valuation and Payout Ratios
These are discussed below:
A. Profitability Ratios
These ratios give an indication of the efficiency with which the operations of business are carried on. The following
are the important profitability ratios:
(i) Gross Profit Ratio (GPR):
This ratio expresses the relationship between Gross Profit and Net Sales. It can be computed as follows:
Gross Profit
GPR = × 100
Net Sales (i.e., Less sales returns)
Significance: The ratio indicates the overall limit within which a business must manage its operating expenses.
It also helps in ascertaining whether the average percentage of mark-up on the goods is maintained. A high
gross profit margin ratio is a sign of good management. A low gross profit margin may reflect higher cost of
goods sold due to the firm’s inability to purchase raw materials at favourable terms, inefficient utilization of
plant and machinery, or over-investment in plant and machinery, resulting in higher cost of production.
expenses, (iv) financial expenses but excludes taxes, dividends and extraordinary losses due to theft of goods,
good destroyed by fire and so on. There are different variants of expenses ratios. That is,
Cost of Goods Sold
(a) Cost of Goods Sold Ratio = × 100
Net Sales
Operating Expenses
(b) Operating Expenses Ratio = × 100
Net Sales
(v) Return on Investment:
An investor or shareholder or other interested parties want to know how much return they will get from their
investment. From the firm’s perspective investment may refer to total assets or net assets. Net assets are total
assets minus current liabilities. Shareholders’ investment is reflected by total equity (net worth). Investments
made by shareholders and debtholders is known as capital employed or invested capital. Invested capital is
capital employed minus cash, cash equivalents and goodwill. Based on the different aspects, we can calculate
the following Return on Investment (ROI) ratios:
(a) Return on Assets (ROA): This ratio measures the operating efficiency of a firm’s assets in generating
profit without effect of methods of financing. It can be calculated as follows:
Earnings before Interest and Taxes (1-Tax)
Post-tax Return on Net Assets (RONA) =
Total Assets
The term average account receivable includes trade debtors and bills receivable. Average accounts receivables
are computed by taking the average receivables in the beginning and at the end of the accounting year.
Debtors’ turnover ratio is used to measure how rapidly receivables are collected. The higher the ratio, better
it is. A high ratio indicates that debts are collected rapidly. The formula for computation of debtors collection
period is as follows:
Debtors Collection Period 12 Months
=
(in month) Debtors Turnover Ratio
For example, if the credit sales are ` 80,000, average accounts receivable ` 20,000, the debtors’ turnover ratio
and debt collection period will be computed as follows:
Net Credit Sales
Debtors Turnover Ratio =
Average Accounts Receivable
80,000
=
20,000
12 Months
Debtors Collection Period =
Debtors Turnover Ratio
12 months
=
4 months
= 3 months
This means on an average three months credit is allowed to the debtor. An increase in the credit period would
result in unnecessary blockage of funds and with increased possibility of losing money due to debts becoming
bad.
Significance: Debtors turnover ratio or debt collection period ratio measures the quality of debtors since
it indicates the speed with which money is collected from the debtor. A shorter collection period implies
prompt payment by debtor. A longer collection period implies too liberal and inefficient credit collection
performance. The credit policy should neither be too liberal nor too restrictive. The former will result in more
blockage of funds and bad debts while the latter will cause lower sales which will reduce profits.
For example, the credit sales of a firm in a year amount to ` 12,00,000. The outstanding amount of debtors at
the beginning and end of the year were ` 1,40,000 and ` 1,60,000 respectively.
` 12,00,000
Debtors turnover ratio = = 8 (times per year)
(` 1,40,000 + 1,60,000) / 2
12 months
The average collection period = = 1.5 months
8
(iii) Creditors (Accounts Payable) Turnover Ratio:
This is similar to Debtors Turnover Ratio. It indicates the speed with which payments for credit purchases are
made to creditors. It can be computed as follows:
Net Credit Purchases
Creditors Turnover Period =
Average Accounts Payable
The term ‘accounts payable’ include trade creditors and bills payable.
With the help of the creditors’ turnover ratio, creditors payment period can be computed as follows:
Creditors Payment Period 12 Months
=
(in month) Creditors Turnover Ratio
For example, if the credit purchases during a year are ` 1,00,000, Average accounts payable ` 25,000, the
creditors’ turnover ratio and Creditor’s collection period will be computed as follows:
Net Credit Purchases
Creditors Turnover Period =
Average Accounts Receivable
` 1,00,000
=
` 25,000
= 4 (times per year)
12 Months
Creditors Payment Period =
Creditors Turnover Ratio
12 months
=
4
= 3 months
Significance: The creditors turnover ratio and the creditors payment period indicate about the promptness
or otherwise in making payment for credit purchases. A higher creditors turnover ratio or a lower creditors
payment period signifies that the creditors are being paid promptly thus enhancing the credit-worthiness of
the company. However, a very favourable ratio to this effect also shows that the business is not taking full
advantage of credit facilities which can be allowed by the creditors.
(iv) Fixed Assets Turnover Ratio:
The ratio indicates the extent to which the investment in fixed assets has contributed towards sales. The ratio
can be calculated as follows:
Net Sales
Fixed Assets Turnover Ratio =
Net Fixed Assets
Significance: The comparison of fixed assets turnover ratio over a period of time indicates whether the
investment in fixed assets has been judicious or not. Of course, investment in fixed assets does not pushup
sales immediately but the trend of increasing sales should be visible. If such trend is not visible or increase
in sales has not been achieved after the expiry of a reasonable time it can be very well said that increased
investments in fixed assets has not been judicious.
(v) Total Assets Turnover Ratio:
Some analysts prefer to calculate total assets turnover ratio.
Net Sales
Net Assets Turnover Ratio =
Total Assets
(vi) Working Capital Turnover Ratio:
Working capital turnover ratio is a formula that calculates how efficiently a company uses working capital to
generate sales. In this formula, working capital refers to the operating capital that a company uses in day-to-
day operations. This ratio demonstrates a company’s ability to use its working capital to generate income.
This formula may also be referred to as net sales to working capital.
Net Annual Sales
Working Capital Turnover Ratio =
Working Capital
For example, if a company’s sales is ` 10,00,000 in sales for a calendar year and ` 2,00,000 is working capital,
then its working capital turnover ratio would be ` 5. This means that every rupee of working capital produces
` 5 in revenue.
C. Solvency Ratios
Solvency Ratios indicate about the financial position of the company. A company is considered to be financially
sound if it is in a position to carry on its business smoothly and meet all its obligations both short-term and
longterm without strain. The Financial or Solvency Ratios can therefore be classified into following categories:
(i) Long-term Solvency Ratios, which include fixed assets ratio, debt equity ratio and proprietary ratio;
(ii) Short-term Solvency Ratios, which include current ratio, liquidity ratio, super-quick ratio and defensive
interval ratio & debt service coverage ratio.
Each of these ratios are now being discussed in detail-
(1) Long-term Solvency Ratios
(i) Debt-Equity Ratio:
The ratio is determined to ascertain the proportion between the ‘outsiders’ ‘funds and share-holders funds’ in
the capital structure of an enterprise. The term outsiders’ funds are generally used to represent total longterm
debt. The ratio can be computed as follows:
Total Long-term Debt
Debt – Equity Ratio =
Shareholders’ Funds
Another approach to the calculation of the debt-equity ratio is to relate the total debt (not merely long-term
debt) to the shareholders’ equity. That is,
In such a case the ratio will be computed as follows:
Total Debt
=
Shareholders’ Funds
The ratio is considered to be ideal if the shareholders’ funds are equal to total long-term debt. However, these
days the ratio is also acceptable if the total long-term debt does not exceed twice of shareholders’ funds.
Significance: The ratio is an indication of the soundness of the long-term financial policies pursued by the
business enterprise. The excessive dependence on outsiders’ funds may cause insolvency of the business. The
ratio provides the margin of safety to the creditor. It tells the owners the extent to which they can gain by
maintaining control with a limited investment.
(ii) Proprietary Ratio:
It is a variant of Debt-Equity Ratio. It establishes relationship between the proprietors’ or shareholders’ funds
and the total tangible assets. It may be expressed as follows:
Shareholders’ Funds
Properietary Ratio =
Total Tangible Assets
Significance: The ratio focuses attention on the general financial strength of the business enterprise. The ratio
is of particular importance to the creditors who can find out the proportion of shareholders’ funds in the total
assets employed in the business. A high proprietary ratio will indicate a relatively little danger to the creditors
or vise-versa in the event of forced reorganization or winding up of the company.
(iii) Capital Gearing Ratio:
This ratio is a useful tool to analyze the capital structure of a company and is computed by dividing the
common stockholders’ equity by fixed interest or dividend bearing funds. Analyzing capital structure means
measuring the relationship between the funds provided by common stockholders and the funds provided by
those who receive a periodic interest or dividend at a fixed rate. A company is said to be low geared if the
larger portion of the capital is composed of common stockholders’ equity. On the other hand, the company
is said to be highly geared if the larger portion of the capital is composed of fixed interest/dividend bearing
funds.
Capital gearing refers to a company’s relative leverage, i.e., its debt versus its equity value.
To calculate the capital gearing ratio, use the following formula:
Common Stockholders’ Equity
Capital Gearing Ratio =
Fixed Cost bearing Funds
For example, the following information has been taken from the Balance Sheet of L&T Limited.
8% bonds payable: ` 8,00,000
12% preferred stock: ` 7,00,000
Common stockholders’ equity: ` 2,000,000
Required: Calculate the company’s capital gearing ratio.
Solution:
Common Stockholders’ Equity
Capital Gearing Ratio =
Fixed Cost bearing Funds
` 20,00,000
=
(` 8,00,000 + ` 7,00,000
` 20,00,000
=
(` 15,00,000
= 4 : 3 (low-geared)
(2) Short-term Solvency Ratios
(i) Current Ratio
The ratio is an indicator of the firm’s commitment to meet its short-term liabilities. It is expressed as follows:
Current Assets
Current Ratio =
Current Liabilities
An ideal current ratio is 2:1. However, a ratio of 1.5:1 is also acceptable if the firm has adequate arrangements
with its bankers to meet its short-term requirements of funds.
Significance: The ratio is an index of the concern’s financial stability, since, it shows the extent to which the
current assets exceed its current liabilities. A higher current ratio would indicate inadequate employment of
funds, while a poor current ratio is a danger signal to the management.
(ii) Liquidity/Quick Ratio:
The ratio is also termed as Acid Test Ratio or Quick Ratio. The ratio is ascertained by comparing the liquid
assets i.e., current assets (excluding stock and prepaid expenses) to current liabilities.
Some accountants prefer the term liquid liabilities for current liabilities. The term ‘liquid liabilities’ means
liabilities payable within a short period. Bank overdraft and cash credit facilities (if they become permanent
modes of financing) are excluded from current liabilities for this purpose. The ratio may be expressed as
follows:
Liquid Assets
Current Ratio =
Current Liabilities
An ideal liquidity ratio is ‘1:1’.
Significance: The ratio is an indicator of short-term solvency of the company. A comparison of the current
ratio to quick ratio should also indicate the inventory hold-ups. For instance, if two units have the same
current ratio but different liquidity ratios, it indicates over-stocking by the concern having low liquidity ratio
as compared to the firm which has a higher liquidity ratio.
(iii) Fixed Charges Cover Ratio (FCCR):
The ratio indicates the number of times the fixed financial charges are covered by income before interest and
tax. This ratio is calculated as follows:
Income before Interest and Tax
FCCR =
Interest
Significance: The ratio is significant from the lender’s point of view. It indicates whether the business would
earn sufficient profits to pay periodically the interest charges. Higher the ratio, better it is.
(iv) Defensive-Interval Ratio (DIR)
This ratio denotes the liquidity of a firm in relation to its ability to meet projected daily expenditure from
operations. It can be expressed as follows:
Liquid Assets (Quick Assets)
Defensive Interval Ratio =
Daily Cash Requirements (Projected)
For example, if the market price of an equity share is ` 20 and earnings per share is ` 5, the price earnings
ratio will be 4 (i.e., 20 ÷ 5). This means for every one rupee of earning people are prepared to pay ` 4.
In other words, the rate of return expected by the investors is 25% Significance. P/E Ratio helps the
investors in deciding whether to buy or not to buy the shares of a company at a particular price. For
Instance, in the example given, if the EPS falls to ` 3, the market price of the share should be ` 12 (i.e.,
3 × 4). In case the market price of the share is ` 15, it will not be advisable to purchase the company’s
shares at that price.
(ii) Market Value to Book Value Share (MV/BV):
This ratio indicates the share price to book value per share.
Market Value Per Share
Market Value to Book Value Share Ratio =
Book Value Per Share
(iii) Tobin’s q:
Tobin’s q is the ratio of the market value of a firm’s assets (or equity and debt) to its assets’ replacement
costs.
Market Value of Assets
Tobin’s q =
Replacement Costs of Assets
(iv) Dividend Pay-Out Ratio:
The ratio indicates what proportion of earning per share has been used for paying dividend. It can be
calculated as follows:
Dividend per Equity Share
Pay-Out Ratio =
Earnings per Equity Share
The lower the pay-out ratio, the higher will be the amount of earnings ploughed back in the business. A
lower pay-out ratio means a stronger financial position of the company.
(v) Dividend Yield Ratio (DYR):
The ratio is calculated by comparing the rate of dividend per share with its market value. It is calculated
as follows:
Dividend per Share
DYR = × 100
Market Price per Share
Significance: The ratio helps an intending investor in knowing the effective return he is going to get on
his investment.
For example, if the market price of a share is ` 25, paid-up value is ` 10 and dividend rate is 20%. The
dividend yield ratio is 8% (i.e., 100 × 2/25). The intending investor can now decide whether it will be
advisable for him to go for purchasing the shares of the company or not at the price prevailing in the
market.
Ratios in Different Industries:
1. Ratios used in Hotel Industry: The variety of ratios used by hotel industry which are:
(i) Room Occupancy Ratio
(ii) Bed Occupancy Ratio
(iii) Double Occupancy Ratio
(iv) Seat Occupancy Ratios etc.
2. Ratios used in Transport Industry: The following important ratios are used in transport industry:
(i) Passenger Kilometers
(ii) Seat occupancy Ratios
(iii) Operating cost per kilometer
3. Bank Industry: The following important ratios are used in Bank Industry:
(i) Operating expenses ratios for various periods
(ii) Loans to deposits ratios
(iii) Operating income ratios for various periods
4. Telecom Industry: The following important ratios are used in telecom Industry.
(i) Average duration of the outgoing call
(ii) Number of outgoing calls per connection
(iii) Revenue per customer
Illustration 7
Following is the Profit and Loss Account and Balance Sheet of Jai Hind Ltd. Redraft them for the purpose of
analysis and calculate the following ratios: (1) Gross Profit Ratio (2) Overall Profitability Ratio (3) Current Ratio
(4) Debt-Equity Ratio (5) Stock-Turnover Ratio (6) Finished Goods Turnover Ratio (7) Liquidity Ratio.
Dr. Profit and Loss A/C for the year ended 31st March, 2024 Cr.
Particulars (`)
Bank 50,000
Debtors 1,00,000
Liquid assets 1,50,000
(+) Stock (Raw Materials and Furnished Goods) 2,50,000
Current assets 4,00,000
(–) Current liabilities (Sundry Creditors and Bills Payable) (1,50,000)
Working capital 2,50,000
(+) Fixed assets 2,50,000
` 50,000 + ` 1,50,000
[Average Stock of Raw Materials = = ` 1,00,000]
2
` 1,00,000 + ` 1,00,000
[Average Stock of Raw Materials = = ` 1,00,000]
2
Illustration 8
The capital of A Ltd. is as follows:
Additional information: Profit (after tax at 35%), ` 2,70,000; Depreciation, ` 60,000; Equity dividend paid 20%;
Market price of equity shares, ` 50.
You are required to compute the following, showing the necessary workings: (a) Dividend yield on the equity
shares (b) Cover for the preference and equity dividends (c) Earnings per shares and (d) Price-earnings ratio.
Solution:
= ` 2 (0.20 × ` 10)
× 100
Market price per share
= 4%
(b) Dividend Coverage Ratio :
` 2,70,000
= = 9 times
` 30,000 (0.10 of ` 3,00,000)
` 2,70,000 – ` 30,000
= = 152 times
` 1,60,000 (80,000 shares ` 2)
(c) Earnings per Equity Share = Earning available to equity shareholders = ` 2,40,000 = ` 3 per share
Number of equity shares outstanding 80,000
Illustration 9
The following are the ratios relating to the activities of X Ltd.
Gross profit for the current year ended December, 31st, 2024 amounts to ` 4,00,000. Closing stock of the year is
` 10,000 above the opening stock. Bills receivables amount to ` 25,000 and bills payable to ` 10,000. Find out (a)
Sales, (b) Closing Stock, and (c) Sundry Creditors.
Solution:
(a) Determination of sales:
` 4,00,000
Sales = × 100 = ` 16,00,000
25
Stock Turnover = Cost of Goods Sold (Sales – Gross Profit) = ` 12,00,000 = 1.5
Average Stock Average Stock
` 12,00,000
6=
Creditors + ` 10,000
Zones of discriminations:
Z > 2.60 “Safe” Zone
1.1 < Z < 2.60 “Grey” Zone
Z < 1.1 “Distress” Zone
Illustration: 10
From the information given below relating to Bad Past Ltd., calculate Altman’s Z-score and comment:
(i) Working Capital to Total Assets = 25%
(ii) Retained Earnings to Total Assets = 30%
(iii) EBIT to Total Assets = 15%
(iv) Market Value of Equity Shares to Book Value of Total Debt = 150%
(v) Sales to Total Assets = 2 times
Solution:
As per Altman’s Model (1968) of Corporate Distress Prediction:
Z= 1.2 X1 +1.4 X2 + 3.3 X3 + 0.6 X4 + 1.0 X5
Here, the five variables are as follows:
X1 = Working Capital to Total Assets = 25%
X2 = Retained Earnings to Total Assets = 30%
X3 = EBIT to Total Assets = 15%
X4 = Market Value of Equity Shares to Book Value of Total Debt =150%
X5 = Sales to Total Assets = 2 times
Hence, Z-score = (1.2 × 25%) + (1.4 × 30%) + (3.3 × 15%) + (0.6 × 150%) + (1 × 2.00)
= 0.30 + 0.42 + 0.495 + 0.90 + 2.00
= 4.115
Comment: As the calculated value of Z-score is much higher than 2.99, it can be strongly predicted that the
company is a non-bankrupt company.
2. Beneish M Score
In 1999, Messod D. Beneish developed a mathematical model that uses financial ratios and eight variables to
identify whether a company has manipulated its earnings1. Beneish M Score helps to uncover companies who are
likely to be manipulating their reported earnings. Companies with a higher score are more likely to be manipulators.
He also found that companies are incentivised to manipulate profits if they have high sales growth, deteriorating
gross margins, rising operating expenses and rising leverage. They are likely to manipulate profits by accelerating
sales recognition, increasing cost deferrals, raising accruals and reducing depreciation.
1 Beneish Messod D. (1999), The Detection of Earnings Manipulation, Financial Analysts Journal, Vol. 55, No. 5 (Sep. -
Oct., 1999), pp. 24-36.
4. Sales Growth Index (SGI): High sales growth does not imply manipulation but high growth companies
are more likely to commit financial fraud because their financial position and capital needs put pressure on
managers to achieve earnings targets. If growth firms face large stock prices losses at the first indication of a
slowdown, they may have greater incentives to manipulate earnings.
SGI = Salest / Salest-1
5. Depreciation Index (DEPI): A falling level of depreciation relative to net fixed assets raises the possibility
that a firm has revised upwards the estimated useful life of assets, or adopted a new method that is income
increasing.
DEPI = (Depreciationt-1/ (PP&Et-1 + Depreciationt-1)) / (Depreciationt / (PP&Et + Depreciationt))
6. Sales, General and Administrative Expenses (SGAI): Analysts might interpret a disproportionate increase
in SG&A relative to sales as a negative signal about a firm’s future prospects, thereby creating an inventive to
inflate profits.
SGAI = (SG&A Expenset / Salest) / (SG&A Expenset-1 / Salest-1)
7. Leverage Index (LVGI): Leverage is measured as total debt relative to total assets. An increase in leverage
creates an incentive to manipulate profits in order to meet debt covenants.
LVGI = [(Current Liabilitiest + Total Long-term Debtt) / Total Assetst] / [(Current Liabilitiest-1 + Total Long-
term Debtt-1) / Total Assetst-1]
8. Total Accruals to Total Assets (TATA): Total accruals are calculated as the change in working capital (other
than cash) less depreciation relative to total assets. Accruals, or a portion thereof, reflect the extent to which
managers make discretionary accounting choices to alter earnings. A higher level of accruals is, therefore,
associated with a higher likelihood of profit manipulation.
TATA = (Income from Continuing Operationst - Cash Flows from Operationst) / Total Assetst
Beneish M Score
Beneish M Score = −4.84 + 0.92 × DSRI + 0.528 × GMI + 0.404 × AQI + 0.892 × SGI + 0.115 × DEPI −0.172
× SGAI + 4.679 × TATA − 0.327 × LVGI
Interpretation:
(a) The threshold value is -1.78 for the model.
(b) If M-score is less than -1.78, the company is unlikely to be a manipulator. For example, an M-score value of
-2.50 suggests a low likelihood of manipulation.
(c) If M-score is greater than −1.78, the company is likely to be a manipulator. For example, an M-score value of
-1.50 suggests a high likelihood of manipulation.
Here are optimal cut-offs according to Beneish, presented as the score followed by the cost of Type I error relative
to cost of Type II error):
M Score Table
2 Piotroski Joseph D., (2000) Value Investing: The Use of Historical Financial Statement Information to Separate Winners
from Losers, The University of Chicago Graduate School of Business
point, and if it is not met, then no points are awarded. The points are then added up to determine the best value
stocks. Piotroski stated that the financial strength of a company could be determined using data solely from its
financial statements. Moreover, a score of 0 is expected to have the weakest financial performance.
F -Score is based on nine signals which measure a stock’s financial condition from three perspectives: profitability,
financial leverage/liquidity and operating efficiency. A fundamental signal is classified as either good or bad
whereof one is good and zero is bad.
A. Financial Performance Signals: Profitability
1. Return on Assets (ROA): (1 point if it is positive in the current year, 0 otherwise);
2. Operating Cash Flow (CFO) (1 point if it is positive in the current year, 0 otherwise);
3. Change in Return of Assets (ΔROA) (1 point if ROA is higher in the current year compared to the previous
one, 0 otherwise);
4. Accruals (F_ ACCRUAL) (1 point if Operating Cash Flow/Total Assets is higher than ROA in the current
year, 0 otherwise);
He defined ROA and CFO as net income before extraordinary items and cash flow from operations, respectively,
scaled by beginning of the year total assets. If the firm’s ROA (CFO) is positive, the indicator variable would
be F_ROA (F_CFO) equal to one, zero otherwise. Further, ΔROA defined as the current year’s ROA less the
prior year’s ROA. If ΔROA > 0, the indicator variable F_ ΔROA equals one, zero otherwise.
The variable ACCRUAL defined as current year’s net income before extraordinary items less cash flow from
operations, scaled by beginning of the year total assets. The indicator variable F_ ACCRUAL equals one if
CFO > ROA, zero otherwise.
B. Financial Performance Signals: Leverage, Liquidity, and Source of Funds
1. Change in Leverage (ΔLEVER) (long-term) ratio (1 point if the ratio is lower this year compared to the
previous one, 0 otherwise);
2. Change in Current ratio (ΔLIQUID) (1 point if it is higher in the current year compared to the previous
one, 0 otherwise);
3. Change in the number of shares (EQ_OFFER) (1 point if no new shares were issued during the last year);
ΔLEVER defined as the historical change in the ratio of total long-term debt to average total assets, and view
an increase (decrease) in financial leverage as a negative (positive) signal. The indicator variable defined
F_ΔLEVER to equal one (zero) if the firm’s leverage ratio fell (rose) in the year preceding portfolio formation.
The variable ΔLIQUID measures the historical change in the firm’s current ratio between the current and
prior year, an improvement in liquidity (i.e., ΔLIQUID > 0) is a good signal about the firm’s ability to service
current debt obligations. The indicator variable F_ΔLIQUID equals one if the firm’s liquidity improved, zero
otherwise.
The indicator variable defined EQ_OFFER to equal one if the firm did not issue common equity in the year
preceding portfolio formation, zero otherwise.
C. Financial Performance Signals: Operating Efficiency
1. Change in Gross Margin (ΔMARGIN) (1 point if it is higher in the current year compared to the previous
one, 0 otherwise);
2. Change in Asset Turnover ratio (ΔTURN) (1 point if it is higher in the current year compared to the
previous one, 0 otherwise);
Interpretation
A company that has Piotroski F-score of 8–9 is considered to be strong. Alternatively, firms achieving the F-score
of 0–2 are considered to be weak.
Average value of Piotroski F-score can be different in different branches of economy (e.g., manufacturing, finance,
etc.). This should be taken into consideration when comparing companies with different specializations.
T
he Balance Sheet provides only a static view of the business. It is a statement of assets and liabilities on a
particular date. It does not show the movement of funds. In business concerns, funds flow from different
sources and similarly funds are invested in various sources of investment. It is a continuous process. The
study and control of this funds flow process is one of the important objectives of Financial Management
to assess the soundness and solvency of a business, financing and investing activities over the related period. Like
the Balance Sheet, even the Profit and Loss Account does not depict the changes that have taken place in financial
condition of a business concern between two dates. Hence, there is a need to prepare an additional statement to
know the changes in assets, liabilities and owners’ equity between dates of two Balance Sheets. Such a statement
is called Funds Flow Statement or Statement of Sources and Uses of Funds or ‘Where Got and Where Gone
Statement’.
Definition of Fund Flow Statement
The Fund Flow Statement, which is also known as the Statement of Changes in financial position, is yet another
tool of analysis of financial statements.
According to Foulke, “A statement of sources and application of funds is a technical device designed to
analyse the changes in the financial condition of a business enterprise between two dates”.
Anthony defines funds flow statement as “Funds Flow Statement describes the sources from which additional
funds were derived and the use to which these sources were put”.
So, Funds Flow Statement gives detailed analysis of changes in distribution of resources between two Balance
Sheet dates. This statement is widely used by the financial analysts and credit granting institutions and Finance
Managers in performing their jobs. Thus, Funds, Flow Statement, in general is able to present that information
which either is not available or not readily apparent from an analysis of other financial statements.
Significance of Fund Flow Statement
It is very useful tool in the financial managers analytical kit. It provides a summary of management decisions on
financing activities of the firm and investment policy. The following are the advantages of Fund Flow Statement.
(i) Analysis of financial operations: The fund flow statement reveals the net affect of various transactions on
the operational and financial position of the business concern. It determines the financial consequences of
business operations. This statement discloses the causes for changes in the assets and liabilities between two
different points of time. It highlights the effect of these changes on the liquidity position of the company.
(ii) Financial policies: Fund flow Statement guides the management in formulating the financial policies such
as dividend, reserve etc.
(iii) Control device: It serves as a measure of control to the management. If actual figures are compared with
budgeted projected figures, management can take remedial action if there are my deviations.
(iv) Evaluation of firm’s financing: Funds flow statement helps in evaluating the firm’s financing. It shows how
the funds were obtained from various sources and used in the past. Based on this, the financial manager can
take corrective action.
(v) Acts as a future guide: Fund flow statement acts as a guide for future, to the management. It helps the
management to know various problems it is going to face in near future for want of funds.
(vi) Appraising the use of working capital: Funds flow statement helps the management in knowing how
effectively the working capital put into use.
(vii) Reveals financial soundness: Funds flow statement reveals the financial soundness of the business to the
creditors, banks, financial institutions.
(viii) Changes in working capital: Funds flow statement highlights the changes in working capital. This helps the
management in framing its investing policy.
(ix) Assessing the degree of risk: Funds flow statement helps the bankers, creditors, financial institutions in
assessing the degree of risk involved in granting the credit to the business concern.
(x) Net results: This statement reveals the net results of operations during the year in terms of cash.
Limitations of Funds Flow Statement Analysis
It indicates only the past changes. It cannot reveal continuous changes.
(i) When both the aspects of the transaction are current, they are not considered.
(ii) When both the aspects of the transaction are non-current, even then they are not included in funds flow
statement.
(iii) Some Management Accountants are of the opinion that this statement is not ideal tool for financial analysis.
(iv) Funds Flow Statement is historic in nature. Hence this projected fund flow statement cannot be prepared with
much accuracy.
Preparation and Analysis of Fund Flow Statement
Two statements are involved in preparing and analysis of fund flow statement.
(I) Statement or Schedule of Changes in Working Capital
(II) Statement of Funds Flow
(I) Statement of Changes in Working Capital: This statement when prepared shows whether the working
capital has increased or decreased during two balance sheet dates. But this does not give the reasons for
increase or decrease in working capital. This statement is prepared by comparing the current assets and the
current liabilities of two periods.
(II) Funds Flow Statement: Funds flow statement is also called as statement of changes in financial position or
statement of sources and applications of funds or where got, where gone statement. The purpose of the funds
flow statement is to provide information about the enterprise’s investing and financing activities. The activities
that the funds flow statement describes can be classified into two categories:
(i) Activities that generate funds, called Sources, and
(ii) Activities that involve spending of funds, called Uses or, Application
When the funds generated are more than funds used, we get an increase in working capital and when funds
generated are lesser than the funds used, we get decrease in working capital. The increase or decrease in working
capital disclosed by the schedule of changes in working capital should tally with the increase or decrease disclosed
by the funds flow statement.
Illustration 11
From the Balance Sheet of X Ltd., prepare: (A) Statement of changes in the Working Capital and (B) Funds Flow
Statement.
Balance Sheet
Solution:
A. Calculation of changes in Working Capital
Assets
Fixed Assets 11,25,000 13,50,000
Less: Accumulated depreciation 2,25,000 2,81,250
Net Fixed Assets 9,00,000 10,68,750
Long – Term Investments (at cost) 2,02,500 2,02,500
Stock (at cost) 2,25,000 3,03,750
Debtors (net of provision for doubtful debts of ` 45,000 and ` 56,250 respectively
for 2023 and 2024 respectively) 2,53,125 2,75,625
Bills receivables 45,000 73,125
Prepaid Expenses 11,250 13,500
Miscellaneous Expenditure 16,875 11,250
Total 16,53,750 19,48,500
Additional Information:
(a) During the year 2023-24, fixed assets with a net book value of ` 11,250 (accumulated depreciation, ` 33,750)
was sold for ` 9,000.
(b) During the year 2023-24, Investments costing ` 90,000 were sold, and also Investments costing ` 90,000 were
purchased.
(c) Debentures were retired at a Premium of 10%.
(d) Tax of ` 61,875 was paid for 2022-23.
(e) During the year 2023-24, bad debts of ` 15,750 were written off against the provision for Doubtful Debt
account.
(f) The proposed dividend for 2022-23 was paid in 2023-24.
Prepare a Funds Flow Statement (Statement of changes in Financial Position on working capital basis) for the year
ended March 31, 2024.
Solution:
In the books of Gama Ltd.
Funds Flow Statement For the year ended March 31, 2024
Working notes:
Statement showing Funds from Operations
(`)
Particulars
2023 2024
Current Assets
Stock 2,25,000 3,03,750
Debtors 2,53,125 2,75,625
Bills Receivables 45,000 73,125
Prepaid Expenses 11,250 13,500
Total Current Assets (A) 5,34,375 6,66,000
Current Liabilities
Accrued Expenses 11,250 13,500
Creditors 1,80,000 2,81,250
Total Current Liabilities (B) 1,91,250 2,94,750
Working Capital (A) – (B) 3,43,125 3,71,250
Increase in Working Capital 28,125
C
ash Flow Statement reveals the causes of changes in cash position of business concern between two
dates of Balance Sheets. According to Ind AS-7 an enterprise should prepare a Cash Flow Statement and
should present it for each period with financial statements prepared. Ind AS-7 has also given the meaning
of the words cash, cash equivalent and cash flows.
(i) Cash: This includes cash on hand and demand deposits with banks.
(ii) Cash equivalents: This includes purely short-term and highly liquid investments which are readily convertible
into cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value. Therefore an investment normally
qualifies as a cash equivalent only when it has a short maturity, of say three months or less.
(iii) Cash flows: This includes inflows and outflows of cash and cash equivalents. If the effect of transaction
results in the increase of cash and its equivalents, it is called an inflow (source) and if it results in the decrease
of total cash, it is known as outflow (use of cash).
A. Cash flows from Operating Activities: Operating activities are the principal revenue-producing activities of
the enterprise and other activities that are not investing or financing activities.
The amount of cash flows arising from operating activities is a key indicator of the extent to which the operations
of the enterprise have generated sufficient cash flows to maintain the operating capability of the enterprise, pay
dividends, repay loans, and make new investments without recourse to external sources of financing.
Cash flows from operating activities are primarily derived from the principal revenue-producing activities of
the enterprise. The following are the important operating activities:-
(i) Cash receipts from the sale of goods and the rendering of services.
(ii) Cash receipts from royalties, fees, commissions and other revenue.
(iii) Cash payments to suppliers for goods and services.
(iv) Cash payments to and on behalf of employees.
(v) Cash receipts and cash payments of an insurance enterprise for premiums and claims, annuities and other
policy benefits
(vi) Cash payments or refunds of income taxes unless they can be specifically identified with financing and
investing activities
(vii) Cash receipts and payments relating in future contracts, forward contracts, option contracts and swap
contracts when the contracts are held for dealing or trading purposes.
(viii) Some transactions such as the sale of an item of plant, may give rise to a gain or loss which is included
in the determination of net profit or loss. However, the cash flows relating to such transactions are cash
flows from investing activities.
An enterprise may hold securities and loans for dealing or trading purposes, in which case they are similar to
inventory acquired specifically for sale. Therefore, cash flows arising from the purchase and sale of dealing
or trading activities are classified as operating activities. Similarly cash advances and loans made by financial
enterprises are usually classified as operating activities since they relate by the main revenue producing activity
of that enterprise.
B. Cash flows from Investing Activities: Investing activities are the acquisition and disposal of long-term assets
and other investments not included in cash equivalents. The separate disclosure of cash flows arising from
investing activities is important because the cash flows represent the extent to which expenditures have been
made for resources intended to generate future income and cash flows.
Examples of cash flows arising from Investing Activities are:
(i) Cash payments to acquire fixed assets (including intangibles). These payments include those relating to
capitalised research & development costs and self constructed fixed assets.
(ii) Cash receipts from disposal of fixed assets (including intangibles).
(iii) Cash payments to acquire shares, warrants, or debt instruments of other enterprises and interests in joint
ventures.
(iv) Cash receipts from disposal of shares, warrants, or debt instruments of other enterprises and interests in
joint venture.
(v) Cash advances and loans made to third parties (other than advances and loans made by a financial
enterprise).
(vi) Cash receipts from the repayment of advances and loans made to third parties (other than advances and
loans of a financial enterprise).
(vii) Cash payments for future contracts, forward contracts, option contracts, and swap contracts except when
the contracts are held for dealing or trading purposes or the payments are classified as financing activities
and
(viii) Cash receipts from future contracts, forward contracts, option contracts and swap contracts except when
the contracts are held for dealing or trading purpose, or the receipts are classified as financing activities.
When a contract is accounted for as a hedge of an identifiable position, the cash flows of the contract are
classified in the same manner as the cash flows of the position being hedged.
C. Cash flows from Financing Activities: Financing activities are activities that result in changes in the size
and composition of the owners capital (including Preference Share Capital in the case of a company) and
borrowing of the enterprise.
The separate disclosure of cash flows arising from financing activities is important because it is useful in
predicting claims on future cash flows by providers of funds (both capital and borrowing) to the enterprise.
at the end of the period. This amount is presented separately from cash flows from operating investing and
financing activities and includes the difference, if any had those cash flows been reported at the end of
period exchange rates.
(f) Non-cash Transactions: Many investing and financing activities do not have a direct impact on current
cash flows although they do affect the capital and asset structure of an enterprise. Examples of non-cash
transactions are :
(i) The acquisition of assets by assuming directly related activities.
(ii) The acquisition of an enterprise by means of issue of shares; and
(iii) The conversion of debt to equity.
Investing and financing transactions that do not require the use of cash or cash equivalents should be
excluded from a Cash Flow Statement. Such transactions should be disclosed elsewhere in the financial
statements in a way that provides all the relevant information about these investing and financing activities.
3.4.2 Methods of Calculating Cash flows (Used in) from Operating Activities
There are two methods of reporting cash flows from operating activities namely (1) Direct Method and (2) Indirect
Method.
1. The Direct Method: Under the direct method, cash receipts (inflows) from operating revenues and cash
payments (outflows) for operating expenses are calculated to arrive at cash flows from operating activities.
The difference between the cash receipts and cash payments is the net cash flow provided by (or used in)
operating activities. The following are the examples of cash receipts and cash payments (called cash flows)
resulting from operating activities :
(a) Cash receipts from the sale of goods and the rendering of services.
(b) Cash receipts from royalties, fees commissions and other revenues.
(c) Cash payment to suppliers for goods and services.
(d) Cash payment to and on behalf of employees.
(e) Cash receipts and cash payment of an insurance enterprise for premiums and claims annuities and other
policy benefits.
(f) Cash payments or refund of income taxes unless they can be specifically identified with financing and
investing activities. and
(g) Cash receipts and payments relating to future contracts, forward contracts, option contracts and swap
contracts when the contracts are held for dealing or trading purposes. The formation about major classes
of gross cash receipts and gross cash payments may be obtained either:
(a) From accounting records of the enterprise; or
(b) By adjusting sales, cost of sales (interest and similar income and interest expense and similar charges
for a financial enterprise) and other items in the statement of profit and loss for;
(i) Changes during the period in inventories and operating receivables and payables,
(ii) Other non-cash items, and
(iii) Other items for which the cash effects are investing or financing cash flows.
Format of Cash Flow Statement: Ind AS-7 has not provided any specific format for preparing a Cash Flows
Statement. The Cash Flow Statement should report cash flows during the period classified by operating, investing
and financing activities; a widely used format of Cash Flow Statement is given below:
Cash Flow Statement (for the year ended.)
Particulars (` ) (` )
Cash Flows from Operating activities
Cash receipts from customers xxx
Cash paid to suppliers and employees (xxx)
Cash generated from operations xxx
Income tax paid (xx)
Cash flow before extraordinary items xxx
Extraordinary items xxx
Net cash from (used in) Operating activities xxx
(Or)
Net profit before tax and extraordinary items xxx
Adjustments for non-cash and non-operating items
(List of individual items such as depreciation, foreign exchange loss, loss on sale of fixed xxx
assets, interest income, dividend income, interest expense etc.)
Operating profit before working capital changes xxx
Adjustments for changes in current assets and current liabilities
(List of individual items) xxx
Cash generated from (used in) operations before tax xxx
Income tax paid xxx
Cash flow before extraordinary items xxx
Extraordinary items (such as refund of tax) xxx
Net Cash from (used in) Operating activities xxx
Cash Flows from investing activities
Individual items of cash inflows and outflows from financing activities xxx
(such as purchase/sale of fixed assets, purchase or sale of investments, interest received, xxx
dividend received etc.
Net cash from (used in) investing activities xxx
Cash Flows from Financing Activities
Individual items of cash inflows and outflows from financing activities xxx
(such as) proceeds from issue of shares, long-term borrowings, repayments of long-term xxx xxx
borrowings, interest paid, dividend paid etc.)
Particulars (` ) (` )
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents xxx
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the period xxx
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the period xxx
2. The Indirect Method: Under the indirect method, the net cash flow from operating activities is determined by
adjusting net profit or loss for the effect of :
(a) Non-cash items such as depreciation, provisions, deferred taxes, and unrealised foreign exchange gains
and losses;
(b) Changes during the period in inventories and operating receivables and payables.
(c) All other items for which the cash effects are investing or financing cash flows.
The indirect method is also called reconciliation method as it involves reconciliation of net profit or loss as
given in the Profit and Loss Account and the net cash flow from operating activities as shown in the Cash Flow
Statement. In other words, net profit or losses adjusted for non-cash and non-operating items which may have
been debited or credited to Profit and Loss Account as follows.
Particulars (` ) (` )
Net profit before tax and extraordinary items xxx
Add : Non-cash and non-operating items which have already been debited to P.L.
Account
(a) Depreciation xxx
(b) Transfer to reserves and provisions xxx
(c) Goodwill written off xxx
(d) Preliminary expenses written off xxx
(e) Other intangible assets written off such as discount or loss on issue of shares / xxx
debentures, underwriting commission etc.
(f) Loss on sale or disposal of fixed assets xxx
(g) Loss on sale of investments xxx
(h) Foreign exchange loss xxx xxx
Less : Non-cash and non-operating items which have already been credited to Profit and xxx
Loss Account
(a) Gain on sale of fixed assets xxx
(b) Profit on sale of investments xxx
(c) Income from interest or dividends on investments xxx
(d) Appreciation xxx
Particulars (` ) (` )
(e) Reserves written back xxx
(f) Foreign exchange gain xxx xxx
Or
Particulars (` ) (` )
xxx
Operating Profit Before Working Capital Changes
Adjustments for changes in current operating assets and liabilities:
Add : Decrease in Accounts of Current Operating Assets (except cash and cash
equivalents) such as :
Decrease in trade debts xxx
Decrease in bills receivables xxx
Decrease in inventories / stock-in-trade xxx
Decrease in prepaid expenses etc. xxx
Add : Increase in accounts of current operating liabilities (except Bank overdraft) such
as :
Increase in creditors xxx
Increase in bills payable xxx
Increase in outstanding expenses xxx xxx
xxxx
Less : Increase in accounts of current operating assets (as stated above) xxx
xxx
Less : Decrease in accounts of current operating liabilities (as stated above) xxx
Cash generated from (used in) operations before tax xxx
Less : Income tax paid xxx
Cash flows before extraordinary items xxx
Add / Less : Extraordinary items if any xxx
Net cash flow from (used in) operating activities xxx
of cash (Example : Sale of current and fixed assets, Issue of shares and debentures etc.) The transactions which
decrease the cash position are known as outflows (example : Purchase of Current and Fixed Assets, redemption of
Debentures, and Preference Shares and other long-term debts). Cash Flow Statement concentrates on transactions
that have a direct impact on cash. This statement depicts factors responsible for such inflow and outflow of cash.
(i) Cash flow statement reveals the causes of changes in cash balances between two balance sheet dates.
(ii) This statement helps the management to evaluate its ability to meet its obligations i.e., payment to creditors,
the payment of bank loan, payment of interest, taxes, dividend etc.
(iii) It throws light on causes for poor liquidity in spite of good profits and excessive liquidity in spite of heavy
losses.
(iv) It helps the management in understanding the past behaviour of cash cycle and in controlling the use of cash
in future.
(v) Cash Flow Statements helps the management in planning repayment of loans, replacement of assets etc.
(vi) This statement is helpful in short-term financial decisions relating to liquidity.
(vii) This statement helps the management in preparing the cash budgets properly.
(viii) This statement helps the financial institution who lends advances to business concerns in estimating their
repaying capacities.
(ix) Since a cash flow statement is based on the cash basis of accounting it is very useful in evaluation of cash
position of a firm.
(x) Cash flow statement discloses the complete story of cash movement. The increase in, or decrease of cash
and the reason therefore can be known.
(xi) Cash flow statement provides information of all activities such as operating, investing, and financing
activities separately.
(xii) Since cash flow statement provides information regarding the sources and utilisation of cash during a
particular period, it is easy for the management to plan carefully for the cash requirements in the future, for
the purpose of redeeming long-term liabilities or / and replacing some fixed assets.
(xiii) A projected cash flow statement reveals the future cash position of a concern. Through this cash flow
statement the firm can know how much cash it can generate and how much cash will be needed to make
various payments.
(xiv) Cash flow statement prepared according to the Ind AS-7 is more suitable for making comparison than the
funds flow statements as there is no standard formats used for the same.
(iv) Cash flow statement is based on cash accounting. It ignores the basic accounting concept of a accrual basis.
(v) Cash flow statement reveals the movement of cash only. In preparation, it ignores most liquid current assets
(example: sundry debtors, bills receivable etc.)
(vi) It is difficult to precisely define the term cash. There are controversies among accountants over a number of
near cash items like cheques, stamps, postal orders etc., to be included in cash.
(vii) Cash flow statement does not give a complete picture of financial position of the concern.
3.4.3 Differences between Funds Flow Statement and Cash Flow Statement
The following are the main differences between a Funds Flow Statement and a Cash Flow Statement:
Illustration 13
From the information contained in Income Statement and Balance Sheet of ‘A’ Ltd. prepare Cash flow statement.
Income Statement for the year ended March 31, 2024.
(`)
Net Sales (A) 2,52,00,000
Less: Cash cost of sales 1,98,00,000
Depreciation 6,00,000
Salaries and Wages 24,00,000
Operating Expenses 8,00,000
Provision for Taxation 8,80,000
(`)
(B) 2,44,80,000
Net Operating Profit (A – B) 7,20,000
Non-recurring Income – Profits on sale of equipment 1,20,000
8,40,000
Retained earnings and Profits brought forward 15,18,000
23,58,000
Dividends declared and paid during the year 7,20,000
Profit and Loss A/c balance as on March 31, 2024 16,38,000
Solution :
Working Notes:
1. Cash receipt from customers: (`)
Sales revenue 2,52,00,000
Add: Debtor at beginning 16,80,000
2,68,80,000
Less: Debtors at the end 18,60,000
Total cash receipt from customers 2,50,20,000
2. Income tax paid: (` )
Cash Flow Statement of A Ltd. for the year ended 31st March 2024
Illustration 14
Balance Sheets of a company as on 31st March, 2023 and 2024 are as follows:
Solution:
Cash Flow Statement for the year ending 31st March, 2024
Particulars (` ) (` )
A Cash flow from Operating Activities
Profit and Loss A/c as on 31.3.2024 3,00,000
Less: Profit and Loss A/c as on 31.3.2023 2,10,000
90,000
Particulars (` ) (` )
Add: Transfer to General Reserve 25,000
Provision for Tax 96,000
Proposed Dividend 1,44,000 2,65,000
Profit before Tax 3,55,000
Adjustment for Depreciation
Particulars (` ) (` )
Net Cash outflow from Financing Activities (C) (2,64,000)
Net increase in Cash and Cash Equivalents during the year (A + B + C) 5,000
Cash and Cash Equivalents at the beginning of the year 88,000
Cash and Cash Equivalents at the end of the year 93,000
Working Notes:
Illustration 15
The Balance Sheets of a company as on 31st March, 2023 and 2024 are given below: (`)
Additional Information:
During the year ended 31st March, 2024 the company:
1. Sold a machine for ` 1,20,000; the cost of machine was ` 2,40,000 and depreciation provided on it was
` 84,000.
Solution:
Cash Flow Statement for the year ending 31st March, 2024
Particulars (` ) (` )
A Cash Flows from Operating Activities
Profit and Loss A/c 72,000
(` 3,60,000 – ` 2,88,000)
Adjustments:
Increase in General Reserve 1,44,000
Depreciation 4,20,000
Provision for Tax 4,08,000
Loss on Sale of Machine 36,000
Premium on Redemption of Debentures 14,400
Proposed Dividend 1,72,800
Preliminary Expenses written off 48,000
Fixed Assets written of 12,000
Interest on Debentures 60,480 13,15,680
Funds from Operations 13,87,680
Increase in Sundry Creditors 40,000
Increase in Bills Payable 8,000
48,000
Increase in Sundry Debtors (2,00,000)
Increase in Stock (44,000) (1,96,000)
Cash generated from operation 11,91,680
Less: Income Tax paid 4,32,000
Particulars (` ) (` )
B Cash flows from Investing Activities
Purchase of Fixed Assets (10,20,000)
Sale of Investment 1,44,000
Sale of Fixed Assets 1,20,000
Net Cash out flows from Investing Activities (7,56,000)
C Cash flow from Financing Activities
Issue of share capital 4,80,000
Redemption of Debentures (3,02,400)
Dividend Paid (1,44,000 – 19,200) (1,24,800)
Interest on Debentures (60,480)
Net Cash outflow from Financing Activities (7,680)
Net Increase in Cash and Cash Equivalents during the year (A+B+C) (4,000)
Cash and Cash Equivalents at the beginning of the year 4,000
Cash and Cash Equivalents at the end of the year Nil
● It is presumed that the 30% debentures have been redeemed at the beginning of the year.
Working Note:
Solved Case 1
Presently, the current assets and current liabilities of a company are ` 16 lakh and ` 8 lakh respectively. Calculate
the effect of each of the following transactions individually and totally on the current ratio of the company.
1. Cash purchase of new machinery for ` 5 lakh.
2. Purchase of new machinery for ` 10 lakh on a medium-term loan from the bank, with 20% margin.
3. Payment of dividend of ` 2 lakh.
4. Receipt of a shipment of new materials at landed cost of ` 5 lakh, against which the bank finance obtained, is
` 3 lakh.
Solved Case 2
A partial list of trend and common-size percentages for ABC Ltd. is given below.
March, current year March, previous year
Trend percentages:
Sales (net) 120 100
Cost of goods sold ? 100
Gross profit on sales ? 100
Operating expenses and income taxes ? 100
Net income ? 100
Common-size percentages:
Sales (net) 100 100
Cost of goods sold ? ?
Gross profit on sales 40 ?
Operating expenses and income taxes 20 25
Net income 20 10
Solved Case 3
ABC Ltd. finds that its opening bank balance of ` 1,80,000 as on April 1, 2023 has been converted into an overdraft
of ` 75,000 by the end of the year. From the information given below, prepare a statement to show how this
happened.
Working Notes:
Exercise
A. Theoretical Questions:
� Multiple Choice Questions
12. ABC Ltd. has a Current Ratio of 1.5: 1 and Net Current Assets of ` 5,00,000. What are the Current Assets?
(a) ` 5,00,000
(b) ` 10,00,000
(c) ` 15,00,000
(d) ` 25,00,000
13. There is deterioration in the management of working capital of XYZ Ltd. What does it refer to?
(a) That the Capital Employed has reduced
(b) That the Profitability has gone up
(c) That debtors collection period has increased
(d) That Sales has decreased.
14. Which of the following does not help to increase Current Ratio?
(a) Issue of Debentures to buy Stock
(b) Issue of Debentures to pay Creditors
(c) Sale of Investment to pay Creditors
(d) Avail Bank Overdraft to buy Machine.
19. A firm has Capital of ` 10,00,000; Sales of ` 5,00,000; Gross Profit of ` 2,00,000 and Expenses of ` 1,00,000.
What is the Net Profit Ratio?
(a) 20%
(b) 50%
(c) 10%
(d) 40%.
20. XYZ Ltd. has earned 8% Return on Total Assests of ` 50,00,000 and has a Net Profit Ratio of 5%. Find out the
Sales of the firm.
(a) ` 4,00,000
(b) ` 2,50,000
(c) ` 80,00,000
(d) ` 83,33,333.
23. Gross Profit Ratio for a firm remains same but the Net Profit Ratio is decreasing. The reason for such behavior
could be:
(a) Increase in Cost of Goods Sold
(b) If Increase in Expense
25. Debt to Total Assets of a firm is 2. The Debt to Equity would be:
(a) 0.80
(b) 0.25
(c) 1.00
(d) 0.75
28. XYZ Ltd. has a Debt Equity Ratio of 1.5 as compared to 1.3 Industry average. It means that the firm has:
(a) Higher Liquidity
(b) Higher Financial Risk
(c) Higher Profitability
(d) Higher Capital Employed.
29. Ratio Analysis can be used to study liquidity, turnover, profitability, etc. of a firm. What does Debt-Equity
Ratio help to study?
(a) Solvency
(b) Liquidity
(c) Profitability
(d) Turnover,
33. The ratio of current assets (` 3,00,000) to current liabilities (` 2,00,000) is 1.5 : 1. The accountant of this firm
is interested in maintaining a current ratio of 2 : 1 by paying some part of current liabilities. Hence, the amount
of current liabilities which must be paid for this purpose is
(a) ` 1,00,000
(b) ` 2,00,000
(c) ` 2,50,000
(d) ` 1,50,000
34. The P/V ratio of a firm dealing in precision instruments is 50% and margin of safety is 40%. Calculate net
profit, if the sales volume is ` 50,00,000.
(a) ` 1,00,000
(b) ` 5,00,000
(c) ` 10,00,000
(d) ` 6,00,000
36. The ratio of Current Assets (`9,00,000) to Current liabilities (`6,00,000) is 1.5 :1. The accountant of this firm
is interested in maintaining a current ratio of 2:1 by paying some part of current liabilities. Hence, the amount
of current liabilities which must be paid for this purpose is
(a) ` 3,00,000
(b) ` 2,00,000
(c) ` 6,00,000
(d) ` 4,00,000
37. A firm has a capital of ` 10 lakhs, sales of ` 5 lakhs, gross profit of ` 2 lakhs and expenses of `1 lakh. The Net
Profit Ratio is:
(a) 50%
(b) 40%
(c) 20%
(d) 10%
39. ROI (Return on Investment) can be decomposed into the following ratios:
(a) Overall Turnover Ratio and Current Ratio
(b) Net Profit Ratio and Fixed Assets Turnover
40. Which of the following does not help to increase Current Ratio?
(a) Issue of Debentures to buy Stock
(b) Issue of Debentures to pay Creditors
(c) Sale of Investment to pay Creditors
(d) Avail Bank Overdraft to buy Machine
47. G Ltd. Is a manufacturing company having asset turnover ratio of 2 and debt- asset ratio of 0.60 for the year
ended 31st March ,2009 . If its net profit margin is 5%, the Return on Equity(ROE) of the company will be :
(a) 20%
(b) 25%
(c) 16.7%
(d) data insufficient
48. A firm seeks to increase its current ratio from 1.5 before its closing date of the accounts. The action that would
make it possible is :
(a) Delaying payment of salaries
(b) Increase charge for depreciation
(c) Making cash payment to creditors
(d) Selling marketable securities for cash at book value.
49. The dividends distributed to the shareholders and taxes paid during the year are shown as application of funds
when provision for dividends and provision for taxes are treated as :
(a) Current liabilities
(b) Non-current liabilities
(c) Fund items
(d) Non-fund items
50. The total asset-turnover ratio and total asset to net-worth of LEENZA LTD. are 2 and 1.75 respectively. If the
net-profit margin of the company is 8%, What will be its Return on Equity (ROE)?
(a) 28.0%
(b) 25.5%
(c) 20.0%
(d) 26.4%
51. The total asset – turnover ratio and total asset to net- worth ratio of a company are 2.10 and 2.50 respectively.
If the net profit margin of the company is 6%, what would be the return on equity?
(a) 30.50%
(b) 31.50%
(c) 30.00%
(d) 32.50%
52. X Ltd has an ROA of 10% and a profit margin of 2%. The Company’s total asset turnover is
(a) 5%
(b) 20%
(c) 12%
(d) 8%
54. IG Ltd. has a gearing of 30%. Its cost of equity is 21% and the cost of debt is 15%. The company’s WACC is:
(a) 14.3%;
(b) 19.2%;
(c) 14.7%;
(d) 4.5%.
55. Y Ltd has an ROA of 10% and a profit margin of 2%. The Company’s total asset turnover is
(a) 5
(b) 20
(c) 12
(d) 8
56. Current Assets ` 20,00,000; Current Liabilities ` 10,00,000 and Stock ` 2,00,000, then what is liquid ratio?
(a) 2 times
(b) 1.8 times
(c) 1.4 times
(d) None of these
57. PAT of a company ` 100 lakhs and number of equity shares of ` 10 each is ` 50 lakhs, then EPS is:
(a) ` 2
(b) ` 1
(c) ` 10
(d) None of these
58. ______________ ratio is the indicator of the firm’s commitment to meet its short term liabilities.
(a) Super quick ratio
(b) Current ratio
(c) Proprietary ratio
(d) Quick ratio
62. When the concept of ratio is defined in respected to the items shown in the financial statements, it is termed as
(a) Accounting ratio
(b) Financial ratio
(c) Costing ratio
(d) None of the above
64. Current Assets ` 20,00,000 ; Current Liabilities `10,00,000 and Stock `4,00,000, then what is liquid ratio?
(a) 2 times
(b) 1.6 times
(c) 1.4 times
(d) None of these
65. A ratio of is considered satisfactory by the financial institutions the greater debt service coverage ratio
indicates the better debt servicing capacity of the organization.
(a) 1
(b) 2
(c) 3
(d) 4
67. Ratio analysis is the process of determining and interpreting numerical relationships based on .
(a) Financial values
(b) Financial statements
(c) Financial numerical information
(d) All of the above
69. The persons interested in the analysis of financial statements can be grouped as
(a) Owners or investors
(b) Creditors
(c) Financial executives
(d) All of the above
73. The treatment of interest and dividends received and paid depends upon the nature of the enterprise. For this
purpose, the enterprises are classified as .
(a) (i) Financial enterprises, and (ii) Operating enterprises.
(b) (i) Financial enterprises, and (ii) Other enterprises.
(c) (i) Financial enterprises, and (ii) Non-Financial enterprises.
(d) (i) Trading enterprises, and (ii) Non - Trading enterprises.
74. Cash Flow Statement is for Income Statement or Funds Flow Statement.
(a) not a substitute
(b) substitute
75. Funds Flow Statement reveals the change in between two Balance Sheet dates.
(a) Working capital
(b) Internal capital
(c) Share capital
(d) Both (a) & (c)
Answers
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
d a a d b b b b b d
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
b c c d d c b c a c
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
b c b d b b b b a b
31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
c d a c b b c b d d
41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
d c b a d c b c b a
51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60
b a a b a b d b d b
61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70
a a d b b a d a d c
71 72 73 74 75
b c b a a
Answer:
1 F 2 T 3 F
4 F 5 F 6 F
7 T 8 F 9 F
10 F 11 F 12 T
13 F 14 T 15 F
16 F 17 F 18 F
19 T 20 F 21 T
Answers:
12. Distinguish between percentage analysis and ratio analysis relating to the interpretation of financial
statements. What is the value of these two types of analysis?
13. How does the acid-test ratio differ from the current ratio? How are they similar? What is the usefulness of
the defensive interval ratio?
14. What is the relationship of the assets turnover rate to the rate of return on total assets?
15. Two companies have the same amount of working capital. The current debt paying ability of one company
is much weaker than that of the other. Explain how this could occur.
16. (a) Discuss some inherent limitations of single-year financial statements for purposes of analysis and
interpretation. (b) To what extent are these limitations overcome by the use of comparative statements?
17. What are the limitations of financial ratios as a technique for appraising the financial position of a company?
18. ‘A uniform system of accounts, including identical forms for balance sheets and income statements is a
prerequisite of inter firm comparisons.’ Elucidate.
19. Discuss Altman’s Z Score Model with criticism.
A. Numerical Questions:
� Comprehensive Numerical Problems
1. You have been furnished with the financial information of Aditya Mills Ltd for the current year.
Balance sheet, March 31, current year
Amount Amount
Liabilities Assets
(` thousand) (` thousand)
Equity share capital (` 100 each) 1,000 Plant and equipment 640
Retained earnings 368 Land and buildings 80
Sundry creditors 104 Cash 160
Bills payable 200 Sundry debtors 360
Other current liabilities 20 Less: Allowances 40 320
Stock 480
Prepaid insurance 12
1,692 1,692
Sundry debtors and stock at the beginning of the year were ` 3,00,000 and ` 4,00,000 respectively.
(a) Determine the following ratios of the Aditya Mills Ltd: (i) Current ratio, (ii) Acid-test ratio, (iii) Stock turnover,
(iv) Debtors turnover, (v) Gross profit ratio, (vi) Net profit ratio, (vii) Operating ratio, (viii) Earnings per share,
(ix) Rate of return on equity capital, and (x) Market value of the shares if P/E ratio is 10 times,
(b) Indicate for each of the following transactions whether the transaction would improve, weaken or have an
effect on the current ratio of the Aditya Mills Ltd: (i) Sell additional equity shares, (ii) Sell 10% debentures,
(iii) Pay bills payable, (iv) Collect sundry debtors, (v) Purchase additional plant, (vi) Issuing bills payable to
creditors, (vii) Collecting bills receivable from debtors, (viii) Purchase of treasury bills, and (ix) Writing off
bad debt.
2. The following is the summary of the financial ratios of a company relating to its liquidity position:
Answer:
1 (a) (i) 3:1 (ii) 1.48:1 (iii) 7 times (iv) 12.12 times (v) 23 % (vi) 3.9 % (vii) 94 % (viii) ` 15.6 (ix) 11.4%
(x) ` 156
(b) (i) Improve (ii) Improve (iii) Improve (iv) No effect (v) Weaken (vi) No effect (vii) No effect (viii)
No effect (ix) Weaken
2 The contributing factor for the divergent trend is the accumulation of stocks with the company over the
years.
3 B need not necessarily be better than A.
Unsolved Case(s)
1. The comparative income statements and balance sheets for MN Ltd. for the years ending December 31, 2024
and 2023, are given here.
Expenses:
2. Comparative income statements for RR Ltd. for 2024 and 2023 are given below.
Sales.......................................................................................................800,000 450,000
(a) Prepare common-size income statements for RR Ltd. for 2024 and 2023.
(b) Return on sales for RR Ltd. is lower in 2024 than in 2023. What expense or expenses are causing this lower
profitability?
3. You are required to state the internal accounting ratios that you would use in this type of business to assist the
management of the company in measuring the efficiency of its operation including its use of capital.
You have been asked by the Management of the WS Ltd. to project the Trading Profit & Loss Account and the
Balance Sheet on the basis of the following estimated figures and ratios for the next financial year ending 31st
December, 2024.
Current ratio 2
4. The following are the summarized Balance Sheets of ABC Ltd. as on 31st December, 2022 and 31st December,
2023.
Liabilities
12,48,000 13,72,000
Assets
Note:
The plant and machinery which cost ` 40,000 and in respect of which ` 26,000 had been written off as
depreciation was sold during the year 2023 for ` 6,000.
Equipment which costs ` 10,000 and in respect of which ` 8,000 had been written off as depreciation was sold
for ` 4,000 during 2023.
The dividend which was declared in 2022 was paid during 2023.
(b) A statement showing the sources and application of working capital (Fund Flow Statement) during 2023.
[Decrease in working capital ` 28,000; Fund from operations ` 1,84,000; Sources and applications of
fund ` 2,94,000 and ` 3,22,000]
References:
● Altman, E. I. 2000. Predicting Financial Distress of Companies; Revisiting the Z-score and Zeta Models.
Journal of Banking and Finance 1(2); 1968 - 2000.
● Beneish, Messod D., 1999. The Detection of Earnings Manipulation, Financial Analysts Journal, September/
October, pp. 24-36.
● Bodie, Zvi et al, Investments, Tata McGraw-Hill Publishing Company Limited New Delhi: 2002.
● Chambers, Donald R., and Nelson J. Lacey. “Corporate Ethics and Shareholder Wealth Maximization.”
Financial Practice and Education 6 (Spring–Summer 1996), 93– 96.
● Chandra Prasanna, Financial Management, Theory and Practice, McGraw Hill., 2019.
● Fama, Eugene F; French, Kenneth R (Summer 2004). The Capital Asset Pricing Model: Theory and Evidence.
Journal of Economic Perspectives. 18 (3): 25–46.
● Fischer Donald E, and Jordon Ronald J., Security Analysis and Portfolio Management, PHI.
● Francis, Jack Clark, Investments: Analysis and Management, McGraw-Hill, Inc. New York: 1991.
● H. Markowitz, Portfolio Selection: Efficient Diversification of Investments, John Wiley & Sons, 1959.
● Khan, M Y and P K Jain, Financial Management- Text, Problems and Cases, McGraw-Hill Publishing Co.,
New Delhi, 2019.
● Piotroski, JD (2000), ‘Value investing: The use of historical financial information to separate winners and
losers’, Journal of Accounting Research, vol. 38, pp. 1−41.
● Ross, Stephen. A, “The Arbitrage Theory of Capital Asset Pricing,” Journal of Economic Theory, Vol. 13,
(December, 1976).
● Solomon, E, Theory of Financial Management, Columbia University Press (New York), 1969.
● Van Horne James C. and Wachowicz John M., Jr. Fundamentals of Financial Management, Prentice Hall, 13th
Edition, 2008.
● White, Gerald I, et. al. The Analysis and use of Financial Statements, John Wiley & Sons, New York.
T
o start any business, raising of funds or collection of funds is very much needed because without money one
cannot do anything. So, we need to know about different sources of funds either long-term or short-term
based on the requirement of the firm.
Sources of Finance – Classification
The sources of capital are classified into three broad categories, where some sources may be internationally
financed. However, these are —
Sources of
Finance
Long-term financing means capital requirements for a period of more than 5 years to 10 or 15 or 20 years based
on other factors. Long-term sources of finance are required for capital expenditures in fixed assets like plant and
machinery, land and building, etc. Long-term financing sources can be in the form of any of them:
(i) Equity Share Capital
(ii) Preference Share Capital
(iii) Term Loans
(iv) Debenture /Bond Capital
(v) Lease Capital or Leasing
(vi) Retained Earnings
(vii) Venture Capital
(iv) Debenture/Bond
A bond or a debenture is the basic debt instrument which may be issued by a borrowing company for a price
which may be less than, equal to or more than the face value. A debenture also carries a promise by the
company to make interest payments to the debenture holders of specified amount, at specified time and also to
repay the principal amount at the end of a specified period. These instruments have some or the other common
features as follows:
(a) Credit Instrument: A debenture holder is a creditor of the company and is entitled to receive payments
of interest and the principal and enjoys some other rights.
(b) Interest Rate: In most of the cases, the debt securities promise a rate of interest payable periodically to
the debt holders. The rate of interest is also denoted as coupon rate.
(c) Collateral: Debt issue may or may not be secured and, therefore, debentures or other such securities may
be called secured debentures or unsecured debentures.
(d) Maturity Date: All debt instruments have a fixed maturity date, when these will be repaid or redeemed in
the manner specified.
(e) Voting Rights: As the debt holders are creditors of the company, they do not have any voting right in
normal situations.
(f) Face Value: Every debt instrument has a face value as well as a maturity value.
(g) Priority in Liquidation: In case of liquidation of the company, the claim of the debt holders is settled in
priority over all shareholders and, generally, other unsecured creditors also.
(e) A financial lease usually provides the lessee an option of renewing the lease for further period at a
normal rent.
(vi) Retained Earnings
The portion of profits not distributed among the shareholders but retained and used in the business is called
retained earnings. It is also known as ploughing back of profit or retained capital or accumulated earnings.
(vii) Venture Capital
Venture capital is a form of equity financing especially designed for funding high risk and high reward
projects. There is a common perception that venture capital is a means of financing high technology projects.
However, venture capital is investment of long-term financial made in:
(a) Ventures promoted by technically or professionally qualified but unproven entrepreneurs, or
(b) Ventures seeking to harness commercially unproven technology, or
(c) High risk ventures.
The term ‘venture capital’ represents financial investment in a highly risky project with the objective of
earning a high rate of return.
From the financing point of view, short-term financing means financing for a period of less than 1 year. The
need for short-term finance arises to finance the current assets of a business like an inventory of raw material
and finished goods, debtors, minimum cash and bank balance etc. Short-term financing is also named as working
capital financing.
Any organisation requires working capital margin to take up day-to-day operations. The working capital amount
is divided into two parts – (a) Permanent Working Capital, and (b) Temporary Working Capital. The permanent
working capital should be financed from long-term sources and temporary working capital should be financed from
short-term sources.
Forfeiting transforms the supplier’s credit granted to the importer into cash transaction for the exporter
protecting him completely from all the risks associated with selling overseas on credit. It effectively
transforms a credit sale into a cash sale.
Procedure
(a) The exporter sells the goods to the importer on a deferred payment basis spread over 3-5 years.
(b) The importer draws a series of promissory notes in favour of the exporter for the payments to be made
inclusive of interest charges.
(c) Such promissory notes are availed or guaranteed by a reputed international bank which can also be
the importer’s banker. (it is endorsed on the promissory note by the guaranteeing bank that it covers
any default of payment of the buyer).
(d) The exporter now sells the availed notes to a forfeiter (which may be the exporter’s banker) at a
discount without recourse.
(e) The forfeiter may hold these notes till maturity or sell them to group of investors interested in taking
up such high-yielding unsecured paper.
3
Exporter Exporter
4 5 1 2
Availing
Forfeiter Bank
3. Bill Discounting
The commercial banks provide immediate cash by discounting genuine trade bills. They deduct a certain
charge as discount charges from the amount of the bill and the balance is credited to the customer’s
account and thus, the customer is able to enjoy credit facilities against the discounting of bills. Of course,
this discount charges include interest for the unexpired period of the bill plus some service charges. Bill
financing is the most liquid one from the banker’s point of view since, in time of emergencies, they can
take those bills to the Reserve Bank of India (RBI) for rediscounting purposes. Infact, it was viewed
primarily as a scheme of accommodation for banks. Now, the situation is completely changed. Today it
is viewed as a kind of loan backed by the security of bills.
4. Factoring
Factoring may be defined as the relationship between the seller of goods and a financial firm, called the
factor, whereby the latter purchases the receivables of the former and also administer the receivable of the
former. Factoring involves sale of receivable of a firm to another firm under an already existing agreement
between the firm and the factor.
Modus Operandi
A factor provides finance to his client up to a certain %age of the unpaid invoices which represent the sale of goods
or services to approved customers. The modus operandi of the factoring scheme is as follows.
(a) There should be a factoring arrangement (invoice purchasing arrangement) between the client (which sells
goods and services to trade customers on credit) and the factor, which is the financing organization.
(b) Whenever the client sells goods to trade customers on credit, he prepares invoices in the usual way.
(c) The goods are sent to the buyers without raising a bill of exchange but accompanied by an invoice.
(d) The debt due by the purchaser to the client is assigned to the factor by advising the trade customers, to pay the
amount due to the client, to the factor.
(e) The client hands over the invoices to the factor under cover of a schedule of offer along with the copies of
invoices and receipted delivery challans or copies of R/R or L/R.
(f) The factor makes an immediate payment upto 80% of the assigned invoices and the balance 20% will be paid
on realization of the debt.
is a standard one. If the debtors fail to repay the debts, the entire responsibility falls on the shoulders of the
factor since he assumes the credit risk also. He cannot pass on this responsibility to his client and, hence, this
type of Factoring is also called ‘Without Recourse’ Factoring.
(ii) With Recourse Factoring or Pure Factoring
As the very name suggests, under this type, the factor does not assume the credit risk. In other words, if the
debtors do not repay their dues in time and if their debts are outstanding beyond a fixed period, say 60 to 90
days from the due date, such debts are automatically assigned back to the client. The client has to take up the
work of collection of overdue account by himself. If the client wants the factor to go on with the collection
work of overdue accounts, the client has to pay extra charges called ‘Refactoring Charges’.
Benefits of Factoring
The benefits of factoring can be summarized as follows:
(a) Better Cash Flows
The seller can offer credit to the customers, within the terms approved by the factor, and can receive
promptpayments as soon as, or shortly after invoicing. This may be cheaper than financing by means of bank
credit. The factoring is an alternative source of financing and can be availed if the firm expects a liquidity
problem on a regular basis. In fact, the factoring ensures a definite pattern of cash inflows from the credit sales.
(b) Better Assets Management
The security for such financial assistance is the receivable itself and, therefore, the assets will remain available
as security for other borrowings.
(c) Better Working Capital Management
Since the finance available from factoring moves directly with the level of the receivables, the problem of
additional working capital required to match the sales growth does not come at all. However, a close interaction
among working capital components implies that efficient management of one component can have positive
benefits on other components.
(d) Better Credit Administration
The debt management services which factors provide relieve the seller of the burden of credit administration
and the seller can concentrate on the cost of staff and office space. In other words, it enables the seller to
concentrate on developing his business.
(e) Better Evaluation
The debt management service may include formal or informal advice on credit standing. Factors hold large
amounts of information about the trading histories of firms. This can be valuable to those who are using
factoring services and can thereby avoid doing business with customers having bad payment record.
(f) Better Risk Management
In case of non-recourse factoring, the seller will have the advantages of repositioning the risk of customers
not properly paying due bills. This will cost more than with recourse factoring and thereby allows the seller to
escape the potentially dire consequences of customer’s default.
(a) Factoring is a broader term covering the entire trade debts of a client whereas discounting covers only those
trade debts which are backed by account receivables.
(b) Under factoring, the factor purchases the trade debt and thus becomes a holder for value. But, under discounting
the financier acts simply as an agent of his customer and he does not become the owner. In other words,
discounting is a kind of advance against bills whereas factoring is an outright purchase of trade debts.
(c) The factors may extend credit without any recourse to the client in the event of non-payment by customers.
But, discounting is always made with recourse to the client.
(d) Account Receivables under discount are subject to rediscounting whereas it is not possible under factoring.
(e) Factoring involves purchase and collection of debts, management of sales ledger, assumption of credit risk,
provision of finance and rendering of consultancy services. But discounting involves simply the provision of
finance alone.
(f) Bill discounting finance is a specific one in the sense that it is based on an individual bill arising out of an
individual transaction only. On the other hand, factoring is based on the ‘whole turnover’ i.e. a bulk finance is
provided against a number of unpaid invoices.
(g) Under discounting, the drawee is always aware of the bank’s charge on receivables. But, under undisclosed
factoring everything is kept highly confidential.
(h) Bill financing through discounting requires registration of charges with the Registrar of companies. In fact,
factoring does not require such registration.
(i) Discounting is always a kind of ‘in-balance sheet financing’. That is, both the amount of receivables and bank
credit are shown in the balance sheet itself due to its ‘with recourse’ nature. But factoring is always “off-
balance sheet financing”.
5. Securitization
Securitization of debt or asset refers to the process of liquidating the illiquid and long-term assets like loans
and receivables of financial institutions like banks by issuing marketable securities against them. In other
words, debt securitization is a method of recycling of funds. It is a process whereby loans and other receivables
are underwritten and sold in form of asset. It is thus a process of transforming the assets of a lending institution
into negotiable instrument for generation of funds.
Characteristics of GDR
(a) The shares underlying the GDR do not carry voting rights.
(b) The instruments are freely traded in the international market.
(c) The investors earn fixed income by way of dividend.
(d) GDRS can be converted into underlying shares, depository/ custodian banks reducing the issue.
Modus Operandi of GDR
The GDR operates in the following ways –
(a) An Indian company issues ordinary equity shares.
(b) These shares are deposited with a custodian bank (mostly domestic bank)
(c) The custodian bank establishes a link with a depository bank overseas.
(d) The depository bank, in turn issues depository receipts in dollars.
(e) Funds are raised when the foreign entities purchase those depository receipts at an agreed price.
(f) The dividends on such issues are paid by the issuing company to the depository bank in local currency.
(g) The depository bank converts the dividends into US Dollars at the ruling exchange rate and distributes it
among the GDR holders.
Advantages of GDR
(a) The Indian companies are able to tap global equity market to raise currency.
(b) The exchange risk borne by the investors as payment of the dividend is made in local currency.
(c) The voting rights are vested only with depository.
(ii) American Depository Receipt (ADR)
The depository receipt in the US market is called ADR. ADRs are those which are issued and listed in any
of the stock exchanges of US. It is an investment in the stock of non- US corporation trading in the US
stock exchange.
Characteristics of ADR
(a) The ADRs may or may not have voting rights.
(b) These are issued in accordance with the provisions laid by SEC, USA.
(c) These are bearer negotiable instrument and the holder can sell it in the market.
(d) The ADRs once sold can be re- issued.
(e) The operation of ADR- similar to that of GDR.
Advantages of ADR
(a) The ADRs are an easy cost-effective way for individuals to hold and own shares in a foreign country.
(b) They save considerable money by reducing administration cost and avoiding foreign taxes on each
transaction.
4. Other Sources
In addition to the sources discussed above, there are some sources which may be availed by a promoter on
casual basis. Some of these are:
(a) Deferred Credit: Supplier of plant and equipment may provide a credit facility and the payment may be
made over number of years. Interest on delayed payment is payable at agreed terms and conditions.
(b) Bills Discounting: In this scheme, a bill is raised by the seller of equipment, which is accepted by the
buyer/ promoter of the project. The seller realizes the sales proceeds by getting the bill discounted by a
commercial bank which, in turn gets the bill rediscounted by IDBI.
(c) Seed Capital Assistance: At the time of availing loan from financial institutions, the promoters have to
contribute seed capital in the project. In case, the promoters do not have seed capital, they can procure the
seed capital from ‘Seed Capital Assistance Schemes’. Two such schemes are:
(i) Risk Capital Foundation Scheme: The scheme was promoted by IFCI to provide seed capital upto
` 40 lakhs to the promoters.
(ii) Seed Capital Assistance Scheme: Under this scheme, seed capital for smaller projects is provided
upto 15 lakhs by IDBI directly or through other financial institutions.
Financing of startups is something different from traditional financing. Many startups choose to not raise funding
from third parties and are funded by their founders only (to prevent debts and equity dilution). However, most
startups do raise funding, especially as they grow larger and scale their operations. No matter how great your
business idea is, one essential element of startup success is your ability to obtain sufficient funding to start and
grow the business. A startup might require funding for one, a few, or all of the following purposes. It is important
that an entrepreneur is clear about why they are raising funds. Founders should have a detailed financial and
business plan before they approach investors.
Stage 3: Validation
At this stage, a startup has a prototype ready and needs to validate the potential demand of the startup’s product/
service. This is called conducting a ‘Proof of Concept (POC)’, after which comes the big market launch.
Category II AIF
As per the AIF Regulation 3(4)(b), AIFs which do not fall in Category I and III and which do not undertake
leverage or borrowing other than to meet day-to-day operational requirements and as permitted in the SEBI
(Alternative Investment Funds) Regulations, 2012.
Various types of funds such as real estate funds, private equity funds (PE funds), funds for distressed assets,
etc. are registered as Category II AIFs.
C. Crowdfunding
Crowdfunding is a collaborative funding model that one can collect small contributions from many individuals
(the crowd). There are two main types of crowdfunding. The donation model is what most people think of
when crowdfunding is mentioned. Funders donate money to a cause in exchange for products, special pricing
on items, or rewards. Beyond the perks, donation funders do not have the opportunity to get anything in return
for their money. Kickstarter and Indiegogo are examples of donation crowdfunding. A more recent model is
investment crowdfunding. Businesses sell ownership stakes in the form or equity or debt so funders (more
accurately, investors) become shareholders in a sense, and they have the potential for financial return.
Some of the popular crowdfunding sites in India are Indiegogo, Wishberry, Ketto, Fundlined and Catapooolt.
In US, Kickstarter, RocketHub, Dreamfunded, Onevest, DonorBox and GoFundMe are popular crowdfunding
platforms.
Advantages of Crowdfunding
Crowdfunding is a great alternative way to fund a venture, and it can be done without giving up equity or
accumulating debt. However, here are some advantages that crowdfunding offers an entrepreneur.
These are –
(a) Marketing Technique
In spite of being an investment tool, crowdfunding also works as a marketing tool. As mass people are
involved in crowdfunding, you can reach them with your startup’s whereabouts. Raising of funds and
reaching the probable customers as well as advertisement both are possible in case crowdfunding.
(b) Indication of proof of Business Concept
Showing investors and convincing yourself that your venture has received sufficient market validation at
an early stage is hard. However, crowdfunding makes this possible. A successful crowdfunding campaign
may be the indication of proof of business concept. This shows trust and integrity towards a venture and
will allow verification throughout the journey that one is on the right track.
(c) Less Risky
In addition to finding enough funding, there will always be unpredictable fees, market validation challenges,
and others looking to get your business off the ground. Launching a crowdfunding campaign prevents
these risks. Crowdfunding today enables entrepreneurs to gain market acceptance and avoid giving up
equity before committing to bringing a product concept to market.
(d) Brainstorming
One of the biggest challenges for small businesses and entrepreneurs is to collect feedback about business’s
performance at an early stage. Through crowdfunding campaigns, entrepreneurs have the opportunity to
interact with the crowd and get comments, feedback, and ideas.
(e) Information about Prospective Loyal Customers
Crowdfunding campaigns not only allow entrepreneurs to showcase their companies and products, but
also give them the opportunity to share the information and purpose behind them. People who see an
entrepreneur’s campaign and decide to contribute believe in the long-term success of the company.
Essentially, these people are early adopters. Early adopters are very important to any business because
they help spread the word in the first place without asking for anything in return. These people care about
the company’s brand and message and are likely to be loyal customers throughout its lifespan.
(f) Easier than Traditional Applications
Applying for a loan or pursuing other capital investments are two of the most painful processes that
every entrepreneur has to go through, especially during the early stages of the startup. But the application
process for crowdfunding is easier compared to these traditional methods.
Crowfunding
Source: IOSCO Staff Working Paper - Crowdfunding: An Infant Industry Growing Fast , 2014.
(a) Social Lending/Donation Crowdfunding: Donation crowdfunding denotes solicitation of funds for social,
artistic, philanthropic or other purpose, and not in exchange for anything of tangible value. For example, Kickstarter,
Indiegogo are some of the platforms that support donation-based crowdfunding.
(b) Reward Crowdfunding: Reward crowdfunding refers to solicitation of funds, wherein investors receive some
existing or future tangible reward (such as an existing or future consumer product or a membership rewards scheme)
as consideration. Most of the websites which support donation crowdfunding, also enable reward crowdfunding,
e.g. Kicktstarter, Rockethub etc.
(c) Peer-to-Peer Lending Crowfunding: In Peer-to-Peer lending, an online platform matches lenders/investors
with borrowers/issuers in order to provide unsecured loans and the interest rate is set by the platform. Some Peer-
to-Peer platforms arrange loans between individuals, while other platforms pool funds which are then lent to small
and medium-sized businesses. Some of the leading examples from the US are Lending Club, Prosper etc. and from
UK are Zopa, Funding Circle etc.
(d) Equity Crowdfunding: Equity Crowfunding refers to fund raising by a business, particularly early-stage
funding, through offering equity interests in the business to investors online. Businesses seeking to raise capital
through this mode typically advertise online through a crowdfunding platform website, which serves as an
intermediary between investors and the start-up companies.
T
he cost of capital is the most important and controversial area in financial management. Capital budgeting
decisions have a major impact on the firm, and cost of capital is used as a criterion to evaluate the capital
budgeting decisions i.e. whether to accept or reject a project. The cost of capital is also equally important
for financing decision.
Business risk is the risk to the firm of being unable to cover fixed operating costs. Financial risk is the risk of
being unable to cover required financial obligations such as interest and preference dividends.
Classification of Costs
Costs can be classified as follows:
A. Historical Cost and Future Cost: Historical cost is the cost which has already been incurred for financing
a particular project. It is based on the actual cost incurred in the previous project. Historical cost is useful for
analyzing the existing capital structure of the firm.
Future cost is the estimated cost for the future. In financing decision, the future cost is more important than the
historical cost as most of the financing decision are related with the future or proposed project that are taken in
future period. But at the same time, the future cost is estimated on the basis of previous experience or historical
data, so both are related.
B. Specific Cost and Composite Cost: The cost of each component or source of capital is known as the specific
cost or component cost. The cost of finance is the minimum return expected by the investors which again
depend on the degree of risk involved in the investment.
When all the specific cost of individual source are combined together to get a single cost of capital of the firm,
it is known as overall or composite or combined or weighted average cost of capital (WACC). Composite cost
is commonly referred as the firm’s cost of capital. It represents the minimum return that a firm must earn on its
existing investment or asset base to satisfy its creditors, owners and other providers of capital.
C. Explicit and Implicit Cost: Explicit cost of any source of finance is the discount rate which equates the
present value of cash inflows with the present value of cash outflows. Van Horne defined explicit cost as – ‘the
discount rate that equates the present value of the funds received by the firm, net of underwriting and other
cost, with the present value of expected outflows.’ These outflows are interest payment, repayment of principal
or dividends, etc.
Implicit cost, also known as the opportunity cost is the cost of the opportunity foregone in order to take
up a particular project. The implicit cost can be defined as “the rate of return associated with the best
investment opportunity for the firm and its shareholders that would be foregone, if the projects presently under
consideration by the firm were accepted.” For example, the implicit cost of retained earnings is an opportunity
cost or implicit cost of capital to the shareholders as they could have invested the fund in anywhere else if the
retained earnings were distributed to them as dividend.
Now, it can be said that explicit cost arises where funds are raised, whereas the implicit cost arises when funds
are used.
D. Average Cost and Marginal Cost: An average cost is the combined cost or weighted average cost of various
source of capital. When the aggregate of the cost of capital of each such source is divided by the aggregate
of the weight of sources, the average cost of capital is obtained. The weight represents the proportion of each
source of in the capital structure.
Marginal cost refers to the average cost of new additional funds required by a firm. It is simply the cost of
additional fund raised. Marginal cost of capital is an important tool for evaluating a new project. The return of
the new project is compared with the marginal cost of capital to decide on the acceptance or rejection of the
project.
capital budgeting decision, the long-term sources of funds are relevant as they constitute the major sources of
financing of fixed assets. In calculating the cost of capital, therefore, the focus is on long-term funds. In other
words, the specific costs have to be calculated for (A) long-term debt (including debentures); (B) preference
shares; (C) equity capital; and (D) retained earnings.
A. Cost of Debt Capital (kd)
Cost of debt capital is the required rate of return on investment of the lenders of a company. Long-term debt
means Long-term loans from financial institutions, capital from issuing debentures or bonds, etc. These Long-
terms debts do not have ownership to the providers of finance. The providers of debt finance do not participate
in the affairs of the firm but they enjoy the charge on profit before tax. This means they are paid before the
payment to the preference shareholders or equity shareholders.
For calculation of cost of debt, first we have to compute ‘Net cash proceed’ out of the issue and ‘Net cash
outflow’. Net cash proceeds are the funds actually received from the sale of securities. Debt like debenture may
be issued at a premium or discount and sometime the issue involve floatation cost like underwriting, brokerage,
etc. So, the amount of discount, premium or floatation cost should be adjusted for calculation of ‘net cash
proceed’.
Net Cash Proceeds = Face value of the debt – Floatation cost – Discount allowed at the time of issue
(if any) + Premium charged at the time of issue (if any)
The ‘net cash outflow’ is the amount of periodic interest and repayment of principal in installment or in lump-
sum at maturity.
The calculation of cost of loan from a financial institution is similar to that of redeemable debenture. So, the
discussion is mainly on debenture and bonds. Financing through debenture or bonds have some specific feature
and some benefits also.
A debenture or bond may be issued at par or at discount as at premium as compared to its face value. Again,
the debenture as bond may be redeemable or irredeemable (perpetual) in nature.
Perpetual / Irredeemable Debt:
Debts may be issued for perpetuity. The debentures which are not redeemed by the issuer is known as irredeemable
debentures. Practically, a firm follows the policy of maintaining a given proportion of debt in its capital structure.
Individual debts may be repaid but they are replaced by new ones. So, debts are never really paid. So, the permanent
part of the debt capital continues for perpetuity.
Formula
Where,
kd = Cost of debt after tax
I = Annual interest payment
NP = Net proceeds of debentures or current market price
t = Tax rate
The cost of debt will be different if the bonds or debentures are issued (i) at par or (ii) at discount or (iii) at
premium. The following example will make it clear.
When Debentures are issued (i) at par or (ii) at discount or (iii) at premium –
Illustration 1
X Ltd. has 10% perpetual debt of ` 1,00,000. The tax rate is 35 %. Determine the cost of capital (before tax as well
as after tax) assuming the debt is issued at (i) par, (ii) 10% discount, and (iii) 10% premium.
Solution:
(i) Debt issued at par –
10,000
Before-tax cost, ki = ` = 10.00%
1,00,000
After-tax cost, kd = ki(1-t) = 10%(1-0.35) = 6.5 %
When both net Proceed of issue and market price of debenture are given –
Illustration 2
Five years ago, KPM Ltd issued 12% irredeemable debentures at ` 105, a ` 5 premium to their par value of ` 100.
The current market price of these debentures is ` 95. If the company pays corporate tax at a rate of 35 % what is
its current cost of debenture capital?
Solution:
Cost of irredeemable debenture:
I
kd =
NP
(1 − t )
kd = Cost of debt after tax
I = Annual interest payment = ` 12
NP = Net proceeds of debentures or current market price = ` 95
t = Tax rate = 35%
12(1 − 0.35)
kd = ` = 0.08211 or 8.21%
95
Student Note: If both net proceed and market price of the debenture or bond is given, the market price to be
taken for computation of cost of debt.
Illustration 3
XYZ Limited keeps a perpetual fixed amount of debt in its books. It pays coupon of 15%. Its debt sells at par in
the market. What is the cost of debt if the firm pays 35% tax? What is the cost of debt if it sells (a) at 5% premium
(b) at 5% discount to the face value?
Solution:
Cost of perpetual (non-redeemable) debt is calculated by using following formula:
I
kd =
NP
(1 − t )
Here,
I = Coupon rate =15%
NP = Market price = ` 100 (as sold at par)
t = Tax = 35%
15(1 − 0.35)
Cost of debt = kd = ` = 9.75%
100
(a) If the market price is at 5% premium to the face value (` 105); then
15(1 − 0.35)
Cost of debt = kd = ` = 9.25%
105
(b) If the market price is at 5% discount to the face value (` 95); then
15(1 − 0.35)
Cost of debt = kd = ` = 10.26%
95
Cost of Redeemable Debenture
The cost of debenture (kd) will be calculated as below:
RV - NP
I (1-t)+
n
Cost of debenture = kd = RV + NP
Where, 2
I = Interest payment
NP = Net proceeds from debentures in case of new issue of debt or current market price in case of existing
debt
RV = Redemption value of debentures
t = Tax rate applicable to the company
n = Life of debentures
The above formula to calculate cost of debt is used where only interest on debt is tax deductable. Sometimes, debts
are issued at discount and/or redeemed at a premium. If discount on issue and/ or premium on redemption are tax
deductible, the following formula can be used to calculate the cost of debts.
Cost of debenture = kd =
In absence of any specific information, students may use any of the above formulae to calculate the cost of debt
(kd) with logical assumption.
Illustration 4
ABC Ltd. issued 5,000, 12% debentures of ` 100 each at a premium of 10% on 1.4.2018 to be matured on 1.4.2023.
The debentures will be redeemed on maturity. Compute the cost of debentures assuming 35% as tax rate.
Solution:
The cost of debenture (kd) will be calculated as below:
RV - NP
I (1-t) +
n
∴ Cost of debenture (kd) = RV + NP
2
Here,
I = Interest on debenture = 10% of ` 100 = ` 12
NP = Net proceeds = 110% of ` 100 = ` 110
RV = Redemption value = ` 100
n = Period of debenture = 5 Years
t = Tax rate = 35 % or 0.35
(100 - 110)
12 (1-0.35) +
5 years
∴ kd= 100 + 110
2
12 x 0.65 - 2 5.8
or, kd= = = 0.05524 or 5.52%
105 105
When Market Price of Debenture is given –
Illustration 5
PQR Ltd. issued 5,000, 12% debentures of ` 100 each on 1.4.2018 to be matured on 1.4.2023. The market price of
the debenture is ` 80. Compute the cost of existing debentures assuming 35% tax rate.
Solution:
RV - NP
I (1-t) +
n
Cost of debenture (kd) = RV+NP
2
I = Interest on debenture = 10% of ` 100 = ` 12
NP = Net proceeds = ` 80
RV = Redemption value = ` 100
n = Period of debenture = 5 Years
t = Tax rate = 35 % or 0.35
100 -80
12 (1-0.35) +
5
∴ kd = 100 +80
2
12 x 0.65 + 4 11.8
kd = = = 13.111 =13.11%
90 90
Illustration 6
Rima & Co. has issued 12% debenture of face value ` 100 for ` 10 lakh. The debenture is expected to be sold at
5% discount. It will also involve flotation cost of ` 5 per debenture. The debentures are redeemable at a premium
of 5% after 10 years. Calculate the cost of debenture if the tax rate is 50%.
Solution:
After tax cost of debenture (kd) may be calculated as follows:
RV- NP
I(1-t) +
Cost of debenture (kd)= n
RV + NP
Where, 2
kd = Cost of debt after tax
I = Rate of interest i.e., 12% or ` 12 per debenture
t = Tax rate i.e. 50% or 0.50
n = Number of years in which debenture is to be redeemed i.e. 10 years
RV = Principal value at the time of redemption i.e. ` 100 + (5% of ` 100) or ` 105 per debenture
NP = Net cash proceeds at the time of issue i.e. ` 100 – (5% of ` 100) – ` 5 or ` 90 per debenture
Amortisation of Bond
A bond may be amortised every year i.e. principal is repaid every year rather than at maturity. In this situation, the
principal will go down with annual payments and interest will be computed on the outstanding amount. The cash
flows of the bonds will be uneven.
The formula for determining the value of a bond or debenture that is amortised every year is as follows :
Illustration 7
X Ltd. is proposing to sell a 5-year bond of ` 10,000 at 10 % rate of interest per annum. The bond amount will be
amortised equally over its life. What is the bond’s present value for an investor if he expects a minimum rate of
return of 6 %?
Solution:
The amount of interest will go on declining as the outstanding amount of bond will be reducing due to amortization.
Since X Ltd. will have to return ` 2,000 every year, the outstanding amount of bond will be zero at the end of fifth
year. The outflows every year will consist of interest payment and repayment of principal as follows:
Where,
kd= 6% = 0.06
Illustration 8
RR Ltd. issued 10,000, 12% convertible debentures of ` 100 each with a maturity period of 5 years. At maturity,
the debenture holders will have the option to convert the debentures into equity shares of the company in the ratio
of 1:10 (10 shares for each debenture). The current market price of the equity shares is ` 14 each and historically
the growth rate of the shares are 5% per annum. Compute the cost of debentures assuming 35% tax rate.
Solution:
Determination of Redemption value:
Higher of,
(i) The cash value of debentures = ` 100
(ii) Value of equity shares = 10 shares × ` 14(1+0.05)5
= 10 shares × 17.868 = `178.68
Therefore, ` 178.68 will be taken as redemption value as it is higher than the cash option and attractive to the
investors.
RV - NP 178.68 - 100
I (1 - t) + 12 (1 - 0.35) +
n 5 7.8 + 15.736
= = = 0.1689 = 16.89%
RV+NP 178.68+100 139.34
2 2
Student Note: In practice, the corporate are normally likely to have multiple debt issues most likely subject
to different interest rates. To determine the overall cost of debt, cost of each debt issue is to be separately
computed. The weighted average of costs of all debt issues would be cost of debt of the firm as a whole. (Khan
& Jain, 2011)
Where,
I = Annual Interest charge
t = Tax rate
n = Number of years
F = Redeemable value of the debt at the time of maturity
S = Net sale proceeds from the issue of debt (face value-expenses)
Where-
kp = Cost of Preference Share Capital
D = Annual Preference Dividend
Dt = Dividend Tax
RV = Redeemable Value
NP = Net Proceeds of the Share
n = No. of Years
Illustration 9
BP Ltd. issued 60,000 12% Redeemable Preference Share of ` 100 each at a premium of ` 5 each, redeemable after
10 years at a premium of ` 10 each. The floatation cost of each share is ` 3. You are required to calculate cost of
preference share capital ignoring dividend tax.
Solution:
Calculation of cost of preference shares (kp)
Preference Dividend (PD) = `100 × 60,000 shares × 0.12 = ` 7,20,000
Flotation Cost = 60,000 shares × ` 3 = ` 1,80,000
Net Proceeds (NP) = ` 105 × 60,000 shares - 1,80,000 = ` 61,20,000
Redemption Value (RV) = 60,000 shares × ` 110 = ` 66,00,000
(RV - NP)
PD +
n
Cost of Redeemable Preference Shares (kp) = RV + NP
2
(66,00,000 - 61,20,000) 4,80,000
7,20,000 + 7,20,000 +
10 10 7, 20, 000 + 48, 000
kp =` = =
66,00,000 + 61,20,000 1,27,20,000 63, 60, 000
2 2
7, 68, 000
= = 0.1208 = 12.08%
63, 60, 000
Illustration 10
Y Co. Ltd. issues 10,000 12% preference shares of ` 100 each at a premium @ 10% but redeemable at a premium
@ 20% after 5 years. The company pays under writing commission @ 5%. If tax on dividend is 12.5%, surcharge
is 2.5% and education cess is 3%, calculate the cost of preference share capital.
Solution:
The cost of capital of redeemable preference share Kp may be computed as follows:
Where,
kp = Cost of preference share capital;
D = Annual preference dividend, i.e. ` 12 per share
RV = Redeemable value; i.e. , ` 100 + (20% of ` 100)= `120
NP = Net Proceeds of the share; ` 100 + (10% of ` 100) – 5% of ` 110
= 1104.50
120 - 104.50
12(1 + 0.1319) +
5 12(1.1319) + 3.1
Therefore, kp = = = 0.1486 or 14.86%
120 + 104.50 112.25
2
D
Cost of preference shares kP = NP [when dividend tax is not considered]
D(1+D1)
NP [when dividend tax is considered]
kP =
Where,
K p = Cost of preference share capital;
D = Annual preference dividend;
Dt = Dividend tax
NP = Net proceeds of the share;
Student Note: Issuance of irredeemable preference shares are not allowed as per the Companies Act, 2013, but
for the academic knowledge purpose it has been presented here.
When Preference Shares are issued (i) at par, (ii) at 10% premium and (iii) at 10% discount
Illustration 11
Simond Ltd. issues 10% irredeemable preference share of ` 100 each for ` 10,00,000. What will be the cost
of preference share capital (kp), if preference shares are issued: (i) at par, (ii) at 10% premium and (iii) at 10%
discount. Assume that there is no dividend distribution tax.
Solution:
The cost of Preference share kp will be –
The cost of Preference share kp will be –
D
kP = NP [as there is no dividend distribution tax]
(i) When shares are issued at par i.e. at `100 per share –
D =10
NP =100
10
∴ kP = 100 = 10 or 10%
(ii) When shares are issued at 10% premium i.e. at ` 110 per share –
D = 10
NP = 110
10
∴ kP = = 0.0909 or 9%
110
(iii) When shares are issued at 10% discount i.e. at ` 90 per share –
D = 10
NP = 90
10
∴ kP = 90 = 0.1111 or 11.11%
Assumptions:
(a) Market values of the shares are directly related to the future dividends on the shares.
(b) Future dividend per share is expected to be constant and the company is expected to earn at least this yield
over a period of time.
Limitations:
There are certain limitations in this approach. The limitations are:
(a) This method does not consider any growth rate i.e. future dividend assumed to be constant. But practically,
shareholders used to expect that the return on their equity investment would grow over time.
(b) It does not include the effect of future earnings or retained earnings.
(c) This approach can lead to ignore the capital appreciation of value of share.
D
Formula: ke = P
0
Where,
ke = Cost of equity share capital
D = Expected divined per share
P0 = Current market price per share
When it is expected that dividend to be received at a uniform rate over the years –
Illustration 12
MNC Ltd. paid dividend per share of ` 4 and the current market price of equity share is ` 20.
Calculate the cost of equity share capital ke.
Solution:
D
ke = P
0
Where,
ke = ?
D=`4
P0 = ` 20
`4
ke = × 100 = 20%
` 20
Illustration 13
AB Ltd. issued shares of ` 100 each at a premium of 10%. The issue involved underwriting commission of 5%. The
rate of dividend expected by the shareholders is 12%. Determine the cost of equity capital (ke).
Solution:
D
Cost of equity capital = ke = P
0
P0 = Current market price per share = Issue price = 100 + 100 × 10% = ` 110
` 12
ke = = 0.1148 = 11.48%
` 104.5
Formula
ke = EP
k e = Cost of equity share capital
Illustration 14
The earnings available to the shareholders amount to ` 40,000. Firm is represented by 10,000 equity shares and the
current market price of equity share is ` 25. Calculate the cost of equity share capital.
Solution:
E
ke = P × 100
ke = ?
P = ` 25
4 × 100 = 16%
ke = `` 25
Illustration 15
Mamon Ltd. is expected to earn ` 30 per share. Company follows fixed payout ratio of 40%. The market price of its
share is ` 200. Find the cost of existing equity if dividend tax of 15 % is imposed on the distributed earnings when:
(a) current level of dividend amount is maintained.
(b) dividend to the shareholders is reduced by the extent of dividend tax.
Solution:
(a) When dividend net of tax to shareholders maintained at same level, such policy would reduce the retained
earnings which in turn reduces the growth.
t = Dividend tax = 15%
D1= Dividend = (` 30 × 40%) = ` 12
Amount of tax = (Dividend 12 × 15% tax) = ` 1.8
Retained earnings = (` 30 - ` 12 - ` 1.8) = ` 16.2
Growth,
Cost of Equity
D1 12
=ke
Ke + g= + 0.081 = 0.141 = 14.1%
P 200
(b) When dividend (gross of tax) to shareholders is maintained at the same level, such policy would keep the level
of retained earnings and growth same but the amount of dividend to the shareholders would reduce by the
extent of dividend tax.
D ` 10.2
ke = P1 + g = ` 200 + 0.09 = 0.141 = 14.1%
If flotation cost is considered in case of newly issued equity shares then cost of equity under this approach will be
calculated as below
D1
ke = P – F + g
0
Where,
F = Flotation cost
When dividend are expected to grow at a uniform rate in each year –
Illustration 16
XYZ Company’s share is currently quoted in the market at ` 20. The company pays a dividend of ` 2 per share
and the investors expect a growth rate of 5% per year. You are required to calculate (a) cost of equity capital of the
company and (b) the market price per share if the anticipated growth rate dividend is 7%.
Solution:
(a) The cost of equity capital (ke) may be ascertained as follows:
D1
ke = P + g
0
Where,
D1 = Dividend per share at the end of the current year i.e. ` 2
P0 = Market price per share i.e. ` 20
D
(b) We know, ke = P + g
0
2
ke = 0.15 = P + 0.07
0
`2 `2
or, P0 = = = ` 25 per share
0.15 - 0.07 .08
Illustration 17
Using Dividend Growth Model, calculate cost of equity (ke) in the following case:
Equity share capital (shares of `10 each) ` 2,00,000
Solution:
For Equity Share Capital (ke) :
DPS1
ke= +g
MPS
Where,
DPS1 = Dividend per share at the end of the current year i.e. ` 11
MPS = Market price per share i.e. ` 180
g = Expected growth rate of dividend i.e. 0.1643 or 16.43% which may be calculated as under –
(` 8 – ` 7)
Growth Rate in 2021 = × 100 = 14.29%
`7
(` 10 – ` 8)
Growth Rate in 2022 = × 100 = 25%
`8
(` 11 – ` 10)
Growth Rate in 2023 = × 100 = 10%
` 10
14.29 + 25 + 10 49.29
Simple Average = = 3 = 16.43% or 0.1643
3
` 11
Therefore, ke = ` 180 + 0.1643 = 0.2254 or 22.54%
Or
Where,
D0 = Current dividend,
Dn = Dividend in n years ago
(ii) Gordon’s Growth Model
According to this method, a growing stream of future dividends arises from a growing level of investment by
the firm in profitable projects, and it will, therefore, be this rate of investment which will partially determine
the growth rate. This model is based on the following assumptions:
(a) The firm is an all-equity firm.
(b) Only source of additional investment is retained earnings.
(c) Every year firm re-invested a constant portion of retained earnings.
(d) Retained earnings produce a constant of annual return
It can be calculated as below:
Growth (g) = b × r
Where
g = Future dividend growth rate
b = Constant portion of retained earnings each year*
r = Average rate of return fund invested
*Proportion of earnings available to equity shareholders which is not distributed as dividend.
Illustration 19
The beta coefficient of Target Ltd. is 1.4. The company has been maintaining 8 % rate of growth in dividends and
earning. The last dividend paid was ` 4 per share. The return on government securities is 10 % while the return on
market portfolio is 15 %. The current market price of one share of Target Ltd. is ` 36.
(a) What will be the equilibrium price per share of Target Ltd?
(b) Would you advise for purchasing the share?
Solution:
(a) The required rate of return (ke) = Rf + β (km – Rf)
= 10% + 1.4 (15% - 10%)
= 17 %
D1
Equilibrium price per share (P0) = k – g
e
(b) The share of Target Ltd. is worth buying as it is undervalued.
Illustration 20
Calculate the cost of equity capital of Mamon Ltd., whose risk free rate of return equals 10%. The firm’s beta
equals 1.75 and the return on the market portfolio equals to 15%.
Solution:
ke =
Rf + β ( Rm- Rf )
= 0.10 +1.75 (0.15-0.10)
= 0.10 + 1.75 (0.05)
= 0.1875 or 18.75 %
Illustration 21
If the risk free rate of return and the market rate of return of an investment are 14% and 18% respectively, calculate
the cost of equity share capital if (a) β = 1, (b) β = 2/3 and (c) β = 5/4.
Solution:
We know,
We know,
ke = Rf + β ( Rm- Rf)
Where, k = Expected rate of return to the investors, or cost of capital
Rf` = Risk free rate of return i.e. 14%
Rm = Market rate of return i.e. 18%
β = Beta coefficient by which the market risk is determined
(a) When β = 1,
ke = 14% + 1 ( 18% – 14%)
= 14% + 4%
= 18%
(b) When β = 2/3,
ke = 14% + 2/3 ( 18% – 14%)
= 14% + 2.6667
= 16.6667%
(c) When β = 5/4,
ke = 14% + 5/4 ( 18% – 14%)
= 14% + 5%
= 19%
Illustration 22
From the following information in respect of a company, you are required to calculate the cost of equity using
CAPM approach:
(a) Risk-free rate of return 12%
(b) Expected market price of equity shares at the year end is ` 1,400
(c) Initial price of investment in equity shares of the company is ` 1,200
(d) Beta risk factor of the company is 0.70
(e) Expected dividend at the year end is ` 140
Solution:
We know under CAPM approach cost of equity can be calculated as;
ke = Rf + β ( Rm- Rf)
Where,
Rf = Risk free rate of return i.e. 12% or 0.12
= 0.2833 or 28.33%
ke = 0.12+ 0.70 (0.2833 – 0.12)
= 0.23431 or 23.43%
kr = ke (1-t) (1-C)
(b) The second method assumes the retained earnings as the investment of existing shareholders in the firm itself.
So, the retained earnings may be treated at par with the equity share capital. This is known as the external yield
criterion. The cost of retained earnings may be measured in the same way as that of equity share capital.
Illustration 23
A firm’s ke (return available to shareholders) is 10%, the average tax rate of shareholders is 30% and it is expected
that 2% is brokerage cost that shareholder will have to pay while investing their dividends in alternative securities.
What is the cost of retained earnings?
Solution:
Cost of Retained Earnings, kr = ke (1 – t) (1 – b)
Where,
ke = rate of return available to shareholders
t = tax rate
b = brokerage cost
Therefore,
kr = 10% (1–0.5) (1–0.02)
= 10%×0.5×0.98
= 4.9%
Illustration 24
AKS Ltd. retains ` 10,00,000 out of its current earnings. The expected rate of return to the shareholders, if they had
invested the funds elsewhere is 10%. The brokerage is 2% and the shareholders come in 30% tax bracket. Calculate
the cost of retained earnings.
Solution:
Computation of cost of Retained Earnings (kr)
kr = k(1-tp) – Brokerage
Where,
k = Opportunity cost;
= 0.07-0.02 = 0.05
= 5%
Alternatively,
Cost of Retained earnings is equal to opportunity cost for benefits forgone by the shareholders.
(`)
Earning before tax (10% of ` 10,00,000) 1,00,000
Less: Tax (30% of ` 1,00,000) 30,000
After Tax Earnings 70,000
Less: Brokerage (2% of ` 10,00,000) 20,000
Net Earnings 50,000
Total Investment 10,00,000
Historical versus Marginal Weights: The first aspect of the decision regarding the selection of appropriate
weights for computing the overall cost of capital is: which system of weighting marginal or historical is preferable?
The critical assumption in any weighting system is that the firm will raise capital in the specified proportions.
Marginal Weights: The use of marginal weights involves weighting the specific costs by the proportion of each
type of fund to the total funds to be raised. The marginal weights represent the %age share of different financing
sources the firm intends to raise/employ. The basis of assigning relative weights is, therefore, new/additional/
incremental issue of funds and, hence, marginal weights.
However, WACC can be computed by using the following three types of weight.
(a) Book value weight
(b) Market value weight
(c) Marginal value weight
Under this method, weight are computed by taking relative proportions of various sources of capital to the capital
structure of the firm. The main advantage of book value weight is that book values are readily available from the
published annual accounts or other records. The other advantage is that it depicts the real situation of the firm.
The main advantage of this weight are stated below:
(a) Book value weight is easier to calculate as the book values of various source of finance are readily available
from the published annual report of the company.
(b) A firm set capital structure target on the basis of book value rather than market value. Therefore, computation
of overall cost of capital on the basis of book value weight provides real situation of the firm
(c) Computation of debt-equity ratio for the purpose of analysing the capital structure also depends on the book
values.
(d) If the securities of the company are not listed in the stock exchange, then it is not possible to make available
the market value of the sources of finance, or even if is available is not reliable. In such a situation there is no
other alternative, rather tp use book value weights for the purpose of computation of weighted average cost of
capital.
The main disadvantages of this weight are stated below:
(a) There is no relationship in between book value weight and the market value of various sources of finance.
(b) Management cannot take decision relating to capital budgeting, financing etc. on the basis of book value
weight.
(c) Computation of weighted average cost of capital on the basis of book value weight is in conflict with the
concept of cost of capital because the latter is computed by considering the market value of various sources of
finance.
Under this method, the proportion of market values of various sources of capital are assigned as weight in
computing the WACC. Book value weight may be operationally convenient but market value is theoretically more
consistent sound and better indicatory of firm’s capital structure. The desirable practice is to employ market weight
to compute the firm’s cost of capital as it aims to maximize the value of the firm.
The main advantage of using market value weights are stated below:-
(a) Costs of specific sources are computed on the basis of their respective market value. Now, if the market values
of various source of finance are used as weights in computing the weighted average cost of capital, then a
consistency in the approach is maintained.
(b) Use of market value weights are in consistent with the objective of maximization of value of the firm.
(c) Use of market value of various source of finance which constitute the capital structure of the firm will reflect
the current cost of capital. Therefore, it will provide a better picture of the firm’s cost of capital.
But there are some practical difficulties for using market value weights which are stated below:-
(a) Market value of the securities may change frequently. This will in turn change the overall cost of capital which
will make the decision criterion for investment somewhat difficult.
(b) Market value of all sources of finance is not readily available like book value, particularly the market value of
retained earnings.
(c) If the securities of the company are not listed in the stock exchange, then market values are not available or
even if they are available, are not reliable.
Although market value weights are operationally inconvenient compared to book value weights, but theoretically
it is more consistent and sounder in reflecting a better picture of the firm’s true capital structure.
Marginal weight means giving weight to the specific costs by proportion of each type of funds to the total funds to
be raised. In the method the value of new or incremental capital is considered rather than the past or current market
values.
In using marginal weight, the firm is concerned with the actual amount of each type of financing used in raising
additional funds to finance new project by the company. Marginal weight is more helpful/ applicable to the actual
process of financing project.
It has been observed that, cost of capital ascertained by using market value weight is higher than the using book
value weight. This is mainly due to the fact, equity and preference share capital usually have higher market values
than their book values. Thus higher cost of capital resulted due to greater emphasis assigned to these sources of
finance.
While book value weights are readily available from the records of the company, the market value weight are not
always available, particularly in the case of retained earnings. In brief, while the book value weights areoperationally
convenient, market value weights theoretical consistent and sound enough and as such a better indicator of a firms
true capital structure.
Book value weights use accounting values to measure the proportion of each type of capital in the firm’s financial
structure. Market value weights measure the proportion of each type of capital at its market value. Market value
weights are appealing because the market values of securities closely approximate the actual Rupees to be received
from their sale. Moreover, because firms calculate the costs of the various types of capital by using prevailing
market prices, it seems reasonable to use market value weights. In addition, the long-term investment cash flows to
which the cost of capital is applied are estimated in terms of current as well as future market values. Market value
weights are clearly preferred over book value weights.
Historical versus Target Weight
Historical weights can be either book or market value weights based on actual capital structure proportions. For
example, past or current book value proportions would constitute a form of historical weighting, as would past or
current market value proportions. Such a weighting scheme would therefore be based on real - rather than desired
proportions.
However, Target weights, which can also be based on either book or market values, reflect the firm’s desired
capital structure proportions. Firms using target weights establish such proportions on the basis of the “optimal”
capital structure they wish to achieve. When one considers the somewhat approximate nature of the calculation of
weighted average cost of capital, the choice of weights may not be critical. However, from a Long-term perspective,
the preferred weighting scheme should be target market value proportions.
Illustration 25
AKS Ltd. has the following capital structure on October 31, 2023:
The market price of equity share is ` 50. It is expected that the company will pay next year a dividend of ` 5 per
share, which will grow at 7% forever. Assume 30% income tax rate. You are required to compute weighted average
cost of capital using market value weights.
Solution:
Workings:
D1 5
(i) Cost of Equity ke = P + g = 50 + 0.07 = 0.1 + 0.07 = 17%
0
WACC is 14.35%
Illustration 26
Asianol Ltd. has the following Capital Structure: ` (in Lakhs)
Equity Share Capital (10 lakhs shares) 100
12% Preference Share Capital (10,000 shares) 10
Retained Earnings 120
14% Debentures (70,000 Debentures) 70
14 % Term Loan 100
400
The market price per equity share is ` 25. The next expected dividend per share is ` 2 and is expected to grow
at 8%. The preference shares are redeemable after 7 years at per and are currently quoted at ` 75 per share.
Debentures are redeemable after 6 years at per and their current market quotation is ` 90 per debenture. The tax
rate applicable to the firm is 50%.
Solution:
(a) Under Book Value Method
(i) Cost of Equity Shares (ke)
= 16%
= 17.8%
= 8.25%
=` 2,50,00,000
= 100:120
= 5:6
=` 1,13,63,637
=
` 1,36,36,363
Weighted
Market- value Weights
Sources of Finance Specific Cost Cost
(` ) Proportion
(%)
Equity share capital 1,13,63,637 0.2700 16.00% 4.32
12% Pref. share capital 7,50,000 0.0178 17.80% 0.32
Retained earnings 1,36,36,363 0.3243 16.00% 5.20
14% Debentures 63,00,000 0.1498 8.25% 1.24
14% Term loan 1,00,00,000 0.2381 7.00% 1.67
Total 4,20,50,000 1.000 12.75
Therefore, WACC under market value is 12.75%.
Illustration 27
The capital structure and cost of capital of a company are given below:
Equity shares represent shares of ` 10 each. The current market value of each share is ` 80 and the corporate tax
rate is 40%.
(i) Compute weighted average cost of capital of the company using both book values and market values as
weights.
(ii) How would you account for the difference, if any, in the average cost of capital under (i) above?
Solution:
Calculation of specific cost of capital:
(i) For Equity share capital (ke)
ke= 16% (given), For Retained Earnings(kr)
kr= ke=16%, assuming external yield criterion
11.50
Book value as weights = or 11.50%
1
14.20
Market value as weights = or 14.20%
1
(ii) It has been observed that the calculation of weighted average cost of capital using market value is higher than
that using book value. The reason being that the market value of equity shares is considerably greater than their
book value. Therefore, it provides higher specific cost iof capital and given greater emphasis to this source of
finance.
Illustration 28
The following is the capital structure of ABC Ltd. as on 31.12.2023
Sources of Finance (` )
Equity Shares: 5,000 shares (of ` 100 each) 5,00,000
10% Preference Shares (of ` 100 each) 2,00,000
12% Debentures 3,00,000
10,00,000
The market price of the company’s share is ` 110 and it is expected that a dividend of ` 10 per share would be
declared for the year 2023. The dividend growth rate is 6%:
(i) If the company is in the 40% tax bracket, compute the weighted average cost of capital.
(ii) Assuming that in order to finance an expansion plan, the company intends to borrow a fund of ` 5 lakhs bearing
14% rate of interest, what will be the company’s revised weighted average cost of capital? This financing
decision is expected to increase dividend form ` 10 to ` 12 per share. However, the market price of equity
share is expected to decline form ` 110 to ` 105 per share.
Solution:
(i) Computation of the Weighted Average Cost of Capital (using Market Value Weights)
(ii) Computation of Revised Weighted Average Cost of Capital (using market value weights)
10
ke = 110 + 0.06 = 0.1509 or 15.09%
Illustration 29
XYZ Ltd. has the following book value capital structure:
The next expected dividend on equity shares per share is ` 3.60; the dividend per share is expected to grow at the
rate of 5%. The market price per share is ` 30.
Preference stock, redeemable after six years, are selling at ` 80 per debenture.
The income tax rate for the company is 30%.
(i) Required to calculate the current weighted average cost of capital using:
(a) Book value proportions; and
(b) Market value proportions
(ii) Determine the weighted marginal cost of capital schedule for the company, if it raises ` 20 crores next year,
given the following information:
(a) The amount will be raised by equity and debt in equal proportions;
(b) The company expects to retain ` 3 crores earning next year;
(c) The additional issue of equity shares will result in the net price per share being fixed at ` 25
(d) The debt capital raised by way of term loans will cost 15% for the first ` 5 crores and 16% for the next 5
crores.
Solution:
(i) (a)
Statement showing computation of Weighted Average Cost of Capital by using Book value
Proportions
Amount Weight
Cost of Weighted Cost
Source of Finance (Book Value) (Book Value Capital (%) of Capital (%)
Proportion)
(` in crores) (B) (C)=(A)×(B)
(A)
Equity Share (Working note 1) 30.00 0.256 17.00 4.352
10% Preference Share (Working note 2) 2.00 0.017 13.33 0.227
Retained earning (Working note 1) 40.00 0.342 17.00 5.814
14 % Debenture (Working note 3) 20.00 0.171 12.07 2.064
15% Term Loan (Working note 1) 25.00 0.214 10.50 2.247
117.00 1.0000 14.704
(b) Statement showing computation of Weighted Average Cost of Capital by using market value proportions
Amount Weight
Cost of Weighted Cost
Source of Finance (Book Value) (Book Value Capital (%) of Capital (%)
Proportion)
(` in crores) (B) (C)=(A)×(B)
(A)
Equity Share (Working note 1) 90.00 0.66 17.00 11.350
(3 crores × ` 30)
10% Preference Share 1.60 0.012 13.33 0.159
(Working note 2) (2 lakh × ` 80)
14 % Debenture (Working note 3) 18.00 0.134 12.07 1.617
(20 lakh × ` 90)
15% Term Loan (Working note 4) 25.00 0.186 10.50 1.953
134.60 1.0000 15.085
[Note: Since retained earnings are treated as equity capital for purposes of calculation of cost of specific source
of finance, the market value of the ordinary shares may be taken to represent the combined market value of equity
shares and retained earnings. The separate market values of retained earnings and ordinary shares may also be
worked out by allocating to each of these a %age of total market value equal to their %age share of the total based
on book value.]
Working Notes:
ke = `3.60 + 0.05
`30
ke = 0.12 + 0.05 = 0.17
Where,
PD = Preference dividend
RV = Redeemable value of preference shares
NP = Current market price of preference shares
n = Redemption period of preference shares
Now, it is given that PD = 10%, RV = ` 100, NP = ` 80 and n = 10 years
(100 - 80)
10 +
10 10 + 2
Therefore kp = x 100 = ×= 100
13.33
= 13.33%
100+80 90
2
3. Cost of Debt (kd)
Where,
I = Interest Payment
NP = Current market price of debentures
RV = Redemption value of debentures
t = Tax rate applicable to the company
n = Redemption period of debentures
Now it is given that I = 14, t = 30%, RV = ` 100, NP = ` 90 and n = 6 years
Therefore,
(100 - 90)
14 (1 - 0.30) + n
kd = (100 - 90) × 100 = 9.8 + 1.667 × 100 = 12.07%
95
2
4. Cost of Term loans (kt)
kt = r(1-t)
(ii) Statement showing weighted marginal cost of capital schedule for the company, if it raises ` 20 crores
next year, given the following information:
Working Notes:
5. Cost of equity share (ke) (including fresh issue of equity shares)
D1
ke = P + g
0
Solved Case 1
A financial consultant of Hypothetical Ltd. recommends that the firm should estimate its cost of equity capital by
applying the capital asset pricing model rather than the dividend yield plus growth model. He has assembled the
following facts:
(i) Systematic risk of the firm is 1.4.
(ii) 182-days treasury bills currently yield, 8%.
(iii) Expected yield on the market portfolio of assets is 13%.
Determine the cost of equity capital based on the above data.
Solution:
Solved Case 2
The following facts relate to Hypothetical Ltd:
Risk-free interest in the market is 10%.
The firm’s beta coefficient, b, is 1.5.
Determine the cost of equity capital using the capital asset pricing model, assuming an expected return on the
market of 14 % for next year. What would be the ke, if the b (a) rises to 2, (b) falls to 1.
Solution:
When b is 1.50, ke = Rf + b(km – Rf) = 0.10 + 1.5 (0.14 – 0.10) = 16%
(a) ke When b = 2, = 0.10 + 2 (0.14 – 0.10) = 18%.
Solved Case 3
Avon Electricals Ltd wishes to determine the weighted average cost of capital for evaluating capital budgeting
projects. You have been supplied with the following information to calculate the value of k0 for the company:
Solution:
kd = ` 200 (1 – 0.35) + (` 2625 – ` 2450) / 20 ÷ (` 2625 + ` 2450) / 2 = 5.47%.
kp = ` 10 ÷ ( ` 100 + ` 98) / 2 = 10.1%.
ke = (` 11 ÷ ` 110) + 0.05 = 15%.
kr = (`11 ÷ `115) + 0.05 = 14.57%.
Solved Case 4
From the following information, determine the appropriate weighted average cost of capital (WACC), relevant for
evaluating long-term investment projects of the company.
Cost of equity 0.18
After tax cost of long-term debt 0.08
After tax cost of short-term debt 0.09
(` )
Solution:
Determination of weighted average cost of capital
Sources of capital Market value (` ) Specific cost (K) Total costs (MV × K)
Equity 7,50,000 0.18 1,35,000
Long-term debt 3,75,000 0.08 30,000
11,25,000 1,65,000
ko = (` 1,65,000 / 11,25,000) × 100 = 14.7%.
Exercise
A. Theoretical Questions:
� Multiple Choice Questions
10. In case the firm is all-equity financed, the WACC would be equal to:
(a) Cost of Debt
(b) Cost of Equity
(c) Neither (a) nor (b)
(d) Both (a) and (b).
12. In order to calculate Weighted Average Cost of capitals (WACC) weights may be based on:
(a) Market Values
(b) Target Values
(c) Book Values
(d) All of the above.
18. Minimum rate of return that a firm must earn in order to satisfy its investors, is also known as:
(a) Average Return on Investment
(b) Weighted Average Cost of Capital
(c) Net Profit Ratio
(d) Average Cost of borrowing.
19. Cost of capital for equity share capital does not imply that:
(a) Market price is equal to book value of share
(b) Shareholders are ready to subscribe to right issue
(c) Market price is more than issue price
(d) All of the three above.
20. In order to calculate the proportion of equity financing used by the company, the following should be used:
(a) Authorised Share Capital
(b) Equity Share Capital plus Reserves and Surplus
(c) Equity Share Capital plus Preference Share Capital
(d) Equity Share Capital plus Long-term Debt.
23. In order to find out cost of equity capital under CAPM, which of the following is not required:
(a) Beta Factor
(b) Market Rate of Return
(c) Market Price of Equity Share
(d) Risk-free Rate of Interest.
24. Tax-rate is relevant and important for calculation of specific cost of capital of:
(a) Equity Share Capital
(b) Preference Share Capital
(c) Debentures
(d) (a) and (b) both.
27. Cost of equity share capital is more than cost of debt because:
(a) Face value of debentures is more than face value of shares
(b) Equity shares have higher risk than debt
(c) Equity shares are easily saleable
(d) All of the above.
28. Which of the following is not a generally accepted approach for calculation of cost of equity?
(a) CAPM
(b) Dividend Discount Model
(c) Rate of Preference Dividend Plus Risk Model
(d) Price-Earnings Ratio.
29. ___________ is the basic debt instrument which may be issued by a borrowing company for a price which
may be less than, equal to or more than the face value.
(a) A bond
(b) A debenture
(c) A bond or a debenture
(d) A bond and a debenture
32. The term “optimal capital structure” implies that combination of external equity and internal equity at
which ………………..
(a) the overall cost of capital is minimised.
(b) the overall cost of capital is maximised.
(c) the market value of the firm is minimised.
(d) the market value of firm is greater than the overall cost of capital.
33. Net Income Approach to capital structure decision was proposed by …….
(a) J. E. Walter
(b) D. Durand
(c) E. Solomon
(d) M.H. Miller and D. Orr
37. Company X issues 11% bonds of ` 100 for an amount aggregating ` 200,000 at 10% premium, redeemable
at par after 5 years. Corporate tax rate is 35%. The cost of bonds would be:
(a) 4.9%
(b) 5.0%
(c) 5.2%
(d) 6.0%
38. Which of the following is not a generally accepted approach for Calculation of Cost of Equity?
(a) CAPM
(b) Dividend Discount Model
(c) Rate of Pref. Dividend Plus Risk
(d) Price-Earnings Ratio
39. A firm has EBIT of ` 50,000. Market value of debt is ` 80,000 and overall capitalization rate is 20%.
Market value of firm under NOI Approach is:
(a) ` 2,50,000
(b) ` 1,70,000
(c) ` 3,00,0000
(d) ` 1,30,000
41. A project has an equity beta of 1.2 and is going to be financed by 30% debt and 70% equity. Assume debt
beta = 0, Rf = 10% and Rm = 18%. What is the required rate of return?
(a) 8.4%
(b) 18%
(c) 16.72%
(d) 10%
42. Pritam Technologies Limited issued 1,00,000, 14% debentures of `100 each, redeemable after 5 years
at ` 110 each. The commission payable to under writers and brokers is 10%. The after-tax cost of debt,
assuming a tax rate of 45%, will be
(a) 15.1%
(b) 12.54%
(c) 10%
(d) 11.7%
43. A project had an equity beta of 1.2 and was going to be financed by a combination of 30% debt and 70%
equity (assume debt beta = 0). Hence, the required rate of return of the project is (assume Rf = 10% and
Rm =18%)
(a) 16.27%
(b) 17.26%
(c) 16.72%
(d) 12.76%
44. A company has expected Net Operating Income – ` 2,40,000; 10% Debt – ` 7,20,000 and Equity
Capitalisation rate - 20% what is the weighted average cost of capital for the company?
(a) 0.15385
(b) 0.13585
(c) 0.18351
(d) 0.15531
45. The required rate of return on equity is 24% and cost of debt is 12%. The company has a capital structure
mix of 80% of equity and 20% debt. What is the overall rate of return, the company should earn? Assume
no tax.
(a) 21.6%
(b) 14.4%
(c) 18.6%
(d) 17.22%
46. MA Ltd. has EBIT of ` 36 crores. The company has 7% debentures of ` 72 crores. Cost of equity is 12.5%.
Ignore taxes. What is the overall cost of Capital? (Ignore taxes)
(a) 11.26%
(b) 11.20%
(c) 11.50%
(d) 11.28%
47. A project had an equity beta of 1.4 and was going to be financed by a conbination of 25% Debt and 75%
Equity (Assume Debt Beta as zero). Hence, the required rate of return of the project is (Assume Rf, = 12%
and Rm = 18%)
(a) 16.72%
(b) 18.30%
(c) 17.45
(d) 12.00
52. SG Ltd has paid dividend of ` 3 per share of ` 10 each last year and it is expected to grow @ 10% next
year. If the market price of share is ` 60 what will be the Cost of equity ?
(a) 12.00%
(b) 12.50%
(c) 16.50%
(d) 15.50
53. Surya Ltd. has issued 30,000 irredeemable 14% debentures of ` 150 each. The cost of floatation of
debentures is 5% of the total issued amount. The company’s taxation rate is 40%. The cost of debentures
is :
(a) 8.95%
(b) 7.64%
(c) 9.86%
(d) 8.84%
54. Anand Ltd. announced a rights issue of four shares of ` 100 each at a premium of 160% for every five
shares held by the existing shareholders. The market value of the shares at the time of rights issue is ` 395.
The value of right is :
(a) ` 90
(b) ` 80
(c) ` 60
(d) ` 55
55. The value of a share of MN Ltd. after right issue was found to be ` 75/-. The theoretical value of the right
is ` 5. The number of existing shares required for a rights share is 2. The subscription price at which the
shares were issued were :
(a) ` 22.50
(b) ` 40.00
(c) ` 65.00
(d) ` 82.00
56. A share of Sun Ltd. is currently quoted at ` 55. The retained earning per share being 40% is ` 4 per share.
If the investors expect annual growth rate of 10%, what would be the cost of equity of Sun Ltd.?
(a) 20.5%
(b) 21.0%
(c) 22.0%
(d) 23.5%
57. In using debt-equity ratio in capital structure decisions, there is an optimal capital structure where :
(a) The WACC is minimum
(b) The cost of debt is lowest
(c) The cost savings are highest
(d) The marginal tax benefit is equal to marginal cost of financial distress
58. Where the firm has sufficient profits from its existing operations, the loss on the new project will :
(a) Cause overall loss
(b) Reduce the overall taxation liability
(c) Increase WACC
(d) Increase cost of debt
59. Mohammad Steels Ltd. Has issued 30,000 irredeemable 14% debentures of ` 150 each. The cost of
floatation of debentures is 5% of the total issued amount. The company’s taxation rate is 40%. The cost of
debentures is :
(a) 8.95%
(b) 7.64%
(c) 9.86%
(d) 8.84%
60. The current price of a share of VOLTAS LTD. is ` 130. The company is planning to go for rights issue.
The subscription price for one rights share is proposed to be ` 114. If the company targets that exrights
value of a share shall not fall below ` 126, the number of existing shares required for one rights share will
be
(a) 1
(b) 2
(c) 3
(d) None of the above
61. A company has expected Net Operating Income – ` 4,80,000; 10% Debt – ` 14,40,000 and Equity
Capitalisation rate - 20% what is the weighted average cost of capital for the company?
(a) 0.15385
(b) 0.13585
(c) 0.18351
(d) 0.15531
62. Ramya Ltd.’s share beta factor is 1.40. The risk free rate of interest of government securities is 9%. The
expected rate of return on the company equity shares is 16%. The cost of equity capital based on CAPM
is:
(a) 9%
(b) 16%
(c) 18.8%
(d) 15.8%
64. From the following select one factor which is sources of fund.
(a) Payment of dividend
(b) Increase in working capital
(c) Non trading Income
(d) None of the above
66. If the CAPM is used to estimate the cost of equity capital, the expected excess market return is equal to
the:
(a) Return on the stock minus the risk-free rate.
(b) Difference between the return on the market and the risk-free rate.
(c) Beta times the market risk premium.
(d) Beta times the risk-free rate.
Answers:
1 c 2 d 3 a 4 a 5 b 6 c 7 c 8 a
9 b 10 b 11 b 12 d 13 a 14 c 15 c 16 c
17 d 18 b 19 d 20 b 21 b 22 c 23 c 24 c
25 d 26 c 27 b 28 c 29 c 30 c 31 b 32 a
33 d 34 b 35 b 36 c 37 a 38 c 39 b 40 c
41 c 42 d 43 c 44 a 45 a 46 a 47 b 48 d
49 d 50 c 51 c 52 d 53 d 54 c 55 c 56 c
57 d 58 b 59 d 60 c 61 a 62 c 63 b 64 c
65 d 66 b 67 c
10. The higher is the corporate tax rate, the higher is the cost of debt.
11. Beta is a measure of systematic risk.
12. Cost of debt is higher than cost of equity.
13. Cost of preference share capital is higher than cost of debt.
14. Cost of preference share capital is higher than cost of equity share capital.
15. Among all long-term sources of finance, equity capital carries maximum cost.
16. The cost of capital is the required rate of return to certain the value of the firm.
17. Different sources of funds have a specific cost of capital related to that source only.
18. Cost of capital does not comprise any risk premium.
19. Cost of capital is basic data for NPV technique.
20. Risk free interest rate and cost of capital are same things.
21. Different sources have same cost of capital.
22. Tax liability of the firm is relevant for cost of capital of all the sources of funds.
23. Cost of debt and Cost of Preference share capital, both, require tax adjustment.
24. Every source of fund has an explicit cost of capital.
25. WACC is the overall cost of capital of the firm.
26. Cost of debt is the same as the rate of interest.
27. Cost of Preference share capital is determined by the rate of fixed dividend.
28. Cost of Equity share capital depends upon the market price of the share.
29. Cost of existing share capital and fresh issue of capital are same.
30. Retained earnings have implicit cost only.
31. WACC is always calculated with reference to book value of different sources of funds.
32. Book value and Market Value weights are always different.
33. Retained earnings have no market value, so these are not included in WACC (based on market value).
34. Long-term sources of finance are used for a period of 5 to 10 years.
35. Medium term sources of finance are needed for a period of 1 to 5 years.
36. The preference shares carry limited voting right though they are a part of the capital.
37. Lease is a contract between the owner of asset and the user of the asset.
38. As compared to operating lease, a financial lease is for a shorter period of time.
39. Short-term financing means financing for a period of less than 1 year.
40. Factoring and discounting are same.
41. ADR means any instrument in the form of a depository receipt or certificate created by the RBI.
42. Crowdfunding is a great alternative way to fund a venture.
The Institute of Cost Accountants of India 291
Financial Management and Business Data Analytics
43. Crowdfunding is a collaborative funding model that lets you collect small contributions from many
individuals.
44. The cost of capital is an integral part of investment decisions as it is used to measure the worth of
investment proposal.
Answers:
1 F 2 F 3 F
4 T 5 T 6 F
7 T 8 F 9 F
10 F 11 T 12 F
13 T 14 F 15 T
16 T 17 T 18 F
19 T 20 F 21 F
22 F 23 F 24 F
25 T 26 F 27 T
28 T 29 F 30 T
31 F 32 F 33 F
34 T 35 T 36 T
37 T 38 F 39 T
40 F 41 F 42 T
43 T 44 T
Answer:
1 less 2 negotiable instrument 3 may or may not
4 Department for 5 Start-up India Seed 6 Crowdfunding
Promotion of Industry Fund Scheme
and Internal Trade
7 Financing 8 Commercial Paper (CP) 9 Retained Earnings
1. Discuss the different sources of finance available to management, both internal and external.
3. Discuss how the cost of capital enters into the process of evaluating capital budgeting proposals?
Particularly, how is it related to the various discounted cash flow techniques for determining a project’s
acceptability?
4. What is financial risk? Is it necessary to assume that firm’s financial structure remains unchanged when
evaluating the firm’s cost of capital? Why is this assumption impractical?
5. Explain why:
(a) Debt is usually considered the cheapest source of financing available to the firm.
(b) The cost of preference shares is less than the cost of equity.
(c) The cost of retained earnings is less than the cost of new equity.
(e) The cost of capital is dependent only on the cost of long-term funds.
6. Explain the problems faced in determining the cost of capital. How is the cost of capital relevant in
capital budgeting decisions?
7. Examine critically the different approaches to the calculation of cost of equity capital.
8. Explain the CAPM approach for computing the cost of equity. Discuss the merits and demerits of the
approach.
9. The determination of any explicit cost of capital requires two things: (i) the net proceeds the firm will
receive from the particular capital source and (ii) the expected future payments the firm will make to the
investors. In spite of the similarity of estimation problems, it is recognised that the cost of equity (both
internal and external) is the most difficult cost to estimate. Briefly explain why this is so.
10. State briefly the assumptions on which the Gordon (valuation) Model for the cost of equity is based.
What does each component of the equation represent?
11. Discuss the approach to determine the cost of retained earnings. Also explain the rationale behind treating
retained earnings as a fully subscribed issue of equity shares.
12. Other things being equal, explain how the following events would affect the company’s weighted average
cost of capital:
(b) The company has started making substantial new investments in assets that are considerably riskier
than the company’s presently owned assets.
(c) The company begins to make use of substantial amounts of debt to finance its new projects.
13. What is the weighted average cost of capital? Examine the rationale behind the use of weighted average
cost of capital.
14. The weighted average cost of capital (k0) may be determined using ‘book’ or ‘market’ weights. Compare
the pros and cons of using market value weights rather than book value weights in calculating the value
of k0.
15. Compare the advantages and disadvantages of using marginal as opposed to historical weights for
calculating the weighted average cost of capital (k0). Which of the weights are more consistent with the
company’s goal of wealth maximization?
B. Numerical Questions:
1. ABC company sold ` 1,000, 6 % debentures carrying no maturity date to the public a decade earlier.
Interest rates since have risen, so that debentures of the quality represented by this company are now
selling at 9 % yield basis.
(a) Determine the current indicated market price of the debentures. Would you buy the debentures for
` 700? Explain your answer.
(b) Assuming that debentures of the company are selling at ` 850, and if the debentures have 8 years to
run to maturity, compute the approximate effective yield an investor would earn on his investment?
2. The shares of a textile company are selling at ` 20 per share. The firm had paid ` 2 per share dividend last
year. The estimated growth of the company is approximately 5 % per year.
(b) Determine the estimated market price of the equity shares if the anticipated growth rate of the firm (i)
rises to 8 % (ii) falls to 3 %.
(c) Determine the market price of the company assuming a growth rate of 20 %. Are you satisfied with
your calculations?
3. Assuming a corporate tax rate of 35 %, compute the after-tax cost of the capital in the following situations:
(a) A perpetual 15 % debentures of ` 1,000, sold at the premium of 10 % with no flotation costs.
(b) A ten year 14 % debenture of ` 2,000, redeemable at par, with 5 % flotation costs.
(c) A ten year 14 % preference share of ` 100, redeemable at premium of 5 %, with 5 % flotation costs.
(d) An equity share selling at ` 50 and paying a dividend of ` 6 per share, which is expected to be
continued indefinitely.
(e) The same equity share (that is, described in situation (d), if dividends are expected to grow at the rate
of 5 %.
(f) An equity share, selling at ` 120 per share, of a company that engages only in equity financing. The
earning per share is ` 20 of which 50 % is paid in dividends. The shareholders expect the company to
earn a constant after-tax rate of 10 % on its investment of retained earnings.
4. From the following information supplied to you, determine the appropriate weighted average cost of
capital, relevant for evaluating long-term investment projects of the company:
Cost of equity 12 %
Answers:
Unsolved Case(s)
1. R. Ltd. manufactures blankets of high quality. Company’s history has been satisfactory, but for the past
sometime its cash flow position was not good. That is why the company has not been able to pay sufficient
dividend to its equity shareholders. The finance manager tried to find out the causes of poor financial situation
of the company and observed that the control of the company was in the hands of several persons who are
unable to take any concrete decision.
To come out of this financial crisis, the finance manager has been deliberating on the source of finance that
needs to be tapped to arrange funds. He wants to make use of such a source as does not prove to be a fixed
burden on the company. He has also kept in mind that company has got its premises on rent and the rent in
exorbitant. Similarly, it has to bear the burden of fixed salaries. He is also worried about the fact that in future
control of the company should not be in the hands of too many persons.
(a) Identify the two sources of finance discussed in the above case.
(b) Identify and explain the advantages of both source by quoting lines from the above case.
2. Shyam Steel Ltd. is a large and creditworthy company that manufacture steel for the Indian market. It now
wants to cater the Asian market and decides to invest in new Hi-tech machines. Since the investment is large,
it requires Long-term finance. It decides to raise funds by issuing equity shares. The issue of equality shares
involves huge floatation cost. To meet the expenses of floatation cost, the company decides to tap the money
market.
(a) Name and explain the money market instrument that company can use for the above purpose.
(b) What is the duration for which the company can get funds through this investment?
(c) State any other purpose for which this instrument can be used.
3. From the given data, calculate the cost of equity shares of X Ltd.
Current market price of the share is ` 120.
Floatation cost per share is ` 5.
Dividend paid on outstanding shares for the past three years is as shown in following Table:
References:
● Bodie, Zvi et al, Investments, Tata McGraw-Hill Publishing Company Limited New Delhi: 2002.
● Chambers, Donald R., and Nelson J. Lacey. “Corporate Ethics and Shareholder Wealth Maximization.”
Financial Practice and Education 6 (Spring–Summer 1996), 93– 96.
● Chandra Prasanna, Financial Management, Theory and Practice, McGraw Hill., 2019.
● Fama, Eugene F; French, Kenneth R (Summer 2004). The Capital Asset Pricing Model: Theory and Evidence.
Journal of Economic Perspectives. 18 (3): 25–46.
● Fischer Donald E, and Jordon Ronald J., Security Analysis and Portfolio Management, PHI.
● Francis, Jack Clark, Investments: Analysis and Management, McGraw-Hill, Inc. New York: 1991.
● H. Markowitz, Portfolio Selection: Efficient Diversification of Investments, John Wiley & Sons, 1959.
● Khan, M Y and P K Jain, Financial Management- Text, Problems and Cases, McGraw-Hill Publishing Co.,
New Delhi, 2019.
● Ross, Stephen. A, “The Arbitrage Theory of Capital Asset Pricing,” Journal of Economic Theory, Vol. 13,
(December, 1976).
● Solomon, E, Theory of Financial Management, Columbia University Press (New York), 1969.
● Van Horne James C. and Wachowicz John M., Jr. Fundamentals of Financial Management, Prentice Hall,
13th Edition, 2008.
S
uccess of finance mainly depends on proper decision making in respect of investment of funds. In general
decision-making means selecting the best alternatives among all available alternatives based on analysing
the positive sides and negative sides of each alternative. In financial management, capital budgeting is
decision making technique. Capital budgeting decision may be defined as firm’s decisions to invest its
current funds most efficiently in long term activities in anticipation of an expected flow of future benefits over a
series of year.
On behalf of financial management, an effective decision should be taken on how and where the available fund be
invested. Successful operation of any business depends upon the investment of resources in such a way as to bring
in benefits or best possible returns from any investment. An investment can be simply defined as an expenditure
in cash or its equivalent during one or more time periods in anticipation of enjoying a net inflow of cash or its
equivalent in some future time period or periods. An appraisal of investment proposals is necessary to ensure that
the investment of resources will bring in desired benefits in future. If the financial resources were in abundance,
it would be possible to accept several investment proposals which satisfy the norms of approval or acceptability.
Since resources are limited, a choice has to be made among the various investment proposals by evaluating their
comparative merit. It is apparent that some techniques should be followed for making appraisal of investment
proposals. Capital Budgeting is one of the appraising techniques of investment decisions. Capital budgeting is
defined as the firm’s decision to invest its current funds most efficiently in long term activities in anticipation of
an expected flow of future benefits over a series of years. It should be remembered that the investment proposal
is common both for fixed assets and current assets. Mainly, the firm’s capital budgeting decisions will include
addition, disposition, modification and replacement of fixed assets.
Some important definitions of capital budgeting are:
Charles. T. Horngren defined capital budgeting as ‘long-term planning for making and financing proposed capital
out lay.’
According to Keller and Ferrara, ‘capital Budgeting represents the plans for the appropriation and expenditure
for fixed asset during the budget period.’
Robert N. Anthony defined as ‘capital budget is essentially a list of what management believes to be worthwhile
projects for the acquisition of new capital assets together with the estimated cost of each product.’
of capital budgeting is employed to evaluate expenditure decisions which involve current outlays but are likely to
produce benefits over a period of time longer than one year. These benefits may be either in the form of increased
revenues or reduced costs. Capital expenditure management, therefore, includes addition, disposition, modification
and replacement of fixed assets. From the preceding discussion may be deduced the following basic features of
capital budgeting: (i) potentially large anticipated benefits; (ii) a relatively high degree of risk; and (iii) a relatively
long time period between the initial outlay and the anticipated returns.
Research and
Bye or Lease
Development
(d) Buy or Lease: This is a most important decision area in financial management whether the firm acquire the
desired equipment and building on lease or buy it. If the asset is acquired on lease, there have to be made a
series of annual or monthly rental payments. If the asset is purchased, there will be a large initial commitment
of funds, but not further payments. The decision–making area is which course of action will be better to
follow? The costs and benefits of the two alternative methods should be matched and compared to arrive at a
conclusion.
(e) Research and Development: The existing production and operations can be improved by the application
of new and more sophisticated production and operations management techniques. New technology can
be borrowed or developed in the laboratories. There is a greater need of funds for continuous research and
development of new technology for future benefits or returns from such investments.
(c) Selection of the Project: After evaluation of the project, the project with highest return should be selected.
There is no hard and fast rule set for the purpose of selecting a project from many alternative projects. Normally
the projects are screened at various levels. However, the final selection of the project vests with the top-level
management.
(d) Execution of Project: After selection of a project, the next step in capital budgeting process is to implement
the project. Thus, the funds are appropriated for capital expenditures. The funds are spent in accordance with
appropriations made in the capital budget funds for the purpose of project execution should be spent only after
seeking format permission for the controller. The follow–up comparison of actual performance with original
estimates ensures better control.
Thus, the top management should follow the above procedure before taking anycapital expenditure decision.
C
apital budgeting is concerned with investment decisions which yield return over a period of time in
future. As we know, capital budgeting decision mainly focuses on cash flows rather than profits. Capital
budgeting involves identifying the cash in flows and cash out flows rather than accounting revenues and
expenses flowing from the investment. So, capital budgeting involves in determination of cash flows.
Cash flows are the most important factor in a capital investment decision. Investment decision has to take place at
present, not in future and therefore capital expenditure is a cash-flow concept, rather than a profit-based concept.
That’s why computation of cash flow decides the success or failure of any investment decision.
The cash flows associated with a proposal may be classified into: (i) Initial Cash Flow, (ii) Subsequent Cash Flow
and (iii) Terminal Cash Flow. These are discussed below:
(i) Initial Cash Flow:
Any long-term investment decision will involve large amount of initial cash outlay. It reflects the cash spent for
acquiring the asset, known as initial cash outflow. For estimating the initial cash outflow, the following aspects are
taken into consideration.
(a) The cost of the asset, installation cost, transportation cost and any other incidental cost, i.e., all the costs to be
incurred for the asset in order to bring it to workable condition, are to be taken into consideration.
(b) Sunk cost which has already been incurred or committed to be incurred, hence, which has no effect on the
present or future decision, will be ignored as it is irrelevant cost for the decision.
c) For investment decisions relating to replacement of an existing asset usually involve salvage value which is
considered as cash inflow and subtracted from the cash outflow relating to the installation of the new asset. If
the existing asset is the only asset in the concerned block of asset, the incidence of income tax on gain or loss
on sale of the existing asset is also to be considered, as the block of asset will cease to exist due to sale of the
asset. The tax impact on gain on sale of asset represent burden of tax, hence cash outflow and tax impact on
loss on sale represent savings of tax, hence, cash inflow. Therefore, tax on gain on sale of asset has to be added
and tax on loss on sale has to be subtracted in order to determine initial cash outflow. However, if there are
other assets in the same block, the question of gain or loss on sale of asset will not arise, only the sale proceed
from sale of old asset will be deducted from the total initial cash outflow.
(d) Change in working capital requirement due to the new investment decision requires to be considered. If
additional working capital is required, it will increase the initial cash outflow. On the other hand, in a replacement
situation, if requirement of working capital is decreased, such decrease in working capital requirement will
reduce the total initial cash outflow.
Illustration 1
From the following information calculate Net Cash Inflow after Taxes.
Solution:
Calculation of Net Cash Inflow after Taxes
Particulars Amount (` )
EBIT 2,00,000
Less: Tax (30%) 60,000
1,40,000
Depreciation 1,00,000
Net Cash Inflow after Taxes 2,40,000
Alternatively,
T
he foremost requirement for evaluation of any capital investment proposal is to estimate the future
benefits accruing from the investment proposal. Theoretically, two alternative criteria are available to
quantify the benefits: (i) accounting profit, and (ii) cash flows. Cash flow and profit are both important
financial measures in any business organisation, but cash flow and profit are not the same things. It is
critical to understand the difference between them to make key decisions regarding a business’s performance and
financial health.
Cash flow refers to the net balance of cash moving into and out of a business at a specific point in time. Cash flow
can be positive or negative. Positive cash flow indicates that a company has more money moving into it than out of
it. Negative cash flow indicates that a company has more money moving out of it than into it. On the other hand,
profit is typically defined as the balance that remains when all of a business’s operating expenses are subtracted
from its revenues. Accounting profit is to be adjusted for non-cash expenditures to determine the actual cash inflow.
The cash flow approach of measuring future benefits of a project is superior to the accounting approach as cash
flows are theoretically better measures of the net economic benefits of costs associated with a proposed project.
However, changes in profits do not necessarily mean changes in cash flows. It is not difficult to find examples of
firms in practice that experience cash shortages in spite of increasing profits. Cash flow and profit are not same in
many reasons. The important reasons are:
(i) Profit, as measured is based on accrual concept— revenue (sales) is recognized when it is earned, rather than
when cash is received, and expense is recognized when it is incurred rather than when cash is paid. In other
words, profit includes cash revenues as well as receivables and excludes cash expenses as well as payable.
(ii) For computing profit, expenditures are arbitrarily divided into revenue and capital expenditures. Revenue
expenditures are entirely charged to profits while capital expenditures are not. Capital expenditures are
capitalized as assets (investments), and depreciated over their economic life. Only annual depreciation is
charged to profit. Further, depreciation (DEP) is an accounting entry and does not involve any cash flow. Thus,
the measurement of profit excludes some cash flows such as capital expenditures and includes some non-cash
items such as depreciation.
We can explain differences between profit and cash flow.
Assume that a firm is entirely equity-financed, and it receives its revenues (REV) in cash and pays its expenses
(EXP) and capital expenditures (CAPEX) also in cash. Further, assume that taxes do not exist. Under these
circumstances, profit can be expressed in the following equation:
Profit = Revenues − Expenses – Depreciation
Profit = REV − EXP − DEP.................................................................................................................................... (1)
T
he capital budgeting appraisal methods or techniques for evaluation of investment proposals will help
the company to decide the desirability of an investment proposal, depending upon their relative income
generating capacity and rank them in order if their desirability. These methods provide the company a
set of normal method should enable to measure the real worth of the investment proposal. Appraisal of
investment proposals are based on objective, quantified and economic costs and benefits.
(b) When cash flows are not uniform: When the project’s cash inflows are not uniform, but vary from year to
year payback period is calculated by the process of cumulating cash inflows till the time when cumulative cash
flows become equal to the original investment outlay.
Advantages: The following are the advantages of the payback period method:
(i) (Easy to calculate: It is one of the easiest methods of evaluating the investment projects. It is simple to
understand and easy to compute.
(ii) Knowledge: The knowledge of payback period is useful in decision-making, the shorter the period better the
project.
(iii) Protection from loss due to obsolescence: This method is very suitable to such industries where mechanical
and technical changes are routine practice and hence, shorter payback period practice avoids such losses.
(iv) Easily availability of information: It can be computed on the basis of accounting information, what is
available from the books.
Disadvantages: However, the payback period method has certain disadvantages and limitations:
(i) Failure in taking cash flows after payback period: This method is not taking into account the cash flows
received by the company after the payback period.
(ii) Not considering the time value of money: It does not take into account the time value of money.
(iii) Non-considering of interest factor: It does not take into account the interest factor involved in the capital
outlay.
(iv) Maximisation of market value not possible: It is not consistent with the objective of maximizing the market
value of share.
(v) Failure in taking magnitude and timing of cash inflows: It fails to consider the pattern of cash inflows i.e.,
the magnitude and timing of cash inflows.
Accept-Reject Decision:
The payback period can be used as an accept or reject criterion as well as a method of ranking projects. The
payback period is the number of years to recover the investment made in a project. If the payback period calculated
for a project is less than the maximum payback period set-up by the company, it can be accepted. As a ranking
method it gives the highest rank to a project which has the lowest payback period, and the lowest rank to a project
with the highest payback period. Whenever a company faces the problem of choosing among two or more mutually
exclusive projects, it can select a project on the basis of payback period, which has shorter period than the other
projects.
With equal and unequal cash flows
Illustration 2
Pioneer Ltd. is considering two mutually-exclusive projects. Both require an initial cash outlay of ` 10,000 each
for machinery and have a life of 5 years. The company’s required rate of return is 10% and it pays tax at 50%. The
projects will be depreciated on a straight-line basis. The net cash flows (before taxes) expected to be generated by
the projects and the present value (PV) factor (at 10%) are as follows:
(` in ‘000)
Solution:
(` in ‘000)
Payback period would be the time when initial investment is recovered in cash. The investment is ` 10,000.
Payback period would be between 3 and 4 years.
` 10,000 - ` 9,000
Payback Period =3 +
` 9,000
= 3.11 years
(` )
Payback Periods of Project - 2
2020 2021 2022 2023 2024
Year
(Year 1) (Year 2) (Year 3) (Year 4) (Year 5)
Cash Flows 6,000 3,000 2,000 5,000 5,000
Less: Depreciation 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000 2,000
Earnings before Tax (EBT) 4,000 1,000 0 3,000 3,000
Less: Tax at (50%) 2,000 500 0 1,500 1,500
Net Income 2,000 500 0 1,500 1,500
Cash flows after tax 4,000 2,500 2,000 3,500 3,500
Cumulative cash flows 4,000 6,500 8,500 12,000 15,500
A project with an initial investment of ` 50 Lakh and life of 10 years, generates CFAT of ` 10 Lakh per annum.
Calculate Payback Reciprocal of the project.
Solution:
` 10 lakh
Payback Reciprocal = = 20%
` 50 lakh
3. Payback Profitability
As the profitability beyond the Payback Period is not taken into consideration in Payback Period method, the
projects with higher Payback period are rejected though such projects with longer life may generate higher
benefits after recovering its initial investment. In Payback Profitability method, the profitability beyond the
payback period is considered and projects generating higher benefits after the recovery of initial investment are
considered for selection.
Payback Profitability = Net Cash Inflow after Taxes after recovering the Initial Investment, i.e., Total Net
Cash Inflow after Taxes – Initial Investment
4. Accounting or Average Rate of Return (ARR) Method
This technique uses the accounting information revealed by the financial statements to measure the profitability
of an investment proposal. It can be determined by dividing the average income after taxes by the average
investment. According to Solomon, Accounting Rate of Return can be calculated as the ratio of average net
income to the initial investment.
On the basis of this method, the company can select all those projects whose ARR is higher than the minimum
rate established by the company. It can reject the projects with an ARR lower than the expected rate of return.
This method also helps the management to rank the proposal on the basis of ARR.
(ii) It can be readily computed with the help of the available accounting data;
(iii) It uses the entire stream of earnings to calculate the ARR.
Disadvantages: This method has the following limitations:
(i) It is not based on cash flows generated by a project;
(ii) This method does not consider the objective of wealth maximization;
(iii) It ignores the length of the project’s useful life;
(iv) If does not take into account the fact that the profile can be re-invested; and
(v) It ignores the time value of money.
Accept-Reject Decision
With the help of the ARR, the financial decision maker can decide whether to accept or reject the investment
proposal. As an accept-reject criterion, the actual ARR would be compared with a pre-determined or a
minimum required rate of return or cut-off rate. A project would qualify to be accepted if the actual ARR is
higher than the minimum desired ARR. Otherwise, it is liable to be rejected. Alternatively, the ranking method
can be used to select or reject proposals. Thus, the alternative proposals under consideration may be arranged
in the descending order of magnitude, starting with the proposal with the highest ARR and ending with the
proposal having the lowest ARR. Obviously, projects having higher ARR would be preferred to projects with
lower ARR.
Illustration 4
Determine the average rate of return from the following data of two machines, A and B.
(` in “000)
Solution:
ARR = (Average income/Average investment) x 100
Average income of Machines A and B = (` 36,875/5)
=
` 7,375
Average investment = Salvage value + [1/2 (Cost of machine – Salvage value)]
= ` 3,000 + [1/2 (` 56,125 – ` 3,000)]
= ` 29,562.50
ARR (for machines A and B) = (` 7,375/` 29563.50) × 100
= 24.9 %
Present Value:
It is very important to have idea about present value for applying discounted cash flows techniques. The concept
of present value has already been discussed in Time Value of Money chapter in detail. Present value states that an
amount of money today is worth more than the same amount in the future. In other words, present value shows
that money received in the future is not worth as much as an equal amount received today. The present value or
the discounted cash flow procedure recognizes that cashflow streams at different time periods differ in value and
can be compared only when they are expressed in terms of a common denominator, that is, present values. It, thus,
takes into account the time value of money.
The value of a firm depends upon the net cash inflows generated by the firm assets and also on future returns. The
amount of cash inflows and risk associated with the uncertainty of future returns forms the basis of valuation. To
get the present value, cash inflows are to be discounted at the required rate of return i.e., minimum rate expected
by the investor to account for their timing and risk. The cash inflows and outflows of an investment decision are to
be compared at zero time period or at the same value by discounting them at required rate of return. The following
formula can be used to discount the future inflows of a project to compare with its cash outflows.
The present value (PV) formula is PV=FV/(1+i)n, where you divide the future value (FV) by a factor of 1 + i for
each period between present and future dates. Here, i = PVIF/Rate of Discount and n = No. of Periods.
Where,
C = Annual Cash inflows
Cn = Cash inflow in the year n
k = Cost of Capital
I = Initial Investment
Or
Where,
Ct = Net cash inflow – outflows during a single period t.
Accept-Reject Decision:
If the NPV is positive or at least equal to zero, the project can be accepted. If it is negative, the proposal can be
rejected. Among the various alternatives, the project which gives the highest positive NPV should be selected.
NPV is positive = A positive NPV indicates that the projected earnings generated by a project or investment.
Cash inflows are generated at a rate higher than the minimum required by the firm.
NPV is zero = Cash inflows are generated at a rate equal to the minimum required.
NPV is negative = An investment with a negative NPV will result in a net loss. Cash inflows are generated at a rate
lower than the minimum required by the firm.
The market value per share will increase if the project with positive NPV is selected.
Illustration 5
A project requires an initial investment of ` 2,25,000 and is expected to generate the following net cash inflows:
Year 1: ` 95,000; Year 2: ` 80,000; Year 3: ` 60,000; Year 4: ` 55,000. Compute net present value of the project
if the minimum desired rate of return is 12%.
Solution:
Computation of PVECF (` )
Cash Inflows
Period PVIF @ 12% Present Value (` )
Amount (` )
Year 1 95,000 0.893 84,835
Year 2 80,000 0.797 63,760
Year 3 60,000 0.712 42,720
Year 4 55,000 0.636 34,980
PVECF (Total) 2,26,295
Illustration 6
Parrot Ltd. is the manufacturer of a low-end consumer durable N. In order to modernize the manufacturing facility,
Parrot Ltd. wants to buy a new machinery costing ` 10,00,000 at cash price. The annual cash flow before tax over
the entire life span of the company is ` 3,00,000 p.a. The marginal rate of tax is 30% and cost of capital is 10% p.a.
The scrap value at the end of the useful life of the machinery is negligible. The company is currently following a
straight-line method of charging depreciation on machineries. Do you think the project is financially viable?
The company has an alternative to charge accelerated depreciation @ 30% of the depreciable amount each for the
first three years and @ 10% for the fourth year. Does it change your suggestion?
Solution:
Computation of NPV (Under Straight Line Method of Depreciation) (` )
(5)=
(1) (2) (3) (4)=(2) – (3) (6)=(4)-(5)+(3) (7) (8)=(6)×(7)
(4)×30%
1 3,00,000 2,00,000 1,00,000 40,000 2,60,000 0.909 2,36,340
(10,00,000/5)
2 3,00,000 2,00,000 1,00,000 40,000 2,60,000 0.826 2,14,760
3 3,00,000 2,00,000 1,00,000 40,000 2,60,000 0.751
1,95,260
4 3,00,000 2,00,000 1,00,000 40,000 2,60,000 0.683 1,77,580
5 3,00,000 2,00,000 1,00,000 40,000 2,60,000 0.621 1,61,460
Total PV* 9,85,400
Less. Initial investment 10,00,000
NPV (14,600)
Note: * Alternatively, Total PV = CFAT p.a.× PVIFA (10%, 5 Years) = ` 2,60,000 × 3.79 = ` 9,85,400.
Since the NPV is negative, the decision of buying the machine is not viable.
Since the NPV is positive, the decision of buying the machine is viable.
Accept-Reject Decision:
If the Profitability Index (PI) is greater than or equal to one, the project should be accepted otherwise rejected.
Specifically, if the PI is greater than 1, the project generates value and the company may want to proceed with the
project. If the PI is less than 1, the project destroys value and the company should not proceed with the project. If
the PI is equal to 1, the project breaks even and the company is indifferent between proceeding or not proceeding
with the project.
So, the higher the profitability index, the more attractive the investment.
Illustration 7
A project requires an initial investment of ` 225,000 and is expected to generate the following net cash inflows:
Year 1: ` 95,000; Year 2: ` 80,000; Year 3: ` 60,000; Year 4: ` 55,000. Compute profitability index of the project
if the appropriate discount rate for this project is 12%.
Solution:
Cash Inflows
Period PVIF @ 12% Present Value (` )
Amount (` )
Year 1 95,000 0.893 84,835
Year 2 80,000 0.797 63,760
Year 3 60,000 0.712 42,720
Year 4 55,000 0.636 34,980
(PVECF) 2,26,295
Where,
PVECF = Present value of the expected cash inflows
PVICF = Present value of invested cash outflows
or, = (` 2,26,295 ÷ ` 2,25,000)
= 1.00058
The project seems attractive because its profitability index is greater than 1.
Where,
C = Initial Capital outlay
A1 , A2 , A3 etc. = Expected future cash inflows at the end of year 1, 2, 3 and so on.
r = Internal Rate of Return
n = Number of years of project
Where,
i = Discount rate
n = No. of periods
In the above equation ‘r’ is to be solved in order to find out IRR.
Computation of IRR
The IRR is to be determined by trial-and-error method. The following steps can be used for its computation.
(i) Compute the present value of the cash flows from an investment, by using arbitrary by selected interest rate.
(ii) Then compare the present value so obtained with capital outlay.
(iii) If the present value is higher than the cost, then the present value of inflows is to be determined by using
higher rate.
(iv) This procedure is to be continued until the present value of the inflows from the investment are approximately
equal to its outflow.
(v) The interest rate that brings about equality is the internal rate of return.
The rate at which the cost of investment and the present value of future cash flows match will be considered as
the ideal rate of return. A project that can achieve this is a profitable project. In other words, at this rate the cash
outflows and the present value of inflows are equal, making the project attractive.
Remember, the internal rate of return is using the interpolation technique to calculate it and it is very important to
understand this concept so that you can get a better understanding of how IRR works. In order to find out the exact
IRR between two near rates, the following formula is to be used.
P1 - C0
IRR = L + × D
P1 - P2
Illustration 8
Calculate IRR by using interpolation technique when initial investment is ` 56,000.
10% ` 60,000
11% ` 50,000
Solution:
10% ` 60,000
IRR = ? ` 56,000
11% ` 50,000
P1 - C0
IRR = L + × D
P1 - P2
Where, L = Lower rate of interest = 10%
P1 = Present value at lower rate of interest = ` 60,000
P2 = Present value at higher rate of interest = ` 50,000
C0 = Cash outlay or initial investment = ` 56,000
D = Difference in rate of interest = 11% - 10% = 1%
60000 - 56000
= 10 + × 1
60000 - 50000
= 10.4%
Accept-Reject Decision:
If the internal rate of return exceeds the required rate of return, then the project will be accepted. If the project’s
IRR is less than the required rate of return, it should be rejected. In case of ranking the proposals the technique of
IRR is significantly used. The projects with highest rate of return will be ranked as first compared to the lowest
rate of return projects.
‘Payback Period’ and ‘Accounting Rate of Return’, all money units are given the same weight which is
unrealistic. Thus, the IRR is more realistic method of project valuation. This method improves the quality of
estimates reducing the uncertainty to minimum.
(v) Elimination of pre-determined discount rate: Unlike the NPV method, the IRR method eliminates the use
of the required rate of return which is usually a pre-determined rate of cost of capital for discounting the cash
flow consistent with the cost of capital. Therefore, the IRR is more reliable measure of the profitability of the
investment proposals.
Limitation: The following are the limitations of the IRR:
(i) It is very difficult to understand and use
(ii) It involves a very complicated computational work
(iii) It may not give unique answer in all situations.
(iv) The assumption of re-investment of cash flows may not be possible in practice.
(v) In evaluating the mutually exclusive proposals, this method fails to select the most profitable project which is
consistent with the objective of maximization of shareholders wealthy.
Both NPV and IRR are sound analytical tools of capital budgeting.Net present value (NPV) is the difference
between the present value of cash inflows and the present value of cash outflows over a period of time. By contrast,
the internal rate of return (IRR) is a calculation used to estimate the profitability of potential investments.
Similarities:
(i) NPV and IRR both are two discounted cash flow methods used for evaluating investments or capital projects.
(ii) Both recognize the time value of money.
(iii) Both take into account the cash flows over the entire life of the project.
(iv) Both are consistent with the objective of maximizing the wealth of shareholders.
(v) Both are difficult to calculate.
(vi) Both techniques may often give contradictory result in the case of alternative proposals which are mutually
exclusive.
NPV
Positive
IRR
0
Cost Capital %
Negative
Recommendations -
The NPV method is generally considered to be superior theoretically because:
(i) It is simple to calculate as compared to IRR.
(ii) It does not suffer from the limitation of multiple rates.
(iii) NPV assumes that intermediate cash flows are reinvested at firm’s cost of capital. The reinvestment assumption
of NPV is more realistic than IRR method.
But IRR method is favoured by some analysts because:
(i) It is easier to visualize and to interpret as compared to NPV.
(ii) Even in the absence of cost of capital, IRR gives an idea of project’s profitability. Note - Unless the cost of
capital is known, NPV cannot be used.
(iii) IRR method is preferable to NPV in the evaluation of risky projects.
Total Investment
DPBP =
Discounted annual cash inflows
[When cash flows are uniform]
When the project’s cash inflows are not uniform, that means vary from year to year, payback period is
calculated by the process of cumulating cash inflows till the time when cumulative cash flows become equal
to the original investment outlay. If necessary, we have to use interpolation technique to find out the fraction
of payback period.
Cumulative cash flow in year before recovery
DPBP = Year before the discounted pay back period occurs +
Discounted cash flow in year after recovery
[When cash flows are not uniform]
Accept-Reject Decision:
The shorter a discounted payback period is means the sooner a project or investment will generate cash flows to
cover the initial cost. A general rule to consider when using the discounted payback period is to accept projects that
have a payback period that is shorter than the target timeframe. So, out of two projects, selection should be based
on the period of discounting payback period (lesser payback period should be preferred.)
The shorter the discounted payback period, the quicker the project generates cash inflows and breaks even.
While comparing two mutually exclusive projects, the one with the shorter discounted payback period should
be accepted.
Advantages: Following are the advantages of discounted payback period:
(i) The discounted payback period is used as part of capital budgeting to determine which projects to take on.
(ii) More accurate than the standard payback period calculation, the discounted payback period factors in the
time value of money.
(iii) The discounted payback period formula shows how long it will take to recoup an investment based on
observing the present value of the project’s projected cash flows.
(iv) The shorter a discounted payback period is, means the sooner a project or investment will generate cash flows
to cover the initial cost.
Illustration 9
Assume a business that is considering a given project. Below are some selected data from the discounted cash flow
model created by the company’s financial analysts:
A project requires an initial investment of ` 1,91,315 and is expected to generate the following net cash inflows:
Year 1: ` 95,000; Year 2: ` 80,000; Year 3: ` 60,000; Year 4: ` 55,000. Compute discounted payback period of the
project if the appropriate discount rate for this project is 12%.
Solution:
We can calculate the discounted payback period as follows:
Computation of DPBP
1
MIRR = (Future value of positive cash flows / present value of negative cash flows) – 1.
n
Advantages:
(i) The standard internal rate of return calculation may overstate the potential future value of a project.
(ii) MIRR can distort the cost of reinvested growth from stage to stage in a project.
(iii) MIRR allows for adjusting the assumed rate of reinvested growth for different stages of a project.
Disadvantages:
The disadvantage of MIRR is that it asks for two additional decisions, i.e., determination of financing rate and cost
of capital.
Illustration 10
M Ltd. for a construction company and asked you to calculate the MIRR for two mutually exclusive projects to
determine which project should be selected.
Project X has a total life of 3 years with a cost of capital 12% and a financing cost 14%.
Project Y has a total life of 3 years with a cost of capital 15% and a financing cost 18%.
The expected cash flows of the projects are in the table below: (` )
Solution:
M Ltd. calculates the future value of the positive cash flows discounted at the cost of capital.
Project X: ` 4,000 × (1 + 12% )1 + ` 5,000 = ` 9,480
Project Y: ` 3,000 × (1 + 15% )1 + ` 1,500 = ` 4,950
Then, it calculates the present value of the negative cash flows discounted at the financing cost.
Project X: ` –1,000 + ` ( –2,000) / (1 + 14% )1 = ` –3,000
Project Y: ` – 800 + ` ( –700 / 1 + 18%)1 = ` –1,500
To calculate the MIRR for each project M Ltd. uses the formula:
MIRR = (Future value of positive cash flows / present value of negative cash flows) (1/n) – 1.
Therefore,
Project X: ` 9,480 / (` 3,000)1/3 -1 = 5.3%
Project Y: ` 4,950 / (` 1,500)1/3 -1 = 10.0%
Given that these are mutually exclusive projects and project Y should be undertaken because it has a higher MIRR
than project X.
Illustration 11
A firm is considering a project requiring ` 50 lakh of investment. Expected cash flow is ` 10 lakh per annum for 8
years. The rate of return required by the equity investors from the project is 15%. The firm is able to raise ` 24 lakh
of debt finance carrying 14% interest for the project. The debt is repayable in equal annual installments over the
eight-year period – the first to be paid at the end of the first year. The tax rate is 40%. You are required to calculate
adjusted NPV. Assume equity cost is 5%.
Solution:
Base case NPV = ` (–) 50,00,000 + ∑ ` 10,00,000 / 1.158 = ` (–) 5,12,700
Equity Finance ` 26 lakh, Debt Finance ` 24 lakh.
Equity Issue Cost is assumed to be 5%.
Therefore, to get ` 26 lakh, total equity issue = ` 26 / 0.95 = ` 27.37 lakh
Difference of ` (27.37 – 26) lakh = ` 01.37 lakh is the cost of underwriting, brokerage, etc. for the issue.
(` in lakh)
Year 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Outstanding Debt at the beginning 24 21 18 15 12 09 06 03
Interest 3.36 2.94 2.52 2.10 1.68 1.26 0.84 0.42
Tax Shield 1.344 1.176 1.008 0.840 0.672 0.504 0.336 0.168
PV of Tax Shield 1.179 0.9049 0.6804 0. 497 0.349 0.230 0.134 0.059
(Discounting at 14%, cost of debt) Total PV of Tax Shield: 4.0333
Adjusted NPV = Base case NPV – Issue Cost + Present Value of Tax Shield
= ` (– 5,12,700 – 1,37,000 + 4,03,333) = ` (–) 2,46,367
C
onglomerates are companies that either partially or fully own a number of other companies. Here,
conglomerate means large company. In case of investment in or by the large company environment,
hurdle rate is an important criterion. Hurdle rate will guide us to make effective investment decision. A
hurdle rate, which is also known as benchmark or cut-off rate or the minimum required rate of return or
target rate that investors are expecting to receive on an investment. The rate is determined by assessing the cost
of capital, risks involved, current opportunities in business expansion, rates of return for similar investments, and
other factors that could directly affect an investment.
In other words, before accepting and implementing a certain investment project, its internal rate of return (IRR)
should be equal to or greater than the hurdle rate. Any potential investments must possess a return rate that is higher
than the hurdle rate in order for it to be acceptable in the long run.
As we find in practical, most companies use their Weighted Average Cost of Capital (WACC) as a hurdle rate for
investments. Generally, it is utilized to analyze a potential investment, taking the risks involved and the opportunity
cost of foregoing other projects into consideration. One of the main advantages of a hurdle rate is its objectivity,
which prevents management from accepting a project based on non-financial factors. Some projects get more
attention due to popularity, while others involve the use of new and exciting technology. Another way of looking
at the hurdle rate is that it’s the required rate of return investors demand from a company. Therefore, any project
the company invests in must be equal to or ideally greater than its cost of capital.
In conglomerate environment, at present, the most common way to use the hurdle rate to evaluate an investment
is using a discounted cash flow (DCF) technique. The DCF technique uses the concept of the time value of money
(opportunity cost) to forecast all future cash flows and then discount them back to today’s value to provide the net
present value.
NPV Vs. IRR
In case of mutually exclusive projects, financial appraisal using NPV & IRR methods may provide conflicting
results. The reasons for such conflicts may be attributed to
(i) Difference in timing / pattern of cash inflows of the alternative proposals (Time Disparity),
(ii) Difference in their amount of investment (Size Disparity) and
(iii) Difference in the life of the alternative proposals (Life Disparity).
Capital Rationing
There may be situations where a firm has a number of independent projects that yield a positive NPV or having IRR
more than it’s cut off rate, PI more than 1, i.e., the projects are financially viable, hence, acceptable. However, the
most important resource in investment decisions, i.e., funds, are not sufficient enough to undertake all the projects.
In such a case, the projects are selected in such a way so that NPV becomes maximum in order to maximize wealth
of shareholders. Investment planning in such situation is Capital Rationing.
Illustration 12
X Ltd. has a capital budget of ` 1.5 crore for the year. From the following information relating to six independent
proposals, select the projects if (i) the projects are divisible and (ii) the projects are indivisible.
*Only ` 50,00,000 can be invested in Project A, i.e., 5/7th of the total investment can be made. Proportionate NPV
is 5/7 × ` 30,00,000 = ` 21,42,857
● So selected projects are E, B, D and 5/7th part of A
Year (` )
1 1,00,000
2 1,00,000
3 80,000
4 80,000
5 40,000
Depreciation may be taken as 20% on original cost and taxation at 50% of net income.
You are required to evaluate the project according to each of the following methods:
(a) Payback period method
(b) Rate of return on original investment method
(c) Rate of return on average investment method
(d) Discounted cash flow method taking cost of capital as 10%
(e) Net present value index method
(f) Internal rate of return method.
(g) Modified internal rate of return method.
Solution:
Working Notes:
Cash
Profit Profit inflows Cumula- Dis- Present Dis- Present Dis- Present
Present
before after tax after tax tive cash Discount- counting value counting Value counting value
Year Value
tax @ 50% [PAT + inflows ing factor factor @ @20% factor @ @30% factor @ @32%
Dep] @ 10% (` )
(` ) (` ) (` ) 20% (` ) 30% (` ) 32% (` )
(` )
1 1,00,000 50,000 90,000 90,000 0.9091 81,819 0.8333 74,997 0.7692 69,228 0.7576 68,184
2 1,00,000 50,000 90,000 1,80,000 0.8264 74,376 0.6944 62,496 0.5917 53,253 0.5739 51,651
3 80,000 40,000 80,000 2,60,000 0.7513 60,104 0.5787 46,296 0.4552 36,416 0.4348 34,784
4 80,000 40,000 80,000 3,40,000 0.6830 54,640 0.4823 38,584 0.3501 28,008 0.3294 26,352
5 40,000 20,000 60,000 4,00,000 0.6209 37,254 0.4019 24,114 0.2693 16,158 0.2495 14,970
1 2 3 4 5 Total
Cash inflow after tax (` ) 90,000 90,000 80,000 80,000 60,000 --
Re-investment period 4 3 2 1 0
Re-investment at 10% 10% 10% 10% 10%
Future value factor (1.1)4 (1.1)3 (1.1)2 (1.1) 1
Future value (` ) 1,31,769 1,19,790 96,800 88,000 60,000 4,96,359
Illustration 14
A company has just installed a machine Model A for the manufacture of a new product at capital cost of ` 1,00,000.
The annual operating costs are estimated at ` 50,000 (excluding depreciation) and these costs are estimated on
the basis of an annual volume of 1,00,000 units of production. The fixed costs at this volume of 1,00,000 units of
output will amount to ` 4,00,000 p.a. The selling price is ` 5 per unit of output. The machine has a five-year life
with no residual value.
The company has now come across another machine called Super Model which is capable of giving, the same
volume of production at an estimated annual operating cost of ` 30,000 exclusives of depreciation. The fixed costs
will however, remain the same in value. This machine also will have a five-year life with no residual value. The
capital cost of this machine is ` 1,50,000.
The company has an offer for the sale of the machine Model A (which has just been installed) at ` 50,000 and the
cost of removal thereof will amount to ` 10,000. Ignore tax.
In view of the lower operating cost, the company is desirous of dismantling of the machine Model A and installing
the Super Model Machine. Assume that Model A has not yet started commercial production and that the time lag
in the removal thereof and the installation of the Super Model machine is not material.
The cost of capital is 14% and the P.V. Factors for each of the five years respectively are 0.877, 0.769, 0.675, 0.592
and 0.519.
State whether the company should replace Model A machine by installing the Super Model machine. Will there be
any change in your decision if the Model A machine has not been installed and the company is in the process of
consideration of selection of either of the two models of the machine? Present suitable statement to illustrate your
answer.
Solution:
(A) Appraisal of Replacement Decision under NPV method
Step 1:
Calculation of Present value of net cash outflow or net investment required. (`)
Cost of super model 1,50,000
Less: Sale proceeds of Model A 50,000
(-) Cost of removal 10,000 40,000
Net investment required 1,10,000
Step 2:
Calculation of present value of incremental operating cash flows:
Comment:
As net present value is negative, the replacement decision is not financially feasible.
Working Notes:
* 1. Total incremental cash inflows = ` 20,000
Present value of incremental recurring cash inflows for 5 years
=
` 20,000 × PVAF 5 years 14%
=
` 20,000 × 3.433
P.V of cash flows = ` 68,660
Step 1:
Calculation of Present value of cash outflow
Cost of machine = ` 1,00,000
Step 2:
Calculation of present value of recurring cash inflows or operating cash inflows
Cash inflows after tax (as above) – ` 50,000
PV of operating cash inflows for 5 years = ` 50,000 × PVAF 5 years 14%
=
` 50,000 × 3.433
=
` 1,71,650
Step 3:
Calculation of PV of terminal cash inflows = Nil
Step 4:
Calculation of NPV (` )
PV of total cash inflows = 1,71,650
Less: Outflow = 1,00,000
Net Present Value (under alternative I) = 71,650
3 1,80,000 2,00,000
4 2,10,000 2,40,000
5 2,20,000 2,30,000
(a) Calculate the net investment required by the new machine.
(b) If the company’s cost of capital is 15%, determine whether the new machine should be purchased.
Solution:
Appraisal of Replacement Decision under NPV method
Step 1:
Calculation of present value of net investment required: (` ) (` )
Cost of new asset 65,000
Add: Installation cost 10,000
75,000
Add: Additional WC 10,000
85,000
Less: Sale proceeds of old machine 30,000
Less: Tax 5,000
[8,000 × 55/100 + 2000 × 30/100] 25,000
Net Investment required 60,000
Step 2:
Calculation of Present Value of Incremental Operating cash inflows for 5 years.
Step 3:
Calculation of PV of terminal cash inflow (` )
Salvage value of asset 5,000
[No tax because book value and salvage value are equal]
Working capital recovered [100% recovered] 10,000
Terminal cash inflows 15,000
Its PV at the end of 5th year = ` 15,000 × 0.4972 = 7,458
Step 4:
Calculation of NPV (` )
PV of total cash inflows [` 82,711 + ` 7,458] = 90,169
(–) Outflow = 60,000
NPV = 30,169
Comment:
As NPV is positive, it is advised to replace.
Note 1: Depreciation for old Machine = ` 28,000 / 7 = ` 4,000
Illustration 17
A plastic manufacturer has under consideration the proposal of production of high-quality plastic glasses. The
necessary equipment to manufacture the glasses would cost ` 1 lakh and would last 5 year The tax relevant rate
of depreciation is 20% on written down value. There is no other asset in this block. The expected salvage value is
` 10,000. The glasses can be sold at ` 4 each. Regardless of the level of production, the manufacturer will incur
cash cost of ` 25,000 each year if the project is undertaken. The overhead costs allocated to this new line would
be ` 5,000. The variable costs are estimated at ` 2 per glass. The manufacturer estimates it will sell about 75,000
glasses per year; the tax rate is 35%. Should the proposed equipment be purchased? Assume 20% cost of capital
and additional working requirement, ` 50,000.
Solution:
Cash outflows
Cost of production equipment (` ) 1,00,000
Additional working capital requirement (` ) 50,000
Cash outflows (`) 1,50,000
Years
Particulars
1 (` ) 2 (` ) 3 (` ) 4 (` ) 5 (` )
Sales revenue (75,000 × ` 4) 3,00,000 3,00,000 3,00,000 3,00,000 3,00,000
Less: Costs
Variable costs (75,000 × 2) 1,50,000 1,50,000 1,50,000 1,50,000 1,50,000
Additional fixed costs 25,000 25,000 25,000 25,000 25,000
Depreciation (D) 20,000 16,000 12,800 10,240 Nil *
Earnings before taxes 1,05,000 1,09,000 1,12,200 1,14,760 1,25,000
Less: Taxes 36,750 38,150 39,270 40,166 43,750
Earnings after taxes (EAT) 68,250 70,850 72,930 74,594 81,250
CFAT (EAT + D) 88,250 86,850 85,730 84,834 81,250
Add: Recovery of Working 50,000
Capital
Add: Salvage value (SV) 10,000
Add: Tax benefit on short 10,836
term capital loss **
1,52,086
Multiplied by PV factor @ 0.20 0.833 0.694 0.579 0.482 0.402
PV (CFAT × PV factor) 73,512 60,274 49,638 40,890 61,139
Total PV (t = 1 – 5) 2,85,453
Less: Cash outflows 1,50,000
NPV 1,35,453
* As the block consists of single asset, no depreciation is to be charged in the terminating year as the asset has
been sold in the year.
** (` 1,00,000 – ` 59,040 accumulated depreciation – ` 10,000, SV) × 0.35 = ` 10,836.
Recommendation: The company is advised to buy the proposed equipment
Illustration 18
Modern Enterprises Ltd. is considering the purchase of a new computer system for its research and development
division, which would cost ` 35 lakh. The operation and maintenance costs (excluding depreciation) are expected
to be ` 7 lakh per annum. It is estimated that the useful life of the system would be 6 years, at the end of which the
disposal value is expected to be ` 1 lakh.
The tangible benefits expected from the system in the form of reduction in design and draftsmanship costs would
be ` 12 lakh per annum. The disposal of used drawing office equipment and furniture initially is anticipated to net
` 9 lakh.
As capital expenditure in research and development, the proposal would attract a 100% write-off for tax purposes.
The gains arising from disposal of used assets may be considered tax free. The effective tax rate is 35%. The
average cost of capital of the company is 12%.
After appropriate analysis of cash flows, advise the company of the financial viability of the proposal. Ignore tax
on salvage value.
Solution:
Assessment of Financial Viability of proposal (` in lakh)
Incremental cash outflows
Cost of new computer system 35
Less: Sale proceeds from drawing office equipment and furniture 9
26
Incremental CFAT and NPV:
(a) Cost savings (years 1–6)
Reduction in design and draftsmanship costs 12
Less: Operation and maintenance costs 7
Cost savings (earnings) before taxes 5
Less: Taxes (0.35) 1.75
Earnings after taxes (CFAT) 3.25
(×) PV factor of annuity for 6 years (0.12) × 4.111
Total PV of cost savings 13.36
(b) Tax savings on account of depreciation
Cost of new computer system (` 35 lakhs × 0.35) 12.25
(×) PV factor for year 1 × 0.892
Total PV 9.93
(c) Terminal salvage value at the end of year 6 (` 1 lakh × 0.507) 0.507
(d) Gross PV of CFAT [(a) + (b) + (c)] 24.797
Less: Cash outflows 26.000
NPV (1.203)
Illustration 19
A textile company is considering two mutually exclusive investment proposals. Their expected cashflow streams
(CFAT) are given as follows:
Proposal X Proposal Y
Year
(` in thousand) (` in thousand)
0 (500) (700)
1 145 100
2 145 110
Proposal X Proposal Y
Year
(` in thousand) (` in thousand)
3 145 130
4 145 150
5 145 160
6 145 150
7 120
8 120
9 110
10 100
The company employs the risk-adjusted method of evaluating risky projects and selects the appropriate required
rate of return as follows:
Project payback Required rate of return (percentage)
Less than 1 year 8
1 to 5 years 10
5 to 10 years 12
Over 10 years 15
Which proposal should be acceptable to the company?
Solution:
i. Payback period (PB) for Proposal X = ` 5,00,000/` 1,45,000 = 3.448 year
The appropriate risk adjusted rate of return for payback period of 3.448 years is 0.10.
Solution:
Net Present Value (NPV)
Particulars Amount (` )
1. Profit after Tax (PAT) 10,00,000
2. Add: Depreciation (` 1,00,00,000 ÷ 10 years) 10,00,000
3. CFAT (1 + 2) for years 1-10 20,00,000
4. PV factor (annuity) for 10 years (at 0.12) = 5.650
5. Total PV (3 × 4) 1,13,00,000
6. (a) CFAT in year 10 = ` 10,00,000
(b) Relevant PV factor = 0.322
(c) Additional PV in year 10 (a × b) 3,22,000
7. Total PV (5 + 6) 1,16,22,000
8. Project cost (t = 0) 1,10,00,000
9. NPV (7 – 8) 6,22,000
Illustration 21
A company has to replace one of its machines, which has become unserviceable. Two options are available to the
company:
(i) A more expensive machine (EM) with 12 years life.
(ii) A less expensive machine (LM) with 6 years life.
If machine LM is chosen, it will be replaced at the end of 6 years by another LM machine.
The pattern of maintenance, running costs and prices as under:
Particulars EM (` ) LM (` )
Purchase price 20,00,000 14,00,000
Scarp value at end of life 3,00,000 3,00,000
Overhauling is due at the end of 8 Year
th
4th Year
Overhauling cost 4,00,000 2,00,000
Annual repairing expenses 2,00,000 2,80,000
Year 4 6 8 12
PV Factor 0.5921 0.4556 0.3506 0.2076
Present Value Interest Factor for an Annuity, PVIFA (14%)
Solution:
Machine EM -12 Year’s Life
Illustration 23
A manufacturing company has an old machine having no book value which can be sold for ` 100,000. The company
is thinking to choose one of the following two alternatives:
(i) To incur additional cost of ` 20,00,000 to upgrade the existing old machine.
(ii) To replace old machine with a new machine costing of ` 40,00,000 along with installation cost of ` 100,000.
The above two alternatives envisage useful life to be 5 years. The expected after-tax profits for three alternatives
are as under:
Incremental Cash Inflows after Taxes (CFAT) of New over Old Machine
Old Machine Upgraded Machine
Incremental
Year PAT/CFAT (` ) PAT (` ) Depreciation (` ) CFAT (` )
CFAT=5-2 (` )
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
1 10,00,000 12,00,000 8,20,000 20,20,000 10,20,000
2 10,80,000 12,80,000 8,20,000 21,00,000 10,20,000
3 11,60,000 13,80,000 8,20,000 22,00,000 10,40,000
4 12,40,000 14,80,000 8,20,000 23,00,000 10,60,000
5 13,20,000 16,00,000 8,20,000 24,20,000 11,00,000
Total 58,00,000
Calculation of NPV of both options
Upgraded Machine New Machine
Year Incremental Incremental
PVF Total PV (` ) PVF Total PV (` )
CFAT (` ) CFAT (` )
1 5,00,000 0.870 4,35,000 10,20,000 0.870 8,87,400
2 5,00,000 0.756 3,78,000 10,20,000 0.756 7,71,120
3 4,60,000 0.658 3,02,680 10,40,000 0.658 6,84,320
4 4,60,000 0.572 2,63,120 10,60,000 0.572 6,06,320
5 4,80,000 0.497 2,38,560 11,00,000 0.497 5,46,700
16,17,360 34,95,860
Less: Cash Outflows 20,00,000 40,40,000
NPV -3,82,640 -5,54,140
Decision: As the NPV in both the alternatives are negative, the company should continue with the existing old
machine.
Illustration 24
Vedika Ltd., with a limited investment funds of ` 6,00,000 is evaluating the desirability of 5 (five) investment
proposals. Their profiles are summarized below:
Project Investment (` ) Annual Cash flow (after tax) (` ) Life (in years)
M 1,00,000 36,000 10
N 2,00,000 1,00,000 4
O 2,40,000 60,000 8
P 3,00,000 80,000 16
Q 4,00,000 60,000 25
PVIFA
Year 10 4 8 16 25
Solution:
Calcualtion of NPV of the Projects
PV (Cash flow NPV
Investment Cash flow
Project Annuity × annuity) (PV – invest.)
(` ) (` )
(` ) (` )
M 1,00,000 36,000 6.145 2,21,220 1,21,220
N 2,00,000 1,00,000 3.170 3,17,000 1,17,000
O 2,40,000 60,000 5.335 3,20,100 80,100
P 3,00,000 80,000 7.824 6,25,920 3,25,920
Q 4,00,000 60,000 9.077 5,44,620 1,44,620
Life of project is not relevant in determination of NPV.
Year 0 1 2 3 4 5
Cash Flows (` ) (`) (`) (`) (`) (`) (`)
Project M (4,00,000) 70,000 1,60,000 1,80,000 1,50,000 40,000
Project N (4,00,000) 4,36,000 20,000 20,000 8,000 6,000
You are required to:
i. Calculate the NPV and IRR of each project.
Year 0 1 2 3 4 5
PVIF at 10% 1000 0.909 0.826 0.751 0.683 0.621
PVIF at 20% 1000 0.833 0.694 0.579 0.482 0.402
Solution:
(i) Calculation of NPV and IRR
NPV of Project M
Cash Flows Discount factor Discount Values Discount Factor Discounted
Year
(` ) (10%) (` ) (20%) Value (` )
0 (4,00,000) 1.000 (4,00,000) 1000 (4,00,000)
1 70,000 0.909 63,630 0.833 58,310
2 1,60,000 0.826 1,32,160 0.694 1,11,040
3 1,80,000 0.751 1,35,180 0.579 1,04,220
4 1,50,000 0.683 1,02,450 0.482 72,300
5 40,000 0.621 24,840 0.402 16,080
NPV 58,260 (38,050)
IRR of Project M:
At 20% NPV is (-) ` 38050 and at 10% NPV is ` 58,260
58260
So, IRR = 10 + × 10
58260 + 38050
= 16.05%
NPV of Project N
Cash Flows Discount factor Discount Discount Discounted
Year
(` ) (10%) Values (` ) Factor (20%) Value (` )
0 (4,00,000) 1000 (4,00,000) 1000 (4,00,000)
1 4,36,000 0.909 3,96,324 0.833 3,63,188
2 20,000 0.826 16,520 0.694 13,880
3 20,000 0.751 15,020 0.579 11,580
4 8,000 0.683 5,464 0.482 3,856
5 6,000 0.621 3,726 0.402 2,412
NPV 37,054 (5,084)
IRR of Project M:
At 20% NPV is (-) ` 5084 and at 10% NPV is ` 37054
37054
So, IRR = 10 + × 10
37054 + 5084
= 18.79%
(ii) Since, both the projects are generating the positive NPV at the company’s cost of capital at 10% hence, they
are acceptable. IF company follows NPV method, then the company will have to select Project M because it
has higher NPV.
If the company follows IRR method, then Project N should be selected because of higher Internal Rate of
Return (IRR), but when NPV and IRR give contradictory results. A project with higher NPV is generally
preferred because of higher return in absolute terms. Hence, Project M should be selected.
(iii) Because of the difference in the pattern of the cash flows the inconsistency in the ranking of the projects arises.
Project M’s major cash flow occur mainly in the middle three years whereas project N generated the major
cash flow in the first year itself.
Illustration 26
Information of two projects is given below:
Project A B
Cash Inflows (` ‘000) Year-end
1 50 282
2 300 250
3 360 180
4 208 NIL
Initial Investment – beginning of year 1 535 540
Evaluate which project is better under each of the following criteria taking discount rate as 10% p.a.
(i) NPV
(ii) Discounted Payback period
(iii) Profitability Index
Solution: (` in ‘000)
705.67
Project A (Profitability Index) = = 1.32 (` in ‘000)
535
598.018
Project B (Profitability Index) = = 1.12 (` in ‘000)
540
Illustration 27
Lokesh Ltd. is considering buying a machine costing ` 15,00,000 which yields the following annual income:
End of year 1 2 3 4 5
Annual Income after Depreciation but 3,50,000 3,72,000 3,10,000 1,75,000 1,10,000
before tax
PV Factor at 12% of ` 1 0.893 0.797 0.712 0.636 0.567
Corporate tax rate applicable is 30%. Depreciation is on straight line basis for 5 year There is no scrap value.
Normal rate of return is 12%. Round off calculations to the nearest rupee and calculate:
(a) Payback Period
(b) Discounted Payback Period
(c) Net Present Value
(d) Profitability Index
Solution:
Calculation of Present Value (`)
(c) Net Present Value = Present value of cash inflows – Present value of cash outflows
(d) Profitability Index = Present value of cash inflows / Present value of cash outflows
Illustration 28
Robin Ltd. is examining two manually exclusive investment proposals. The management uses Net Present Value
method to evaluate new investment proposals. Depreciation is charged using Straight line Method. Other details
relating to these proposals are:
You are required to advise the company on which proposal should be taken up by it.
Solution:
Proposal X (` ) Proposal Y (` )
Earnings before Interest and Taxes 13,00,000 24,50,000
Less: Tax @ 30% 3,90,000 7,35,000
Earnings after Tax 9,10,000 17,15,000
Add: Depreciation 22,20,000 35,70,000
Cash inflow (a) 31,30,000 52,85,000
Present value annuity factor @ 10% (b) 3.1698 3.7907
Present Value of cash inflow (a) × (b) 99,21,474 2,00,33,850
Add: Present value of salvage value:
Proposal X: ` 1,20,000 × 0.683 81,960 -
Proposal Y: ` 1,50,000 × 0.6209 - 93,135
Total Present Value 1,00,03,434 2,01,26,985
Less: Initial Outflow 90,00,000 1,80,00,000
Net Present Value 10,03,434 21,26,985
Working Note:
X Y
Depreciation
Cost (` ) 90,00,000 1,80,00,000
Less: Salvage Value (` ) 1,20,000 1,50,000
88,80,000 1,78,50,000
Advice – Annualized Net Present Value is more in case of Project Y hence, we should accept project Y.
Illustration 29
ABC Ltd. wishes to evaluate two mutually exclusive proposals to acquire a machine. Machines M and N are being
considered, each costing ` 2,00,000 and having an estimated life of 5 years and 4 years respectively. Both have nil
salvage value. The anticipated cash flows after adjustment of taxes for M and N are given below:
Find the accounting rate of return and net present value for both the machines and advise ABC Ltd., which machine
should be bought. The required rate of return is 10% p.a.
Present Value factor for 10%:
End of year 1 2 3 4 5
0.909 0.826 0.751 0.683 0.621
Solution:
Ranking of Proposals:
Note: [For evaluation of ARR the average investment has been taken at half of the initial cost for all the two
machines]
M = ` 70,000 + ` 60,000 + ` 60,000 + ` 50,000 + ` 90,000 = ` 3,30,000 ÷ 5 = ` 66,000
N = ` 1,00,000 + ` 90,000 + ` 80,000 + ` 40,000 = ` 3,10,000 ÷ 4 = ` 77,500
AV Profit
M ARR = × 100
AV Investment
66000 - 40000
= × 100 = 26%
100000
77500 - 50000
N = × 100 = 27.5%
100000
Rank: Machine ‘N’ to be selected under both the methods as it generates higher NPV and average rate of return.
Illustration 30
FB Chemical Ltd. has three potential projects, all with an initial cost of ` 20,00,000 and estimated life of five year
The capital budget for the year will only allow the company to accept one of the three projects.
Given the discount rates and the future cash flows of each project, which project should the company accept?
Project 1 has an annual cash flow of ` 5,00,000 and discount rate of 6%.
Project 2 has an annual cash flow of ` 6,00,000 and discount rate of 9%.
Project 3 has the following cash inflows and discount rate of 15%
Year 1 2 3 4 5
Cash Inflows ` 10,00,000 8,00,000 6,00,000 2,00,000 1,00,000
Solution:
Project 1’s NPV = ` [5,00,000 (0.943 + 0.889 + 0.839 + 0.792 + 0.747) – 20,00,000]
=` 1,05,000
Project 2’s NPV = ` [6,00,000 (0.917 + 0.841 + 0.772 + 0.708 + 0.649) – 20,00,000]
=` 3,32,200
Illustration 31
P Ltd. has four potential projects all with an initial cost of ` 15,00,000. The capital budget for the year will only
allow the company to take up only one of the three projects. Given the discount rates and the future cash flows of
each project, which project should they accept?
Solution:
Cash outflow = ` 15,00,000
Life of the Project = 5 Years
1. Calculation of NPV of Project A
NPV = PV of Cash Inflow (CI) – PV of cash outflow
PV of CI = CI × PV of Annuity factor for 5 years @ 4%
= ` 3,50,000 × 4.452 = ` 15,58,200
NPV = ` 15,58,200 – ` 15,00,000
= ` 58,200
2. Calculation of NPV of Project B
PV of CI = CI × PV of Annuity factor for 5 years @ 8%
= ` 4,00,000 × 3.993 = ` 15,97,200
NPV = ` 15,97,200 – ` 15,00,000
= ` 97200
3. Calculation of NPV of Project C
= ` 3,95,500
Recommendation: The management of P Ltd. may be advised to select Project C as its NPV is more than NPV
of Project A & B.
Solved Case 1
A company is considering an investment proposal to install new milling controls at a cost of ` 50,000. The facility
has a life expectancy of 5 years and no salvage value. The tax rate is 35%. Assume the firm uses straight line
depreciation and the same is allowed for tax purposes. The estimated cash flows before depreciation and tax
(CFBT) from the investment proposal are as follows:
Year CFBT (` )
1 10,000
2 10,692
3 12,769
4 13,462
5 20,385
Compute the following:
(i) Payback period,
(ii) Average rate of return,
(iii) Internal rate of return,
(iv) Net present value at 10% discount rate,
(v) Profitability index at 10% discount rate.
Solution:
Average income
(ii) Average rate of return (ARR) = AverageInvestment × 100
` 2250 (` 11250 ÷ 5)
= × 100 = 9%
` 25000 (` 50000 ÷ 2)
The fake payback period = 4.0816 (` 50,000 / ` 12,250). The value closest to the fake payback period of 4.0816
against 5 years is 4.100 against 7%. Since the actual cash flow stream is the initial years are slightly below the
average cash flow stream, the IRR is likely to be lower than 7%. Let us try with 6%.
PV factor Total PV
Year CFAT
(0.06) (0.07) (0.06) (` ) (0.07)
1 ` 10,000 0.943 0.935 ` 9,430 9350
2 10,450 0.890 0.873 9,300 9,123
3 11,800 0.840 0.816 9,912 9,629
4 12,250 0.792 0.763 9,702 9,347
5 16,750 0.747 0.713 12,512 11,942
Total PV 50,856 49,391
Less: Initial outlay 50,000 50,000
NPV 856 (609)
The IRR is between 6% and 7%. By interpolation, IRR = 6.6%.
(iv) Net present value (NPV)
Solved Case 2
The H Ltd is considering investment in a new product. The information for one year is given as follows:
Particulars (`)
(a) Sales 1,00,000
(b) Manufacturing cost of sales (including ` 10,000 of depreciation) 40,000
(c) Selling and administrative expenses (directly associated with the product) 20,000
(d) Decrease in contribution of other products 2,000
(e) Increase in accounts receivable 7,000
(f) Increase in inventories 10,000
(g) Increase in current liabilities 15,000
(h) Income taxes associated with product income 6,000
You are required to compute the relevant cash flows of the year to be considered in evaluating this investment
proposal.
Solution:
Exercise
A. Theoretical Questions:
~ Multiple Choice Questions
1. Capital Budgeting is a part of:
(a) Investment Decision
(b) Working Capital Management
(c) Marketing Management
(d) Capital Structure.
2. Capital Budgeting deals with:
(a) Long-term Decisions
(b) Short-term Decisions
(c) Both (a) and (b)
(d) Neither (a) nor (b).
3. Which of the following is not used in Capital Budgeting?
(a) Time Value of Money
(b) Sensitivity Analysis
(c) Net Assets Method
(d) Cash Flows.
4. Capital Budgeting Decisions are:
(a) Reversible
(b) Irreversible
(c) Unimportant
(d) All of the above.
5. Which of the following is not incorporated in Capital Budgeting?
(a) Tax-Effect
(b) Time Value of Money
(c) Required Rate of Return
(d) Rate of Cash Discount.
6. Which of the following is not a capital budgeting decision?
(a) Expansion Programme
(b) Merger
(c) Replacement of an Asset
(d) Inventory Level.
30. In a single projects situation, results of internal rate of return and net present value lead to
(a) cash flow decision
(b) cost decision
(c) same decisions
(d) different decisions
31. The discount rate which forces net present values to become zero is classified as
(a) positive rate of return
(b) negative rate of return
(c) external rate of return
(d) internal rate of return
32. A point where profile of net present value crosses horizontal axis at plotted graph indicates project
(a) costs
(b) cash flows
(c) internal rate of return
(d) external rate of return
33. Payback period in which an expected cash flows are discounted with help of project cost of capital is
classified as
(a) discounted payback period
(b) discounted rate of return
(c) discounted cash flows
(d) discounted project cost
34. Number of years forecasted to recover an original investment is classified as
(a) payback period
(b) forecasted period
(c) original period
(d) investment period
35. In proper capital budgeting analysis we evaluate incremental
(a) Accounting income
(b) Cash flow
(c) Earnings
(d) Operating profit
What is the present value of lease rentals, if lease rentals are payable at the end of the year? [Given PV
factors at 12% for years (1-8) is 4.9676.]
(a) ₹ 98,14,680
(b) ₹ 89,41,680
(c) ₹ 94,18,860
(d) ₹ 96,84,190
42. Given for a project: Annual Cash inflow ₹80,000 Useful life 4 years Pay-Back period 2.855 years What
is the cost of the project?
(a) ₹ 2,28,500
(b) ₹ 2,28,400
(c) ₹ 2,28,600
(d) ₹ 2,28,700
43. The following is not a Discounted Cash Flow Technique:
(a) NPV
(b) PI
(c) Accounting of Average Rate of Return
(d) IRR
44. Which of the following is not incorporated in Capital Building?
(a) Tax-Effect
(b) Time Value of Money
(c) Required Rate of Return
(d) Rate of Cash Discount
45. Which of the following variables is not known in Internal Rate of Return?
(a) Initial Cash Flows
(b) Discount Rate
(c) Terminal Inflows
(d) Life of the Project
46. Capital Budgeting techniques which considers the time value of money is based on
(a) Cash Flows of the organization
(b) Accounting Profit of the organization
(c) Interest Rate on Borrowings
(d) Last Dividend Paid
52. A project whose cash flows are more than capital invested for rate of return then net present value will be
(a) positive
(b) independent
(c) negative
(d) zero
53. NPV is positive indicates :
(a) Cash inflows are generated at a rate higher than the minimum required by the firm.
(b) Cash inflows are generated at a rate equal to the minimum required
(c) Cash inflows are generated at a rate lower than the minimum required by the firm.
(d) None of the above
Answers:
1 a 2 a 3 c
4 b 5 d 6 d
7 a 8 d 9 b
10 d 11 d 12 c
13 c 14 c 15 b
16 c 17 c 18 b
19 c 20 c 21 a
22 b 23 d 24 d
25 b 26 a 27 b
28 c 29 a 30 c
31 d 32 c 33 a
34 a 35 b 36 b
37 c 38 c 39 c
40 a 41 b 42 b
43 c 44 d 45 b
46 a 47 c 48 a
49 d 50 d 51 a
52 a 53 a
3. Two competing projects have the following NPVs: Project X, + ` 5 lakh (with initial outlay of ` 25 lakh)
and Project Y, + ` 4,20,000 (with initial outlay of ` 20,00,000). The company should opt for project X as
it has higher NPV.
4. A project requires an initial investment of ` 10,00,000. The estimated cash inflows from the project are as
follows: ` 3 lakh (year 1),` 1 lakh (year 2), ` 3 lakh (year 3), ` 6 lakh (Year 4) and ` 4 lakh (year 5). The
Payback of the project is 4 years.
5. A project requires an investment of ` 20 lakh. The estimated profit after tax for years 1-5 are: ` 3 lakh, `
3 lakh, ` 3 lakh, ` 6 lakh and ` 8 lakh. The accounting rate of return is 21%
6. In the case of independent investment projects, if the NPV of the project is zero, IRR is equal to cost of
capital.
7. A company has evaluated 3 investment proposals under IRR method, yielding different rates of return.
Though the IRR values are varying, reinvestment rate of intermediate cash inflows is assumed to be the
same for all these 3 proposals.
8. Since IRR is expressed in percentage figure, it is the best method for evaluating capital budgeting projects.
9. The more distant the CFAT, the higher is the present value of such cash flows.
10. NPV is the best method of evaluating long-term investment proposals.
11. Investment decisions and capital budgeting are same.
12. Capital budgeting decisions are long term decisions.
13. Capital budgeting decisions are reversible in nature.
14. Capital budgeting decisions do not affect the future Stability of the firm.
15. There is a time element involved in capital budgeting.
16. An expansion decision is not a capital budgeting decision
17. In mutually exclusive decision situation, the firm can accept all feasible proposals.
18. Capital budgeting and capital rationing are alternative to each other.
19. Correct capital budgeting decisions can be taken by comparing the cost with future benefits.
20. Future expected profits from investments are taken as returns from the investment for capital budgeting.
21. Cash flows are the appropriate measure of costs and benefits from an investment proposal.
22. Sunk cost is a relevant cost in capital budgeting.
23. The opportunity cost of an input is always considered, in capital budgeting.
24. Allocated overhead costs are not relevant for capital budgeting.
25. Cash flows and accounting profits are different.
26. Cash flows are same as profit before tax.
27. Net cash flow is on after-tax basis.
28. The term capital budgeting is used interchangeably with capital expenditure decision.
29. The key function of the financial management is the selection of the most profitable portfolio of capital
investment.
30. Capital budgeting decisions are crucial, affecting all the departments of the firm.
Answer:
1 F 2 F 3 T
4 F 5 F 6 T
7 F 8 F 9 F
10 T 11 F 12 T
13 F 14 F 15 T
16 F 17 F 18 F
19 F 20 F 21 T
22 F 23 F 24 T
25 T 26 F 27 T
28 T 29 T 30 T
Answers:
11. Discuss the advantages and disadvantages of all the evaluation techniques of capital budgeting.
B. Numerical Questions :
CFAT
Year
A (` ) B (` ) C (` )
1 50,000 80,000 1,00,000
2 50,000 80,000 1,00,000
3 50,000 80,000 10,000
4 50,000 30,000 --
5 1,90,000 -- --
(a) Rank each project applying the methods of PB, NPV, IRR and profitability index (PI).
(b) What would the profitability index be if the IRR equaled the required return on investment? What is
the significance of a profitability index less than one?
(c) Recommend the project to be adopted and give reasons.
2. Royal Industries Ltd. is considering the replacement of one of its moulding machines. The existing
machine is in good operating condition, but is smaller than required if the firm is to expand its operations.
The old machine is 5 years old, has a current salvage value of ` 30,000 and a remaining depreciable life of
10 years.
The machine was originally purchased for ` 75,000 and is being depreciated at ` 5,000 per year for tax
purposes.
The new machine will cost ` 1,50,000 and will be depreciated on a straight line basis over 10 years, with
no salvage value. The management anticipates that, with the expanded operations, there will be need of
an additional net working capital of ` 30,000. The new machine will allow the firm to expand current
operations, and thereby increase annual revenues of ` 40,000, and variable operating costs from ` 2,00,000
to ` 2,10,000. The company’s tax rate is 35% and its cost of capital is 10%. Should the company replace
its existing machine? Assume that the loss on sale of existing machine can be claimed as short-term capital
loss in the current year itself.
3. Arvind Mills Ltd. is considering two mutually exclusive investment proposals for its expansion
programme. Proposal A requires an initial investment of ` 7,50,000 and yearly cash operating costs of
` 50,000. Proposal B requires an initial investment of ` 5,00,000 and yearly cash operating costs of `
1,00,000. The life of the equipment used in both the investment proposals will be 12 years, with no salvage
value; depreciation is on the straight-line basis for tax purposes. The anticipated increase in revenues is
` 1,50,000 per year in both the investment proposals. The firm’s tax rate is 35% and its cost of capital is
15%. Which investment proposal should be undertaken by the company?
4. Initial investment is ` 100 lakh is same for both the projects A & B. The net cash inflows after taxes for
project A is ` 25 lakh per annum for 5 years and those for project B over its life of 5 years are ` 20 lakh,
` 25 lakh, ` 30 lakh, ` 30 lakh and ` 20 lakh respectively. Find out payback period of both the projects.
5. Z Ltd. has two projects under consideration A & B, each costing ` 60 lakh. The projects are mutually
exclusive. Life for project A is 4 years & project B is 3 years. Salvage value NIL for both the projects. Tax
Rate 33.99%. Cost of Capital is 15%.
Answers:
1 (i) PB: C, B, A; NPV: A, B; IRR: A, B
(ii) The profitability index would be 1. The significance of a PI less than 1 is that NPV is negative
and the project should not be undertaken.
(iii) Project A, because its NPV is the highest.
2 NPV ` 9,915. The company should replace the existing machine.
3 Proposal B should be accepted, since NPV is negative.
4 Project A: 4 Years and Project B: 3.75 Years
5 NPV of Project A: ` 117.18 lakh and NPV of Project B: ` 100.621; As Project “A” has a higher Net
Present Value, it has to be taken up)
Unsolved Case(s)
1. The cost of a project is ` 50,000 and it generates cash inflows of ` 20,000, ` 15,000, ` 25,000, and ` 10,000
over four years.
Required: Using the present value index method, appraise the profitability of the proposed investment,
assuming a 10% rate of discount, charged semi-annually.
2. The cost of a plant is ` 50,000. It has an estimated life of 5 years after which it would be disposed of (scrap
value is nil). Profit Before Depreciation, Interest and Taxes (PBIT) is estimated to be ` 17,500 p.a. Calculate
the yearly cash flow from the plant when tax rate is 30%.
3. Oxford Ltd. has decided to diversify its production and wanted to invest its surplus funds on the most profitable
project. It has only two projects under consideration – ‘X’ and ‘Y’. The cost of project ‘X’ is ` 100 lacs and
that of ‘Y’ is ` 10 lacs. Both projects are expected to have a life of 8 years only and at the end of this period ‘X’
will have a salvage value of ` 4 lacs and ‘B’ ` 14 lacs. The running expenses of ‘X’ will be ` 35 lacs per year
and that of ‘Y’ ` 20 lacs per year. In either case, the company expects a rate of return of 10%. The company’s
tax rate is 50%. Depreciation is charged on straight line basis. Which project is profitable?
4. A firm is considering an introduction of a new product which will have a life of five years. Two alternatives of
promoting the product have been identified:
Option 1: This involves hiring many agents. An immediate investment of ` 5,00,000 is required to promote
the product. This will result in a net cash inflow of ` 3,00,000 at the end of each year for the next five years.
However, agents need to pay ` 50,000 per year. After the contract is terminated, the agent has to pay a lump
sum of ` 1,00,000 at the end of the fifth year.
Option 2: Under this alternative, the firm will not employ agents but will sell directly to the customers. The
initial cost of advertising is ` 2,50,000. This earns cash at the end of each year ` 1,50,000. However, this
alternative comes with a sales administration fee of ` 50,000. The firm also proposes to allocate fixed costs
worth ` 20,000 per year to this product if this alternative is pursued.
Required:
(i) Advise the management, which method of promotion is to be adopted? You may assume that the firm’s
cost of capital is 20%.
(ii) Calculate the internal rate of return (IRR) for option 2.
References:
● Bierman, H., and S. Smidt, The Capital Budgeting Decision, Macmillan, New York, 1974.
● Bodie, Zvi et al, Investments, Tata McGraw-Hill Publishing Company Limited, New Delhi: 2002.
● Chambers, Donald R., and Nelson J. Lacey. “Corporate Ethics and Shareholder Wealth Maximization.”
Financial Practice and Education 6 (Spring–Summer 1996), 93– 96.
● Chandra Prasanna, Financial Management, Theory and Practice, McGraw Hill., 2019.
● Emery, D R and J D Finnerty, Corporate Financial Management, Prentice–Hall International, London, 1997.
● Fama, Eugene F; French, Kenneth R (Summer 2004). The Capital Asset Pricing Model: Theory and Evidence.
● Journal of Economic Perspectives. 18 (3): 25–46.
● Fischer Donald E, and Jordon Ronald J., Security Analysis and Portfolio Management, PHI.
● Francis, Jack Clark, Investments: Analysis and Management, McGraw-Hill, Inc. New York: 1991.
● H. Markowitz, Portfolio Selection: Efficient Diversification of Investments, John Wiley & Sons, 1959.
● Khan, M Y and P K Jain, Financial Management- Text, Problems and Cases, McGraw-Hill Publishing Co.,
New Delhi, 2019.
● Pandey I.M., Financial Management, Pearson, 12th Edition, 2021.
● Ross, Stephen. A, “The Arbitrage Theory of Capital Asset Pricing,” Journal of Economic Theory, Vol. 13,
(December, 1976).
● Solomon, E, Theory of Financial Management, Columbia University Press (New York), 1969.
● Van Horne James C. and Wachowicz John M., Jr. Fundamentals of Financial Management, Prentice Hall, 13th
Edition, 2008.
T
hhe financial management of business involves the management of long-term assets, long-term capital,
and the management of short-term assets and liabilities. Management of working capital concerns with
the management of assets such as cash, marketable securities, receivables, inventories and other current
assets also liabilities include payables and accruals.
Working capital management is essentially the management of current assets and current liabilities in an
organisation. It is concerned with the problems that has been arising in attempting to manage the current assets,
the current liabilities and inter relationship that exists between them. The role of the working capital management
is to manage the firm’s current assets and liabilities in such a way that a satisfactory level of working capital is
maintained.
Net working capital refers to the excess of the current assets over current liabilities. Net working capital (NWC)
can alternatively define as the part of the current assets which are financed with the long-term funds. Since, current
liabilities represent sources of short-term funds, as long as the current assets exceeds the current liabilities, the
excess must be financed with the long-term funds.
Though both concepts are important for managing it. Gross working capital is more helpful to the management in
managing each individual current assets for day-to-day operations. But, in the long run, it is the net working capital
that is useful for the purpose.
When we want to know the sources from which funds are obtained, it is not working capital that is more important
and should be given greater emphasis. The definition given by the Accountants, U.S.A., will give clear view of
working capital which is given below:
“Working capital sometimes called net working capital, is represented by excess of current assets over current
liabilities and identifies the relatively liquid portion of total enterprise capital which constitutes a margin of better
for maturing obligations within the ordinary operation cycle of the business.”
Each concern has its own limitations and constraints within which it has to decide whether it should give importance
to gross or not working capital.
Current Assets
An asset is classified as current asset when:
(a) it is expected to be realised or intends to be sold or consumed in normal operating cycle of the organisation;
(b) the asset is held primarily for the purpose of trading;
(c) it is expected to be realised within twelve months after the reporting period;
(d) it is non- restricted cash or cash equivalent.
Generally current assets of an organisation, for the purpose of working capital management can be classified into
the following main heads:
(i) Inventory (raw material, work-in-process and finished goods)
(ii) Receivables (trade receivables and bills receivables)
(iii) Cash or cash equivalents (short-term marketable securities)
(iv) Prepaid expenses
Current Liabilities
A liability is classified as current liability when:
(a) it is expected to be settled in normal operating cycle of the organisation
requires to maintain certain stocks of goods as also some credit to debtors. Further, if we go to manufacturing
organisation the cycle period of working capital is high because the funds are to be invested in each and every
type of inventory forms of raw-material, work-in-progress, finished goods as also debtors. Industrial units too
require a large amount of working capital.
2. Production Policies: These policies will have a great significance in determining the size of the working
capital. Where production policies are designed in such a way that uniform production is carried on throughout
the accounting period, such concern requires a uniform and lesser amount of working capital. On the other
hand, the concerns with production policies according to the needs of the customers will be peak at sometimes
and require high amount of working capital. In seasonal industries too, where production policies are laid
down tightly in the business season requires a high amount of working capital.
3. Process of Manufacture: If the manufacturing process of a particular industry is longer due to its complex
nature, more working capital is required to finance that process, because, longer the period of manufacture, the
larger the inventory tied up in the process and naturally requires a high amount of working capital.
4. Growth and Expansion of Business: A business concern at status requires a uniform amount of working
capital as against the concerns which are growing and expanding. It is the tendency of any business organisation
to grow further and further till its saturation point, if any. Such growth may be within the existing units by
increased activities. Similarly, business concerns will expand their organisation by establishing new units. In
both the cases, the need for working capital requirement increases as the organisation increases.
5. Fluctuations in the Trade Cycle: Business activities vary according to the general fluctuations in the world.
There are four stages in a trade cycle which affects the activities of any business concern. Accordingly, the
requirements of working capital are bound to change. When conditions of boom prevail, it is the policy of any
prudent management to build or pile up large stock of inventories of various forms to take the advantage of the
lower prices. Such fluctuations cause a business concern to demand for more amount of working capital. The
other phase of trade cycle i.e., depression i.e., low or absence of business activities cause business concerns
to demand for more working capital. In condition of depression, the products produced are not sold due to
fall in demand, lack of purchasing power of the people. As a result of which entire production obtained was
not sold in the market and high inventories are piled up. Therefore, there arises the need for heavy amount of
working capital. Thus, the two extreme stages of trade cycles make the business concerns to demand for more
working capital. In the former case due to acts and policies of management and in the later case due to natural
phenomena of trade cycle.
6. Terms and Conditions of Purchases and Sales: A business concern which allows more credit to its customers
and buys its supplies for cash requires more amount of working capital. On the other hand, business concerns
which do not allow more credit period to its customers and seek better credit facilities for their supplies
naturally require lesser amount of working capital.
7. Dividend Policy: A consistent dividend policy may affect the size of working capital. When some amount of
working capital is financed out of the internal generation of funds such affect will be there. The relationship
between dividend policy and working capital is well established and very few companies declare dividend
without giving due consideration to its effects on cash and their needs for cash.
If the dividend is to be declared in cash, such outflow reduces working capital and therefore, most of the
business concerns declare dividend now-a-days in the form of bonus shares as such retain their cash. A shortage
of working capital acts as powerful reason for reducing or skipping cash dividend.
8. Price Level Changes: The changes in prices make the functions of a finance manager difficult. The anticipations
of future price level changes are necessary to avoid their affects on working capital of the firm. Generally,
rising price level will require a company to demand for more amount of working capital, because the same
level of current assets requires higher amount of working capital due to increased prices.
9. Operating Efficiency: The operating efficiency of a firm relates to its optimum utilisation of resources available
whether in any form of factor of production, say, capital, labour, material, machines etc.; If a company is
able to effectively operate its costs, its operating cycle is accelerated and requires relatively lessor amount of
working capital. On the other hand, if a firm is not able to utilise its resources properly will have slow operating
cycle and naturally requires higher amount of working capital.
10. Percentage of Profits and Appropriation out of Profits: The capacity of all the firms will not be same in
generating their profits. It is natural that some firms enjoy a dominant and monopoly positions due to the
quality of its products, reputations, goodwill etc. (for example Colgate Tooth Paste, Bata Chapels etc.,) and
some companies will not have such position due to poor quality and other inherent hazards.
The company policy of retaining or distribution of profits will also affect the working capital. More appropriation
out of profits than distribution of profit necessarily reduces the requirements of working capital.
11. Other Factors: Apart from the above general considerations, there may be some factors responsible for
determination of working capital which are inherent to the type of business. Some of such factors may be as
follows:
(a) General co-ordination and control of the activities in the organisation.
(b) Absence of specialisation of products and their advantages.
(c) Market facilities.
(d) Means of transport and communication system.
(e) Sector in which the firm works i.e., private or public sector etc.
(f) Government policy as regard to: (i) Imports and Exports
(g) Tax considerations.
(h) Availability of labour and its organisation.
(i) Area in which it is situated such as backward, rural sub-urban, etc.,
Time
Figure 6.1: Types of working capital on the basis of Nature
Cash
Debtors &
Raw
Bills
Materials
Receivable
Work-in-
Sales Progress
(WIP)
Finished
Products
In case of trading concerns, the operating cycle will be: Cash → Stock → Debtors → Cash.
DEBTORS CASH
STOCK
In case of financial concerns, the operating cycle will be: Cash → Debtors → Cash only.
DEBTORS CASH
Gross operating cycle = Inventory conversion period (ICP) + Debtors conversion period (DCP)
GOC = I CP + DCP
Net operating cycle (NOC) is the difference between gross operating cycle and payables deferral period. Net
operating cycle = Gross operating cycle (GOC) – Creditors deferral period (CDP).
It is obvious from the above that the time gap between the sales and their actual realisation of cash is technically
termed as Operating Cycle or Working Capital Cycle.
The period of working capital cycle may differ from one business enterprise to the Students Note: Some
other depending upon the nature of the enterprise and its activities. It means the pattern authors consider 12
of working capital cycle do change according to its activities. months = 360 days
12 months/365 days
(ii) Work-in- Progress (WIP) Inventory
The relevant costs to determine work-in-process inventory are the proportionate share of cost of raw materials
and conversion costs such as labour and manufacturing overhead costs excluding depreciation. Depreciation
is excluded as it does not involve any cash expenditure.
12 months/365 days
(iii) Finished Goods Inventory
Working capital required to finance the finished goods inventory is given below:
Cost of goods
Budgeted Finished goods
productions × produced per
× holding period
unit (excluding
(in units) (months or days)
depreciation)
12 months/365 days
(iv) Debtors
The working capital included in debtors should be estimated in relation to total cost price (excluding
depreciation)
12 months/365 days
(v) Cash and Bank Balances
Apart from working capital needs for financing inventories and debtors, firms also find it useful to have some
minimum cash balances with them. It is difficult to lay down the exact procedure of determining such an
amount. This would primarily be based on the motives for holding cash balances of the business firm, attitude
of management toward risk, the access to the borrowing sources in times of need and past experience, and so
on.
12 months/365 days
(ii) Direct Wages
12 months/365 days
(iii) Overheads
12 months/365 days
12 months/365 days
Illustration 1
PQR Ltd. produces a product with the following revenue cost structure:
Solution:
Statement showing estimate of Working Capital
Illustration 2
A and B Ltd is desired to purchase a business and has consulted you, and one point on which you are asked to
advise them, is the average amount of working capital which will be required in the first year’s working.
You are given the following estimates and instructed to add 12 % to your computed figure to allow for contingencies.
Solution:
Statement to determine Net Working Capital for AB Ltd.
Particulars Amount (`)
(a) Current assets:
(i) Stocks of finished product 6,000
(ii) Stock of stores and materials 7,000
(iii) Debtors:
Inland sales (` 3,12,000 × 6/52) 36,000
Export sales (78,000 × 1.5/52) 2,250
(iv) Advance payment of sundry expenses (8,000 × 1/4) 2,000
Total investment in current assets 53,250
(b) Current liabilities:
(i) Wages (`2,60,000 × 1.5/52) 7,500
(ii) Stock and materials (` 52,000 × 1.5/12) 6,500
(iii) Rent and royalties (` 12,000 × 6/12) 6,000
(iv) Clerical staff (` 62,400 × 0.5/12) 2,600
(v) Manager (` 4,800 × 0.5/12) 200
(vi) Miscellaneous expenses (` 52,000 × 1.5/12) 6,500
Total estimate of current liabilities 29,300
(c) Net working capital
(i) Current assets - Current liabilities (a - b) 23,950
(ii) Add: 12% contingency allowance 2,874
Average amount of working capital required 26,824
Assumptions:
(i) A time period of 52 weeks / 12 months has been assumed in year.
(ii) Undrawn profit has been ignored in the working capital computation for the following reasons:
(a) For the purpose of determining working capital provided by net profit, it is necessary to adjust the net
profit for income tax and dividends / drawings, and so on.
(b) Profit need not always be a source of financing working capital. It may be used for other purposes like
purchase of fixed assets, payment of long-term loans, and so on. Since the firm does not seem to have such
uses, ` 10,000 may be treated as source of working capital. But the net working capital will not change.
(iii) Actual working capital requirement would be more than what is estimated here as the cash component of
current assets is not known.
Illustration 3
A company has prepared its annual budget, relevant details of which are reproduced below:
(a) Sales ` 46.80 lakhs (25% cash sales and balance on credit) 78,000 units
(b) Raw material cost 60% of sales value
(c) Labour cost ` 6 per unit
(d) Variable overheads ` 1 per unit
(e) Fixed overheads ` 5 lakhs (including
` 1,10,000 as depreciation)
Prepare the working capital budget for a year for the company, making whatever assumptions that you may find
necessary.
Solution:
Unit Selling Price and Cost (`)
Selling price ( ` 46,80,000 ÷ 78,000) 60
Cost:
Raw materials (60% of ` 46,80,000 ÷ 78,000) 36
Labour 6
Variable overheads 1
Fixed overheads (excluding depreciation) 5
Total cost per unit 48
Illustration 4
A company plans to manufacture and sell 400 units of a domestic appliance per month at a price of ` 600 each. The
ratio of costs to selling price are as follows:
Illustration 5
(a) From the following details, prepare an estimate of the requirement of Working Capital:
Wages and overheads are paid at the beginning of the month following. In production, all the required materials
are charged in the initial stage and wages and overheads accrue evenly.
(b) What is the effect of double shift working on the requirement of working capital?
Solution:
(a) Computation of requirement of Working Capital
Annual production 60,000 units
Monthly production 5,000 units
Unit Cost Sheet
Particulars (`)
Selling price 5.00
Cost of Raw Material 60% of ` 5 = ` 3.00
Wages 10% of ` 5 = ` 0.50
Overheads 20% of ` 5 = ` 1.00
Total cost per unit 4.50
Profit per unit 0.50
Cash 20,000
Total Current Assets (A) 2,11,250
On the basis of above assumptions, the following capital requirement is estimated as follows:
Work in Progress:
Raw materials 1 15,000
3 × 60,000 ×
12
Wages and Overheads 1 1 3,125 18,125
**1.25 × 60,000 × ×
12 2
Stock of finished Goods 3 1,27,500
4.25 × 1,20,000 ×
12
Debtors (on sales) 3 1,50,000
5.00 × 1,20,000 ×
12
Cash (double) 40,000
Total Current Assets (A) 3,85,625
Working Capital required for two shifts: (A-B) = ` 3,85,625 – ` 72,500 = ` 3,13,125
Therefore, additional working capital required for second shift = ` 3,13,125 – ` 1,73,750 = ` 1,39,375
** Calculation of Cost per unit
Illustration 6
Solaris Ltd. sells goods in domestic market at a gross profit of 25%, not counting on depreciation as a part of the
‘cost of goods sold’. Its estimates for next year are as follows:
Amounts ` In lakhs
Sales - Home at 1 month’s credit 1,200
Exports at 3 months’ credit, selling price 10 %below home price 540
Materials used (suppliers extend 2 months’ credit) 450
Wages paid, ½ month in arrears 360
Manufacturing expenses, paid 1 month in arrears 540
Administrative expenses, paid 1 month in arrears 120
Sales promotion expenses (payable quarterly - in advance) 60
Income - tax payable in 4 instalments of which one falls in the next financial year 150
The company keeps 1 month’s stock of each of raw materials and finished goods and believes in keeping ` 20
lakh as cash. Assuming a 15% safety margin, ascertain the estimated working capital requirement of the company
(ignore work -in-process).
Solution:
Statement showing determination of Working Capital (Amount in ` lakhs)
Current Assets (`) Computation
Cash 20.00
Raw Materials 37.50 (450 lakh / 12)
Finished Goods 122.50 (1,470 lakh / 12)
Debtors-Domestic market 100.00 (1,200 / 12 )
Export Market 135.00 (540 × 3 / 12)
Sales Promotion Expense 15.00 (60 lakh × 3 / 12)
Total Current Assets (A) 430.00
Current Liabilities (`)
Raw Materials (450 × 2 / 12) 75.00
Wages (360 / 24) 15.00
Manufacturing Expenses (540 /12) 45.00
Administration Expenses (120/12) 10.00
Total Current Liabilities (B) 145.00
Net Current Assets (A-B) 285.00
Add: Safety Margin @ 15% 42.75
Working Capital Requirement 327.75
Working notes:
1. Cost of Production
` in lakhs
Illustration 7
Camellia Industries Ltd. is desirous of assessing its Working Capital requirements for the next year. The finance
manager has collected the following information for the purpose.
The product is subject to excise duty of 10% (levied on cost of production) and is sold at ` 300 per unit.
Additional information:
i. Budgeted level of activity is 1,20,000 units of output for the next year.
ii. Raw material cost consists of the following:
Pig iron 65 per unit
Ferro alloys 15 per unit
Cast iron borings 10 per unit
iii. Raw materials are purchased from different suppliers, extending different credit period. Pig iron 2 months
Ferro alloys ½ months
Cast iron borings 1 month.
iv. Product is in process for a period of 1/2 month. Production process requires full unit (100 %) of pig iron and
ferroalloys in beginning of production. Cast iron boring is required only to the extent of 50 % in the beginning
and the remaining is needed at a uniform rate during the process. Direct labour and other overheads accrue
similarly at a uniform rate throughout production process.
v. Past trends indicate that the pig iron is required to be stored for 2 months and other materials for 1 month.
vi. Finished goods are in stock for a period of 1 month.
vii. It is estimated that one-fourth of total sales are on cash basis and the remaining sales are on credit. The past
experience of the firm has been to collect the credit sales in 2 months.
viii. Average time-lag in payment of all overheads is 1 month and ½ month in the case of direct labour.
ix. Desired cash balance is to be maintained at ` 10 lakh.
You are required to determine the amount of net working capital of the firm. State your assumptions, if any.
Solution:
Determination of Net Working Capital of Camelia Industries Ltd.
R
eceivables refers the book debts or debtors owed to the firm by customers arising from sale of goods
or services in the ordinary course of business. These constitute an important component of the current
assets of a firm. However, debt involves an element of risk and bad debts also. Hence, it calls for careful
analysis the important dimensions of the efficient management of receivables within the framework of a
firm’s objectives of value maximization. The goal of receivables management is to maximize the value of the firm
by achieving a tradeoff between risk and profitability.
Profitability
Liquidity
Loose
Tight Credit Policy
Figure 6.5: Optimum credit policy (Trade off between liquidity and profitability)
Comment:
The Policy should be adopted since net benefits under this policy are higher as compared to other policies.
(i) Total Fixed Cost = [Average Cost per unit - Variable Cost per unit] × No. of units sold on credit under Present
Policy
(ii) Opportunity Cost
Collection Period (Days) Required Rate of Return
Total Cost of Credit Sales × ×
365 (or 360) 100
Illustration 8
XYZ Corporation whose current sales are in the region of `6 lakh per annum and an average collection period of
30 days wants to pursue a more liberal policy to improve sales. A study made by a management consultant reveals
the following information;
The selling price per unit is ` 3. Average cost per unit is ` 2.25 and variable costs per unit are ` 2. The current
bad debt loss is 1%. Required return on additional investment is 20%. Assume a 360 days year. Which of the above
policies would you recommend for adoption?
Solution:
A. Statement showing the Evaluation of Debtors Policies (Total Approach)
Working Notes:
(i) Fixed Cost = [Average Cost per unit - Variable Cost per unit] × No. of units sold
Total Cost of Credit Sales × Collection period (Days) × Required Rate of Return
365 ( or 360) 100
Present Policy = (4,50,000 × 30 / 360) × (20 / 100) = ` 7,500
(B) Another method of solving the problem is Incremental Approach. Here we assume that sales are all
credit sales.
Recommendation: The Proposed Policy ‘A’ should be adopted since the Expected Rate of Return (44.49%) is
more than the Required Rate of Return (20%) and is the highest among the given policies compared.
Illustration 9
ABC Corporation is considering relaxing its present credit policy and is in the process of evaluating two proposed
policies. Currently the firm has annual credit sales of ` 50 lakhs and accounts receivable turnover ratio of 4 times
a year. The current level of loss due to bad debts is `1,50,000. The firm is required to give a return of 25% on the
investment in new accounts receivables. The company’s variable costs are 70% of the selling price. Given the
following information, which is the better option?
(Amount in `)
Solution:
Statement showing the Evaluation of Debtors Policies
Recommendation: The Proposed Policy ‘I’ should be adopted since the net benefits under this policy is higher
as compared to other policies.
Illustration 10
A firm is considering pushing up its sales by extending credit facilities to the following categories of customers:
(a) Customers with a 10% risk of non-payment, and
(b) Customers with a 30% risk of non-payment.
The incremental sales expected in case of category (a) are `40,000 while in case of category (b) they are `50,000.
The cost of production and selling costs are 60% of sales while the collection costs amount to 5% of sales in case
of category (a) and 10% of sales in case of category (b).
You are required to advise the firm about extending credit facilities to each of the above categories of customers.
Solution:
Evaluation of Credit Policies
Category (a) 10% Risk of Non-payment
Particulars (`)
Incremental sales 40,000
Less: Bad debts @ 10% 4,000
Sales realized 36,000
Less: Cost of production and selling cost (40,000 × 60%) 24,000
Less: Collection cost (40,000 × 5%) 2,000 26,000
Incremental profit 10,000
(`)
Incremental sales 50,000
Less: Bad debts @ 30% (50,000 × 30%) 15,000
Sales realized 35,000
Less: Cost of production and selling cost (50,000 × 60%) 30,000
Less: Collection cost (50,000 × 10%) 5,000 35,000
Incremental profit Nil
Comment: Advise to extend credit facility to category (a) customers alone.
A
substantial part of purchases of goods and services in business are on credit terms rather than against
cash payment. While the supplier of goods and services tend to perceive credit as a lever for enhancing
sales or as a form of non-price instrument of competition, the buyer tends to look upon it as a loaning
of goods or inventory. Generally, the supplier’s credit is referred to as Accounts Payable, Trade Credit,
Trade Bill, Trade Acceptance, Commercial Draft or Bills Payable depending on the nature of credit provided.
Payables or accounts payables are amounts due to vendors or suppliers for goods or services received that have
not yet been paid for. They are short- term deferments of cash payments that the buyer of goods and services is
allowed by the seller. Payables constitute current or short-term liabilities representing the buyer’s obligation to pay
a certain amount on a date in the near future for value of goods or services received. The sum of all outstanding
amounts owed to vendors or suppliers or third-party is shown as the accounts payable balance on the company’s
balance sheet.
Payables management is the handling of a company’s unpaid debts to third-party vendors for purchases made on
credit. Account payables management involves tasks such as seeking trade credit lines, acquiring favorable terms
of purchase, and managing the timing and flow of purchase.
open credit on the due date, the supplier may require a formal acknowledgement of debt and a commitment
of payment by a fixed date.
(c) Bills Payables: Bills Payables are instruments drawn by the seller and accepted by the buyer for payment
on the expiry of the specified duration. The bill will indicate the banker to whom the amount is to be paid
on the due date, and the goods will be delivered to the buyer against acceptance of the bill. The seller may
either retain the bill and present it for payment on the due date or may raise funds immediately thereon by
discounting it with the banker. The buyer will then pay the amount of the bill to the banker on the due date.
at a particular point of time. This has double advantages. For manufacturer, they can schedule production
more conveniently and reduce the inventory levels. Whereas, the buyer has the advantage of not having to
pay for the goods until the peak, of the selling period. Under this arrangement, credit is extended for a longer
period than normal.
Illustration 11
A supplier of X Ltd. offers the company 2/15 net 40 payment terms. To translate the shortened description of
the payment terms, the supplier will allow a 2% discount if paid within 15 days, or a regular payment in 40 days.
Determine the cost of credit related to these terms.
Solution:
Cost of credit can be calculated by using the following formula:
d 365 days
×
(100 − d ) t
Where,
d = Size of discount or discount percentage (%)
t = Allowed payment days – discount days
2 365 days
= ×
(100 − 2) 40 − 15
2 365 days
= ×
(98) 25
= 0.0204 × 14.4
= 0.29376
i.e., 29.4%
The above formula does not take into account the compounding effect and. So, the cost of credit shall be even
higher. The cost of lost cash discount can be estimated by the formula:
365
100 t
1
100 d
I
nventory constitutes an important item in the working capital of many business concerns. Net working capital
is the difference between current assets and current liabilities. Inventory is a major item of current assets. The
term inventory refers to the stocks of the product a firm is offering for sale and the components that make up
the product. Inventory is stores of goods and stocks. This includes raw materials, work-in-process and finished
goods. Raw materials consist of those units or input which are used to manufacture goods that require further
processing to become finished goods. Finished goods are products ready for sale. The classification of inventory
and the levels of the components vary from organisation to organisation depending upon the nature of business. For
example, steel is a finished product for a steel industry, but raw material for an automobile manufacturer.
Thus, inventory may be defined as “Stock of goods that is held for future use”. Since inventory constitute about
50 to 60 % of current assets, the management of inventories is crucial to successful Working Capital Management.
Working capital requirements are influenced by inventory holding. Hence, there is a need for effective and efficient
management of inventory A good inventory management is important to the successful operations of the most of
the organizations, unfortunately the importance of inventory is not always appreciated by top management. This
may be due to a failure to recognize the link between inventory and achievement of organisational goals or due to
ignorance of the impact that inventory can have on costs and profits. Inventory management refers to an optimum
investment in inventory. It should neither be too low to effect the production adversely nor too high to block the
funds unnecessarily. Excess investment in inventory is unprofitable for the business. Both excess and inadequate
investment in inventory is not desirable. The firm should operate within the two danger points. The purpose of
inventory management is to determine and maintain the optimum level of inventory investment.
The purpose of inventory management is to determine and maintain the optimum level of inventory investment.
Carrying Cost
Cost EOQ
Odering Cost
Quantity
Figure 6.6: Graphical Representation of EOQ
Illustration 12
Calculate the Economic Order Quantity from the following information. Also state the number of orders to be
placed in a year.
Consumption of materials per annum : 10,000 kg
Order placing cost per order : ` 50
Cost per kg. of raw materials : `2
Storage costs : 8% on average inventory
Solution:
2AO
Economic Ordering Quantity =
C
Where,
A = Annual demand
O = Ordering Cost
C = Carrying Cost
2 × 10, 000 × 50
EOQ = 2×8
100
2 × 10, 000 × 50 × 25
EOQ =
4
EOQ = 2,500 Kg
Total consumption of material per annum
No. of orders to be placed in a year =
EOQ
10,000 kg
= = 4 Orders per year
2,500 kg
Illustration 13
The average annual consumption of a material is 18,250 units at a price of `36.50 per unit. The storage cost is
20% on an average inventory and the cost of placing an order is ` 50. How much quantity is to be purchased at a
time?
Solution:
2AO
Economic Ordering Quantity =
C
Where,
A = Annual demand
O = Ordering Cost
C = Carrying Cost
EOQ = 18,25,000
√
7.3
B. Minimum Level:
The Minimum Level indicates the lowest quantitative balance of an item of material which must be
maintained at all times so that there is no stoppage of production due to the material being not available.
In fixing the minimum level, the following factors are to be considered: -
(a) Nature of the item: For special material purchased against customer’s specific orders, no minimum level
is necessary. This applies to other levels also.
(b) The minimum time (normal re-order period) required replenishing supply: This is known as the Lead
Time and are defined as the anticipated time lag between the dates of issuing orders and the receipt of
materials. Longer the lead time, lower is minimum level, the re-order point remaining constant.
(c) Rate of consumption (normal, minimum or maximum) of the material.
Minimum Level
Re-Order level – (Normal Rate of Consumption × Normal Re-Order Period)
C. Re-Order Level:
When the stock in hand reaches the ordering or re-ordering level, store keeper has to initiate the action
for replenish the material. This level is fixed somewhere between the maximum and minimum levels in
such a manner that the difference of quantity of the material between the Re-ordering Level and Minimum
Level will be sufficient to meet the requirements of production up to the time the fresh supply of material is
received.
The basic factors which are taken into consideration in fixing a Re-ordering Level for a store item include
minimum quantity of item to be kept, rate of consumption and lead time which are applied for computing of
this level.
Re-Ordering level
Minimum Level + Consumption during lead time
Or
Minimum Level + (Normal Rate of Consumption × Normal Re-order Period)
Another formula for computing the Re-Order level is as below:
Re-Order level
Maximum Rate of Consumption × Maximum Re-Order period (lead time)
D. Danger Level
It is the level at which normal issue of raw materials are stopped and only emergency issues are only made.
This is a level fixed usually below the Minimum Level. When the stock reaches this level very urgent
action for purchases is indicated. This presupposed that the minimum level contains a cushion to cover such
contingencies. The normal lead time cannot be afforded at this stage. It is necessary to resort to unorthodox
hasty purchase procedure resulting in higher purchase cost.
The practice in some firms is to fix danger level below the Re-Ordering Level but above the Minimum Level.
In such case, if action for purchase of an item was taken when the stock reached the Re-Ordering Level, the
Danger Level is of no significance except that a check with the purchases department may be made as soon
as the Danger Level is reached to ensure that everything is all right and that delivery will be made on the
scheduled date.
Danger Level
Normal Rate of Consumption × Maximum reorder Period for emergency purchases
Illustration 14
The components A and B are used as follows:
Normal usage............................................300 units per week each
Maximum usage.......................................450 units per week each
Minimum usage........................................150 units per week each
Reorder Quantity............................A- 2,400 units; B- 3,600 units.
Reorder period........................... A -4 to 6 weeks, B -2 to 4 weeks.
Particulars A B
(a) Reorder Level (ROL) 2,700 units 1,800 units
[Max. Consumption × Max. Re-order Period] (450 × 6) (450 × 4)
(b) Minimum Level
[ROL – (Normal Consumption × Normal Re- 1,200 units 900 units
order period)] [2,700 – (300×5)] [1,800 – (300 × 3)]
(c) Maximum Level
[ROL + ROQ – (Min. Consumption × Min. Re- 4,500 units 5,100 units
order Period)] [2,700 + 2400 – (150×4)] [1,800 + 3,600 – (150 × 2)]
(d) Average Stock Level 2,850 units 3,000 units
[Min. Level + Max. Level] / 2 [4,500 + 1,200 / 2] [5,100 + 900 / 2]
Or (or) (or)
[Min. Level + ½ Re-order Quantity] 2,400 units 2,700 units
1,200 + ½ (2,400) 900 + ½ (3,600)
3. ABC Analysis:
The “ABC Analysis” is an analytical method of stock control which aims at concentrating efforts on those
items where attention is needed most. It is based on the concept that a small number of the items in inventory
may typically represent the bulk money value of the total materials used in production process, while a
relatively large number of items may present a small portion of the money value of stores used resulting in
a small number of items be subjected to greater degree of continuous control.
Under this system, the materials stocked may be classified into a number of categories according to their
importance, i.e., their value and frequency of replenishment during a period. The first category (we may call
it group ‘A’ items) may consist of only a small percentage of total items handled but combined value may be
a large portion of the total stock value. The second category, naming it as group ‘B’ items, may be relatively
less important. In the third category, consisting of group ‘C’ items, all the remaining items of stock may be
included which are quite large in number but their value is not high.
This concept may be clear by the following example:
Category ‘A’ items represent 70% of the total investment but as little as only 6% of the number of items.
Maximum control must be exercised on these items. Category ‘B’ is of secondary importance and normal control
procedures may be followed. Category ‘C’ comprising of 64% in quantity but only 10% in value, needs a simpler,
less elaborate and economic system of control.
(e) As the work is carried out systematically and without undue haste the figures are readily available.
(f) Actual stock can be compared with the authorized maximum and minimum levels, thus keeping the
stocks within the prescribed limits. The disadvantages of excess stocks are avoided and capitalised up in
stores materials cannot exceed the budget.
(g) The recorder level of various items of stores are readily available thus facilitating the work of procurement
of stores.
(h) For monthly or quarterly financial statements like Profit and Loss Account and Balance Sheet the stock
figures are readily available and it is not necessary to have physical verification of the balances.
5. VED Analysis
VED stands for Vital, Essential and Desirable- analysis is used primarily for control of spare parts. The spare
parts can be classified into three categories i.e Vital, Essential and Desirable- keeping in view the criticality
to production.
Vital: The spares, stock-out of which even for a short time will stop the production for quite some time, and
where in the stock-out cost is very high are known as Vital spares. For a car Assembly Company, Engine is
a vital part, without the engine the assembly activity will not be started.
Essential: The spares or material absence of which cannot be tolerated for more than few hours or a day and
the cost of lost production is high and which is essential for production to continue are known as Essential
items. For a car assembly company ‘Tyres’ is an essential item, without fixing the tyres the assembly of car
will not be completed.
Desirable: The Desirable spares are those parts which are needed, but their absence for even a week or more
also will not lead to stoppage of production. For example, CD player, for a car assembly company.
Some spares though small in value, may be vital for production, requires constant attention. Such spares
may not pay attention if the organization adopts ABC analysis.
6. FSN Analysis
FSN analysis is the process of classifying the materials based on their movement from inventory for a
specified period. All the items are classified in to F-Fast moving, S- Slow moving and N-Non-moving Items
based on consumption and average stay in the inventory. Higher the stay of item in the inventory, the slower
would be the movement of the material. This analysis helps the store keeper / purchase department to keep
the fast-moving items always available & take necessary steps to dispose off the non-moving inventory.
7. Just-in-Time (JIT)
Just in time (JIT) is a production strategy that strives to improve a business return on investment by reducing
in-process inventory and associated carrying costs. Inventory is seen as incurring costs, or waste, instead
of adding and storing value, contrary to traditional accounting. In short, the Just-in-Time inventory system
focuses on “the right material, at the right time, at the right place, and in the exact amount” without the safety
net of inventory.
The advantages of Just-in-Time system are as follows: -
(a) Increased emphasis on supplier relationships. A company without inventory does not want a supply
system problem that creates a part shortage. This makes supplier relationships extremely important.
(b) Supplies come in at regular intervals throughout the production day. Supply is synchronized with
production demand and the optimal amount of inventory is on hand at any time. When parts move
directly from the truck to the point of assembly, the need for storage facilities is reduced.
(c) Reduces the working capital requirements, as very little inventory is maintained.
(d) Minimizes storage space.
(e) Reduces the chance of inventory obsolescence or damage.
The purpose of the above ratio is to ascertain the speed of movement of a particular item. A high ratio
indicates that the item is moving fast with a minimum investment involved at any point of time. On the other
hand, a low ratio indicates the slow-moving item. Thus, Inventory Turnover Ratio may indicate slow moving
dormant and obsolete stock highlighting the need for appropriate managerial actions.
Illustration 15
Compute the Inventory Turnover Ratio from the following:
Opening Stock - `1,00,000
Closing Stock - `1,60,000
Material Consumed - `7,80,000
Solution:
Value of material consumed during the period
Inventory Turnover Ratio =
Value of average stock held during the period
= ` 1,30,000
` 7,80,000
∴ Inventory Turnover Ratio =
` 1,30,000
= 6.
Illustration 16
Two components A and B are used as follows:
Normal usage = 50 per week each
Re-order quantity = A- 300; B-500
Maximum usage = 75 per week each
Particulars A B
(a) Reorder Level 450 units 300 units
[Max. Consumption × Max. Re-order Period] (75 × 6) (75 × 4)
(b) Minimum Level
[ROL – (Normal Consumption × Normal Re-order 200 units 150 units
period)] [450 – (50 × 5)] [300 – (50 × 3)]
(c) Maximum Level
[ROL + ROQ – (Min. Consumption × Min Re-order 650 units 750 units
period)] [450 + 300 – (25 × 4)] [300 + 500 – (25 × 2)]
(d) Average Stock Level 425 units 450 units
[Min. Level + Max. Level] / 2 [200 + 650 / 2] (or) [150 + 750 / 2] (or)
or or or
[Min. Level + ½ × ROQ] 350 units 400 units
200 + ½ (300) 150 + ½ (500)
Illustration 17
X Ltd. buys its annual requirement of 36,000 units in six installments. Each unit costs `1 and the ordering cost
is `25. The inventory carrying cost is estimated at 20% of unit value. Find the total annual cost of the existing
inventory policy. How much money can be saved by using E.O.Q?
Solution:
2AO
Economic Ordering Quantity =
C
Where,
A = Annual demand
O = Ordering Cost
C = Carrying Cost
2 36, 000 ` 25
EOQ
` 1 20%
Illustration 18
The annual demand for an item is 3,200 units. The unit cost is `6 and inventory carrying charges is 25% p.a. If
the cost of one procurement is `150, determine:
(a) E.O.Q (b) No. of orders per year (c) Time between two consecutive orders.
Solution:
2AO
(a) Economic Ordering Quantity =
C
EOQ =
√ 2 × `63,200 × `150
× 25%
EOQ = 9,60,000
√ 1.5
EOQ = 800 units
A company manufactures a special product which requires a component ‘Alpha’. The following particulars are
collected for the year 2021.
Solution:
(a) Calculation of Economic Order Quantity
2AO
Economic Ordering Quantity =
C
2 8, 000 ` 200
EOQ
` 400 20%
T
he term “Cash” with reference to management of cash is used in two ways. In a narrow sense, cash refers
to coins, currency, cheques, drafts and deposits in banks. The broader view of cash includes near cash
assets such as marketable securities and time deposits in banks. The reason why these near cash assets
are included in cash is that they can readily be converted into cash. Usually, excess cash is invested in
marketable securities as it contributes to profitability.
Cash is one of the most important components of current assets. Every firm should have adequate cash, neither
more nor less. Inadequate cash will lead to production interruptions, while excessive cash remains idle and will
impair profitability. Hence, there is a need for cash management. It is concerned with the managing of (i) cash
inflows and outflows of the firm; (ii) cash flows within the firm and (iii) cash balances held by the firm at a point of
time by financing deficit or investing surplus cash.
three motives for holding cash such as (i) Transaction motives; (ii) Precautionary motives and (iii) Speculative
motives. These are discussed below:
(i) Transaction Motives: A firm needs cash for making transactions in the day-to-day operations. The cash is
needed to make payments for purchases, wages, salaries, other expenses, taxes, dividend, etc. The need to
hold cash would not arise if there were perfect synchronisation between cash receipts and cash payments.
When cash payments exceed cash receipts, the firm would maintain some cash balance to be able to
make required payments. For transactions purpose, a firm may invest its cash in marketable securities.
Generally, the firm will purchase securities whose maturity corresponds with some anticipated payments
whose timing is not perfectly matched with cash receipts.
(ii) Precautionary Motives: Precautionary motive refers to hold cash as a safety margin to act as a financial
reserve. In addition to the non-synchronization of anticipated cash inflows and outflows in the ordinary
course of business, a firm may have to pay cash for purposes which cannot be predicted or anticipated. A
firm may have to face emergencies such as strikes and lock-up from employees, increase in cost of raw
materials, funds and labor, fall in market demand and so on. But how much cash is held against these
emergencies depends on the degree of predictability associated with future cash flows. If there is high
degree of predictability, less cash balance is sufficient. Some firms may have strong borrowing capacity at
a very short notice, so that they can borrow at the time when emergencies occur. Such a firm may hold very
minimum amount of cash for this motive.
(iii) Speculative Motives: It refers to the need to hold cash in order to be able to take advantage of
negotiating purchases that might happen, appealing interest rates and positive exchange rate fluctuations.
Some firms hold cash in excess than transaction and precautionary needs to involve in speculation.
The advantages of speculative motives for holding cash are:
(a) An opportunity to purchase raw materials a reduced price on payment of immediate cash;
(b) Delay purchases of raw materials on the anticipation of a decline in price;
(c) A chance to speculate on interest rate movements by buying securities when interest rates are expected
to decline; and
(d) Make a purchase at a favorable price.
Besides, another motive to hold cash balance is to compensate banks for providing certain services and
loans.
(iv) Compensating Motives: Banks provide a variety of services to business firms such as clearance of cheque,
credit information, transfer of funds and so on. Bank either charge commission, fees for these services
or seek indirect compensation. Usually, clients are required to maintain a minimum balance of cash to
the bank. This balance is called compensating balance. Firms cannot utilize this balance for transaction
purposes, rather banks can use this amount to earn a return.
C= 2A × F
O
Where,
C = Optimum cash balance
A = Annual (or monthly) cash disbursement
F = Fixed cost per transaction
O = Opportunity cost of one rupee per annum (or per month)
(iii) Similarly, the firms cannot predict their daily cash inflows and outflows.
(iv) Degree of uncertainty is high is predicting the cash flow transactions. Behaviour of cash inflow and out
flow is assumed to be too smooth and certain. Cash inflow and outflow of businesses are too erratic. Dail
cash balance may fluctuate, leading to an unpredictable pattern of cash flow. Thus, at no point an ideal
optimum cash balance C be maintained practically.
(v) The model merely suggests only the optimal balance under a set of assumptions. But in actual situation it
may not hold good. Nevertheless, it does offer a conceptual framework and can be used with caution as a
benchmark.
Illustration 20
The outgoings of X Ltd. are estimated to be ` 5,00,000 p.a., spread evenly throughout the year. The money
on deposit earns 12% p.a. more than money in a current account. The switching costs per transaction are `150.
Calculate to optimum amount to be transferred.
Solution:
According to Baumol, the optimum amount to be transferred each time is ascertained as follows:
2AF
C=
O
Where, C = Optimum transaction size
A = Estimate cash outgoings per annum i.e., ` 5,00,000
F = Fixed Cost per transaction i.e., ` 150
O = Opportunity cost of one rupee per annum = Interest rate on fixed deposit i.e. 12% p.a.
Illustration 21
ABC Ltd. has an estimated cash payments of `8,00,000 for a one-month period and the payments are expected to
steady over the period. The fixed cost per transaction is `250 and the interest rate on marketable securities is 12%
p.a. Calculate the optimum transaction size.
Solution:
The optimum transaction size will be calculated as under:
2AF
C=
O
Where, A = Estimate monthly cash payment i.e., ` 8,00,000
F = Cost per transaction i.e., ` 250
O = Interest per annum i.e., 12%p.a. (For one month, the rate of interest is 1% or 0.01)
X Upper limit
Z Return point
Y Lower limit
Time
Cash Balance
Figure 6.7: Stochastic (Miller-Orr) Model
The difference between the upper limit and the lower limit depends on the following factors:
(a) Transaction costs (c)
(b) Interest rate (k)
(c) Standard deviation of the net cash flows
The optimal point of cash balance (Z) is determined by using the formula:
1
3 cσ 2 3
Z ×
=
4 k
Where,
Z = Target cash balance (Optimal cash balance)
c = Transaction cost
k = Interest rate
σ = Standard deviation of net cash flows.
It is observed from the above that the upper and lower limits will be far off from each other, if transaction cost is
higher or cash flows show greater fluctuations. The limits will come closer as the interest increases. Z is inversely
related to the interest rate. The upper and lower control limits can be shown:
Upper limit = Lower limit + Z
Return Point = Lower limit + Z
Limitations: This model is subjected to some practical problems
(i) The first and important problem is in respect of collection of accurate data about transfer costs, holding costs,
number of transfers and expected average cash balance.
(ii) The cost of time devoted by financial managers in dealing with the transfers of cash to securities and vice
versa.
(iii) The model does not take into account the short-term borrowings as an alternative to selling of marketable
securities when cash balance reaches lower limit.
Besides the practical difficulties in the application of the model, the model helps in providing more, better and
quicker information for management of cash. It was observed that the model produced considerable cost savings
in the real-life situations.
Illustration 22
The management of X Ltd. has a policy of maintaining a minimum cash balance of `5,00,000. The standard
deviation of the company’s daily cash flows is `2,00,000. The annual interest rate is 14%. The transaction cost of
buying or selling securities is `150 per transaction. Determine the upper control limit and the return point cash
balance of X Ltd. as per the Miller-Orr Model.
Solution:
The optimal point of cash balance (Z) is determined by using the formula:
1
3 cσ 2 3
Z ==
Z ×
4 k
Where,
Z = Target cash balance (Optimal cash balance)
c = Transaction cost
k = Interest rate
σ = Standard deviation of net cash flows.
1
3 150 × 2, 00, 000 3
Z ×
= = ` 2 22,227
4 0.14 / 365
(b) Strategy for slowing cash outflows: In order to accelerate cash availability in the company, finance
manager must employ some devices that could slow down the speed of payments outward in addition to
accelerating collections. The methods of slowing down disbursements are as follows:
(i) Delaying outward payment;
(ii) Making pay roll periods less frequent;
(iii) Solving disbursement by use of drafts;
(iv) Playing the float;
(v) Centralised payment system;
(vi) By transferring funds from one bank to another bank firm can maximize its cash turnover.
Illustration 23
United Industries Ltd. projects that cash outlays of ` 37,50,000 will occur uniformly throughout the coming
year. United plans to meet its cash requirements by periodically selling marketable securities from its portfolio.
The firm’s marketable securities are invested to earn 12% and the cost per transaction of converting securities to
cash is ` 40.
(a) Use the Baumol Model to determine the optimal transaction size of marketable securities to cash.
(b) What will be the company’s average cash balance?
(c) How many transfers per year will be required?
(d) What will be the total annual cost of maintaining cash balances?
Solution:
(a) Optimal size = 2FA = 2×40×37,50,000 = 50,000
√0 √
(b) Average cash balance = `25,000
0.12
Solution:
The optimal point of cash balance (Z) is determined by using the formula:
1
3 cσ 2 3
Z ×
Z= =
4 k
Where,
L
ong-term sources of finance primarily support fixed assets and secondarily provide the margin money
for working capital. Whereas, short-term sources of finance more or less exclusively support the current
assets. The need for working capital financing mainly because the investment in working capital/current
assets i.e., raw materials, work-in-progress, finished goods and receivables which are typically fluctuates
during the year. The main sources of working capital finance are shown below in a diagram:
Sources of Working
Capital Financing
The two important sources of finance for working capital are: (a) trade credit and (ii) bank credit or borrowings.
Other sources of finance for working capital are (c) factoring and (d) commercial paper.
(a) Trade Credit
Trade credit represents the credit extended by the supplier of goods and services. In practice, the purchasing
firms do not have to pay cash immediately for the purchase made. This deferral of payments is a short-term
financing that is called trade credit. Trade credit arises in the normal transactions of the firm without specific
negotiations, provided the firm is considered creditworthy by its supplier. It is an important source of finance
representing 25% to 50% of short-term financing in different industries. Trade credit is mostly an informal
arrangement and is granted on an open account basis. Open account trade credit appears as sundry creditors
known as accounts payable. Trade credit may also take the form of bills payable.
(b) Bank Credit/ Borrowings
Working capital advances by commercial banks represents the most important source for financing current
assets. In India, banks may give financial assistance in different shapes and forms. The usual form of bank
credits are as follows:
(i) Overdraft
(ii) Cash Credit
(iii) Loans
(d) Factoring
Factoring, as a fund based financial service, provides resources to finance receivables as well as facilities
the collection of receivables. It is another method of raising short-term finance through accounts receivable
credit offered by commercial banks and factors. A commercial bank may provide finance by discounting
the bills or invoices of its customers. Thus, a firm gets immediate payment for sales made on credit. A
factor is a financial institution which offers services relating to management and financing of debts arising
out of credit sales. Factoring is becoming popular all over the world on account of various services offered
by the institutions engaged in it. Factors render services varying from bill discounting facilities offered by
commercial banks to a total take-over of administration of credit sales including maintenance of sales ledger,
collection of accounts receivables, credit control and protection from bad debts, provision of finance and
rendering of advisory services to their clients. Factoring, may be on a recourse basis, where the risk of bad
debts is borne by the client, or on a non-recourse basis, where the risk of credit is borne by the factor.
At present, factoring in India is rendered by only a few financial institutions on a recourse basis. However,
the Report of the Working Group on Money Market (Vaghul Committee) constituted by the Reserve Bank
of India has recommended that banks should be encouraged to set up factoring divisions to provide speedy
finance to the corporate entities.
In spite of many services offered by factoring, it suffers from certain limitations. The most critical fall outs
of factoring include (i) the high cost of factoring as compared to other sources of short-term finance, (ii) the
perception of financial weakness about the firm availing factoring services, and (iii) adverse impact of tough
stance taken by factor, against a defaulting buyer, upon the borrower resulting into reduced future sales.
(iv) Style of credit: The Committee reviewed the deficiencies of lending system also suggested a change in
the style of bank lending. The Committee recommended the bifurcation of total credit limit into fixed and
fluctuating parts. The fixed component was to be treated as a demand loan for the year representing the
minimum level of borrowings, which the borrower expected to use throughout the year. The fluctuating
component was to be taken care of by a demand cash credit. The cash credit portion could be partly used
by way of bills.
(v) Information system: Another important recommendation of the Tandon Committee related to the flow of
information from the borrower to the bank. The Committee argued for the greater flow of information, both
for operational purposes and for the purpose of supervision and follow-up credit. Information was sought
to be provided in three loans—operating statement, quarterly budget and funds flow statement.
The Tandon Committee Report has been widely debated and criticized. At the same time, it is true that bankers
found difficulties in implementing the committee’s recommendations. However, the Tandon Committee report has
brought about a perceptible change in the outlook and attitude of both the bankers and their customers. The report
has helped in bringing a financial discipline through a balanced and integrated scheme for bank lending.
Second Method
In the second method, the borrower will contribute 25% of the total current assets. The remaining of the working
capital gap (i.e., the working capital gap less the borrower’s contribution) can be bridged from the bank borrowings.
This method will give a current ratio of 1.3:1.
The permissible bank borrowings with an example of above two methods are shown below:
Third Method
In the third method, borrower will contribute 100 % of core assets, as defined and 25 % of the balance of
current assets. The remaining of the working capital gap can be met from the borrowings. This method will further
strengthen the current ratio.
After introducing the new system of lending, in some cases the net working capital was negative while in others
it was equal to 25% of working capital gap. Then the Committee allowed this deficiency to be financed, in addition
to the permissible bank finance, by banks. However, it was regularized over a period of time depending upon the
funds generating capacity and ability of the borrower. This type of credit facility was called working capital term
loan. Generally, the working capital term loan was not allowed to be raised in the subsequent years. For additional
credit requirement arising in subsequent years, the borrower’s long-term sources were required to provide 25% of
the additional working capital gap. The banks could grant regular term loans against fixed assets.
Illustration 25
Compute “Maximum Bank Borrowings” permissible under Method I, II & III of Tandon Committee norms from
the following figures and comment on each method.
Solution:
As per Tandon Committee norms -
Method 1
Under Method 1 the proprietor should contribute 25% of Working Capital Gap from their long-term source of
finance and the balance is the Maximum Permissible Bank Borrowings.
In the given problem -
Particulars ` in lakh
Particulars ` in lakh
Particulars ` in lakh
Comment: Maximum permissible bank borrowings under method 3 is ` 112 lakh. But existing bank borrowing
is ` 400 lakh.
Therefore, the excess bank borrowings of ` 288 lakhs convert into term loan.
Chore Committee Report
In April 1979, the Reserve Bank of India constituted a working group to review the system of cash credit under
the chairmanship of Mr. K.B. Chore. The main terms of reference for the group were to review the cash credit
system and suggest modifications and/or alternate types of credit facilities to promote greater credit discipline and
relate credit limits to production. The major recommendations of the Committee are as follows:
(i) Reduced dependence on bank credit: Borrowers should contribute more funds to finance their working
capital requirements, and reduce dependence on bank credit. Therefore, the group recommended firms to be
placed in the second method of lending as explained by the Tandon Committee. In case the borrower was
unable to comply with this requirement immediately, he would be granted excess borrowing in the form of
working capital term loan (WCTL). WCTL should be repaid in semi-annual instalments for a period not
exceeding five years and at a higher rate of interest than under the cash credit system would be charged.
(ii) Credit limit to be separated into ‘peak level’ and ‘normal non-peak level’ limits: Banks should appraise
and fix separate limits for the ‘peak level’ and ‘normal non-peak level’ credit requirements for all borrowers
in excess of `10 lakh, indicating the relevant periods. Within the sanctioned limits for these two periods the
borrower should indicate in advance, his need for funds during a quarter. Any deviation in utilization beyond
10% tolerance limit should be treated as an irregularity and appropriate action should be taken.
(iii) Existing lending system to continue: The existing system of three types of lending such as Cash credit,
loans and bills should continue. Cash credit system should, however, be replaced by loan and bills wherever
possible. Cash credit accounts in case of large borrowers should be scrutinized once in a year. Bifurcation
of cash credit account into demand loan and fluctuating cash credit component, practiced as per the Tandon
Committee recommendation should discontinue. Advances against book debts should be converted to bills
wherever possible and at least 50% of the cash credit limit utilized for financing purchase of raw material
inventory should also be changed to this bill system.
(iv) Information system: The discipline relating to the submission of quarterly statements to be obtained from
the borrowers, under the existing system, should be strictly adhered to in respect of all borrowers having
working capital limits of `50 lakhs and over from the banking system.
capital limit of not less than `5 crore, and the firm should be listed and it is required to obtain necessary credit
rating from credit rating agencies. The minimum current ratio should be 1.33:1. All issue expenses will be borne
by the issuing company. These norms imply that only the large, highly rated companies are able to operate in the
commercial paper market in India.
The Vaghul Working Group had recommended that the size of a single issue should be at least `1 crore and the
size of each commercial paper should not be less than `5 lakh. The RBI had provided for the minimum issue of `25
lakh (rather than `5 lakh as recommended by the Vaghul Committee)
Maturity Period
As per the RBI Guidelines, initially, corporates were permitted to issue CP with a maturity between a minimum
of three months and a maximum of upto six months from the date of issue. Since October 18, 1993, the maximum
maturity period of CP was increased to less than one year. Subsequently, the minimum maturity period had been
reduced from time to time and since May 25, 1998, it was reduced to 15 days. Presently, CP can be issued for
maturity period between a minimum of 15 days and a maximum upto one year from the date of issue.
In USA, there is no prescription of minimum and maximum maturity period of CP but for practical matter, it is
limited upto 270 days. However, 1-day to 7-day CPs are very popular of which 1-day CP constitutes the substantial
component of the CP market. In UK also, there is no restriction but in France, initial maturity ranges from 1 day
to upto 1 year.
Cost
Though the Reserve Bank of India regulates the issue of commercial paper, the market determines the interest
rate. In USA, the interest rate on a commercial paper is a function of prime lending rate, maturity, credit-worthiness
of the issuer and the rating of the paper provided by the rating agency.
In India, the cost of a CP will include the following components:
~ Discount
~ Rating charges
~ Stamp duty
~ Issuing and Paying Agent (IPA) charges
Interest rate on commercial paper is generally less than the bank borrowing rate. A firm does not pay interest
on commercial paper rather sells it at a discount rate from face value. The yield of commercial papers can be
calculated as follows:
Face value - Sale price 360 days
Interest yield = ×
Sale price Days of maturity
Suppose a firm sells 120-day commercial paper (`100 face value) for `96 net, the interest yield will be 12.5%.
` 100 − ` 96 360 days
Interest yield = ×
` 96 120 days
= 0.125
= 12.5%
Interest on CP is tax deductible: therefore, the after-tax interest will be less. Assuming that the firm’s marginal
tax rate is 35 %, the after-tax interest yield is 8.13%.
Therefore, interest yield after tax = 0.125 (1 – 0.35) = 0.0813 or 8.13%.
Illustration 26
XYZ Ltd. issued commercial paper as per the following details:
Date of issue 17th December, 2023
Date of Maturity 17th March, 2024
Size of issue `10 crore
No. of Days 90 Days
Interest rate 11.25%
Face value `100
What was the net amount received by the company on issue of commercial paper?
Solution:
Interest yield for investor of commercial paper
Face Value Net amount realised 360
Net amount realised Maturity period
100 Net amount realised 360
0.1125 days
Net amount realised 90
Or, Net amount realised = ` 9.73 crore
Thus, the company issues a commercial paper worth `10 crore and company receive `9.73 crore
Pre-shipment Finance:
This includes –
(i) Packing Credit, and
(ii) Advance against receivables from the Government like duty back, international price reimbursement scheme
(IPRS) etc.
Post-shipment Finance:
This consists of -
(i) Purchased/discounted/negotiated of export documents,
(ii) Advance against bills sent on collection basis,
(iii) Advance against exports on consignment basis,
(iv) Advance against indrawn balances, and
(v) Advance against receivables form the Government like duty draw back etc.
Pre-shipment Export Credit or Packing Credit
‘Pre-shipment / Packing Credit’ means any loan or advance granted or any other credit provided by a bank to an
exporter for financing the purchase, processing, manufacturing or packing of goods prior to shipment / working
capital expenses towards rendering of services on the basis of letter of credit opened in his favour or in favour of
some other person, by an overseas buyer or a confirmed and irrevocable order for the export of goods / services
from India or any other evidence of an order for export from India having been placed on the exporter or some
other person, unless lodgement of export orders or letter of credit with the bank has been waived. Packing credit
is sanctioned/granted on the basis of letter of credit or a confirmed and irrevocable order for the export of goods /
services from India or any other evidence of an order for export from India.
Pre-shipment Finance is issued by a financial institution when the seller wants the payment of the goods before
shipment. The main objectives behind pre-shipment finance or pre-export finance are to enable exporter to:
~ Procure raw materials.
~ Carry out manufacturing process.
~ Provide a secure warehouse for goods and raw materials.
~ Process and pack the goods.
~ Ship the goods to the buyers.
~ Meet other financial cost of the business.
Requirement of getting Packing Credit
This facility is provided to an exporter who satisfies the following criteria
~ A ten-digit importer/exporter code number allotted by DGFT.
~ Exporter should not be in the caution list of RBI.
~ If the goods to be exported are not under OGL (Open General Licence), the exporter should have the required
license /quota permit to export the goods.
Packing credit facility can be provided to an exporter on production of the following evidences to the bank:
● Formal application for release the packing credit with undertaking to the effect that the exporter would be
ship the goods within stipulated due date and submit the relevant shipping documents to the banks within
prescribed time limit.
● Firm order or irrevocable L/C or original cable / fax / telex message exchange between the exporter and the
buyer.
● Licence issued by DGFT if the goods to be exported fall under the restricted or canalized category. If the
item falls under quota system, proper quota allotment proof needs to be submitted.
The confirmed order received from the overseas buyer should reveal the information about the full name and
address of the overseas buyer, description quantity and value of goods (FOB or CIF), destination port and the last
date of payment.
Eligibility
Pre shipment credit is only issued to that exporter who has the export order in his own name. However, as an
exception, financial institution can also grant credit to a third-party manufacturer or supplier of goods who does not
have export orders in their own name.
In this case some of the responsibilities of meeting the export requirements have been out sourced to them by the
main exporter. In other cases where the export order is divided between two more than two exporters, pre shipment
credit can be shared between them.
Commercial invoice
Packing list
Certificate of origin
Inspection certificate
Insurance certificate
Import Export Code (IEC) certificate
Additionally, an original copy of the letter of credit is mandatory if credit has been availed under the letter
of credit
Apart from these documents, the lender might demand additional documents depending on the type of post-ship-
ment credit availed.
Solved Case 1
From the following projections of XYZ Ltd for the next year, you are required to work out the working capital
(WC) required by the company. (` )
Solution:
Statement showing determination of Net Working Capital (NWC) (` ) (` )
(A) Current assets:
Cash balance 10,000
Inventories:
Raw materials: Opening stock 1,40,000
Add purchases 7,05,000
Less closing stock 1,25,000
Annual consumption 7,20,000
Two months requirements = (` 720000 × 2 / 12) 1,20,000
Work-in-process (yearly cost of production excluding depreciation):
(` 12,00,000 – ` 1,20,000) [` 10,80,000* × 1)/(2 × 12)] 45,000
Finished goods (` 10,80,000)/12 90,000
Debtors (` 10,80,000)/12 90,000**
Total 3,55,000
(B) Current liabilities:
Trade creditors (` 7,05,000 ×1 / 2 × 1 / 12) 29,375
Advances received from debtors 15,000
Total 44,375
(C) Net Working Capital (A – B ) 3,10,625
**It is assumed that there is neither a opening nor closing stock of finished goods and, therefore, cost of sales is
` 10,80,000, excluding depreciation.
Solved Case 2
XYZ Ltd. sells its products on a gross profit of 20 % on sales. The following information is extracted from its
annual accounts for the current year ended March 31. (` )
Solution:
Statement showing the determination of working capital (` ) (` )
(A) Current Assets:
Cash balance 1,00,000
Inventories:
Raw materials (` 12,00,000 × 2 /12) 2,00,000
Finished goods (` 32,00,000 × 1.5/12) 4,00,000 6,00,000
Debtors (` 32,00,000 × 3) / 12 8,00,000
Prepaid sales expenses (` 2,00,000 × 6) / 12 1,00,000
Total 16,00,000
(B) Current Liabilities:
Creditors for goods (` 12,00,000 × 1) / 12 1,00,000
Wages (` 9,60,000 × 0.5)/12 40,000
Manufacturing expenses (` 12,00,000 × 1) / 12 1,00,000
Administrative expenses (` 4,80,000 × 1) / 12 40,000
Total 2,80,000
(C) Net Working Capital (A – B) 13,20,000
Add: Margin (0.10) 1,32,000
Net working capital requirement 14,52,000
Working notes (` )
Sales 40,00,000
Less: gross profit (0.20) 8,00,000
Cost of production 32,00,000
Solved Case 3
ABC Ltd wishes to arrange for overdraft facilities with its bankers during the period April to June of a particular
year when it will be manufacturing mostly for stock.
a. Prepare a cash budget for the above period from the following data, indicating the extent of bank facilities
the company will require at the end of the each month.
b. 50% of the credit sales are realised in the month following the sales, and the remaining sales in the second
month following; creditors are paid in the month following the purchase.
c. Cash in bank on April 1 (estimated) ` 25,000.
Solution:
Cash Budget of ABC Ltd: April-June
April (` ) May (` ) June (` )
(A) Cash inflows: collections
(i) During month of sale -- -- --
(ii) During second month (0.50) 90,000 96,000 54,000
(iii) During third month (0.50) 96,000 54,000 87,000
Total 1,86,000 1,50,000 1,41,000
(B) Cash outflows
Purchase (one-month time-lag) 1,44,000 2,43,000 2,46,000
Wages (paid same month) 11,000 10,000 15,000
Total 1,55,000 2,53,000 2,61,000
(C) Net cash receipts (deficits) 31,000 (1,03,000) (1,20,000)
Cash at start of month (overdraft 25,000 56,000 (47,000)
Cash balance (overdraft) (cumulative) 56,000 (47,000) (1,67,000)
(Overdraft) facilities required (47,000) (1,20,000)
Exercise
A. Theoretical Questions:
~ Multiple Choice Questions
1. Working capital is calculated as _____
A. Core current assets less core current liabilities
B. Current assets less current liabilities
C. Core current assets less current liabilities
D. Liquid assets less current liabilities
2. The basic current liabilities are _____
A. accounts payable and bills payable
B. bank overdraft
C. outstanding expenses.
D. All of the above
3. There are two concepts of working capital – gross and ____
A. Zero
B. Net
C. Cumulative
D. distinctive
4. Working capital is also known as___ capital.
A. Current asset
B. Operating
C. Projecting
D. Operation capital
5. ______ working Capital refers to the firm’s investment in current assets.
A. Zero
B. Net
C. Gross
D. Distinctive
6. In finance, “working capital” means the same thing as _______ assets.
A. Current
B. Fixed
C. Total
D. All of the above
7. ______ working capital refers to the difference between current assets and current liabilities.
A. Zero
B. Net
C. Gross
D. Distinctive
8. A _______ net working capital will arise when current assets exceed current liabilities.
A. Summative
B. Negative
C. Excessive
D. Positive
9. A ______ net working capital occurs when current liabilities are in excess of current assets.
A. Positive
B. Negative
C. Excessive
D. Zero
11. ________ refers to the funds, which an organisation must possess to finance its day to day operations.
A. Retained earnings
B. Fixed capital
C. Working Capital
D. All of the above
15. On the basis of _____, working capital is classified as gross working capital and net working capital.
A. concept
B. time
C. future
D. work
16. ______ cycle analyzes the accounts receivable, inventory, and accounts payable cycles in terms of a number
of days?
A. Business
B. Current asset
C. Operation
D. Operating
17. _______ method is not used for calculating working capital cycle.
A. Trial and error method
B. Regression analysis method
C. Percentage of sales method
D. Operating cycle approach
18. On the basis of _____, working capital may be classified as: 1) Permanent or fixed working capital. 2)
Temporary or variable working capital.
A. concept
B. time
C. future
D. work
21. Conversation of marketable securities into cash entails a fixed cost of `1,000 per transaction. What will be
the optimal conversation size as per Baumol model of cash management?
A. ` 315,628
B. ` 316,228
C. ` 317,678
D. ` 318,426
22. Average collection period is 2 months, cash sales and average receivables are `5,00,000 and `6,50,000
respectively. The sales amount would be-
A. ` 40,00,000
B. ` 42,00,000
C. ` 44,00,000
D. ` 48,50,000
23. If the current ratio is 2.4:1 and working capital is `25,20,000, find the amount of current assets and current
liabilities.
A. Current Assets ` 43,20,000 and Current Liabilities ` 18,00,000
B. Current Assets ` 44,00,000 and Current Liabilities ` 18,50,000
C. Current Assets ` 45,50,000 and Current Liabilities ` 19,00,000
D. Current Assets ` 46,60,000 and Current Liabilities ` 19,30,000
24. X Ltd. distributes its products to more than 500 retailers. The company’s collection period is 30 days and
keeps its inventory for 20 days. The operating cycle would be
A. 40 Days
B. 43 Days
C. 45 Days
D. 50 Days
Answers:
1 D 2 D 3 B
4 B 5 C 6 A
7 B 8 D 9 B
10 S 11 C 12 A
13 C 14 A 15 A
16 D 17 A 18 B
19 B 20 D 21 B
22 C 23 A 24 D
7. In general, manufacturing enterprises require higher working capital than trading firms.
8. The longer the production cycle, the higher is the working capital needed or vice- versa.
9. There is a positive correlation between level of business activity and working capital needs of a business
firm.
10. Efficiency of operation accelerates the pace of cash cycle of a firm but it does not affect its working capital
requirements.
11. A firm should carry higher working capital than required to execute smoothly its planned level of business
activity.
12. The entire sum of net profit earned by a corporate can, per-se, be considered a source of financing working
capital.
13. Cash cost approach is an appropriate basis of computing working capital requirements of a business firm.
14. Working capital tied up with debtors should be estimated in relation to the selling price.
15. From the perspective of determining net working capital, all current liabilities including short-term sources
of finance are considered.
16. Cash, in a narrow sense, implies currency and bank balances only.
17. Cash, in broad sense, includes marketable securities and time deposits in banks.
18. Transaction, precautionary and speculative are three motives for holding cash.
19. Speculative motive cash balance serves to provide a cushion to meet unexpected contingencies.
20. To meet the payment schedule and to minimize funds committed to cash balance are two basic objectives of
cash management.
21. Costs caused due to inadequate cash are referred to as short costs.
22. Baumol model takes into account all motives of holding cash.
23. Miller-Orr model assumes that cash balances randomly fluctuate between an upper bound and lower bound.
24. Orgler’s model is based on the use of a simple linear programming model.
25. Cash budget is based on operating cash flows.
26. The higher the period of cash cycle, the higher is cash turnover.
27. Time taken by the bank in collecting payment from the customer’s bank is referred to as deposit float.
28. Investment in marketable securities is intended to obtain a return on temporarily idle cash.
29. The financial framework of analysis of various decision areas in receivable management should factor all
measurable costs and benefits.
Answers:
1 T 2 F 3 F
4 F 5 T 6 F
7 T 8 T 9 T
10 F 11 F 12 F
13 T 14 F 15 F
16 F 17 T 18 F
19 F 20 T 21 T
22 F 23 T 24 F
25 F 26 F 27 F
28 T 29 T
1. Higher net working capital leads to ___________ (higher / lower) liquidity and higher profitability.
2. Baumol model takes into account all motives of holding ____________.
3. Working Capital equals the aggregate value of current assets ____________ aggregate value of current
liabilities.
4. ________________ = Inventory alteration period + Receivables alteration period.
5. Cash conversion cycle = _______________ – Payable delay period.
6. Gross Working Capital refers to the firm’s investment in _________________.
7. There exists a close association between sales fluctuations and invested amounts in ________.
8. Under the conventional method, ......................... enters into the calculation of working capital.
9. A company’s operating cycle naturally consists of three most important activities: ____________,
____________ and ____________
10. The ____________ shows the time period over which additional no impulsive sources of working capital
financing must be obtained to carry out the firm’s actions.
11. The unit price of producing goods would not differ with the amount ____________
12. There are ___________ among the borrowing and lending rates for savings and financing of equivalent risk.
13. __________________deals with the likelihood that a firm will encounter financial difficulty, such as the
incapability to pay bills on time.
14. Short-term interest rates tend to change __________ over time than long-term interest rates.
15. The ______________ level of working capital investment is the level predictable to maximize shareholder’s
assets.
16. ________________ single working capital investment strategy is necessarily most favourable for all
organizations.
17. The objective of a corporation is to generate value for it’s_____________.
18. Under ___________ working capital strategy, investment in current assets is extremely low.
19. Too much working capital is expensive, falling _______________ and ________________.
Answer:
1 higher 2 cash 3 minus
4 Operating cycle 5 Operating cycle 6 Current Assets
7 Current assets 8 Cash 9 Purchasing resources, producing the
product, selling the product
10 Cash alteration cycle 11 Produced 12 Spreads
13 Risk 14 More 15 Most favourable
16 No 17 Shareholders 18 Aggressive
19 Profitability, return on capital
B. Numerical Questions:
~ Comprehensive Numerical Problems
1. ABC Ltd. has the following selected assets and liabilities: (` )
Cash 45,000
Retained earnings 1,60,000
Equity share capital 1,50,000
Debtors 60,000
Inventory 1,11,000
Debentures 1,00,000
Provision for taxation 57,000
Expenses outstanding 21,000
Land and building 3,00,000
Goodwill 50,000
Furniture 25,000
Creditors 39,000
You are required to determine (i) gross working capital, and (ii) net working capital.
2. While preparing a project report on behalf of a client, you have collected the following data. Estimate the net
working capital required for that project. Add 10% to your computed figure to allow for contingencies.
3. The balance sheet of X Ltd. stood as follows as on March 31 of the current year.
Liabilities (` ) Assets (` )
Current liabilities (CL) 2,000 Current assets (CA) 8,000
Long-term funds 22,000 Fixed assets (FA) 16,000
24,000 24,000
If Current assets earn 2%, Fixed assets earn 14%, Current liabilities cost 4% and long-term funds cost 10%,
calculate (a) total profits on assets and the ratio of Current assets to total assets, (b) the cost of financing and the
ratio of Current liabilities to total assets, and (c) net profitability of the current financial plan.
4. Prudential Ltd. has investigated the profitability of its assets and the cost of its funds. The results indicate:
(i) Current assets earn 1 %
(ii) Fixed assets earn 13 %
(iii) Current liabilities cost 3 %
(iv) Average cost of long-tern funds, 10 %
The current balance sheet is as follows:
Liabilities (` ) Assets (` )
Current liabilities 5,000 Current assets 10,000
Long-term funds 35,000 Fixed assets 30,000
40,000 40,000
(a) What is the net profitability?
(b) The company is contemplating lowering its net working capital to ` 3,500 by (i) either shifting current
assets into fixed assets, or (ii) shifting ` 1,500 of its long-term funds into current liabilities. Work out the
profitability for each of these alternatives. Which one do you prefer and why?
(c) Can both these alternatives be implemented simultaneously? How would it affect the net profitability?
Answers:
1 (i) ` 2,16,000,
(ii) 99,000.
2 ` 49,66,000
Unsolved Case(s)
1. An engineering company is considering its working capital investment for the next year. Estimated fixed
assets and current liabilities for the next year are `5.20 crore and `84.6 crore, respectively. Sales and profit
before interest and taxes (PBIT) depend on current assets investment—particularly inventories and book
debts. The company is examining the following alternative working capital policies:
` (Crore)
You are required to calculate the following for each policy (a) rate of return on total assets, (b) net working
capital position, (c) current ratio, and (d) current asset to fixed asset ratio.
Also discuss the return-risk trade-offs of the three policies.
2. P Ltd. wishes to evaluate its cash conversion cycle. A financial analyst company, X Ltd. indicates that on an
average the firm holds items in inventory for 80 days, pays its suppliers 40 days after purchase and collects
its receivables after 60 days. The company’s annual sales (on all credit) are about `100 crore. Its cost of
goods sold represent 70% of sales and purchases represent about 30% of cost of goods sold. Assume a 365-
day year.
(a) What is P Ltd.’s operating cycle (OC) and cash conversion cycle (CCC)?
(b) What amount of rupees does P Ltd. invested in (i) inventory, (ii) accounts receivable (iii) accounts
payable and (iv) total CCC.
(c) If P Ltd. shorten its cash conversion cycle by reducing its inventory holding period by 10 days, what
effect would it have on its total resource investment in (b) (iv) above.
(d) If P Ltd. shorten its cash conversion cycle by 10 days, would it be best to reduce the inventory holding
period, reduce the receivable collection period, or extend the accounts payable period? Why?
3. R Ltd. feels a lock-box system can shorten its accounts receivable collection period by 3 days. Credit sales
are estimated at ` 365 lakh per year, billed on a continuous basis. The firm’s opportunity cost of funds is
15%. The cost of lock box system is ` 50,000.
(a) Will you advise ‘R’ to go for lock-box system?
(b) Will your answer be different if accounts receivable collection period is reduced by 5 days?
References:
● Banerjee Bhabatosh, Financial Policy and Management Accounting, PHI, Eighth Edition.
● Bodie, Zvi et al, Investments, Tata McGraw-Hill Publishing Company Limited New Delhi: 2002.
● Chambers, Donald R., and Nelson J. Lacey. “Corporate Ethics and Shareholder Wealth Maximization.”
Financial Practice and Education 6 (Spring–Summer 1996), 93– 96.
● Chandra Prasanna, Financial Management, Theory and Practice, McGraw Hill., 2019.
● Fama, Eugene F; French, Kenneth R (Summer 2004). The Capital Asset Pricing Model: Theory and Evidence.
Journal of Economic Perspectives. 18 (3): 25–46.
● Fischer Donald E, and Jordon Ronald J., Security Analysis and Portfolio Management, PHI.
● Francis, Jack Clark, Investments: Analysis and Management, McGraw-Hill, Inc. New York: 1991.
● H. Markowitz, Portfolio Selection: Efficient Diversification of Investments, John Wiley & Sons, 1959.
● Khan, M Y and P K Jain, Financial Management- Text, Problems and Cases, McGraw-Hill Publishing Co.,
New Delhi, 2019.
● Pandey I.M., Financial Management, Pearson, 12th Edition, 2021.
● Ross, Stephen. A, “The Arbitrage Theory of Capital Asset Pricing,” Journal of Economic Theory, Vol. 13,
(December, 1976).
● Solomon, E, Theory of Financial Management, Columbia University Press (New York), 1969.
● Van Horne James C. and Wachowicz John M., Jr. Fundamentals of Financial Management, Prentice Hall,
13th Edition, 2008.
● Ramamoorthy, V E, Working Capital Management, Institute of Financial Management and Research Madras,
1976
● Baumol, WJ, ‘The Transaction Demand for Cash: An Inventory Theoretic Approach’, Quarterly Journal of
Economics, LXV November, 1952, pp 545-56
● Miller, MH and Orr, D, ‘A Model of the Demand for Money in Firms’, Quarterly Journal of Economics,
LXX Aug., 1966, pp 413-435.
● Orgler, YE, Cash Management: Methods and Models, Wadsworth Publishing Company, Balmont, California,
1970.
Introduction 7
F
inancing decision is concerned with the capital structure of the firm. The decision is basically taken about
the proportion of equity capital and debt capital in total capital of the firm. Higher the proportion of debt in
capital of the firm, higher is the risk.
Financial decisions may be classified as long-term finance decisions and short-term finance decisions in broad
manner.
Again, there are four main financial decisions –
(a) Capital Budgeting or Long-term Investment Decision
(b) Capital Structure or Financing Decision
(c) Dividend Decision, and
(d) Working Capital Management Decision.
This module is dealt with mainly capital structure or financing decision. A firm’s capital structure or financing
decision is concerned with obtaining funds to meet firm’s long-term investment requirements. It refers to the
specific mixture of long-term debt and equity, which the firm uses to finance its assets. The finance manager has to
decide exactly how much funds to raise, from which sources to raise and when to raise.
Different feasible combinations of raising required funds must be carefully evaluated and an optimal combination
of different sources of funds should be selected. The optimal capital structure is one which minimises overall cost
of capital and maximises firm’s value. Capital structure decision gives rise to financial risk of a firm.
Capital Staking:
In simple terms, the capital stack refers to the layers of capital. The capital stack represents the underlying
financial structure of a commercial real estate deal. Often, the capital stack is presented as a graphic that shows
the different types of capital in a deal stacked above each other, like a cake with many layers. The capital stack
is typically comprised of four sections in the following order: common equity, preferred equity, mezzanine debt,
and senior debt. Although common equity is listed first in the stack, it holds the lowest priority, meaning common
equity lenders are paid last.
High
COMMON EQUITY
Equity
POTENTIAL RISK & RETURN
PREFERRED EQUITY
MEZZANINE DEBT
Debt
SENIOR DEBT
Low
Senior Debt
Senior debt is the bedrock of the capital stack, which typically takes up the most significant portion of the stack.
It is also the least risky position, as it’s first in line to get paid back in the event of a default or bankruptcy. As an
investor, you should consider a senior debt investment if you want the least amount of risk.
Senior debt is generally secured by a mortgage or deed to the property, which will serve as collateral for the loan.
It’s low risk because, in a worst-case scenario of asset underperformance, you can initiate a foreclosure process
to recover your full capital investment before any other participant. Its low-risk nature also delivers the lowest
potential return to investors, which is a low fixed interest rate.
Mezzanine Debt
Mezzanine debt, sometimes called junior debt, is next in line to get paid out. This debt is often financed by
investors rather than a bank. Because this debt is only paid back after all the senior debt has been paid back, it holds
more risk than the senior debt. To compensate for this risk, investors earn a higher interest rate than the senior debt,
meaning they have a higher potential return.
Mezzanine debt is often critical to the success of a transaction because senior debt holders will typically only
lend up to 50% - 60% of a project in some cases, and unless the equity holders can come up with the remaining,
then mezzanine debt is necessary. Sometimes mezzanine debt can be called “bridge financing” because it bridges
that gap between the senior debt and equity.
Equity Financing
As mentioned before, equity investors buy shares of ownership of the property. These shares will go up and down
in value relative to the property valuation. If the property appreciates, the value of the shares will go up. If the
property sells at a higher valuation than initially purchased, the investors will profit. But even in the equity stack,
not all shares are created equal.
Common Equity
Last in line for payouts are common equity holders. Being a common equity investor means being an owner of
the deal. Common equity has the highest return potential, but it’s also the riskiest because holders can only be paid
after all debt holders, and preferred equity investors have received their returns.
However, in exchange for being last in line, common equity investors will receive all the profit upon the property
sale. In the event of the property appreciates significantly in value, they stand to earn the most substantial return.
Unlike the other stacks, there is also no cap on your potential profit or a fixed term for expected returns.
Preferred Equity
After all the debts been paid off, preferred equity shares are next in the payback line. Preferred equity often acts
as a hybrid between equity and debt. While technically equity shares, they also often have a payout schedule similar
to mezzanine debt (but paid back after the mezzanine debt is paid back in full). Unlike debt, these shares are not
backed by any collateral, which means they hold significant risk in the event of a bankruptcy. While investors hold
significant risk here, they are rewarded with an even higher interest rate than the mezzanine debt and a preference
to be paid back before the common equity.
Features of an Appropriate Capital Structure
A capital structure will be considered to be appropriate if it possesses following features:
(a) Profitability: The capital structure of the company should be most profitable. The most profitable capital
structure is one that tends to minimize cost of financing and maximize earnings per equity share.
(b) Solvency: The pattern of capital structure should be so devised as to ensure that the firm does not run the risk
of becoming insolvent. Excess use of debt threatens the solvency of the company. The debt content should
not, therefore, be such that which increases risk beyond manageable limits.
(c) Flexibility: The capital structure should be flexible to meet the requirements of changing conditions.
Moreover, it should also be possible for the company to provide funds whenever needed to finance its
profitable activities.
(d) Conservatism: The capital structure should be conservative in the sense that the debt content in the total
capital structure does not exceed the limit which the company can bear. In other words, it should be such as
is commensurate with the company’s ability to generate future cash flows.
(e) Control: The capital structure should be so devised that it involves minimum risk of loss of control
of the company.
Determinants of Capital Structure
The following are the factors influencing the capital structure decisions.
The capital structure of a firm depends on a number of factors and these factors are of different importance.
Generally, the following factors should be considered while determining the capital structure of a company.
(e) Flexibility
Flexibility means the firm’s ability to adapt its capital structure to the needs of the changing conditions.
Capital structure should flexible enough to raise additional funds whenever required, without much delay
and cost. The capital structure of the firm must be designed in such a way that it is possible to substitute
one form of financing for another to economise the use of funds. Preference shares and debentures offer the
highest flexibility in the capital structure, as they can be redeemed at the discretion of the firm.
(f) Marketability and Timing
Capital market conditions may change from time to time. Sometimes there may be depression and at over
times there may be boom condition in the market. The firm should decide whether to go for equity issue
or debt capital by taking market sentiments into consideration. In the case of depressed conditions in the
share market, the firm should not issue equity shares but go for debt capital. On the other hand, under boom
conditions, it becomes easy for the firm to mobilise funds by issuing equity shares.
The internal conditions of a firm may also determine the marketability of securities. For example, a highly
levered firm may find it difficult to raise additional debt. In the same way, a firm may find it very difficult to
mobilise funds by issuing any kind of security in the market merely because of its small size.
(g) Floatation Costs:
Floatation costs are not a very significant factor in the determination of capital structure. These costs are
incurred when the funds are raised externally. They include cost of the issue of prospectus, brokerage,
commissions, etc. Generally, the cost of floatation for debt is less than for equity. So, there may be a temptation
for debt capital. There will be no floatation cost for retained earnings. As is said earlier, floatation costs are
not a significant factor except for small companies. Floatation costs can be an important consideration in
deciding the size of the issue of securities, because these costs as a percentage of funds raised will decline
with the size of the issue. Hence, greater the size of the issue, more will be the savings in terms of floatation
costs. However, a large issue affects the firm’s financial flexibility.
(h) Purpose of Financing
The purpose for which funds are raised should also be considered while determining the sources of capital
structure. If funds are raised for productive purpose, debt capital is appropriate as the interest can be paid out
of profits generated from the investment. But, if it is for unproductive purpose, equity should be preferred.
(i) Legal Requirements
The various guidelines issued by the Government from time to time regarding the issue of shares and
debentures should be kept in mind while determining the capital structure of a firm. These legal restrictions
are very significant as they give a framework within which capital structure decisions should be made.
7.1.1 Collateral
Collateral term is very much related and relevant for determining of capital structure as well as capital stacking.
The term collateral refers to an asset that a lender accepts as security for a loan. Collateral may take the form of
real estate or other kinds of assets, depending on the purpose of the loan. The collateral acts as a form of protection
for the lender. That means, if the borrower defaults on their loan payments, the lender can seize the collateral asset
and sell it to recoup some or all of its losses.
7.1.2 Covenant (Financial and Non-financial), Negative Covenants and Cross Default
In legal and financial terminology, a covenant is a promise in an indenture, or any other formal debt agreement,
that certain activities will or will not be carried out or that certain thresholds will be met. Covenants in finance
most often relate to terms in a financial contract, such as a loan document or bond issue stating the limits at which
the borrower can further lend. Covenants are often put in place by lenders to protect themselves from borrowers
defaulting on their obligations due to financial actions detrimental to themselves or the business.
Covenants are most often represented in terms of financial ratios that must be maintained, such as a maximum
debt-to-asset ratio or other such ratios. Covenants can cover everything from minimum dividend payments to
levels that must be maintained in working capital to key employees remaining with the firm.
Financial Covenants
Financial covenants are aspects of an agreement (generally loans) that limit or provide restrictions on how
a company or individual operates their finances. A financial covenant can stipulate how much debt a company
can take on or even how stringent financial ratios must be maintained as a part of such an agreement. Financial
covenants, by their very definition, revolve around the financial aspects of an agreement or contract.
Non-Financial Covenants
Non-financial covenants also serve the purpose of a safety net to the lender. They are usually undertaken by a
lender as a measure to prevent the risks related to money-lending activities. Non-financial covenants come with
many of the complementary aspects to an agreement that do not discuss finances. They are a critical part of financial
agreements that help guide the terms of a contract, as well as provide barriers for one or either party to operate
between. It helps to ensure the faithful execution of the contract that occurs in good faith by the two signing parties.
Positive Covenants
A positive covenant is a clause in a loan contract that requires a borrower to perform specific actions. Examples of
positive covenants include requirements to maintain adequate levels of insurance, requirements to furnish audited
financial statements to the lender, compliance with applicable laws, and maintenance of proper accounting books
and credit rating, if applicable. Positive covenant is also known as affirmative covenant.
A violation of a positive covenant ordinarily results in outright default. Certain loan contracts may contain
clauses that provide a borrower with a grace period to remedy the violation. If not corrected, creditors are entitled
to announce default and demand immediate repayment of principal and any accrued interest.
Negative Covenants
Negative covenants are put in place to make borrowers refrain from certain actions that could result in the
deterioration of their credit standing and ability to repay existing debt. The most common forms of negative
covenants are financial ratios that a borrower must maintain as of the date of the financial statements. For instance,
most loan agreements require a ratio of total debt to a certain measure of earnings not to exceed a maximum
amount, which ensures that a company does not burden itself with more debt than it can afford to service.
Another common negative covenant is an interest coverage ratio, which says that Earnings Before Interest and
Taxes (EBIT) must be greater in proportion to interest payments by a certain number of times. The ratio puts a
check on a borrower to make sure that he generates enough earnings to afford paying interest.
Cross Default
Cross default is a clause added to certain loans or bonds that stipulate that a default event triggered in one
instance will carry over to another. Cross default is a provision in a bond indenture or loan agreement that puts a
borrower in default if the borrower defaults on another obligation. For example, a cross-default clause in a loan
agreement may say that a person automatically defaults on his car loan if he defaults on his mortgage. The cross-
default provision exists to protect the interest of lenders, who desire to have equal rights to a borrower’s assets in
case of default on one of the loan contracts.
Cross-default is caused by an event of default of a borrower on another loan. Default typically occurs when a
borrower fails to pay interest or principal on time, or when he violates one of the negative or affirmative covenants.
A negative covenant requires a borrower to refrain from certain activities, such as having indebtedness to profits
above certain levels or profits insufficient to cover interest payment. Affirmative covenants obligate the borrower
to perform certain actions, such as furnishing audited financial statements on a timely basis or maintaining certain
types of business insurance.
If a borrower defaults on one of his loans by violating covenants or not paying principal or interest on time, a
cross-default clause in another loan document triggers an event of default as well. Typically, cross-default provisions
allow a borrower to remedy or waive the event of default on an unrelated contract before declaring a cross-default.
it completely. The main objective of debt management is to ensure that the organisation’s financing needs and its
payment obligations are met at the lowest possible cost over the medium to long run, consistent with a prudent
degree of risk.
However, senior debt and junior debt (subordinated debt or mezzanine debt), both are long-term liabilities or non-
current liabilities of the company. They are an important source of finance in debt financing. There are times when
the Cost of Equity exceeds the cost of debt, in such a situation preference shifts from equity to debt. Senior Debt
and Junior Debt is important tool for debt financing. They help the company in both, in the short as well as long
term. Though their ultimate objective to gather resources are almost the same, they have different characteristics
altogether. They both act as a source of finance for the issuing company, but they both carry different levels of risk,
interest rate, repayment priority, and may attract different kinds of investors or lenders, etc.
Senior debt is often secured. Secured debt is debt secured by the assets or other collateral of a company and can
include liens and claims on certain assets. When a company files for bankruptcy, the issuers of senior debt, typically
bondholders or banks are having the best chance of being repaid. Next in line are junior debt holders, preferred
stockholders, and common stockholders. In some cases, these parties are paid by selling collateral that has been
held for debt repayment.
Senior debt and subordinated debt are long-term sources of debt finance serving different purposes. It would be
absolutely wrong to say, one debt is more important than the other. So, both kinds of debt are equally important and
should be managed properly for any organisation.
Capital Structure
Theories
Net Modigliani
Packing
Net Income Operating Traditional and Trade-off
Order
Approach Income Approach Miller Theory
Theory
Approach Hypothesis
In analysing the capital structure theories, the following basic definitions are used:
S = Market value of common shares
D = Market value of debt
V = Market value of the firm = S + D
NOI = X = Expected net operating income, i.e., Earnings Before Interest and Taxes (EBIT)
NI = NOI - Interest = Net Income or shareholder’s earnings.
0.10 ke
Cost of Capital
ko
0.5
kd
0 Degree of Leverage X
It is evident from the above diagram that when degree of leverage is zero (i.e., no debt capital employed), overall
cost of capital is equal to cost of equity (ko = ke). If debt capital is employed further and further which is relatively
cheap when compared to cost of equity, the overall cost of capital declines, and it becomes equal to cost of debt (kd)
when leverage is one (i.e., the firm is fully debt financed). Thus, according to this theory, the firm’s capital structure
will be optimum, when degree of leverage is one.
Y ke
ko
Cost of Capital (%)
kd
0
X
Degree of Leverage
Figure 7.4: Net Operating Income Approach
The above diagram shows that ko and kd are constant and ke increases with leverage continuously. The increase
in cost of equity (ke) exactly offsets the advantage of low-cost debt, so that overall cost of capital (ko) remains
constant, at every degree of leverage. It implies that every capital structure is optimum and there is no unique
optimum capital structure.
3. The Traditional Approach
This approach, which is also known as intermediate approach, has been popularised by Ezra Solomon. It is a
compromise between the two extremes of Net Income Approach and Net Operating Income Approach. According
to this approach, cost of capital can be reduced or the value of the firm can be increased with a judicious mix of debt
and equity. This theory says that cost of capital declines with increase in debt capital up to a reasonable level, and
later it increases with a further rise in debt capital. The way in which the overall cost of capital reacts to changes in
capital structure can be divided into three stages under traditional position.
Stage I
In this stage, the cost of equity (ke) and the cost of debt (kd) are constant and cost of debt is less than cost of equity.
The employment of debt capital up to a reasonable level will cause the overall cost of capital to decline due to the
low-cost advantage of debt.
Stage II
Once the firm has reached a reasonable level of leverage, a further increase in debt will have no effect on the
value of the firm and the cost of capital. This is because of the fact that a further rise in debt. Capital increases the
risk to equity shareholders which leads to a rise in equity capitalisation rate (ke).
This rise in cost of equity exactly offsets the low–cost advantage of debt capital so that the overall cost of capital
remains constant.
Stage III
If the firm increases debt capital further and further beyond reasonable level, it will cause an increase in risk to
both equity shareholders and debt holders, because of which both cost of equity and cost of debt start rising in this
stage. This will in turn to cause an increase in overall cost of capital. If the overall effect of all the three stages is
taken, it is evident that cost of capital declines and the value of the firm increases with a rise in debt capital up to a
certain reasonable level. If debt capital is further increased beyond this level, the overall cost of capital (ko) tends
to rise and as a result the value of the firm will decline.
Y
ke
ko
Cost of Capital
kd
0
Range of Optimum Capital Structure X
Proposition I
According to Modigliani–Miller, for the firms in the same risk class, the total market value is independent of
capital structure and is determined by capitalising net operating income by the rate appropriate to that risk class.
Proposition I can be expressed as follows:
X NOI
V S D
ke ko
Where, V = The market value of the firm
S = The market value of equity
D = The market value of debt
According the Proposition I the average cost of capital is not affected by degree of leverage and is determined
as follows:
k = X/ V
According to M –M, the average cost of capital is constant as shown in the following figure.
Y
Cost of Capital %
ko
0
Degree of Leverage X
Because of this arbitrage process, the market price of securities in higher valued market will come down and the
market price of securities in the lower valued market will go up, and this switching process is continued until the
equilibrium is established in the market values. So, Modigliani–Miller, argue that there is no possibility of different
market values for identical firms.
Reverse Working of Arbitrage Process
Arbitrage process also works in the reverse direction. Leverage has neither advantage nor disadvantage.
If an unlevered firm (with no debt capital) has higher market value than a levered firm (with debt capital)
arbitrage process works in reverse direction. Investors will try to switch their investments from unlevered firm to
levered firm so that equilibrium is established in no time.
Thus, Modigliani–Miller proved in terms of their proposition I that the value of the firm is not affected by debt-
equity mix.
Proposition II
Modigliani–Miller’s proposition II defines cost of equity. According to them, for any firm in a given risk class,
the cost of equity is equal to the constant average cost of capital (ko) plus a premium for the financial risk, which is
equal to debt – equity ratio times the spread between average cost and cost of debt.
Thus, cost of equity is:
ke = ko + (ko – kd) × D/S
Where, ke = Cost of equity; ko = Average cost of capital
D/S = Debt – Equity ratio; kd = Cost of debt
Modigliani–Miller argue that ko will not increase with the increase in the leverage, because the low – cost
advantage of debt capital will be exactly offset by the increase in the cost of equity as caused by increased risk
to equity shareholders. The crucial part of the Modigliani–Miller Thesis is that an excessive use of leverage will
increase the risk to the debt holders which results in an increase in cost of debt (kd). However, this will not lead to a
rise in ko. Modigliani–Miller maintain that in such a case ke will increase at a decreasing rate or even it may decline.
This is because of the reason that at an increased leverage, the increased risk will be shared by the debt holders.
Hence ko remain constant. This is illustrated in the figure given below:
Y
Cost of Capital %
ke
ko
kd
0
Leverage 0
The trade-off theory of capital structure is the idea that a company chooses how much debt finance and how
much equity finance to use by balancing the costs and benefits. The trade-off theory of capital structure postulates
that managers attempt to balance the benefits of interest tax shields against the present value of the possible costs
of financial distress.
According to the trade-off theory, every firm has an optimal debt-equity ratio that maximises its value. The
optimal debt-equity ratio of a profitable firm that has stable, tangible assets would be higher than the optimal
debt-equity ratio of an unprofitable firm with risky, intangible assets. A profitable firm can avail of tax shield
associated with debt fully. Further, when assets are stable and tangible, financial distress costs and agency costs tend
to be lower.
How well does the trade-off theory explain corporate financing behaviour? It explains reasonably well some
industry differences in capital structures. For example, power companies and refineries use more debt as their
assets are tangible and safe. Software companies, on the other hand, borrow less because their assets are mostly
intangible and somewhat risky. The trade-off theory, however, cannot explain why some profitable companies
depend so little on debt. Some companies having highly profitable, use very little debt. They pay large amounts by
way of income tax which they can possibly save to some extent by using debt without causing any concern about
their solvency.
6. Pecking Order Theory
The pecking order theory has emerged as alternative theory to the trade-off theory. Rather than introducing
corporate taxes and financial distress into the M-M framework. The pecking order theory states that internal
financing is preferred over external financing, and if external finance is required, firms should issue debt first and
equity as a last resort. Moreover, the pecking order seems to explain why profitable firms have low debt ratios: This
happens not because they have low target debt ratios, but because they do not need to obtain external financing.
Thus, unlike the trade-off theory the pecking order theory is capable of explaining differences in capital structures
within industries.
(d) Tax-shield on Interest is Secondary: In the pecking-order theory, the tax-shield on interest is regarded as
the secondary consideration and relegated to the second place in designing capital structure.
Illustration 1
The expected annual net operating income of a company (EBIT) is `50,000. The company has `2,00,000, 10%
debentures. The equity capitalisation rate (ke) of the company is 12.5%. Find the value of the firm and overall cost
of capital under Net Income approach.
Solution:
Calculation of value of firm and overall cost of capital under Net Income Approach
Illustration 2
Assuming no taxes and given the Earnings Before Interest and Taxes (EBIT), interest (I) at 10% and equity
capitalisation rate (ke) below, calculate the total market value of each firm under Net Income approach:
Firms EBIT I ke
(`) (`)
X 2,00,000 20,000 12.0%
Y 3,00,000 60,000 16.0%
Z 5,00,000 2,00,000 15.0%
W 6,00,000 2,40,000 18.0%
Also determine the Weight Average Cost of Capital (WACC) for each firm.
Solution :
Calculation of valuation of each firm under Net Income Approach
Illustration 3
The existing capital structure of XYZ Ltd. is as under: (` )
The existing rate of return on the company’s capital is 12% and the income-tax rate is 50%.
The company requires a sum ` 25,00,000 to finance an expansion programme for which it is considering the
following alternatives:
(i) Issue of 20,000 equity shares at a premium of ` 25 per share.
(ii) Issue of 10% preference shares.
(iii) Issue of 8% debentures.
It is estimated that the P/E ratios in the cases of equity preference and debenture financing would be 20,17 and
16 respectively.
Which of the above alternatives would you consider to be the best?
Solution:
Illustration 4
XL Limited provides you with following figures:
Illustration 5
From the following data find out the value of each firm and value of each equity share as per the Modigliani-
Miller approach:
X (` ) Y (` ) Z (` )
EBIT (`) 13,00,000 13,00,000 13,00,000
No. of shares 3,00,000 2,50,000 2,00,000
12% debentures (`) 9,00,000 10,00,000
Every firm expect 12% return on investment.
Solution:
Calculation of value of each firm under Modigliani–Miller Approach:
Firm X (` ) Y (` ) Z (` )
1. Value of Firm (`) 1,08,33,333 1,08,33,333 1,08,33,333
2. Debt (`) - 9,00,000 10,00,000
3. Value of equity(1-2) (`) 1,08,33,333 99,33,333 98,33,333
4. No. of equity shares 3,00,000 2,50,000 2,00,000
5. Market price; (3/4) (`) 36.11 39.73 49.17
Illustration 6
Z Co. has a capital structure of 30% debt and 70% equity. The company is considering various investment
proposals costing less than ` 30 lakh. The company does not want to disturb its present capital structure.
The cost of raising the debt and equity are as follows:
Assuming the tax rate is 50%, compute the cost of two projects A and B, whose fund requirements are ` 8 lakh
and ` 22 lakh respectively. If the projects are expected to yield after tax return of 11%, determine under what
conditions if would be acceptable.
Solution:
Capital Structure: (given) = 30% Debt and 70% Equity
Calculation of overall cost of capital at different investment outlays
Comment: Both the projects, A and B, are not acceptable as the cost of capital is more than the expected yield
of the project. In order to accept the project, the Expected return should always greater than the cost of capital.
Illustration 7
Company X and Company Y are in the same risk class, and are identical in every fashion except that Company
X uses debt while Company Y does not. The levered firm has 9,00,000 debentures, carrying 10% rate of interest.
Both the firms earn 20% before interest and taxes on their total assets of `15 lakh.
Assume perfect capital markets, rational investors and so on; a tax rate of 50% and capitalisation rate of 15% for
an all equity company.
(i) Compute the value of firms X and Y using the Net Income (NI) approach.
(ii) Compute the value of each firm using the Net Operating Income (NOI) approach.
(iii) Using the NOI approach, calculate the overall cost of capital (ko) for firms X and Y.
(iv) Which of these two firms has an optimal capital structure according to the NOI approach? Why?
Solution:
(i) Computation of Value of Firms X and Y using NI Approach:
NI approach assumes no taxes. Since, the tax rate is given in the problem, we have to work out of NI approach.
Value of Levered Firm (X) = Value of Unlevered Firm + Debt (Tax rate)
= Value of Y Ltd. + Debt (Tax rate)
= `10,00,000 + (`9,00,000 × 50%)
= ` 14,50,000
(iii) Computation of Overall Cost of Capital (ko) using NOI approach:
For Y Ltd –
ko = ke = 15% (as there is no debt)
For Firm X –
(iv) Out of two firms, Firm Y seems to have optimum capital structure as it has lower cost of capital
higher value of firm.
Illustration 8
A Company’s current operating income is ` 4 lakh. The firm has ` 10 lakh of 10% debt outstanding. Its cost of
equity capital is estimated to be 15%.
(i) Determine the current value of the firm using traditional valuation approach.
(ii) Calculate the firm’s overall capitalisation ratio as well as both types of leverage ratios (a) B/S (b) B/V.
Solution:
(i) Calculation of value of firm under Traditional Approach:
= 13.33%
Leverage Ratios
` 10,00,000
(a) B/S Ratio =Borrowing/ Shareholders funds = = 0.5
` 20,00,000
` 10,00,000
(b) B/V Ratio =Borrowing/Value of firm = = 0.33
` 30,00,000
in reduction in the value of shares. Thus, in leverage analysis, explicit cost of debt capital is considered, while its
implicit costs are ignored. Leverage principle assumes that the required additional debt capital should be raised till
the expected rate of return on investment is higher than cost of debt capital.
Illustration 9
Calculate the operating leverage for each of the four firms, A, B, C and D from the following price and cost data.
What conclusions can you draw with respect to levels of fixed cost and the degree of operating leverage DOL
result? Explain. Assume number of units sold is 5,000.
Firms
A B C D
Sale Price per Unit (`) 20 32 50 70
Variable Cost per Unit (`) 6 16 20 50
Fixed Operating Cost (`) 80,000 40,000 2,00,000 Nil
Solution:
Firms
A (`) B (`) C (`) D (`)
Sales (Units) 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000
Sales revenue (Units × Price) 1,00,000 1,60,000 2,50,000 3,50,000
Less: Variable cost 30,000 80,000 1,00,000 2,50,000
(Units × VC per unit)
Less: Fixed Operating Costs 80,000 40,000 2,00,000 Nil
EBIT (10,000) 40,000 (50,000) 1,00,000
=7
` 1,60,000 – ` 80,000
DOL(B) =
` 40,000
= 2
` 2,50,000 – ` 1,00,000
DOL(C) =
` 50,000
= 3
` 3,50,000 – ` 2,50,000
DOL(D) =
` 1,00,000
=1
The operating leverage exists only when there are fixed costs. In the case of firm D, there is no magnified effect
on the EBIT due to change in sales, 20% increase in sales has resulted in a 20% increase in EBIT. In the case of
other firms, operating leverage exists. It is maximum in firm A, followed by firm C and minimum in firm B. The
interpretation of DOL of 7 is that 1% change in sales results in 7% change in EBIT level in the direction of the
change of sales level of firm A.
the firm’s operations. For example, a steel mill by way of its heavy investment in plant and equipment will have a
large fixed operating cost component consisting of depreciation. Financial leverage, on the other hand, is always a
choice item. No firm is required to have any long-term debt or preferred stock financing. Firms can, instead, finance
operations and capital expenditures from internal sources and the issuance of common stock. Nevertheless, it is a
rare firm that has no financial leverage.
The most commonly used measures of financial leverages are:
Debt Debt (D)
(i) Debt Ratio = Total Capital (V) = Debt (D) + Shareholders Equity (E)
Debt (D)
(ii) Debt-Equity Ratio: =
Shareholders Equity (E)
EBIT
(iii) Interest Coverage Ratio =
Interest
EBIT
Degree of Financial Leverage (DFL) =
EBT
OR,
Percentage change in Earnings per Share
Degree of Financial Leverage (DFL) =
Percentage change in Operating Profit (EBIT)
Note: (i) Financial Leverage is the change in the level of EPS due to change in EBIT.
(ii) Financial leverage occurs die to presence of fixed financial cost (Interest) in the business.
Illustration 10
EBIT
A company uses the DFL formula as DFL = and finds DFL when EBIT = ` 2,06,000 and EBT =
EBT
` 1,72,000.
Solution:
Here, DFL = (EBIT) / (EBT) = `206,000 / `172,000 = 1.2
The company’s degree of financial leverage is 1.2, indicating a lower level of fluctuation in its earnings, which
means it could likely take on substantial additional debt.
Computationally, we can make use of the fact that the degree of total leverage is simply the product of the degree
of operating leverage and the degree of financial leverage as follows:
Degree of Combined Leverage (DCL) = (Contribution /EBIT) × (EBIT/EBT)
= Contribution/EBT
OR,
% Change in EBIT % Change in EPS % Change in EPS
Degree of Combined Leverage (DCL) = × =
% Change in Sales % Changee in EBIT % Change in Sales
For eample, if operating leverage of a firm= 1.4 whereas financial leverage = 2, then the degree of combined
leverage equals 1.4 × 2 = 2.8.
Illustration 11
The ABC Ltd. has the following balance sheet and income statement information:
` 2,20,000
DFL = = 1.37
` 1,60,000
DCL = DOL × DFL = 1.27 × 1.37 = 1.75
(b) Earnings per share at the new sales level
Illustration 12
A firm’s sales, variable costs and fixed cost amount to ` 75 lakh, ` 42 lakh and ` 6 lakh respectively. It has
borrowed ` 45 lakh at 9% and its equity capital totals ` 55 lakh.
(a) What is the firm’s ROI?
(b) Does it have favorable financial leverage?
(c) If the firm belongs to an industry whose asset turnover is 3, does it have high or low asset leverage?
(d) What are the operating, financial and combined leverages of the firm?
(e) If the sales drop to ` 50 lakh what will the new EBIT be?
(f) At what level will the EBT of the firm equal to zero?
Solution:
(a) ROI = EBIT/Investment
EBIT = Sales – VC – FC
= ` 75 lakh – ` 42 lakh – ` 6 lakh
= ` 27 lakh
ROI = ` 27 lakh/` 100 lakh
= 27 %
(b) Yes, the firm has favourable financial leverage as its ROI is higher than the interest on debt.
(c) Asset turnover = Sales/Total Assets or Total Investments = ` 75 lakh/` 100 lakh = 0.75. It is lower than the
industry average.
Sales - Variable costs ` 75 lakh - ` 42 lakh
(d) Operating Leverage = = = 1.22
EBIT ` 27 lakh
EBIT ` 27 lakh
Financial Leverage = = = 1.18
EBIT - Interest ` 27 lakh - ` 4.05 lakh
Sales - VC ` 33 lakh
Combined Leverage = = = 1.44
EBIT - Interest ` 22,95,000
Alternatively, = OL × FL = 1.22 × 1.18 = 1.44
(f) Zero EBT implies Break-Even Sales (BESR) = FC/CV ratio, CV ratio = ` 33 lakh/` 75 lakh = 44%.
BESR = (` 6 lakh + ` 4.05 lakh)/0.44 = ` 22,84,091.
Confirmation Table
Futhermore, it is profitable to raise debt for strengthening EPS, if there is likelihood that future operating profits
are going to be higher than the level of EBIT as determined. On the other hand, it is advisable to issue equity shares
for raising more funds if it is expected that EBIT is going to be lower than that determined.
Illustration 13
Excel Limited is considering three financing plans. The key information are as follows:
(a) Total funds to be raised, ` 2,00,000.
(b) Financing plans
Solution:
(i) Determination of EPS under plans A, B and C
DP ` 8,000 ` 12,308
Plan C = =
(1-t) 0.65
0.65X (X – ` 8,000)0.65
=
` 10,000 ` 5,000
X = ` 10,400/0.65
= ` 16,000
(b) B and C:
X t 1 t X 1 t D P
N1 N2
or, 0.65X – ` 5,200 = 0.65X – ` 8,000
or, 0.65X – 0.65X = ` 5,200 – ` 8,000
Thus, indifference point between plans B and C is indeterminate.
(c) A and C:
X 1 t X 1 t D P
N1 N2
0.65 0.65X – ` 8,000
=
` 10,000 ` 5,000
or, 0.65X = 13X – ` 16,000
or, X = ` 16,000/0.65
i.e., ` 24,615
Domination of plan: Plan B dominates plan C as the financial BEP of plan B is lower.
Illustration 14
The selected financial data for A, B and C companies for the current year ended March 31, 2024 are as follows:
Particulars A B C
Variable expenses as a percentage of sales 66.67 75 50
Interest expenses (`) 200 300 1000
Degree of operating leverage (DOL) 5 6 2
Degree of financial leverage (DFL) 3 4 2
Income-tax rate 0.35 0.35 0.35
(a) Prepare income statements for A, B, and C companies.
(b) Comment on the financial position and structure of these companies.
Solution:
(a) Income statement of companies A, B and C for the current year, ended March 31, 2024
VC = 0.667 × ` 4,500
= ` 3,000
Company B:
EBIT
4 =
EBIT – ` 300
EBIT = ` 400
S – 0.75 S
6 =
` 400
= ` 9,600
VC = 0.75 × ` 9,600 = ` 7,200
Company C:
EBIT
2 =
EBIT – ` 1,000
EBIT = ` 2,000
S – 0.50 S
6 =
` 2,000
= ` 24,000
VC = 0.50 × ` 24,000
= ` 12,000
(b) The financial position of company C can be regarded better than other companies:
(i) It has the least financial risk as it has minimum degree of financial leverage. It is true that there will be
a more magnified impact on EPS of A and B due to change in EBIT, but, their EBIT level due to low
sales is very low.
(ii) From the point of view of DCL, company C is better placed. The degree of combined leverage is
maximum in company B (24); for company A (15) and for company C it is 4. The total risk (business
plus financial) of company C is the lowest.
(iii) The ability of the company C to meet interest liability is better.
The EBIT/interest ratios for the three companies are:
C, 2.0 (` 2,000 ÷ ` 1,000)
B, 1.5 (` 300 ÷ ` 200)
A, 1.33 (` 400 ÷ ` 300)
Illustration 15
Calculate (a) the operating leverage, (b) financial leverage and (c) combined leverage from the following data
under situations I and II and financial plans, A and B.
(i) Installed capacity- 4,000 units
(ii) Actual production and sales- 75 % of the capacity.
(iii) Selling price- ` 300 per unit
(iv) Variable cost- ` 150 per unit
(v) Fixed cost:
Solution:
(a) Determination of operating leverage
Illustration 16
Calculate operating leverage and financial leverage under situations A, B and C and financial plans 1, 2 and 3
respectively from the following information relating to the operation and capital structure of X, Y, Z Ltd. Also find
out the combinations of operating and financial leverage which give the highest value and the least value.
Financial Plan
Particulars
1 (` ) 2 (` ) 3 (` )
Equity (`) 5,000 7,500 2,500
Debt (`) 5,000 2,500 7,500
Cost of debt (for all plans) (%) 12
Solution:
Illustration 17
The XYZ Company plans to expand assets by 50%. To finance the expansion, it is choosing between a straight
6% debt issue and equity issue. Its current balance sheet and income statement are shown below:
Balance Sheet of XYZ company as on March 31, 2024
Sales levels
` 20 lakh ` 40 lakh ` 80 lakh ` 100 lakh
Sales levels
` 20 lakh ` 40 lakh ` 80 lakh ` 100 lakh
D
ividend decision means the decision-making mechanism of the management regarding declaration of
dividends. It is crucial decision for the top management to determine the portion of earnings available
for the distribution as the dividend at the end of every financial year. A company’s ultimate objective
is the maximization of shareholders’ wealth. It must, therefore, be very vigilant about its profit-sharing
policies to retain the faith of the shareholders. Dividend payout policies derive enormous importance by virtue of
being a bridge between the company and shareholders for profit-sharing. Without an organized dividend policy, it
would be difficult for the investors to judge the intentions of the management.
Dividend is a major cash outlay for many companies. At first glance, it would appear that a company could
distribute as much as possible to please its shareholders. It might seem equally obvious that a firm could invest
money for its shareholders instead of paying dividends.
A firm’s decisions about dividends are often mixed up with other financing and investment decisions. Some
firms pay low dividends because management is optimistic about a firm’s future and wishes to retain earnings for
expansion. Another firm might finance capital expenditures largely by borrowing. This releases cash for dividends.
The firm’s dividend policy must be isolated from other problems of financial management. The dividend policy
is a trade-off between retained earnings on the one hand and paying out cash and issuing shares on the other. There
are many firms that pay dividends and also issue stock from time to time. They could avoid the stock issues (where
costs are highest for the firm) by paying lower dividends. Many other firms restrict dividends so that they do not
have issue shares. They on the other hand could occasionally issue stock and increase dividends. Thus, both firms
face dividend policy trade-off. There are many reasons for paying dividends and there are many reasons for not
paying any dividends. As a result, dividend policy is always controversial.
However, different issues of dividend and dividend policies will be discussed in the following sections.
LIQUIDATING SCRIP
DIVIDEND DIVIDEND
financial management is. The future prospects, expansion,diversification mergers are affecting by dividing policies
and for a healthy and buoyant capitalmarket, both dividends and retained earnings are important factors.
(d) Owner’s considerations: This may include the tax status of shareholders, their opportunities for investment
dilution of ownership etc.
(e) Capital market conditions and inflation: Capital market conditions and rate of inflation also play a
dominant role in determining the dividend policy. The extent to which a firm has access to capital market,
also affects the dividend policy. A firm having easy access to capital market will follow liberal dividend policy
as compared to the firm having limited access. Sometime dividends are paid to keep the firms ‘eligible’ for
certain things in the capital market. In inflation, rising prices eat into the value of money of investors which
they are receiving as dividends. Good companies will try to compensate for rate of inflation by paying higher
dividends. Replacement decision of the companies also affects the dividend policy.
Theory of
Dividend
Walter’s Model
According to this model founded by James E. Walter, the dividend policy of a company has an impact on the
share valuation, i.e., dividends are relevant. The key argument is support of the relevance proposition of Walter’s
model is the relationship between the return on a firm’s investment (its internal rate of return) ‘r’ and its cost of
capital (i.e. the required rate of return) ‘k’. If the return on investments exceeds the cost of capital, the firm should
retain the earnings, whereas it should distribute the earnings to the shareholders in cash the required rate of return
exceeds the expected return on the firm’s investments. The rationale is that if r>k, the firm is able to earn more
than what the shareholders could by reinvesting, if the earnings are paid to them. The implication of r<k is that
shareholders can earn a higher return by reinvesting elsewhere.
Quantitatively,
r
D E D
P k
K
Where:
P = The prevailing market price of a share
Solution:
r
D E D
As per Walter Model = P = k
k
Where,
P = The prevailing market price of a share
D = Dividend per share = 0.3 × `6 = `1.80
E = Earnings per share = ` 6
Illustration 19
From the following data calculate the value of an equity share of each of the following three companies according
to Walter’s Model when dividend pay-out ratio is (i) Nil, (ii) 25%, (iii) 50%, (iv) 75% and (v) 100%.
D + E - D r
Value of each Equity share P = k
k
Where, D = Dividend per share, E = Earnings per share, r = Internal rate of return, k = Cost of Capital and
D/P Ratio = Dividend payout ratio.
D/P Ratio X Ltd. [Where, r > k] Y Ltd. [Where, r < k] Z Ltd. [Where, r = k]
E = ` 10 E = ` 10 E = ` 10
r = 15% or, 0.15 r = 5% or, 0.05 r = 10% or, 0.10
k = 10% or, 0.10 k = 10% or, 0.10 k = 10% or, 0.10
0.15 0.05 0.10
So, r/k = or, 1.5 So, r/k = or, 0.5 So, r/k = or, 1.
0.10 0.10 0.10
When D = E × D/P Ratio D = E × D/P Ratio D = E × D/P Ratio
D/P Ratio = 10 × Nil = Nil = 10 × Nil = Nil = 10 × Nil = Nil
is Nil
Thus, Thus, Thus,
Nil 10 Nill 1.5 Nil 10 Nill 0.5 Nil 10 Nill 1
P P P
0.10 0.10 0.10
= ` 150 = ` 50 = ` 100
Comment: In case of X Ltd., the internal rate of return (r) is more than the cost of capital (k). In this case, the
value of share is increasing alongwiththe decrease in the dividend payout ratio. In this way, it is seen that when the
dividend payout ratio is zero, the value of each share is maximum i.e., ` 150. So, in this case, the firm should retain
the whole earnings in hand without paying dividend so that the value of share is increases. Again, as r > k, X Ltd.
is a Growth firm.
In case of Y Ltd., the internal rate of return (r) is less than the cost of capital (k) i.e., r < k. In this case, the value of
share is increasing alongwith the increase in the dividend payout ratio. In this way, it is seen that when the dividend
payout ratio is maximum (100%, the value of share is maximum (` 100). So, in this case, the firm should distribute
its entire earnings without retaining any earnings so that the value of the share increases. Again, as r < K, Y Ltd.
is a Declining firm.
In case of Z Ltd., the internal rate of return (r) is equivalent to the cost of capital (K) i.e., r = K. In this case,
whatever may be the dividend payout ratio, the value of share always remains constant (` 100). That is, the dividend
payout ratio never affects the value of the share. Again, as r = K, Z Ltd. is a Normal Firm.
Gordon’s Model
According to this model founded by Myron Gordon, the dividend policy of the company has an impact on share
valuation i.e., dividends are relevant. Myron J Gordon (1962) said that “... investors prefer the early resolution of
uncertainty and are willing to pay a higher price of the shares that offer the greater current dividends.”
Gordon suggested -
(i) The higher the earnings retention rate, the greater the required future return from investments to compensate
for risk.
(ii) The risk attitude of investors will ensure that r will rise for each successive year in the future to reflect growth
uncertainty.
The model is based on the following assumptions:
(a) All equity firm: The firm is an all equity firm.
(b) No external financing: No external financing is used and only retained earnings would be used to finance
any expansion.
(c) Constant return: The internal rate of return, ‘r’, of the firm is constant. This ignores the diminishing
marginal efficiency of investment.
(d) Constant cost of capital: The appropriate discount rate, k for the firm remains constant.
(e) Perpetual earnings: The firm and its stream of earnings are perpetual.
(f) No taxes: Corporate taxes do not exist.
(g) Constant retention: The retention ratio, b, once decided upon is constant.
(h) Cost of capital greater than growth rate: The discount rate is greater than the growth, k>g.
Quantitatively,
Y 1 b
P
k br
Where,
P is the price per share
Y is the earnings per share
b is the retention ratio
1-b is the payout ratio
br is the growth rate
r is the return on investment
k is the rate of return required by shareholders (also called capitalization rate)
On comparing r and k, the relationship between market price and the pay-out ratio is exactly the same as compared
to the Walter model.
The crux of Gordon’s arguments is two-fold assumptions:
(a) Investors are risk averse, and
(b) They put a premium on a certain return and discount/penalize uncertain returns. In other words, the rational
investors prefer current dividend.
A company which retains earnings is perceived as risky as the future payment of dividend amount and timing is
uncertain. Thus, they would discount future dividends, that is, they would place less importance on it as compared
to current dividend. The above argument underlying Gordon’s model of dividend relevance is also described as
bird-in-hand argument. i.e., what is available at present is preferable to what may be available in the future. Gordon
argues the more distant the future is, the more uncertain it is likely to be.
Illustration 20
From the following data calculate the value of an Equity Share of each of the following three companies
according to the Gordon’s Model when dividend payout ratio is (i) 25%, (ii) 50%, and (iii) 100%.
Solution:
Statement showing for valuation of each equity share according to Gordon’s Model
E 1 b
Value of each Equity share (P)
k br
Where, k = Cost of Capital, r = Internal rate of return, (1-b) = Dividend payout ratio and b = Retention ratio.
Where b = 75% or, 0.75 b = 75% or, 0.75 b = 75% or, 0.75
(1-b) = 25% or, br = 0.75 × 0.12 = 0.09 br = 0.75 × 0.08 = 0.06 br = 0.75 × 0.10 = 0.075
b = 75%
12 1 0.75 12 1 0.75 12 1 0.75
P P P
0.10 0.09 0.10 0.06 0.10 0.075
12 0.25 12 0.25 12 0.25
0.01 0.04 0.025
= ` 300 = ` 75 = ` 120
Where b = 50% or, 0.50 b = 50% or, 0.50 b = 50% or, 0.50
(1-b) = 50% or, br = 0.50 × 0.12 = 0.06 br = 0.50 × 0.08 = 0.04 br = 0.50 × 0.10 = 0.05
b = 0.50
12 1 0.50 12 1 0.50 12 1 0.50
P P P
0.10 0.06 0.10 0.04 0.10 0.05
12 0.50 12 0.50 12 0.50
0.04 0.04 0.05
= ` 150 = ` 100 = ` 120
Where b =0 b =0 b =0
(1-b) = 100% br = 0 × 0.12 = 0 br = 0 × 0.08 = 0 br = 0 × 0.10 = 0
or,
12 1 0 12 1 0 12 1 0
b=0 P P P
0.10 0 0.10 0 0.10 0
12 12 12
0.10 0.10 0.10
= ` 120 = ` 120 = ` 120
Comment: In case of X Ltd., the internal rate of return is more than the cost of capital i.e. r > k. In this case, the
value of share is increasing along with the decrease in the dividend payout ratio. So, the company should retain
comparatively large amount of retained earnings in hand by reducing the dividend payout ratio so that the value of
share increases. Again, as r > k, X Ltd. is a Growth Firm.
In case of Y Ltd., the internal rate of return is less than the cost of capital i.e. r < k. In this case, the value of share
is increasing along with the increase in the dividend payout ratio. So, the firm should distribute its entire earnings,
without keeping any retained earnings in hand so that the value of the share is maximum. Again, since r < k, Y Ltd.
is a Declining Firm.
In case of Z Ltd., the internal rate of return (r) is equal to the cost of capital (k) i.e. r = k, in this case, whatever
may be the dividend payout ratio, the value of share remains constant. That is, the dividend payout ratio does never
affect the value of the share. Again, since r = k, Z Ltd. is a Normal Firm.
P1 D1
P0
1 k
Where,
P0 is the prevailing market price
k is the cost of equity capital
D1 is the dividend to be received at the end of period one
P1 is the market price at the end of period one
The number of shares to be issued for new projects, in lieu of dividend payments is given by the following
formula:
1 - (E+nD1 )
m=
P1
Where,
n – is the number of shares outstanding at the beginning of the period.
m – is number of new shares issued.
I – Total investment amount required for the new project.
E – Earnings of net income of the firm during the period.
Proof:
Let n represent the original number of outstanding shares of the company, ‘D’ be the dividend distributed to
the ‘n’ shareholders, I be the total investment amount required for the new project, and ‘E’ be the Earnings (net
income) of the firm during the period. And let ‘m’ represent the number of new shares issued to meet the shortfall
in investment issued at a current market price of P1.
According to the M-M Model, the market price of a share in the beginning of the period is equal to the present
value of dividends paid at the end of the period plus the market price of the share at the end of the period. It is
calculated by applying the following formula:
(P1 + D1)
PO =
1+k
Where,
P0 is the prevailing market price.
k is the cost of equity capital.
D1 is the dividend to be received at the end of period one.
P1 is the market price at the end of period one.
Assuming no external financing and the current market capitalization of the firm would be calculated as follows:
(nP1 + nD1)
nPO=
1+k
n is the number of shares.
Adding and subtracting mP1 on numerator in the RHS of the equation, we have–
(m + n) nD1 – mP1
nPO=
1+k
Now, mP1 = Amount raised = Investment – [Earnings – Dividends distributed]
= I – [E-nD1]
Criticisms:
Because of the unrealistic nature of the assumption, M-M’s hypothesis lacks practical relevance in the real-world
situation. Thus, it is being criticised on the following grounds.
(a) The assumption that taxes do not exist is far from reality.
(b) M-M argue that the internal and external financing are equivalent. This cannot be true if the costs of floating
new issues exist.
(c) According to M-M’s hypothesis the wealth of a shareholder will be same whether the firm pays dividends
or not. But, because of the transactions costs and inconvenience associated with the sale of shares to realise
capital gains, shareholders prefer dividends to capital gains.
(d) Even under the condition of certainty it is not correct to assume that the discount rate (k) should be same
whether firm uses the external or internal financing.
(e) If investors have desire to diversify their port folios, the discount rate for external and internal financing will
be different.
(f) M-M argues that, even if the assumption of perfect certainty is dropped and uncertainty is considered,
dividend policy continues to be irrelevant. But according to number of writers, dividends are relevant under
conditions of uncertainty.
Illustration 21
Bangabasi Ltd. belongs to a risk-class for which the appropriate capitalisation rate is 10%. It currently has
outstanding 2000 equity shares of `100 each. The firm is contemplating the declaration of dividend of `8 per share
at the end of the current financial year. It expects to have net earnings of `20,000 and has a proposal for making
new investment of ` 24,000. Show that under the Modigliani–Miller assumption, the payment of dividend does not
affect the value of the firm.
Solution:
P0 = Opening price of each share = `100
P1 = Market price of each share at the end of the year.
D1 = Dividend per share to be paid at the end of the year = ` 8
k = Cost of capital = 0.10.
n = No. of Outstanding share at the beginning of the year = 2,000 shares.
∆n = No. of additional shares to be issued.
E = Earning of the company = ` 20,000.
I = Total amount required for investment = ` 24,000.
= P0
P1 D1
(i) P
1 k
8 + P1
or, 100 =
1 + 0.10
or, 8 + P1 = `100 × 1.10
or, P1 = `110 – 8
or, P1 = `102
P1 n n I E
(iv) Value of the firm (nP0) =
1 k
20, 000
102 2, 000 24, 000 20, 000
102
or, nP0 =
1 0.10
2, 24, 000 24, 000 20, 000
or, nP0 =
1 0.10
2, 20, 000
or, nP0 =
1.10
or, nP0 = ` 2,00,000
Hence, total value of the firm is ` 2,00,000.
Valuation of the firm when dividends are not paid:
= P0
P1 D1
(i) P0
1 k
0 + P1
100 =
1 + 0.10
or, P1 = 100 × 1.10
or, P1 = `110.
(ii) Amount required to be raised from the issue of new share
(∆nP1) = I – (E – nD1)
or, ∆nP1 = `24,000 – (20,000 – 2,000 × 0)
or, ∆nP1 = `24,000 – (20,000 – 0)
or, ∆nP1 = 4,000
(iii) ∆nP1 = 4,000
∆n(110) = `4000 (P1 = 110)
4, 000
or, ∆n =
110
P1 n n I E
(iv) Value of the firm (nP0) =
1 k
4, 000
110 2, 000 24, 000 20, 000
or, nP0 = 110
1 0.10
2, 20, 000
or, nP0 =
1.10
1 D0 1 g 2 1
n D 1 g
t
P 0
t 1 1 k e k e g 2 1 k e t
t
where:
P = Intrinsic value = PV of dividends + PV of price
D t = Expected dividend
= Appropriate discount factor for the investment
= Initial dividend growth rate
= Steady dividend growth rate
Lintner Model
John Linter surveyed dividend behaviour of several corporate and showed that–
(a) Firms set long run target pay-out ratios.
(b) Managers are concerned more about change in the dividend than the absolute level.
(c) Dividends tend to follow earnings, but dividends follow a smoother path than earnings.
(d) Dividends are sticky in nature because managers have a reluctance to effect dividend changes that may have
to be reversed.
Linter expressed corporate dividend behaviour in the form of a following model:
Dt = crEPSt + (1-c)Dt-1
Dt = DPS for year t
c = Adjustment Rate or Speed or Adjustment
r = Target Payout Rate
EPS1 = EPS for year t
Dt-1 = DPS for year t–1
The Linter model shows that the current dividend depends partly on current earnings and partly on previous
year’s dividend. Likewise, the dividend for the previous year depends on the earnings of that year and the dividend
for the year preceding that year, so on and so forth. Thus, as per the Linter Model, dividends can be described in
terms of a weighted average of past earnings.
Dividend Dates
Declaration date: The date on which board of directors declare dividend is called a declaration date.
Record date: Record date, is that date when the company closes its stock transfer books and makes up a list of
the shareholders for payment of dividends.
Ex-dividend date: It is that date notified by the stock exchange, as a date which will entail a buyer of shares, the
dividend, if bought before the ex-dividend date. This date sets up the convention of declaring that the right to the
dividend remains with the stock until ‘x’ days prior to the Record date. Thus, whoever buys share on or beyond the
ex-dividend date are not entitled to dividend.
Payment date: The date on which the company mails the cheques to the recorded holders.
Let us say, settlement of stocks follows ‘T+3’, which means that, when you buy a stock, it takes three days from
the transaction date (T) for the change to be entered into the company’s record books. As mentioned, if you are not
in the company’s recorded books on the date of record, you won’t receive the dividend payment. To ensure that you
are in the record books, you need to buy stock at least three days before the date of record, which also happens to
be the day before the ex-dividend date.
Advantages:
(a) It preserves the company’s liquidity as no cash is used.
(b) The shareholders can liquidate these shares whenever they require.
(c) It is excellent way to bring the paid Capital of the company in line with actual capital employed by the
company in the business.
(d) If broadens the capital base and improves the image of the company.
(e) It is inexpensive method of raising the capital by which the cash resources of the company are conserved.
(f) It reduces the market price of the shares, rendering the shares more marketable
(g) It is perceived as an indication by the market that the company financial position is sound.
Disadvantages:
(a) Since the reserves have been used to issue bonus shares, it indicates that future dividend would decline.
(b) Issue of bonus shares involve lengthy legal procedures and approvals.
Solved Case 1
Alfa Ltd. with net operating earnings of ` 3,00,000 is attempting to evaluate a number of possible capital
structures, given below. Which of the capital structure will you recommend, and why?
Debt in capital Cost of debt (Ki) (per Cost of equity (Ke) (per
Capital structure
structure (` ) cent) cent)
1 3,00,000 10 12
2 4,00,000 10 12.5
3 5,00,000 11 13.5
4 6,00,000 12 15
5 7,00,000 14 18
Solution:
Determination of capital structure
Capital structure having debts of ` 3,00,000 is recommended as the overall cost of capital at this level is
the lowest.
Solved Case 2
From the following selected operating data, determine the degree of operating leverage. Which company has the
greater amount of business risk? Why?
A Ltd (` ) B Ltd (` )
Sales 25,00,000 30,00,000
Fixed costs 7,50,000 15,00,000
Variable expenses as a percentage of sales are 50% for firm A and 25% for firm B.
Solution:
Solved Case 3
The operating income of Hypothetical Ltd amounts to ` 1,86,000. It pays 35% tax on its income. Its capital
structure consists of the following: (`)
Solution:
(i) Determination of EPS
Particulars Amount (`)
EBIT 1,86,000
Less interest (0.14 × ` 5,00,000) 70,000
EBT 1,16,000
Less taxes (0.35) 40,600
EAT 75,400
Less: Dividend on preference shares 15,000
Earnings available for equity holders 60,400
EPS (` 60,400 ÷ 4,000) 15.1
Exercise
A. Theoritical Questions
18. If the fixed cost of production is zero, which one of the following is correct?
(a) OL is zero
(b) FL is zero
(c) CL is zero
(d) None of the above
24. In order to calculate EPS, Profit after Tax and Preference Dividend is divided by:
(a) MP of Equity Shares
(b) Number of Equity Shares
(c) Face Value of Equity Shares
(d) All of the above.
29. Relationship between change in Sales and d Operating Profit is known as:
(a) Financial Leverage
(b) Operating Leverage
(c) Net Profit Ratio
(d) Gross Profit Ratio.
30. If a firm has no Preference share capital, Financial Breakeven level is defined as equal to –
(a) EBIT
(b) Interest liability
(c) Equity Dividend
(d) Tax Liability.
32. Which of the following is not a relevant factor m EPS Analysis of capital structure?
(a) Rate of Interest on Debt
(b) Tax Rate
(c) Amount of Preference Share Capital
(d) Dividend paid last year.
33. For a constant EBIT, if the debt level is further increased then
(a) EPS will always increase
(b) EPS may increase
(c) EPS will never increase
(d) None of the above
34. Between two capital plans, if expected EBIT is more than indifference level of EBIT, then
(a) Both plans be rejected
(b) Both plans are good
(c) One is better than other
(d) Both plans are break-even
36. What is the value of a levered firm L Ltd. if it has the same EBIT as an unlevered firm U Ltd., (with value of
` 700 lakh), has a debt of ` 200 lakh, tax rate is 35 % under M-M approach?
(a) ` 770 lakh
(b) ` 500 lakh
(c) ` 630 lakh
(d) ` 900 lakh
37. The degree of operating leverage and degree of financial leverage of VINTEX LTD. are 2.00 and 1.5
respectively. What will be the percentage change in EPS, if the sale increases by 10%?
(a) 10% increase
(b) 15% increase
(c) 30% increase
(d) 35% increase
38. The Degree of Operating Leverage (DOL) and the Degree of Financial Leverage of ALANTA LTD. are 3
and 1.67 respectively. If the management of the company targets to increase the EPS by 10 %, by how much
percentage should sales volume be increased? (Rounded off your answer to the nearest value.)
(a) 5.00%
(b) 3.40%
(c) 3.00%
(d) 2.00%
39. According to Gordon’s Dividend Capitalisation Model, if the share price of a firm is ` 43, its dividend pay-
out ratio is 60%, cost of equity is 9%, ROI is 12% and the number of shares are 12,000, what will be the net
profit of the firm?
(a) ` 15,480
(b) ` 23,220
(c) ` 36,120
(d) ` 54,180
Answers:
1 a 2 d 3 c
4 a 5 a 6 c
7 a 8 b 9 c
10 c 11 b 12 b
13 b 14 b 15 b
16 c 17 c 18 d
19 b 20 d 21 c
22 c 23 b 24 b
25 b 26 a 27 d
28 b 29 b 30 b
31 b 32 d 33 b
34 c 35 b 36 a
37 c 38 d 39 c
24. According to M-M theory, the market price of the share will remain unchanged even after the payment
of dividends.
25. The term dividend refers to that portion of profit (after tax) or earnings or retained earnings which is
distributed among the owners/shareholders of the firm.
Answers:
1 F 2 F 3 F
4 F 5 T 6 T
7 F 8 F 9 T
10 T 11 T 12 F
13 T 14 F 15 T
16 F 17 T 18 F
19 F 20 T 21 F
22 F 23 T 24 T
25 T
B. Numerical Questions:
~ Comprehensive Numerical Problems
Financing plans
Sources of funds
1 2
Equity 15,000 shares of ` 100 each 30,000 shares of ` 100 each
Preference shares 12%, 25,000 shares of ` 100 each --
Debentures ` 5,00,000 at a coupon rate of 0.10 15,00,000, coupon rate of 0.11
Assuming 35% tax rate,
(i) Determine the two EBIT - EPS coordinates for each financial plan.
(ii) Determine the (a) indifference point, and (b) financial break-even point for each financing plan.
(iii) Which plan has more financial risk and why?
(iv) Indicate over what EBIT range, if any, one plan is better than the other.
(v) If the firm is fairly certain that its EBIT will be ` 12,50,000, which plan would you recommend,
and why?
3. Hypothetical Ltd. is in need of ` 1,00,000 to finance its increased net working capital requirements.
The finance manager of the company believes that its various financial costs and share price will be
unaffected by the selection of a particular plan, since a small sum is involved. Debentures will cost 10%,
preference shares 11%, and equity shares can be sold for ` 25 per share. The tax rate is 35%.
Unsolved Case(s)
1. The two companies, X Ltd. and Y Ltd., belong to an equivalent risk class. These two firms are identical in
every respect except that X Ltd. is unlevered while Company Y Ltd. has 10 % debentures of ` 30 lakh. The
other relevant information regarding their valuation and capitalisation rates are as follows:
(a) An investor owns 10 % equity shares of company Y Ltd. Show the arbitrage process and the amount by
which he could reduce his outlay through the use of leverage.
(b) According to Modigliani and Miller, when will this arbitrage process come to an end?
2. VE Ltd. has EBIT of ` 2 million and tax rate is 40%. The return on equity without debt is 14%. Determine
the value of the company according to M-M hypothesis when,
A. Debt is absent
B. Debt is ` 2 million
C. Debt is ` 6 million
3. GC Ltd. follows a current dividend policy of distributing 40% of its earnings. The shares of the company
trade at ` 200. The management is of the opinion that an increase in the dividend payout from current 40%
to either 50% or 60% would increase the value of the firm and provide better returns to the investors.
Assuming that the firm continues to remain in the same business and expected earnings of ` 40 per share in
the coming year, examine the shareholders’ return if GC Ltd. changes its payout to (a) 50%, and (60%).
4. From the following data, calculate DOL and DFL, and DTL (degree of total leverage). Given the selling
price is ` 2 per unit, fixed cost is ` 1,00,000 and variable cost is ` 7 per unit and the number of units is
1,00,000.
5. From the following data, calculate percentage change in EPS if sales are expected to increase by 5%:
EBIT ` 10,00,000
PBT ` 4,00,000
6. From the following data of four firms, calculate the EPS, the DOL and the DFL:
References:
● Bodie, Zvi et al, Investments, Tata McGraw-Hill Publishing Company Limited New Delhi: 2002.
● Chandra Prasanna, Financial Management, Theory and Practice, McGraw Hill., 2019.
● Fama, Eugene F; French, Kenneth R (Summer 2004). The Capital Asset Pricing Model: Theory and
Evidence. Journal of Economic Perspectives. 18 (3): 25–46.
● Fischer Donald E, and Jordon Ronald J., Security Analysis and Portfolio Management, PHI.
● Francis, Jack Clark, Investments: Analysis and Management, McGraw-Hill, Inc. New York: 1991.
● Gitman, LJ, Principles of Managerial Finance, Harper & Row, New York, 1997.
● H. Markowitz, Portfolio Selection: Efficient Diversification of Investments, John Wiley & Sons, 1959.
● Johnson, R L, Financial Decision Makving, Goodyear Publishing Co., California, 1973.
● Joy, PM, Introduction to Financial Management, Irwin Homewood Ill., p 226.
● Khan, M Y and P K Jain, Financial Management- Text, Problems and Cases, McGraw-Hill Publishing Co.,
New Delhi, 2019.
● Miller, M H and Modigiliani, ‘Dividend policy, growth and the valuation of shares’, Journal of Business,
October 1961, pp 441-33.
● Nemmers, E F and A Grunewald, Basic Managerial Finance, West Publishing Co., New York, 1975.
● Pandey I.M., Financial Management, Pearson, 12th Edition, 2021.
● Solomon, E, Theory of Financial Management, Columbia University Press (New York), 1969.
● Van Horne James C. and Wachowicz John M., Jr. Fundamentals of Financial Management, Prentice Hall,
13th Edition, 2008.
(v) Structured data: It is well organized and easily searchable. It is often found in database and spreadsheets.
(v) Unstructured data: Information that doesn’t have a predefined data model or is not organized in a specific
manner such as text documents, images, videos, social media posts etc.
(vi) Quantitative data: Numerical data that can be measured and expressed using numbers.
(vii)Qualitative data: Descriptive data typically based on qualities or characteristics. It is often captured through
observations, interviews or open ended responses.
(viii)Continuous data: It can take any value within a range like height or weight.
(ix) Categorical data: It falls into specific categories or groups like types of cars or colours.
D
ata plays a very important role in the study of finance and cost accounting. From the inception of the
study of finance, accounting and cost accounting, data always played an important role. Be it in the
form of financial statements, or cost statements etc the finance and accounting professionals played a
significant role in helping the management to make prudent decisions.
The kinds of data used in finance and costing may be quantitative as well as qualitative in nature.
~ Quantitative financial data: By the term ‘quantitative data’, we mean the data expressed in numbers.
The quantitative data availability in finance is significant. The stock price data, financial statements etc
are examples of quantitative data. As most of the financial records are maintained in the form of organised
numerical data.
~ Qualitative financial data: However, some data in financial studies may appear in a qualitative format
e.g. text, videos, audio etc. These types of data may be very useful for financial analysis. For example, the
‘management discussion and analysis’ presented as part of annual report of a company is mostly presented
in the form of text. This information is useful for getting an insight into the performance of the business.
Similarly, key executives often appear for an interview in business channels. These interactions are often
goldmines for data and information.
Types of data
1) Financial data:
2) Market Data:
3) Cost Data:
(iii) Overheads
4) Budgetary Data:
(iii) Demographics
I
n plain terms, digitization implies the process of converting the data and information from analogue to digital
format. The data in the original form may be stored in as an object, a document or an image. The objective
of digitization is to create a digital surrogate of the data and information in the form of binary numbers that
facilitate processing using computers. There are primarily two basic objectives of digitization. First is to
provide a widespread access of data and information to a very large group of users simultaneously. Secondly,
digitization helps in preservation of data for a longer period. One of largest digitization project taken up in India is
‘Unique Identification number’ (UID) or ‘Aadhar’.
Why we digitize?
There are many arguments that favour digitization of records. Some of them are mentioned below:
● Improves classification and indexing for documents, this helps in retrieval of the records.
● Digitized records may be accessed by more than one person simultaneously.
● It becomes easier to reuse the data, which are difficult to reuse in present format e.g. very large maps, data
recorded in microfilms etc.
● Helps in work processing
● Higher integration with business information systems
● Easier to keep back-up files and retrieval during any unexpected disaster
● Can be accessed from multiple locations through networked systems
● Increased scope for rise in organizational productivity
● Requires less physical storage space
How do we digitize?
Large institution takes up digitization projects with meticulous planning and execution. The entire process of
digitization may be segregated into six phases:
Phase 2: Assessment
In any institutions, all records are never digitized. The data that requires digitization is to be decided on the basis
of content and context. Some data may be digitized in a consolidated format, and some in detailed format. The files,
tables, documents, expected future use etc are to be accessed and evaluated for the assessment.
The hardware and software requirements for digitization is also assessed at this stage. The human resource
requirement for executing the digitization project is also planned. The risk assessment at this level e.g. possibilities
of natural disasters, and/or cyber attacks etc also need to be completed.
Phase 3: Planning
Successful execution of digitization project needs meticulous planning. There are several stages for planning e.g.
selection of digitization approach, Project documentation, Resources management, Technical specifications, and
Risk management.
The institution may decide to complete the digitization in-house or alternatively by an outsourced agency. It may
also be done on-demand or in batches.
Phase 4: Digitization activities
Upon the completion of assessment and planning phase, the digitization activities start. The Wisconsin Historical
Society developed a six-phase process viz. Planning, Capture, Primary quality control, Editing, Secondary quality
control, and storage and management.
The planning schedule is prepared at the fist stage, calibration of hardware/software and scanning etc is done
next. A primary quality check is done on the output to check the reliability. Cropping, colour correction, assigning
Metadata etc is done at the editing stage. A final check of quality is done on randomly selected samples. And
finally, user copies are created, and uploaded to dedicated storage space, after doing file validation. The digitization
process may be viewed at figure 8.9 below.
Text
Cropping
Image
Erasing Table Save
PDF PDF
JPEG DOC
GIF RTF
Save
TIFF HTML
etc.... EXCEL
PPT
IR / DL
etc..
Figure 8.9: The complete digitization process. Source: Bandi, S., Angadi, M. and Shivarama, J. Best
practices in digitization: Planning and workflow processes. In Proceedings of the Emerging
Technologies and Future of Libraries: Issues and Challenges (Gulbarga University,
Karnataka, India, 30-31 January), 2015
Phase 6: Evaluation
Once the digitization project is updated and implemented, the final phase should be a systematic determination
of the project’s merit, worth and significant using objective criteria. The primary purpose is to enable reflection and
assist identify changes that would improve future digitization processes.
Transformation of Data to
8.4
Decision Relevant Information
T
he emergence of big data has changed the world of business like never before. The most important shift
has happened in the information generation and the decision-making process. There is a strong emergence
of analytics that supports a more intensive data-centric and data-driven information generation and
decision-making process. The data that encompasses the organization is being harnessed into information
that apprises, cares and prudent decision making in a judicious and repeatable manner.
The pertinent question here is, What an enterprise needs to do for transforming data into relevant information?
As noted earlier, all types of data may not lead to relevant information for decision making. The biannual KPMG
global CFO report says, for today’s finance function leaders, “biggest challenges lie in creating the efficiencies
needed to gather and process basic financial data and continue to deliver traditional finance outputs while at the
same time redeploying their limited resources to enable higher-value business decision support activities.”
To make the data turn into user friendly information, it should go through six core steps:
1. Collection of data: The collection of data may be done with standardized systems in place. Appropriate
software and hardware may be used for this purpose. Appointment of trained staff also plays an important
role in collecting accurate and relevant data.
2. Organising the data: The raw data needs to be organized in an appropriate manner to generate relevant
information. The data may be grouped, arranged in a manner that create useful information for the target
user groups.
3. Data processing: At this step, data needs to be cleaned to remove the unnecessary elements. If any data
point is missing or not available, that also need to be addressed. The options available for presentation
format for the data also need to be decided.
4. Integration of data: Data integration is the process of combining data from various sources into a single,
unified form. This step include creation of data network sources, a master server and users accessing the data
from master server. Data integration eventually enables the analytics tools to produce effective, actionable
business intelligence.
5. Data reporting: Data reporting stage involves translating the data into a consumable format to make
it accessible by the users. For example, for a business firm, they should be able to provide summarized
financial information e.g. revenue, net profit etc. The objective is, a user, who wants to understand the
financial position of the company should get the relevant and accurate information.
6. Data utilization: At this ultimate step, data is being utilized to back corporate activities and enhance
operational efficiencies and productivity for the growth of business. This makes the corporate decision
making really ‘data driven’.
Communication of Information
8.5
for Quality Decision-making
T
he quality information should lead to quality decisions. With the help of well curated and reported data, the
decision makers should be able to add higher-value business insights leading to better strategic decision
making.
In a sense, a judicious use of data analytics is essential for implementation of ‘lean finance’, which implies
optimized finance processes with reduced cost and increased speed, flexibility and quality. By transforming the
information into a process for quality decision making, the firm should achieve the following abilities:
(i) Logical understanding of a wide-ranging structured and unstructured data and put on that information to
corporate planning, budgeting and forecasting and decision support
(ii) Predict outcomes more effectively compared to conventional forecasting techniques based on historical
financial reports
(iii) Real time spotting of emerging opportunities and also capability gaps.
(iv) Making strategies for responding to uncertain events like market volatility and ‘black swan’ events through
simulation.
(v) Diagnose, filter and excerpt value from financial and operational information for making better business
decisions
(vi) Recognize viable advantages to service customers in a better manner
(vii) Identifying possible fraud possibilities on the basis of data analytics.
(viii) Building impressive and useful dashboards to measure and demonstrate success leading to effective
strategies.
Professional Scepticism
8.6
Regarding Data
W
hile data analytics is an important tool for decision making, managers should never take an important
analysis at face value. A deeper understanding of hidden insights that lie underneath the surface of the
data set need to be explored, and what appears on the surface should be looked with some scepticism.
The emergence of new data analytics tools and techniques in financial environment allows the accounting and
finance professionals to gain unique insights into the data, but at the same time creating very unique challenges
while exercising scepticism. As the availability of data is bigger now, analysts and auditors not only getting more
information, but also is facing challenges about managing and investigating red flags.
One major concern about the use of data analytics is the likelihood of false positives, i.e. the data may identify
few potential anomalies that could be later identified as reasonable and explained variation of data.
Studies show that the frequency of false positives increase proportionately with the size and complexity of data.
Few studies also show that analysts face problems while determining outliers using data analytics tools.
Professional scepticism is an important focus area for practitioners, researchers, regulators and standard setters.
At the same time, professional scepticism may result into additional costs e.g. strained client relationships, and
budget coverages.
Under such circumstances, it is important to identify and understand conditions in which the finance and audit
professionals should apply professional scepticism. There is a requirement to keep a fine balance between costly
scepticism and underutilizing data analytics to keep the cost under control.
D
ata analytics can help in decision making process and make an impact. However, this empowerment
for business also comes with challenges. The question is how the business organizations can ethically
collect, store and use data? And what rights need to be upheld? Below we will discuss five guiding
principles in this regard. Data ethics addresses the moral obligations of gathering, protecting and
using personally identifiable information. In present days, it is a major concern for analysts, managers and data
professionals.
The five basic principles of data ethics that a business organization should follow are:
(i) Regarding ownership: The first principle is that ownership of any personal information belongs to the
person. It is unlawful and unethical to collect someone’s personal data without their consent. The consent
may be obtained through digital privacy policies or signed agreements or by asking the users to agree with
terms and conditions. It is always advisable to ask for permission beforehand to avoid future legal and
ethical complications. In case of financial data, some data may be sensitive in nature. Prior permission
must be obtained before using the financial data for further analysis.
(ii) Regarding transparency: Maintaining transparency is important while gathering data. The objective with
which the company is collecting user’s data should be known to the user. For example is the company is
using cookies to track the online behaviour of the user, it should be mentioned to the user through a written
policy that cookies would be used for tracking user’s online behaviour and the collected data will be stored
in a secure database to train an algorithm to enhance user experience. After reading the policy, the user
may decide to accept or not to accept the policy. Similarly, while collecting the financial data from clients,
it should be clearly mentioned that for which purpose the data should be used.
(iii) Regarding privacy: As the user may allow to collect, store and analyze the personally identifiable
information (PII), that does not imply it should be made publicly available. For companies, it is mandatory
to publish some financial information to public e.g. through annual reports. However, there may be many
confidential information, which if falls on a wrong hand may create problems and financial loss. To
protect privacy of data, a data security process should be in place. This may include file encryption and
dual authentication password etc. The possibility of breach of data privacy may also be done through de-
identifying a dataset.
(iv) Regarding intention: The intension of data analysis should never be making profits out of others
weaknesses or for hurting others. Collecting data which is unnecessary for analysis should be avoided and
it’s unethical.
(v) Regarding outcomes: In some cases, even if the intentions are good, the result of data analysis may
inadvertently hurt the clients and data providers. This is called disparate impact, which is unethical.
Exercise
A. Theoretical Questions:
~ Multiple Choice Questions:
1 b 2 a 3 a 4 b 5 d
~ State True or False
1. Improves classification and indexing for documents, this helps in retrieval of the records.
2. Data is not a source of information
3. One of largest digitization project taken up in India is ‘Unique Identification number’ (UID) or ‘Aadhar’
4. When these ‘information’ is used for solving a problem, we may it’s the use of knowledge
5. Any data expressed as a number is a numerical data
Answer:
1 T 2 F 3 T 4 T 5 T
1. Discuss the five basic principles of data ethics that a business organization should follow
2. ‘The quality information should lead to quality decisions’ – Discuss
3. Discuss the six core steps that may turn the data into user friendly information.
4. Discuss the six phases that comprise the entire process of digitization.
5. Why we digitize the data?
Unsolved Case
1. Ram Kumar is the head data scientist of Anjana Ltd. For the last few weeks, he is working along with
his team for extracting information from a huge pile of data collected over time. His team members are
working day and night for collecting and cleaning the data. He has to make a presentation before the senior
management of the company to explain the findings. Discuss the important steps, he need to take care of to
transform raw data into useful knowledge.
References:
● Data-driven business transformation. KPMG International
● Davy Cielen, Arno D B Meysman, and Mohamed Ali. Introducing Data Science. Manning Publications Co
USA
● www.finance.yahoo.com
● www.google.com
● Data, Information and Knowledge. Cambridge International
● Data Analytics and Skeptical Actions: The Countervailing Effects of False Positives and Consistent Rewards
for SkepticismBy Dereck Barr-Pulliam, Joseph Brazel, Jennifer McCallen and Kimberly Walker
● Annual Report of Hindustan Unilever Limited. (2021-22)
● www.uidai.gov.in
● Bandi, S., Angadi, M. and Shivarama, J. Best. Practices in digitization: Planning and workflow processes.
In Proceedings of the Emerging Technologies and Future of Libraries: Issues and Challenges
● Finance’s Key Role in Building the Data-Driven Enterprise. Harvard Business Review Analytic Services
● How to Embrace Data Analytics to Be Successful. Institute of Management Accountants. USA
● The Data Analytics Implementation Journey in Business and Finance. Institute of Management Accountants.
USA
● Principles of data ethics in business. Business Insights. Harvard Business School.
Development of Data
9.1
Processing
D
ata processing (DP) is the process of organising, categorising, and manipulating data in order to extract
information. Information in this context refers to valuable connections and trends that may be used to
address pressing issues. In recent years, the capacity and effectiveness of DP have increased manifold
with the development of technology.
Data processing that used to require a lot of human labour progressively superseded by modern tools and
technology. The techniques and procedures used in DP information extraction algorithms for data are well
developed in recent years, for instance, the treatment of facial data classification is necessary for recognition, and
time series analysis is necessary for processing stock market data.
The information extracted as a result of DP is also heavily reliant on the quality of the data. Data quality may get
affected due to several issues like missing data and duplications. There may be other fundamental problems, such
as incorrect equipment design and biased data collecting, which are more difficult to address.
The history of DP can be divided into three phases as a result of technological advancements (figure 9.1):
MANUAL DP
MECHANICAL DP
ELECTRONIC DP
Figure 9.1: History of data processing
(i) Manual DP: Manual DP involves processing data without much assistance from machines. Prior to the
phase of mechanical DP only small-scale data processing was possible using manual efforts. However, in
some special cases Manual DP is still in use today, and it is typically due to the data’s difficulty in digitization
or inability to be read by machines, like in the case of retrieving data from outdated texts or documents.
(ii) Mechanical DP: Mechanical DP processes data using mechanical (not modern computers) tools and
technologies. This phase began in 1890 (Bohme et al., 1991) when a system made up of intricate punch card
machines was installed by the US Bureau of the Census in order to assist in compiling the findings of a recent
national population census. Use of mechanical DP made it quicker and easier to search and compute the data
than manual process.
(iii) Electronic DP: And finally, the electronic DP replaced the other two that resulted fall in mistakes and
rising productivity. Data processing is being done electronically using computers and other cutting-edge
electronics. It is now widely used in industry, research institutions and academia.
discover significance in numbers that were days, weeks, months, or even years old since that was the only
accessible information.
It was processed in batches, which meant that no analysis could be performed until a batch of data had
been gathered within a predetermined timescale. Consequently, any conclusions drawn from this data were
possibly invalid.
With technological advancement and improved hardware, real-time analytics are now available, as Data
Engineering, Data Science, Machine Learning, and Business Intelligence work together to provide the
optimal user experience. Thanks to dynamic data pipelines, data streams, and a speedier data transmission
between source and analyzer, businesses can now respond quickly to consumer interactions. With real-time
analysis, there are no delays in establishing a customer’s worth to an organisation, and credit ratings and
transactions are far more precise.
(iii) Customer data management: Data science enables effective management of client data. In recent years,
many financial institutions may have processed their data solely through the machine learning capabilities
of Business Intelligence (BI). However, the proliferation of big data and unstructured data has rendered
this method significantly less effective for predicting risk and future trends.
There are currently more transactions occurring every minute than ever before, thus there is better data
accessibility for analysis. Due to the arrival of social media and new Internet of Things (IoT) devices, a
significant portion of this data does not conform to the structure of organised data previously employed.
Using methods such as text analytics, data mining, and natural language processing, data science is well-
equipped to deal with massive volumes of unstructured new data. Consequently, despite the fact that data
availability has been enhanced, data science implies that a company’s analytical capabilities may also be
upgraded, leading to a greater understanding of market patterns and client behaviour.
(iv) Consumer Analytics: In a world where choice has never been more crucial, it has become evident that
each customer is unique; nonetheless, there have never been more consumers. This contradiction cannot
be sustained without the intelligence and automation of machine learning.
It is as important to ensure that each client receives a customised service as it is to process their data swiftly
and efficiently, without time-intensive individualised analysis.
As a consequence, insurance firms are using real-time analytics in conjunction with prior data patterns
and quick analysis of each customer’s transaction history to eliminate sub-zero consumers, enhance cross-
sales, and calculate a consumer’s lifetime worth. This allows each financial institution to keep their own
degree of security while still reviewing each application individually.
(v) Customer segmentation: Despite the fact that each consumer is unique, it is only possible to comprehend
their behaviour after they have been categorised or divided. Customers are frequently segmented based on
socioeconomic factors, such as geography, age, and buying patterns.
By examining these clusters collectively, organisations in the financial industry and beyond may assess a
customer’s current and long-term worth. With this information, organisations may eliminate clients who
provide little value and focus on those with promise.
To do this, data scientists can use automated machine learning algorithms to categorise their clients based
on specified attributes that have been assigned relative relevance scores. Comparing these groupings to
former customers reveals the expected value of time invested with each client.
(vi) Personalized services: The requirement to customise each customer’s experience extends beyond gauging
risk assessment. Even major organisations strive to provide customised service to their consumers as a
method of enhancing their reputation and increasing customer lifetime value. This is also true for businesses
in the finance sector.
From customer evaluations to telephone interactions, everything can be studied in a way that benefits both
the business and the consumer. By delivering the consumer a product that precisely meets their needs,
cross-selling may be facilitated by a thorough comprehension of these interactions.
Natural language processing (NLP) and voice recognition technologies dissect these encounters into a
series of important points that can identify chances to increase revenue, enhance the customer service
experience, and steer the company’s future. Due to the rapid progress of NLP research, the potential is yet
to be fully realised.
(vii) Advanced customer service: Data science’s capacity to give superior customer service goes hand in
hand with its ability to provide customised services. As client interactions may be evaluated in real-time,
more effective recommendations can be offered to the customer care agent managing the customer’s case
throughout the conversation.
Natural language processing can offer chances for practical financial advise based on what the consumer
is saying, even if the customer is unsure of the product they are seeking.
The customer support agent can then cross-sell or up-sell while efficiently addressing the client’s inquiry.
The knowledge from each encounter may then be utilised to inform subsequent interactions of a similar
nature, hence enhancing the system’s efficacy over time.
(viii) Predictive Analytics: Predictive analytics enables organisations in the financial sector to extrapolate from
existing data and anticipate what may occur in the future, including how patterns may evolve. When
prediction is necessary, machine learning is utilised. Using machine learning techniques, pre-processed
data may be input into the system in order for it to learn how to anticipate future occurrences accurately.
More information improves the prediction model. Typically, for an algorithm to function in shallow
learning, the data must be cleansed and altered. Deep learning, on the other hand, changes the data without
the need for human preparation to establish the initial rules, and so achieves superior performance.
In the case of stock market pricing, machine learning algorithms learn trends from past data in a certain
interval (may be a week, month, or quarter) and then forecast future stock market trends based on this
historical information. This allows data scientists to depict expected patterns for end-users in order to assist
them in making investment decisions and developing trading strategies.
(ix) Fraud detection: With a rise in financial transactions, the risk for fraud also increases. Tracking incidents of
fraud, such as identity theft and credit card scams, and limiting the resulting harm is a primary responsibility
for financial institutions. As the technologies used to analyse big data become more sophisticated, so do
their capacity to detect fraud early on.
Artificial intelligence and machine learning algorithms can now detect credit card fraud significantly more
precisely, owing to the vast amount of data accessible from which to draw trends and the capacity to
respond in real time to suspect behaviour.
If a major purchase is made on a credit card belonging to a consumer who has traditionally been very
frugal, the card can be immediately terminated, and a notification sent to the card owner.
This protects not just the client, but also the bank and the client’s insurance carrier. When it comes to
trading, machine learning techniques discover irregularities and notify the relevant financial institution,
enabling speedy inquiry.
(x) Anomaly detection: Financial services have long placed a premium on detecting abnormalities in a
customer’s bank account activities, partly because anomalies are only proved to be anomalous after the
event happens. Although data science can provide real-time insights, it cannot anticipate singular incidents
of credit card fraud or identity theft.
However, data analytics can discover instances of unlawful insider trading before they cause considerable
harm. The methods for anomaly identification consist of Recurrent Neural Networks and Long Short-Term
Memory models.
These algorithms can analyse the behaviour of traders before and after information about the stock market
becomes public in order to determine if they illegally monopolised stock market forecasts and took
advantage of investors. Transformers, which are next-generation designs for a variety of applications,
including Anomaly Detection, are the foundation of more modern solutions.
(xi) Algorithmic trading: Algorithmic trading is one of the key uses of data science in finance. Algorithmic
trading happens when an unsupervised computer utilising the intelligence supplied by an algorithm trade
suggestion on the stock market. As a consequence, it eliminates the risk of loss caused by indecision and
human error.
The trading algorithm used to be developed according to a set of stringent rules that decide whether it
will trade on a specific market at a specific moment (there is no restriction for which markets algorithmic
trading can work on).
This method is known as Reinforcement Learning, in which the model is taught using penalties and rewards
associated with the rules. Each time a transaction proves to be a poor option, a model of reinforcement
learning ensures that the algorithm learns and adapts its rules accordingly.
One of the primary advantages of algorithmic trading is the increased frequency of deals. Based on facts
and taught behaviour, the computer can operate in a fraction of a second without human indecision or
thought. Similarly, the machine will only trade when it perceives a profit opportunity according to its rule
set, regardless of how rare these chances may be.
(v) Reporting:
Data reporting is the act of gathering and structuring raw data and turning it into a consumable format in order to
evaluate the organisation’s continuous performance.
The data reports can provide answers to fundamental inquiries regarding the status of the firm. They can display
the status of certain data within an Excel document or a simple data visualisation tool. Static data reports often
employ the same structure throughout time and collect data from a single source.
A data report is nothing more than a set of documented facts and numbers. Consider the population count as an
illustration. This is a technical paper conveying basic facts on the population and demographics of a country. It may
be presented in text or in a graphical manner, such as a graph or chart. However, static information may be utilised
to evaluate present situations.
(vi) Classification:
Data classification is the process of classifying data according to important categories so that it may be utilised and
safeguarded more effectively. The categorization process makes data easier to identify and access on a fundamental
level. Regarding risk management, compliance, and data security, the classification of data is of special relevance.
Classifying data entails labelling it to make it searchable and trackable. Additionally, it avoids many duplications
of data, which can minimise storage and backup expenses and accelerate the search procedure. The categorization
process may sound very technical, yet it is a topic that your organisation’s leadership must comprehend.
Three primary methods of data classification are recognised as industry standards:
● Classification based on content, examines and interprets files for sensitive data.
● Context-based classification considers, among other characteristics, application, location, and creator as
indirect markers of sensitive information.
● User-based classification relies on the human selection of each document by the end user. To indicate
sensitive documents, user-based classification depends on human expertise and judgement during document
creation, editing, review, or distribution.
In addition to the classification kinds, it is prudent for an organisation to identify the relative risk associated with
the data types, how the data is handled, and where it is stored/sent (endpoints). It is standard practise to divide data
and systems into three risk categories.
~ Low risk: If data is accessible to the public and recovery is simple, then this data collection and the
mechanisms around it pose a smaller risk than others.
~ Moderate risk: Essentially, they are non-public or internal (to a business or its partners) data. However, it is
unlikely to be too mission-critical or sensitive to be considered “high risk.” The intermediate category may
include proprietary operating processes, cost of products, and certain corporate paperwork.
~ High risk: Anything even vaguely sensitive or critical to operational security falls under the category of high
risk. Additionally, data that is incredibly difficult to retrieve (if lost). All secret, sensitive, and essential data
falls under the category of high risk.
Data classification matrix
Data creation and labelling may be simple for certain companies. If there are not a significant number of data
kinds or if your firm has fewer transactions, it will likely be easier to determine the risk of your data and systems.
However, many businesses working with large volumes or numerous types of data will certainly require a thorough
method for assessing their risk. Many utilise a “data categorization matrix” for this purpose.
Creating a matrix that rates data and/or systems based on how likely they are to be hacked and how sensitive the
data is enables you to rapidly identify how to classify and safeguard all sensitive information (figure 9.3).
Access Only those individuals EMU employees and non- EMU affiliates and general
designated with approved employees who have a public with a need to know
access. - business need to know
Figure 9.3: Sample risk classification matrix
Data classification process
Steps for effective data classification
~ Understanding the current setup: Taking a comprehensive look at the location of the organisation’s current
data and any applicable legislation is likely the best beginning point for successfully classifying data. Before
one classifies data, one must know what data he is having.
~ Creation of a data classification policy: Without adequate policy, maintaining compliance with data
protection standards in an organisation is practically difficult. Priority number one should be the creation of
a policy.
~ Prioritize and organize data: Now that a data classification policy is in place, it is time to categorise the
data. Based on the sensitivity and privacy of the data, the optimal method to be chosen for tagging it.
~ Types of distribution
Distributions are basically classified based on the type of data:
(i) Discrete distributions: A discrete distribution that results from countable data and has a finite number
of potential values. In addition, discrete distributions may be displayed in tables, and the values of the
random variable can be counted. Example: rolling dice, selecting a specific amount of heads, etc.
Following are the discrete distributions of various types:
(a) Binomial distributions: The binomial distribution quantifies the chance of obtaining a specific
number of successes or failures each experiment.
Binomial distribution applies to attributes that are categorised into two mutually exclusive and
exhaustive classes, such as number of successes/failures and number of acceptances/rejections.
Example: When tossing a coin: The likelihood of a coin falling on its head is one-half and the
probability of a coin landing on its tail is one-half.
(b) Poisson distribution: The Poisson distribution is the discrete probability distribution that quantifies
the chance of a certain number of events occurring in a given time period, where the events occur in
a well-defined order.
Poisson distribution applies to attributes that can potentially take on huge values, but in practise take
on tiny ones.
Example: Number of flaws, mistakes, accidents, absentees etc.
(c) Hypergeometric distribution: The hypergeometric distribution is a discrete distribution that
assesses the chance of a certain number of successes in (n) trials, without replacement, from a
sufficiently large population (N). Specifically, sampling without replacement.
The hypergeometric distribution is comparable to the binomial distribution; the primary distinction
between the two is that the chance of success is not the same for all trials in the binomial distribution
but it is in the hypergeometric distribution.
(d) Geometric distribution: The geometric distribution is a discrete distribution that assesses the
probability of the occurrence of the first success. A possible extension is the negative binomial
distribution.
Example: A marketing representative from an advertising firm chooses hockey players from several
institutions at random till he discovers an Olympic participant.
(ii) Continuous distributions: A distribution with an unlimited number of (variable) data points that may
be represented on a continuous measuring scale. A continuous random variable is a random variable
with an unlimited and uncountable set of potential values. It is more than a simple count and is often
described using probability density functions (pdf). The probability density function describes the
characteristics of a random variable. Normally clustered frequency distribution is seen. Therefore, the
probability density function views it as the distribution’s “shape.”
In certain mapping tools, defining the location of the shop might be challenging. A store’s postal code will also
facilitate the generation of neighborhood-specific data. Without a postal code data verification, it is more probable
that data may lose its value. If the data needs to be recollected or the postal code needs to be manually input, further
expenses will also be incurred.
A straightforward solution to the issue would be to provide a check that guarantees a valid postal code is entered.
The solution may be a drop-down menu or an auto-complete form that enables the user to select a valid postal code
from a list. This kind of data validation is referred to as a code validation or code check.
Solved Case 1
Maitreyee is working as a data analyst with a financial organisation. She is supplied with a large amount of
data, and she plans to use statistical techniques for inferring some useful information and knowledge from it. But,
before starting the process of data analysis, she found that the provided data is not cleaned. She knows that before
applying the data analysis tools, cleaning the data is essential.
In your opinion, what steps Maitreyee should follow to clean the data, and what are the benefits of clean data.
Teaching note - outline for solution:
The instructor may initiate the discussions with explaining the concept of data cleaning and about the importance
of data cleaning.
The instructor may also elaborate the consequences of using an uncleaned dataset on the final analysis. She may
discuss the steps five steps of data cleaning in detail, such as,
(i) Removal of duplicate and irrelevant information
(ii) Fix structural errors
(iii) Filter unwanted outliers
(iv) Handle missing data
(v) Validation and QA
At the outset, Maitreyee should focus on answering the following questions:
(a) Does the data make sense?
(b) Does the data adhere to the regulations applicable to its field?
(c) Does it verify or contradict your working hypothesis, or does it shed any light on it?
(d) Can data patterns assist you in formulating your next theory?
(e) If not, is this due to an issue with data quality?
The instructor may close the discussions with explaining the benefits of using clean data, such as:
(i) Validity
(ii) Accuracy
(iii) Completeness
(iv) Consistency
Exercise
A. Theoretical Questions:
~ Multiple Choice Questions
1 d 2 a 3 a 4 a 5 a
1. Data validation could be operationally defined as a process which ensures the correspondence of the
final (published) data with a number of quality characteristics.
2. Data analysis is described as the process of cleaning, converting, and modelling data to obtain actionable
business intelligence.
3. Financial data such as revenues, accounts receivable, and net profits are often summarised in a company’s
data reporting.
4. Structured data consists of tabular information that may be readily imported into a database and then
utilised by analytics software or other applications.
5. Data distribution is a function that identifies and quantifies all potential values for a variable, as well as
their relative frequency (probability of how often they occur).
Answer:
1 T 2 T 3 T 4 T 5 T
~ Fill in the blanks
1. Data may be classified as Restricted, ________ or Public by an entity.
2. Data organisation is the _____________ of unstructured data into distinct groups.
3. Classification, frequency distribution tables, _______________, graphical representations, etc. are
examples of data organisation techniques.
4. The distribution or student’s distribution is a probability distribution with a bell shape that is symmetrical
about it’s ______.
5. _________ is the process of correcting or deleting inaccurate, corrupted, improperly formatted, duplicate,
or insufficient data from a dataset.
Answer:
1 Private 2 Classification
3 Image representation 4 mean
5 Data cleaning
References:
● Davy Cielen, Arno D B Meysman, and Mohamed Ali. Introducing Data Science. Manning Publications Co
USA
● www.tableau.com
● www.corporatefinanceinstitute.com
● Marco Di Zio, Nadežda Fursova, Tjalling Gelsema, Sarah Gießing, Ugo Guarnera, Jūratė Petrauskienė, Lucas
Quensel-von Kalben, Mauro Scanu, K.O. ten Bosch, Mark van der Loo, Katrin Walsdorfer. Methodology of
data validation
● Barbara S Hawkins, and Stephen W Singer. Design, development and implementation of data processing
system for multiple control trials and epidemiologic studies. Controlled clinical trials (1986)
instance, if the objective is to display the income from the prior quarter, the goal is declarative. If, on the
other hand, one is curious as to whether the income increase correlates with the social media spending, the
objective is exploratory. According to Berinato, determining the answers would assist in determining the
tools and formats required.
● Always keep the audience in mind: Who views the data visualisations will determine the degree of
detail required. For instance, finance data presentations for the C-suite require high-level, highly relevant
information to aid in strategic decision-making. However, if one is delivering a presentation to ‘line of
business’ executives, delving into the deeper details might offer them with knowledge that influences their
daily operations.
● Invest in the best technology: There are a multitude of technological tools that make it simple to produce
engaging visualisations in the current digital age. The firm should first implement an ERP that removes data
silos and develops a centralised information repository. Then, look for tools that allows to instantly display
data by dragging and dropping assets, charts, and graphs; offer search options and guided navigation to assist
in answering queries; and enable any member of the financial team to generate graphics.
● Improve the team’s ability to visualise data: Most of the agile finance directors rank their team’s data
visualisation abilities as good, compared to only twenty four percent of their counterparts, according to an
AICPA survey. While everyone on the finance team can understand the fundamentals of data visualisation,
training and a shift in hiring priorities may advance the team’s data visualisation skills. Find ways
to incorporate user training on data visualisation tools, so that the staff is aware of the options that the
technology affords. Additionally, when making new recruits, look out individuals with proficiency in data
analytics and extensive data visualisation experience.
The amount of data analysed by financial teams has grown dramatically. Data visualisations may help the team
convey its strategic findings more effectively throughout the enterprise.
T
he absence of data visualisation would make it difficult for organisations to immediately recognise data
patterns. The graphical depiction of data sets enables analysts to visualise new concepts and patterns.
With the daily increase in data volume, it is hard to make sense of the quintillion bytes of data without
data proliferation, which includes data visualisation.
Every company may benefit from a better knowledge of their data, hence data visualisation is expanding into
all industries where data exists. Information is the most crucial asset for every organisation. Through the use of
visuals, one may effectively communicate their ideas and make use of the information.
Dashboards, graphs, infographics, maps, charts, videos, and slides may all be used to visualise and comprehend
data. Visualizing the data enables decision-makers to interrelate the data to gain better insights and capitalises on
the following objectives of data visualisation:
● Making a better data analysis:
Analysing reports assists company stakeholders’ in focusing their attention on the areas that require it. The
visual mediums aid analysts in comprehending the essential business issues. Whether it is a sales report or a
marketing plan, a visual representation of data assists businesses in increasing their profits through improved
analysis and business choices.
● Faster decision making:
Visuals are easier for humans to process than tiresome tabular forms or reports. If the data is effectively
communicated, decision-makers may move swiftly on the basis of fresh data insights, increasing both
decision-making and corporate growth.
● Analysing complicated data:
Data visualisation enables business users to obtain comprehension of their large quantities of data. It is
advantageous for them to identify new data trends and faults. Understanding these patterns enables users to
focus on regions that suggest red flags or progress. In turn, this process propels the firm forward.
The objective of data visualisation is rather obvious. It is to interpret the data and apply the information for the
advantage of the organisation. Its value increases as it is displayed. Without visualisation, it is difficult to rapidly
explain data discoveries, recognise trends to extract insights, and engage with data fluidly.
Without visualisation, data scientists won’t be able to see trends or flaws. Nonetheless, it is essential to effectively
explain data discoveries and extract vital information from them. And interactive data visualisation tools make all
the difference in this regard.
The continuing epidemic is a current example that is both topical and recent. However, data visualisation assists
specialists in remaining informed and composed despite the volume of data.
(i) Data visualisation enhances the effect of communications for the audiences and delivers the most convincing
data analysis outcomes. It unites the organisation’s communications systems across all organisations and
fields.
(ii) Visualisation allows to interpret large volumes of data more quickly and effectively at a glance. It facilitates
a better understanding of the data for measuring its impact on the business and graphically communicates
the knowledge to internal and external audiences.
(iii) One cannot make decisions in a vacuum. Data and insights available to decision-makers facilitate decision
analysis. Unbiased data devoid of mistakes enables access to the appropriate information and visualisation
to convey and maintain the relevance of that information.
Data Presentation
10.3
Architecture
D
ata presentation architecture (DPA) is a set of skills that aims to identify, find, modify, format, and
present data in a manner that ideally conveys meaning and provides insight. According to Kelly Lautt,
“data Presentation Architecture (DPA) is a rarely applied skill set critical for the success and value of
Business Intelligence. Data presentation architecture weds the science of numbers, data and statistics
in discovering valuable information from data and making it usable, relevant and actionable with the arts of data
Visualisation, communications, organisational psychology and change management in order to provide business
intelligence solutions with the data scope, delivery timing, format and Visualisations that will most effectively
support and drive operational, tactical and strategic behaviour toward understood business (or organisational)
goals. DPA is neither an IT nor a business skill set but exists as a separate field of expertise. Often confused with
data Visualisation, data presentation architecture is a much broader skill set that includes determining what data
on what schedule and in what exact format is to be presented, not just the best way to present data that has already
been chosen (which is data Visualisation). Data Visualisation skills are one element of DPA.”
Objectives
There are following objectives of DPA:
(i) Utilize data to impart information in the most efficient method feasible (provide pertinent, timely and
comprehensive data to each audience participant in a clear and reasonable manner that conveys important
meaning, is actionable and can affect understanding, behaviour and decisions).
(ii) To utilise data to deliver information as effectively as feasible (minimise noise, complexity, and unneeded
data or detail based on the demands and tasks of each audience).
Scope of DPA
In the light of abovementioned objectives, the scope of DPA may be defined as:
(i) Defining significant meaning (relevant information) required by each audience member in every scenario.
(ii) Obtaining the proper data (focus area, historic reach, extensiveness, level of detail, etc.)
(iii) Determining the needed frequency of data refreshes (the currency of the data)
(iv) determining the optimal presentation moment (the frequency of the user needs to view the data)
(v) Using suitable analysis, categorization, visualisation, and other display styles
(vi) Developing appropriate delivery techniques for each audience member based on their job, duties, locations,
and technological access
10.4.1 Dashboard
A data visualisation dashboard (Figure 10.3) is an interactive dashboard that enables to manage important metrics
across numerous financial channels, visualise the data points, and generate reports for customers that summarise
the results.
Creating reports for your audience is one of the most effective means of establishing a strong working relationship
with them. Using an interactive data dashboard, the audience would be able to view the performance of their
company at a glance.
On addition to having all the data in a single dashboard, a data visualisation dashboard helps to explain what the
company is doing and why, also fosters client relationships, and gives a data set to guide decision-making.
There are numerous levels of dashboards, ranging from those that represent metrics vital to the firm as a whole
to those that measure values vital to teams inside an organisation. For a dashboard to be helpful, it must be
automatically or routinely updated to reflect the present condition of affairs.
Figure 10.3: A sample dashboard showing traveller spend analysis using Tableau (Source: https://www.tableau.com/)
Figure 10.4: Bar chart showing the change in EVA for Hindustan Unilever Ltd. (Source: HUL annual
report for the year 2021-22)
Figure 10.5: Line graph: The movement of HUL share price over time (Source: HUL annual report for the
year 2021-22)
Figure 10.6: Pie Chart - Categories of HUL shareholders as on 31st March 2022 (Source: HUL annual
report for the year 2021-22)
(iv) Map:
For displaying any type of location data, including postal codes, state abbreviations, country names, and
custom geocoding, maps are a no-brainer. If the data is related with geographic information, maps are a
simple and effective approach to illustrate the relationship.
There should be a correlation between location and the patterns in the data. Such as insurance claims by
state and product export destinations by country, automobile accidents by postal code, and custom sales
areas etc.
Figure 10.7: Map: Average state GDP growth (Source: Economist intelligence unit)
Figure 10.8: Cyclone hazard prone districts of India considering all the parameters and wind based on
BMTPC Atlas (Source: www.ndma.gov.in)
(vi) Scatter plots
Scatter plots are a useful tool for examining the connection between many variables, revealing whether one
variable is a good predictor of another or whether they tend to vary independently. A scatter plot displays
several unique data points on a single graph.
Figure 10.9: Grouped Scatterplot - Number of holdings and Irrigated area in Andhra Pradesh. (Source:
indiadataportal.com)
(vii) Gantt Chart
Gantt charts represent a project’s timeline or activity changes across time. A Gantt chart depicts tasks that
must be accomplished before others may begin, as well as the allocation of resources. However, Gantt
charts are not restricted to projects. This graphic can depict any data connected to a time series. Figure
10.10 depicts the Gnatt chart of a project.
Figure 10.11: Bubble chart: the proportions of professions of people who generate programming languages
(Source: Wikipedia)
(ix) Histogram
Histograms illustrate the distribution of the data among various groups. Histograms divide data into
discrete categories (sometimes known as “bins”) and provide a bar proportionate to the number of entries
inside each category. This chart type might be used to show data such as number of items. Figure 10.12 is
showing the sample histogram chart showing the frequency of something in terms of age.
6 Frequency
4
Frequency
0 5 10 15 20 More
Age
10.4.3 Tables
Tables, often known as “crosstabs” or “matrices,” emphasise individual values above aesthetic formatting. They
are one of the most prevalent methods for showing data and, thus, one of the most essential methods for analysing
data. While their focus is not intrinsically visual, as reading numbers is a linguistic exercise, visual features may be
added to tables to make them more effective and simpler to assimilate.
Tables are most frequently encountered on websites, as part of restaurant menus, and within Microsoft Excel.
It is crucial to know how to interpret tables and make the most of the information they provide since they are
ubiquitous. It is also crucial for analysts and knowledge workers to learn how to make information easier for their
audience to comprehend.
Analysts typically utilise tables to view specific values. They facilitate the identification of measurements or
dimensions across a set of intervals (e.g., what was the company’s profit in November 2018) (Ex. How many
sales did each person close in 2019). A summary table may also efficiently summarise a huge data collection by
providing subtotals and grand totals for each interval or dimension. The problem with tables is that they scale
poorly. More than ten to fifteen rows and five columns make the table difficult to read, comprehend, and get insight
from. This is because a table engages the brain’s linguistic systems whereas data visualisation excites the brain’s
visual systems.
Adding visual features to the table will allow users to obtain understanding from the data more quickly than
with a simple table. Gradients of colour and size aid in identifying trends and outliers. Icons assist the observer
in recognising a shift in proportions. Using different markings will highlight relationships more effectively than a
table of raw data.
Tables and crosstabs are handy for doing comparative analysis between certain data points. They are simple
to construct and may effectively convey a single essential message. Before including a crosstab into a data
visualisation, one should assess whether it serves the project’s aims. Figure 10.13 shows a sample Visualisation of
tabular data.
W
e will now examine some of the most successful data visualisation tools for data scientists and how they
may boost their productivity. Here are four popular data visualisation tools that may assist data scientists
in making more compelling presentations.
(i) Tableau
Tableau is a data visualisation application for creating interactive graphs, charts, and maps. It enables one
to connect to many data sources and generate visualisations in minutes.
Tableau Desktop is the first product of its kind. It is designed to produce static visualisations that may be
published on one or more web pages, but it is incapable of producing interactive maps.
Tableau Public is a free version of Tableau Desktop with some restrictions.
It takes time and effort to understand Tableau, but there are several tools available to assist doing it. As a
data scientist, Tableau must be the most important tool one should understand and employ on a daily basis.
The application may be accessed through https://www.tableau.com/ (Figure 10.14)
(iv) QlikView
QlikView is a data discovery platform that enables users to make quicker, more informed choices by
speeding analytics, uncovering new business insights, and enhancing the precision of outcomes.
An easy software development kit that has been utilized by enterprises worldwide for many years. It may
mix diverse data sources with color-coded tables, bar graphs, line graphs, pie charts, and sliders.
It has been designed using a “drag and drop” Visualisation interface, allowing users to input data from a
variety of sources, including databases and spreadsheets, without having to write code. These properties
also make it a reasonably easy-to-learn and -understand instrument. The application may be accessed
through https://www.qlik.com/us/products/qlikview (Figure 10.17)
Solved Case 1
Sutapa is working as an analyst with SN Company Limited. She is entrusted with the responsibility of making a
presentation before the senior management. She knows that data Visualisation is an important tool for presentation,
and a good data Visualisation can make her presentation more effective. However, she is not very sure about the
data visualisation tools, that are available.
What are the important data Visualisation tools available that Sutapa may use for an effective and impressive
presentation.
Teaching note - outline for solution:
The instructor may initiate the discussions with explaining the importance of data Visualisation. She may also
discuss the objectives of data Visualisation:
(i) Making a better data analysis:
(ii) Faster decision making
(iii) Analysing complicated data
For an effective data Visualisation, the presenter should keep certain important issues in mind:
(i) Know the objective
(ii) Always keep the audience in mind
(iii) Invest in the best technology
(iv) Improve the team’s ability to visualise data
There are various tools available for data Visualisation. The instructor may extend the discussion with mentioning
the following tools. He should also explain the suitability of each tool for visualising and presenting the data:
(i) Dashboards
(ii) Bar charts
(iii) Histogram
(iv) Pie chart
(v) Line chart
(vi) Maps
(vii) Gantt chart
(viii) Bubble Chart etc.
One of the major comforting factor is development of recent software that makes the process of data Visualisation
less painful. The instructor may conclude the discussions with mention of few popular softwares, viz:
(i) Microsoft Power Bi
(ii) Tableau
(iii) Microsoft Excel etc
Exercise
A. Theoretical Questions:
~ Multiple Choice Questions
1 d 2 d 3 d 4 d 5 a
1. Data visualisation enhances the effect of communications for the audiences and delivers the most
convincing data analysis outcomes.
2. Visualisation allows to interpret large volumes of data more quickly and effectively at a glance.
3. Data presentation architecture (DPA) is a set of skills that aims to identify, find, modify, format, and
present data in a manner that ideally conveys meaning and provides insight.
4. Scatter plots are a useful tool for examining the connection between many variables, revealing whether
one variable is a good predictor of another or whether they tend to vary independently.
5. Gantt charts represent a project’s timeline or activity changes across time.
Answer:
1 T 2 T 3 T 4 T 5 T
1. Discuss the ways in which the finance professionals may be helped by data Visualisation in analysing
and reporting information.
2. Discuss the objectives of data Visualisation.
3. How to use data Visualisation in report design?
Unsolved Case(s)
1. Maitreyee works as a financial analyst with a bank. The departmental meeting with her managing director is
going to happen very soon. Maitreyee is entrusted with the task of preparing a dashboard that will cover the
performance of his department during the past quarter. She wants to prepare the dashboard in such a way,
that it should not look cluttered, but at the same time, it covers all the available information in a visually
pleasing manner.
Discuss the different approaches Maitreyee may adopt to meet her objective.
References:
● Davy Cielen, Arno D B Meysman, and Mohamed Ali. Introducing Data Science. Manning Publications Co
USA
● Cathy O’Neil, Rachell Schutt. Doing data science. O’Reilley
● Joel Grus. Data science from scratch. O’Reilley
● https://go.oracle.com
● https://sfmagazine.com
● https://hbr.org/
● https://www.tableau.com
● http://country.eiu.com
● https://en.wikipedia.org
● https://vdl.sci.utah.edu
● https://towardsdatascience.com
D
ata mining, also known as knowledge discovery in data (KDD), is the extraction of patterns and other
useful information from massive data sets. Given the advancement of data warehousing technologies
and the expansion of big data, the use of data mining techniques has advanced dramatically over the
past two decades, supporting businesses in translating their raw data into meaningful information.
Nevertheless, despite the fact that technology is always evolving to manage massive amounts of data, leaders
continue to struggle with scalability and automation.
Through smart data analytics, data mining has enhanced corporate decision making. The data mining techniques
behind these investigations may be categorised into two primary purposes: describing the target dataset or
predicting results using machine learning algorithms. These strategies are used to organise and filter data, bringing
to the surface the most relevant information, including fraud detection, user habits, bottlenecks, and even security
breaches.
When paired with data analytics and visualisation technologies like as Apache Spark, data mining has never been
more accessible and the extraction of valuable insights has never been quicker. Artificial intelligence advancements
continue to accelerate adoption across sectors.
Based on the dataset, an extra step may be done to minimise the number of dimensions, as an excessive
amount of features might slow down any further calculation. Data scientists seek to maintain the most
essential predictors to guarantee optimal model accuracy.
(iii) Model building and pattern mining:
Data scientists may study any intriguing relationship between the data, such as frequent patterns, clustering
algorithms, or correlations, depending on the sort of research. While high frequency patterns have larger
applicability, data variations can often be more fascinating, exposing possible fraud areas.
Depending on the available data, deep learning algorithms may also be utilised to categorise or cluster a
data collection. If the input data is marked (i.e. supervised learning), a classification model may be used to
categorise data, or a regression may be employed to forecast the probability of a specific assignment. If the
dataset is unlabeled (i.e. unsupervised learning), the particular data points in the training set are compared to
uncover underlying commonalities, then clustered based on those features.
(iv) Result evaluation and implementation of knowledge:
After aggregating the data, the findings must be analysed and understood. When completing results, they
must be valid, original, practical, and comprehensible. When this criterion is satisfied, companies can execute
new strategies based on this understanding, therefore attaining their intended goals.
B
usinesses utilise analytics to study and evaluate their data, and then translate their discoveries into insights
that eventually aid executives, managers, and operational personnel in making more educated and
prudent business choices. Descriptive analytics, which examines what has occurred in a firm, diagnostic
analytics, which explores why did it occur, predictive analytics, which examines what could occur, and
prescriptive analytics, which examines what should occur, are the four most important forms of analytics used by
enterprises. While each of these approaches has its own distinct insights, benefits, and drawbacks in their use, when
combined, these analytics tools may be an exceptionally valuable asset for a corporation.
It is also essential to examine the privacy principles while utilising data. Public entities and the business
sector should consider individual privacy when using data analytics. As more and more firms seek to big data
(huge, complex data sets) to raise revenue and enhance corporate efficiency and effectiveness, regulations
are becoming increasingly required.
Vesset states that in order to correctly measure against KPIs, businesses must catalogue and arrange the appropriate
data sources in order to extract the necessary data and generate metrics depending on the present status of the
business.
Step 3: Preparation and collection of data: Data preparation, which includes publication, transformation, and
cleaning, occurs prior to analysis and is a crucial step for ensuring correctness; it is also one of the most time-
consuming tasks for the analyst.
Step 4: Analysis of data: Utilizing summary statistics, clustering, pattern tracking, and regression analysis, we
discover data trends and evaluate performance.
Step 5: Presentation of data: Lastly, charts and graphs are utilised to portray findings in a manner that non-
experts in analytics may comprehend.
X
ML is a file format and markup language for storing, transferring, and recreating arbitrary data. It specifies
a set of standards for encoding texts in a format that is understandable by both humans and machines. XML
is defined by the 1998 XML 1.0 Specification of the World Wide Web Consortium and numerous other
related specifications, which are all free open standards.
XML’s design objectives stress Internet usability, universality, and simplicity. It is a textual data format with
significant support for many human languages via Unicode. Although XML’s architecture is centred on texts, the
language is commonly used to express arbitrary data structures, such as those employed by web services.
Several schema systems exist to help in the design of XML-based languages, and numerous application
programming interfaces (APIs) have been developed by programmers to facilitate the processing of XML data.
Serialization, or storing, sending, and rebuilding arbitrary data, is the primary function of XML. In order for
two dissimilar systems to share data, they must agree on a file format. XML normalises this procedure. XML is
comparable to a universal language for describing information.
As a markup language, XML labels, categorises, and arranges information systematically.
The data structure is represented by XML tags, which also contain information. The information included within
the tags is encoded according to the XML standard. A supplementary XML schema (XSD) defines the required
metadata for reading and verifying XML. This is likewise known as the canonical schema. A “well-formed” XML
document complies to fundamental XML principles, whereas a “valid” document adheres to its schema.
IETF RFC 7303 (which supersedes the previous RFC 3023) specifies the criteria for constructing media types for
use in XML messages. It specifies the application/xml and text/xml media types. They are utilised for transferring
unmodified XML files without revealing their intrinsic meanings. RFC 7303 also suggests that media types for
XML-based languages end in +xml, such as image/svg+xml for SVG.
RFC 3470, commonly known as IETF BCP 70, provides further recommendations for the use of XML in a
networked setting. This document covers many elements of building and implementing an XML-based language.
Numerous industrial data standards, including Health Level 7, OpenTravel Alliance, FpML, MISMO, and
National Information Exchange Model, are founded on XML and the extensive capabilities of the XML schema
definition. Darwin Information Typing Architecture is an XML industry data standard in publishing. Numerous
publication formats rely heavily on XML as their basis.
XBRL for G/L Journal XBRL for Financial XBRL for Regulatory
Entry Reporting Statements Filings
Financial
Participants COMPANIES Publisher and Investors
Data Aggregators
Trading Managements
Auditors Regulators
Partners Accountants
SOFTWARE VENDORS
XBRL allows organisations to arrange data using tags. When a piece of data is labelled as “revenue,” for instance,
XBRL enabled applications know that it pertains to revenue. It conforms to a fixed definition of income and may
appropriately utilise it. The integrity of the data is safeguarded by norms that have been already accepted. In
addition, XBRL offers expanded contextual information on the precise data content of financial documents. For
example, when a a monetary amount is stated. XBRL tags may designate the data as “currency” or “accounts”
within a report.
With XBRL, a business, a person, or another software programme may quickly produce a variety of output
formats and reports based on a financial statement.
# BI Methods:
Company intelligence is a broad word that encompasses the procedures and methods of gathering, storing,
and evaluating data from business operations or activities in order to maximise performance. All of these factors
combine to provide a full perspective of a firm, enabling individuals to make better, proactive decisions. In recent
years, business intelligence has expanded to incorporate more procedures and activities designed to enhance
performance. These procedures consist of:
(i) Data mining: Large datasets may be mined for patterns using databases, analytics, and machine learning
(ML).
(ii) Reporting: The dissemination of data analysis to stakeholders in order for them to form conclusions and
make decisions.
(iii) Performance metrics and benchmarking: Comparing current performance data to previous performance
data in order to measure performance versus objectives, generally utilising customised dashboards.
(iv) Descriptive analytics: Utilizing basic data analysis to determine what transpired
(v) Querying: BI extracts responses from data sets in response to data-specific queries.
(vi) Statistical analysis: Taking the results of descriptive analytics and use statistics to further explore the data,
such as how and why this pattern occurred.
(vii) Data Visualization: Data consumption is facilitated by transforming data analysis into visual representations
such as charts, graphs, and histograms.
(viii) Visual Analysis: Exploring data using visual storytelling to share findings in real-time and maintain the
flow of analysis.
(ix) Data Preparation: Multiple data source compilation, dimension and measurement identification, and data
analysis preparation.
famous “Turing Test,” in which a human interrogator attempts to differentiate between a machine and a human
written answer. Although this test has been subjected to considerable examination since its publication, it remains
an essential aspect of the history of artificial intelligence and a continuing philosophical thought that employs
principles from linguistics.
Stuart Russell and Peter Norvig then published ‘Artificial Intelligence: A Modern Approach’, which has since
become one of the most influential AI textbooks. In it, they discuss four alternative aims or definitions of artificial
intelligence, which distinguish computer systems based on reasoning and thinking vs. acting:
~ Human approach:
● Systems that think like humans
● Systems that act like humans
~ Ideal approach:
● Systems that think rationally
● Systems that act rationally
Artificial intelligence is, in its simplest form, a topic that combines computer science and substantial datasets
to allow problem-solving. In addition, it includes the subfields of machine learning and deep learning, which are
commonly associated with artificial intelligence. These fields consist of AI algorithms that aim to develop expert
systems that make predictions or classifications based on input data.
As expected with any new developing technology on the market, AI development is still surrounded by a great
deal of hype. According to Gartner’s hype cycle, self-driving vehicles and personal assistants follow “a normal
evolution of innovation, from overenthusiasm through disillusionment to an ultimate grasp of the innovation’s
importance and position in a market or area.” According to Lex Fridman’s 2019 MIT lecture, we are at the top of
inflated expectations and nearing the trough of disillusionment.
AI has several applications in the area of financial services (fig 11.2).
(iii) Insurance Claim Processing (ii) Retail and commercial lending scores
ARTIFICIAL INTELLIGENCE
IN FINANCE
Weak AI, also known as Narrow AI or Artificial Narrow Intelligence (ANI), is AI that has been trained and
honed to do particular tasks. Most of the AI that surrounds us today is powered by weak AI. This form of artificial
intelligence is anything but feeble; it allows sophisticated applications such as Apple’s Siri, Amazon’s Alexa, IBM
Watson, and driverless cars, among others.
Artificial General Intelligence (AGI) and Artificial Super Intelligence (AIS) comprise strong AI (ASI). Artificial
general intelligence (AGI), sometimes known as general artificial intelligence (AI), is a hypothetical kind of artificial
intelligence in which a machine possesses human-level intellect, a self-aware consciousness, and the ability to
solve problems, learn, and plan for the future. Superintelligence, also known as Artificial Super Intelligence (ASI),
would transcend the intelligence and capabilities of the human brain. Despite the fact that strong AI is yet totally
theoretical and has no practical applications, this does not preclude AI researchers from studying its development.
In the meanwhile, the finest instances of ASI may come from science fiction, such as HAL from 2001: A Space
Odyssey, a superhuman, rogue computer aide.
Artificial Intelligence
Machine Learning
Deep Learning
can function continuously, around-the-clock, and with 100 percent accuracy and dependability.
Robotic Process Automation bots possess a digital skill set that exceeds that of humans. Consider RPA bots to
be a Digital Workforce capable of interacting with any system or application. Bots may copy-paste, scrape site
data, do computations, access and transfer files, analyse emails, log into programmes, connect to APIs, and extract
unstructured data, among other tasks. Due to the adaptability of bots to any interface or workflow, there is no need
to modify existing corporate systems, apps, or processes in order to automate.
RPA bots are simple to configure, utilise, and distribute. You will be able to configure RPA bots if you know how
to record video on a mobile device. Moving files around at work is as simple as pressing record, play, and stop
buttons and utilising drag-and-drop. RPA bots may be scheduled, copied, altered, and shared to conduct enterprise-
wide business operations.
Benefits of RPA
(i) Higher productivity
(ii) Higher accuracy
(iii) Saving of cost
(iv) Integration across platforms
(v) Better customer experience
(vi) Harnessing AI
(vii) Scalability
I
n artificial intelligence, there are two schools of thought: data-driven and model-driven. The data-driven
strategy focuses on enhancing data quality and data governance in order to enhance the performance of a
particular problem statement. In contrast, the model-driven method attempts to increase performance by
developing new models and algorithmic manipulations (or upgrades). In a perfect world, these should go
hand in hand, but in fact, model-driven techniques have advanced far more than data-driven ones. In terms of
data governance, data management, data quality handling, and general awareness, there is still much room for
improvement.
Recent work on Covid-19 serves as an illustration in this perspective. While the globe was struggling from the
epidemic, several AI-related projects emerged. Whether it’s recognising Covid-19 from a CT scan, X-ray, or other
medical imaging, estimating the course of the disease, or even projecting the overall number of fatalities, artificial
intelligence is essential. On the one hand, this extensive effort around the globe has increased our understanding
of the illness and, in certain locations, assisted clinical personnel in their work with vast populations. However,
only few of the vast quantity of work was judged suitable for any actual implementation procedure, such as in the
healthcare industry. Primarily data quality difficulties are responsible for this deficiency in practicality. Numerous
projects and studies utilised duplicate photos from different sources. Even still, training data are notably lacking in
external validation and demographic information. The majority of these studies would fail a systematic review and
fail to reveal biases. Consequently, the quoted performance cannot be applied to real-world scenarios.
A crucial feature of Data science to keep in mind is that poor data will never result in superior performance,
regardless of how strong your model is. Real-world applications require an understanding of systematic data
collection, management, and consumption for a Data Science project. Only then can society reap the rewards of
the ‘wonderful AI’.
Solved Case 1
Arjun joined as an instructor in a higher learning institution. His responsibility is to teach data analysis
to students. He is particularly interested in teaching analytics and model building. Arjun was preparing a teaching
plan for the new upcoming batch.
What elements do you think, he should incorporate into the plan.
Teaching note - outline for solution:
The instructor may explain first the utility of data analytics from the perspective of business organizations.
He may explain how data analytics may translate their discoveries into insights that eventually aid executives,
managers, and operational personnel in making more educated and prudent business choices.
He may further explain the four forms of data analytics:
(i) Descriptive analytics
(ii) Diagnostic analytics
(iii) Predictive analytics
(iv) Prescriptive analytics
The instructor should explain each of the terms along with their appropriateness in using under real-life problem
situations.
The advantages and disadvantages of using each of the methods should also be discussed thoroughly.
Exercise
A. Theoretical Questions:
~ Multiple Choice Questions
1. Following are the benefits of data analytics
(a) Improves decision making process
(b) Increase in efficiency of operations
(c) Improved service to stakeholders
(d) All of the above
2. Following are the techniques of data mining
(a) Association rules
(b) Neural network
(c) Decision tree
(d) All of the above
3. XML is the abbreviated form of
(a) Extensible mark-up language
(b) Extended mark-up language
(c) Extendable mark-up language
(d) Extensive mark-up language
4. XBRL is the abbreviated form of
(a) eXtensible Business Reporting Language
(b) eXtensive Business Reporting Language
(c) eXtended Business Reporting Language
(d) eXtensive Business Reporting Language
5. Following are the types of cloud computing
(a) Private cloud
(b) Public cloud
(c) Hybrid cloud
(d) All of the above
Answer:
1 d 2 d 3 a 4 a 5 d
~ State True or False
1. Decision tree classifies or predicts likely outcomes based on a collection of decisions.
2. K-nearest neighbour, often known as the KNN algorithm, classifies data points depending on their
closeness to and correlation with other accessible data.
3. Utilizing data mining techniques, hidden patterns and future trends and behaviours in financial
markets may be predicted.
4. Social analytics are virtually always a type of descriptive analytics.
5. Diagnostic analytics highlights the tools are employed to question the data, “Why did this occur?”
Answer:
1 T 2 T 3 T 4 T 5 T
References:
● Davy Cielen, Arno D B Meysman, and Mohamed Ali. Introducing Data Science. Manning Publications Co
USA
● Cathy O’Neil, Rachell Schutt. Doing data science. O’Reilley
● Joel Grus. Data science from scratch. O’Reilley
● https://corporatefinanceinstitute.com
● https://www.ibm.com
● https://studyonline.unsw.edu.au
● https://www.tableau.com
● https://www.automationanywhere.com
● John McCarthy, What is artificial intelligence? http://www-formal.stanford.edu/jmc/
● Understanding the XML Standard for Business Reporting and Finance. White paper. Software AG
Period(n)/
1% 2% 3% 4% 5% 6% 7% 8% 9% 10% 11% 12% 13% 14% 15% 16% 20%
percent(k)
1 1.0100 1.0200 1.0300 1.0400 1.0500 1.0600 1.0700 1.0800 1.0900 1.1000 1.1100 1.1200 1.1300 1.1400 1.1500 1.1600 1.2000
2 1.0201 1.0404 1.0609 1.0816 1.1025 1.1236 1.1449 1.1664 1.1881 1.2100 1.2321 1.2544 1.2769 1.2996 1.3225 1.3456 1.4400
3 1.0303 1.0612 1.0927 1.1249 1.1576 1.1910 1.2250 1.2597 1.2950 1.3310 1.3676 1.4049 1.4429 1.4815 1.5209 1.5609 1.7280
4 1.0406 1.0824 1.1255 1.1699 1.2155 1.2625 1.3108 1.3605 1.4116 1.4641 1.5181 1.5735 1.6305 1.6890 1.7490 1.8106 2.0736
5 1.0510 1.1041 1.1593 1.2167 1.2763 1.3382 1.4026 1.4693 1.5386 1.6105 1.6851 1.7623 1.8424 1.9254 2.0114 2.1003 2.4883
645
Data Analysis and Modelling
25 1.2824 1.6406 2.0938 2.6658 3.3864 4.2919 5.4274 6.8485 8.6231 10.8347 13.5855 17.0001 21.2305 26.4619 32.9190 40.8742 95.3962
Present value and Future value tables
646
Table 2 - Future value interest factors for an annuity. Formula: FV = [(1 + k)^n - 1] / k
Period
(n)/per 1% 2% 3% 4% 5% 6% 7% 8% 9% 10% 11% 12% 13% 14% 15% 16% 20%
cent(k)
1 1.0000 1.0200 1.0300 1.0400 1.0500 1.0600 1.0700 1.0800 1.0900 1.1000 1.1100 1.1200 1.1300 1.1400 1.1500 1.1600 1.2000
2 2.0100 2.0200 2.0300 2.0400 2.0500 2.0600 2.0700 2.0800 2.0900 2.1000 2.1100 2.1200 2.1300 2.1400 2.1500 2.1600 2.2000
3 3.0301 3.0604 3.0909 3.1216 3.1525 3.1836 3.2149 3.2464 3.2781 3.3100 3.3421 3.3744 3.4069 3.4396 3.4725 3.5056 3.6400
4 4.0604 4.1216 4.1836 4.2465 4.3101 4.3746 4.4399 4.5061 4.5731 4.6410 4.7097 4.7793 4.8498 4.9211 4.9934 5.0665 5.3680
5 5.1010 5.2040 5.3091 5.4163 5.5256 5.6371 5.7507 5.8666 5.9847 6.1051 6.2278 6.3528 6.4803 6.6101 6.7424 6.8771 7.4416
6 6.1520 6.3081 6.4684 6.6330 6.8019 6.9753 7.1533 7.3359 7.5233 7.7156 7.9129 8.1152 8.3227 8.5355 8.7537 8.9775 9.9299
7 7.2135 7.4343 7.6625 7.8983 8.1420 8.3938 8.6540 8.9228 9.2004 9.4872 9.7833 10.0890 10.4047 10.7305 11.0668 11.4139 12.9159
8 8.2857 8.5830 8.8923 9.2142 9.5491 9.8975 10.2598 10.6366 11.0285 11.4359 11.8594 12.2997 12.7573 13.2328 13.7268 14.2401 16.4991
9 9.3685 9.7546 10.1591 10.5828 11.0266 11.4913 11.9780 12.4876 13.0210 13.5795 14.1640 14.7757 15.4157 16.0853 16.7858 17.5185 20.7989
10 10.4622 10.9497 11.4639 12.0061 12.5779 13.1808 13.8164 14.4866 15.1929 15.9374 16.7220 17.5487 18.4197 19.3373 20.3037 21.3215 25.9587
Financial Management and Business Data Analytics
11 11.5668 12.1687 12.8078 13.4864 14.2068 14.9716 15.7836 16.6455 17.5603 18.5312 19.5614 20.6546 21.8143 23.0445 24.3493 25.7329 32.1504
12 12.6825 13.4121 14.1920 15.0258 15.9171 16.8699 17.8885 18.9771 20.1407 21.3843 22.7132 24.1331 25.6502 27.2707 29.0017 30.8502 39.5805
13 13.8093 14.6803 15.6178 16.6268 17.7130 18.8821 20.1406 21.4953 22.9534 24.5227 26.2116 28.0291 29.9847 32.0887 34.3519 36.7862 48.4966
14 14.9474 15.9739 17.0863 18.2919 19.5986 21.0151 22.5505 24.2149 26.0192 27.9750 30.0949 32.3926 34.8827 37.5811 40.5047 43.6720 59.1959
15 16.0969 17.2934 18.5989 20.0236 21.5786 23.2760 25.1290 27.1521 29.3609 31.7725 34.4054 37.2797 40.4175 43.8424 47.5804 51.6595 72.0351
16 17.2579 18.6393 20.1569 21.8245 23.6575 25.6725 27.8881 30.3243 33.0034 35.9497 39.1899 42.7533 46.6717 50.9804 55.7175 60.9250 87.4421
17 18.4304 20.0121 21.7616 23.6975 25.8404 28.2129 30.8402 33.7502 36.9737 40.5447 44.5008 48.8837 53.7391 59.1176 65.0751 71.6730 105.931
18 19.6147 21.4123 23.4144 25.6454 28.1324 30.9057 33.9990 37.4502 41.3013 45.5992 50.3959 55.7497 61.7251 68.3941 75.8364 84.1407 128.117
19 20.8109 22.8406 25.1169 27.6712 30.5390 33.7600 37.3790 41.4463 46.0185 51.1591 56.9395 63.4397 70.7494 78.9692 88.2118 98.6032 154.740
20 22.0190 24.2974 26.8704 29.7781 33.0660 36.7856 40.9955 45.7620 51.1601 57.2750 64.2028 72.0524 80.9468 91.0249 102.444 115.380 186.688
21 23.2392 25.7833 28.6765 31.9692 35.7193 39.9927 44.8652 50.4229 56.7645 64.0025 72.2651 81.6987 92.4699 104.768 118.810 134.841 225.026
22 24.4716 27.2990 30.5368 34.2480 38.5052 43.3923 49.0057 55.4568 62.8733 71.4027 81.2143 92.5026 105.491 120.436 137.632 157.415 271.031
23 25.7163 28.8450 32.4529 36.6179 41.4305 46.9958 53.4361 60.8933 69.5319 79.5430 91.1479 104.603 120.205 138.297 159.276 183.601 326.237
24 26.9735 30.4219 34.4265 39.0826 44.5020 50.8156 58.1767 66.7648 76.7898 88.4973 102.174 118.155 136.831 158.659 184.168 213.978 392.484
25 28.2432 32.0303 36.4593 41.6459 47.7271 54.8645 63.2490 73.1059 84.7009 98.3471 114.413 133.334 155.620 181.871 212.793 249.214 471.981
647
25 0.7798 0.6095 0.4776 0.3751 0.2953 0.2330 0.1842 0.1460 0.1160 0.0923 0.0736 0.0588 0.0471 0.0378 0.0304 0.0245 0.0105
Data Analysis and Modelling
Present value and Future value tables
648
Table 4 - Present value interest factors for an annuity. Formula: PV = [1 - 1/(1 + k)^n] / k
Period
(n)/per 1% 2% 3% 4% 5% 6% 7% 8% 9% 10% 11% 12% 13% 14% 15% 16% 20%
cent(k)
1 0.9901 0.9804 0.9709 0.9615 0.9524 0.9434 0.9346 0.9259 0.9174 0.9091 0.9009 0.8929 0.8850 0.8772 0.8696 0.8621 0.8333
2 1.9704 1.9416 1.9135 1.8861 1.8594 1.8334 1.8080 1.7833 1.7591 1.7355 1.7125 1.6901 1.6681 1.6467 1.6257 1.6052 1.5278
3 2.9410 2.8839 2.8286 2.7751 2.7232 2.6730 2.6243 2.5771 2.5313 2.4869 2.4437 2.4018 2.3612 2.3216 2.2832 2.2459 2.1065
4 3.9020 3.8077 3.7171 3.6299 3.5460 3.4651 3.3872 3.3121 3.2397 3.1699 3.1024 3.0373 2.9745 2.9137 2.8550 2.7982 2.5887
5 4.8534 4.7135 4.5797 4.4518 4.3295 4.2124 4.1002 3.9927 3.8897 3.7908 3.6959 3.6048 3.5172 3.4331 3.3522 3.2743 2.9906
6 5.7955 5.6014 5.4172 5.2421 5.0757 4.9173 4.7665 4.6229 4.4859 4.3553 4.2305 4.1114 3.9975 3.8887 3.7845 3.6847 3.3255
7 6.7282 6.4720 6.2303 6.0021 5.7864 5.5824 5.3893 5.2064 5.0330 4.8684 4.7122 4.5638 4.4226 4.2883 4.1604 4.0386 3.6046
8 7.6517 7.3255 7.0197 6.7327 6.4632 6.2098 5.9713 5.7466 5.5348 5.3349 5.1461 4.9676 4.7988 4.6389 4.4873 4.3436 3.8372
9 8.5660 8.1622 7.7861 7.4353 7.1078 6.8017 6.5152 6.2469 5.9952 5.7590 5.5370 5.3282 5.1317 4.9464 4.7716 4.6065 4.0310
10 9.4713 8.9826 8.5302 8.1109 7.7217 7.3601 7.0236 6.7101 6.4177 6.1446 5.8892 5.6502 5.4262 5.2161 5.0188 4.8332 4.1925
Financial Management and Business Data Analytics
11 10.3676 9.7868 9.2526 8.7605 8.3064 7.8869 7.4987 7.1390 6.8052 6.4951 6.2065 5.9377 5.6869 5.4527 5.2337 5.0286 4.3271
12 11.2551 10.5753 9.9540 9.3851 8.8633 8.3838 7.9427 7.5361 7.1607 6.8137 6.4924 6.1944 5.9176 5.6603 5.4206 5.1971 4.4392
13 12.1337 11.3484 10.6350 9.9856 9.3936 8.8527 8.3577 7.9038 7.4869 7.1034 6.7499 6.4235 6.1218 5.8424 5.5831 5.3423 4.5327
14 13.0037 12.1062 11.2961 10.5631 9.8986 9.2950 8.7455 8.2442 7.7862 7.3667 6.9819 6.6282 6.3025 6.0021 5.7245 5.4675 4.6106
15 13.8651 12.8493 11.9379 11.1184 10.3797 9.7122 9.1079 8.5595 8.0607 7.6061 7.1909 6.8109 6.4624 6.1422 5.8474 5.5755 4.6755
16 14.7179 13.5777 12.5611 11.6523 10.8378 10.1059 9.4466 8.8514 8.3126 7.8237 7.3792 6.9740 6.6039 6.2651 5.9542 5.6685 4.7296
17 15.5623 14.2919 13.1661 12.1657 11.2741 10.4773 9.7632 9.1216 8.5436 8.0216 7.5488 7.1196 6.7291 6.3729 6.0472 5.7487 4.7746
18 16.3983 14.9920 13.7535 12.6593 11.6896 10.8276 10.0591 9.3719 8.7556 8.2014 7.7016 7.2497 6.8399 6.4674 6.1280 5.8178 4.8122
19 17.2260 15.6785 14.3238 13.1339 12.0853 11.1581 10.3356 9.6036 8.9501 8.3649 7.8393 7.3658 6.9380 6.5504 6.1982 5.8775 4.8435
20 18.0456 16.3514 14.8775 13.5903 12.4622 11.4699 10.5940 9.8181 9.1285 8.5136 7.9633 7.4694 7.0248 6.6231 6.2593 5.9288 4.8696
21 18.8570 17.0112 15.4150 14.0292 12.8212 11.7641 10.8355 10.0168 9.2922 8.6487 8.0751 7.5620 7.1016 6.6870 6.3125 5.9731 4.8913
22 19.6604 17.6580 15.9369 14.4511 13.1630 12.0416 11.0612 10.2007 9.4424 8.7715 8.1757 7.6446 7.1695 6.7429 6.3587 6.0113 4.9094
23 20.4558 18.2922 16.4436 14.8568 13.4886 12.3034 11.2722 10.3711 9.5802 8.8832 8.2664 7.7184 7.2297 6.7921 6.3988 6.0442 4.9245
24 21.2434 18.9139 16.9355 15.2470 13.7986 12.5504 11.4693 10.5288 9.7066 8.9847 8.3481 7.7843 7.2829 6.8351 6.4338 6.0726 4.9371
25 22.0232 19.5235 17.4131 15.6221 14.0939 12.7834 11.6536 10.6748 9.8226 9.0770 8.4217 7.8431 7.3300 6.8729 6.4641 6.0971 4.9476